Official Software
Get notified when we add a new FordTransit Manual

We cover 60 Ford vehicles, were you looking for one of these?

Ford - Ranger - Workshop Manual - 1983 - 2011
Ford Focus Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L (2009))
Ford - Escape - Workshop Manual - 2010 - 2010
Ford - Fiesta - Workshop Manual - 2007 - 2007
Ford Edge 06 07 08 09 2010 Service Repair Manual
Ford Explorer Sport Trac 4wd Workshop Manual (V6-245 4.0L SOHC VIN K SFI (2001))
Ford Fusion Fwd Workshop Manual (L4-2.3L (2008))
Ford - Figo - Workshop Manual - 2010 - 2010
Ford Focus Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L VIN N (2006))
Ford Ranger Service Repair Manual PDF
Ford - Mustang - Parts Catalogue - 1964 - 1973
2001-2006 Ford Escape Repair Manual
Ford - F 150 - Workshop Manual - (2008)
Ford Mondeo 2007.5 02.2007 Workshop Manual ((02.2007-))
Ford - KA - Workshop Manual - 1996 - 2008
Ford Focus 2002 Wiring Diagram PDF
Ford Explorer 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-4.6L SOHC VIN W (2004))
Ford Ranger 2wd Workshop Manual (L4-153 2.5L SOHC VIN C SFI (1998))
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L SOHC VIN 5 (2005))
Ford Flex Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2009))
Ford Freestyle Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.0L VIN 1 (2005))
Ford - Taurus - Workshop Manual - 2002 - 2002
Ford - Focus ST - Workshop Manual - 2010 - 2011
Ford Mustang Workshop Manual (V6-4.0L VIN N (2006))
Ford Explorer 4wd Workshop Manual (V6-245 4.0L SOHC VIN K SFI (2001))
Ford - Escape - Workshop Manual - 2009 - 2009
Ford Escort Zx2 Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L DOHC VIN 3 (2000))
Ford Fusion Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.0L (2009))
Ford Explorer Sport Trac 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.0L VIN E (2002))
Ford Ranger 4wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.0L VIN E (2001))
Ford Ranger 2wd Workshop Manual (L4-2.3L VIN D (2001))
Ford Thunderbird Workshop Manual (V6-232 3.8L SC (1989))
Ford Mondeo 2001 10.2000-02.2007 Workshop Manual ((10.2000-02.2007))
Ford Taurus Workshop Manual (V6-3.0L VIN U (2000))
Ford Edge Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2007))
Ford - Ranger Pick-ups - Owners Manual - 1993 - 2005
Ford Freestar Workshop Manual (V6-4.2L VIN 2 (2004))
2001 Ford Ranger Service & Repair Manual
Ford - Focus - Workshop Manual - (2004)
Ford - Ranger - Workshop Manual - (2015)
Ford Mustang Workshop Manual (V8-4.6L SOHC VIN X (2003))
Ford Fusion Fwd Workshop Manual (L4-2.5L Hybrid (2010))
Ford Explorer 4wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.0L VIN E (1999))
Ford - Focus - Owners Manual - 2007 - 2012
Ford Focus Workshop Manual (L4-2.0L DOHC VIN 3 (2002))
Ford Fusion Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2010))
Ford - Ranger Courier - Workshop Manual - 1999 - 1906
Ford Mustang Workshop Manual (V6-3.9L VIN 6 (2004))
Ford Ranger 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-3.0L VIN U (1998))
Ford Escape 4wd Workshop Manual (L4-2.3L VIN H Hybrid (2005))
Ford Expedition 2wd Workshop Manual (V8-281 4.6L SOHC (1998))
Ford - F 250 - Workshop Manual - 1980 - 1997
Ford Windstar Workshop Manual (V6-3.8L VIN 4 (1997))
Ford Bronco Workshop Manual (V8-351 5.8L VIN G 2-bbl (1982))
Ford Taurus Workshop Manual (V6-3.0L DOHC VIN S (2000))
Ford Crown Victoria Workshop Manual (V8-4.6L SOHC VIN 6 (1996))
Ford - F 150 - Workshop Manual - 1992 - 1997
Ford - Explorer - Workshop Manual - 2000 - 2000
Ford Thunderbird Workshop Manual (V8-281 4.6L SOHC (1994))
Ford Escape 4wd Workshop Manual (V6-3.0L (2008))
Summary of Content
2015 TRANSIT Owner’s Manual 2015 TRANSIT Owner’s Manual fordowner.com ford.ca May 2014 Second Printing Owner’s Manual Transit Litho in U.S.A. FK3J 19A321 AB The information contained in this publication was correct at the time of going to print. In the interest of continuous development, we reserve the right to change specifications, design or equipment at any time without notice or obligation. No part of this publication may be reproduced, transmitted, stored in a retrieval system or translated into any language in any form by any means without our written permission. Errors and omissions excepted. © Ford Motor Company 2014 All rights reserved. Part Number: 03/2014 20140509210105 Table of Contents Introduction Keys and Remote Controls About This Manual...........................................7 Symbols Glossary.............................................7 Data Recording..................................................9 California Proposition 65.............................10 Perchlorate........................................................10 Ford Credit.........................................................10 Replacement Parts Recommendation......................................10 Special Notices.................................................11 Mobile Communications Equipment......................................................11 Export Unique Options...................................11 Principle of Operation..................................44 General Information on Radio Frequencies..................................................44 Remote Control..............................................44 Replacing a Lost Key or Remote Control...........................................................46 MyKey™ Principle of Operation...................................47 Creating a MyKey............................................47 Clearing All MyKeys.......................................48 Checking MyKey System Status..............50 Using MyKey With Remote Start Systems..........................................................51 MyKey Troubleshooting...............................52 Child Safety General Information.......................................13 Installing Child Seats.....................................14 Booster Seats..................................................22 Child Seat Positioning..................................24 Child Safety Locks..........................................25 Locks Locking and Unlocking.................................54 Security Passive Anti-Theft System........................59 Anti-Theft Alarm...........................................60 Safety Belts Principle of Operation...................................27 Fastening the Safety Belts.........................28 Safety Belt Height Adjustment................30 Safety Belt Warning Lamp and Indicator Chime.............................................................30 Safety Belt Minder..........................................31 Child Restraint and Safety Belt Maintenance................................................32 Steering Wheel Adjusting the Steering Wheel....................61 Audio Control - Vehicles Without: Touchscreen Display..................................61 Audio Control - Vehicles With: Touchscreen Display.................................62 Voice Control - Vehicles Without: Touchscreen Display.................................62 Voice Control - Vehicles With: Touchscreen Display.................................62 Cruise Control..................................................63 Information Display Control.......................63 Supplementary Restraints System Principle of Operation - Canada/United States of America......................................33 Driver and Passenger Airbags...................34 Side Airbags.....................................................40 Safety Canopy™.............................................41 Crash Sensors and Airbag Indicator........42 Airbag Disposal...............................................43 Wipers and Washers Windshield Wipers........................................64 Autowipers.......................................................64 Windshield Washers.....................................65 1 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Table of Contents Power Seats.....................................................98 Rear Seats........................................................99 Lighting General Information.....................................66 Lighting Control..............................................66 Autolamps........................................................67 Instrument Lighting Dimmer.....................68 Daytime Running Lamps............................68 Direction Indicators.......................................69 Interior Lamps.................................................69 Auxiliary Power Points Auxiliary Power Points................................103 Cigar Lighter...................................................104 Storage Compartments Cup Holders....................................................105 Overhead Console.......................................105 Bottle Holder..................................................105 Windows and Mirrors Power Windows..............................................70 Exterior Mirrors..................................................71 Interior Mirror.....................................................71 Rear Quarter Windows.................................72 Starting and Stopping the Engine General Information....................................106 Ignition Switch..............................................106 Starting a Gasoline Engine.......................106 Starting a Diesel Engine.............................107 Diesel Particulate Filter..............................108 Switching Off the Engine..........................109 Engine Block Heater....................................109 Instrument Cluster Gauges................................................................73 Warning Lamps and Indicators.................75 Audible Warnings and Indicators..............77 Information Displays General Information......................................79 Trip Computer.................................................82 Personalized Settings..................................83 Information Messages.................................84 Fuel and Refueling Safety Precautions.........................................111 Fuel Quality - Gasoline................................112 Fuel Quality - Diesel......................................113 Running Out of Fuel......................................115 Catalytic Converter.......................................116 Selective Catalytic Reduction System...........................................................117 Refueling..........................................................120 Fuel Consumption........................................122 Emission Control System...........................122 Climate Control Principle of Operation..................................89 Air Vents............................................................89 Manual Climate Control..............................90 Hints on Controlling the Interior Climate...........................................................91 Rear Passenger Climate Controls............93 Heated Windows and Mirrors....................93 Transmission Automatic Transmission............................133 Seats Sitting in the Correct Position...................95 Head Restraints..............................................95 Manual Seats...................................................97 Brakes General Information.....................................137 2 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Table of Contents Hints on Driving With Anti-Lock Brakes............................................................137 Parking Brake.................................................138 Reduced Engine Performance.................173 Economical Driving.......................................173 Cold Weather Precautions........................174 Driving Through Water................................174 Floor Mats........................................................174 Traction Control Principle of Operation.................................139 Using Traction Control................................139 Roadside Emergencies Roadside Assistance...................................176 Hazard Warning Flashers...........................177 Fuel Shutoff.....................................................177 Jump Starting the Vehicle.........................178 Post-Crash Alert System...........................180 Stability Control Principle of Operation..................................141 Using Stability Control................................142 Parking Aids Principle of Operation.................................143 Parking Aid......................................................143 Rear View Camera.......................................144 Customer Assistance Load Carrying Getting the Services You Need.................181 In California (U.S. Only).............................182 The Better Business Bureau (BBB) Auto Line Program (U.S. Only)......................183 Utilizing the Mediation/Arbitration Program (Canada Only)........................183 Getting Assistance Outside the U.S. and Canada.........................................................184 Ordering Additional Owner's Literature.....................................................185 Reporting Safety Defects (U.S. Only).............................................................185 Reporting Safety Defects (Canada Only).............................................................186 Load Retaining Fixtures..............................153 Load Limit........................................................153 Fuses Towing Fuse Box Locations......................................187 Fuse Specification Chart...........................188 Changing a Fuse...........................................198 Cruise Control Principle of Operation.................................147 Using Cruise Control....................................147 Driving Aids Speed Limiter................................................149 Driver Alert......................................................149 Lane Keeping System.................................150 Towing a Trailer..............................................161 Trailer Sway Control....................................162 Recommended Towing Weights............162 Essential Towing Checks...........................164 Transporting the Vehicle............................170 Towing the Vehicle on Four Wheels........171 Maintenance General Information..................................200 Opening and Closing the Hood.............200 Under Hood Overview - 3.5L....................201 Under Hood Overview - 3.7L...................202 Under Hood Overview - 3.2L Power Stroke Diesel.............................................203 Driving Hints Breaking-In......................................................173 3 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Table of Contents Engine Oil Dipstick - 3.5L.........................204 Engine Oil Dipstick - 3.7L..........................204 Engine Oil Dipstick - 3.2L Power Stroke Diesel...........................................................204 Engine Oil Check..........................................204 Changing the Engine Oil and Oil Filter.............................................................205 Engine Coolant Check...............................206 Automatic Transmission Fluid Check...........................................................209 Brake Fluid Check.........................................210 Power Steering Fluid Check.....................210 Washer Fluid Check.....................................210 Draining the Fuel Filter Water Trap........210 Fuel Filter - Gasoline....................................212 Changing the 12V Battery..........................213 Checking the Wiper Blades.......................215 Changing the Wiper Blades......................215 Adjusting the Headlamps..........................215 Removing a Headlamp...............................216 Changing a Bulb............................................217 Bulb Specification Chart............................221 Changing the Engine Air Filter - 3.5L.....223 Changing the Engine Air Filter - 3.7L......224 Changing the Engine Air Filter - 3.2L Power Stroke Diesel................................225 Engine Specifications - 3.5L....................265 Engine Specifications - 3.7L....................265 Engine Specifications - 3.2L Power Stroke Diesel.............................................266 Motorcraft Parts - 3.5L..............................267 Motorcraft Parts - 3.7L..............................268 Motorcraft Parts - 3.2L Power Stroke Diesel...........................................................269 Vehicle Identification Number................270 Vehicle Certification Label.......................270 Transmission Code Designation..............271 Capacities and Specifications - 3.5L......271 Capacities and Specifications - 3.7L.....274 Capacities and Specifications - 3.2L Power Stroke Diesel................................278 Vehicle Care Audio System Wheels and Tires General Information...................................233 Tire Care..........................................................234 Using Winter Tires.......................................250 Using Snow Chains......................................251 Tire Pressure Monitoring System............251 Changing a Road Wheel...........................256 Technical Specifications...........................264 Capacities and Specifications Cleaning Products........................................227 Cleaning the Exterior...................................227 Waxing.............................................................228 Cleaning the Engine....................................228 Cleaning the Windows and Wiper Blades..........................................................229 Cleaning the Interior...................................229 Cleaning the Instrument Panel and Instrument Cluster Lens.......................229 Repairing Minor Paint Damage..............230 Cleaning the Alloy Wheels.......................230 Vehicle Storage..............................................231 General Information...................................282 Audio Unit - Vehicles With: AM/FM......283 Audio Unit - Vehicles With: Premium AM/ FM/CD.........................................................286 Audio Unit - Vehicles With: AM/FM/CD/ SYNC............................................................288 Audio Unit - Vehicles With: AM/FM/CD/ SYNC/Satellite Radio............................290 Digital Radio..................................................292 Satellite Radio..............................................294 Audio Input Jack...........................................297 USB Port..........................................................297 Media Hub......................................................298 4 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Table of Contents Audio Troubleshooting..............................299 SYNC™ General Information..................................300 Using Voice Recognition...........................302 Using SYNC™ With Your Phone............305 SYNC™ Applications and Services......320 Using SYNC™ With Your Media Player............................................................332 SYNC™ Troubleshooting.........................342 MyFord Touch™ General Information...................................349 Settings............................................................357 Entertainment..............................................368 Phone...............................................................387 Information....................................................395 Navigation.....................................................404 Accessories Accessories.....................................................414 Auxiliary Switches........................................415 Appendices End User License Agreement..................416 Extended Service Plan (ESP) Extended Service Plan (ESP)..................431 Scheduled Maintenance General Maintenance Information........433 Normal Scheduled Maintenance..........436 Special Operating Conditions Scheduled Maintenance.............................................438 Scheduled Maintenance Record............441 5 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 6 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Introduction Note: Either Ford Motor Company or an authorized Ford dealer may have originally sold this incomplete vehicle to a vehicle modifier who upfitted it. As a result, some of the options and features on this vehicle may differ from what we describe in this manual. ABOUT THIS MANUAL Thank you for choosing Ford. We recommend that you take some time to get to know your vehicle by reading this manual. The more that you know about it, the greater the safety and pleasure you will get from driving it. This manual may qualify the location of a component as left-hand side or right-hand side. The side is determined when facing forward in the seat. WARNING Driving while distracted can result in loss of vehicle control, crash and injury. We strongly recommend that you use extreme caution when using any device that may take your focus off the road. Your primary responsibility is the safe operation of your vehicle. We recommend against the use of any handheld device while driving and encourage the use of voice-operated systems when possible. Make sure you are aware of all applicable local laws that may affect the use of electronic devices while driving. E154903 Note: This manual describes product features and options available throughout the range of available models, sometimes even before they are generally available. It may describe options not fitted to your vehicle. A Right-hand side B Left-hand side Protecting the Environment You must play your part in protecting the environment. Correct vehicle usage and the authorized disposal of waste, cleaning and lubrication materials are significant steps toward this aim. Note: Some of the illustrations in this manual may show features as used in different models, so may appear different to you on your vehicle. However, the essential information in the illustrations is always correct. SYMBOLS GLOSSARY Note: Always use and operate your vehicle in line with all applicable laws and regulations. These are some of the symbols you may see on your vehicle. Note: Pass on this manual when selling your vehicle. It is an integral part of the vehicle. Safety alert See Owner's Manual 7 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Introduction Air conditioning system Engine air filter Anti-lock braking system Engine coolant Avoid smoking, flames or sparks Engine coolant temperature Battery Engine oil Battery acid Explosive gas Brake fluid - non petroleum based Fan warning Brake system Fasten safety belt Cabin air filter Front airbag Check fuel cap Front fog lamps Child safety door lock or unlock Fuel pump reset Child seat lower anchor Fuse compartment Child seat tether anchor Hazard warning flashers Cruise control Heated rear window Do not open when hot Heated windshield E162384 E71340 Interior luggage compartment release 8 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Introduction Jack Shield the eyes E167012 Stability control Keep out of reach of children E138639 E161353 Windshield wash and wipe Lighting control Low tire pressure warning DATA RECORDING Maintain correct fluid level A large number of electronic components of your vehicle contain data storage modules temporarily or permanently storing technical data about the condition of the vehicle, events and errors. Note operating instructions In general, this technical information documents the condition of parts, modules, systems or the environment: • Operating conditions of system components (e.g. filling levels). • Status messages of the vehicle and its individual components (e.g. number of wheel revolutions/rotational speed, deceleration, lateral acceleration). • Malfunction and defects in important system components (e.g. lighting and brake system). • Vehicle reactions in particular driving situations (e.g. inflation of an airbag, activation of the stability regulation system). • Environmental conditions (e.g. temperature). Panic alarm Parking aid E139213 Parking brake Power steering fluid Power windows front/rear Power window lockout These data are exclusively technical and help identification and correction of errors as well as optimisation of vehicle functions. Motion profiles indicating travelled routes cannot be created with these data. Service engine soon Side airbag 9 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Introduction If services are used (e.g. repair works, service processes, warranty cases, quality assurance), employees of the service network (including manufacturers) are able to read out this technical information from the event and error data storage modules using special diagnostic devices. If required, you will receive further information. After an error has been corrected, these data are deleted from the error storage module or they are constantly overwritten. Web Address www.dtsc.ca.gov/hazardouswaste/ perchlorate FORD CREDIT (U.S. Only) Ford Credit offers a full range of financing and lease plans to help you acquire your vehicle. If you have financed or leased your vehicle through Ford Credit, thank you for your business. When using the vehicle, situations may occur in which these technical data related to other information (accident report, damages on the vehicle, witness statements etc.) may be associated with a specific person - possibly, with the assistance of an expert. For your convenience we offer a number of ways to contact us, as well as to help manage your account. Phone: 1-800-727-7000 Additional functions contractually agreed upon with the client (e.g. vehicle location in emergency cases) allow the transmission of particular vehicle data from the vehicle. For more information regarding Ford Credit, as well as to access Account Manager, please go to www.fordcredit.com. REPLACEMENT PARTS RECOMMENDATION CALIFORNIA PROPOSITION 65 WARNING Your vehicle has been built to the highest standards using quality parts. We recommend that you demand the use of genuine Ford and Motorcraft parts whenever your vehicle requires scheduled maintenance or repair. You can clearly identify genuine Ford and Motorcraft parts by looking for the Ford, FoMoCo or Motorcraft branding on the parts or their packaging. Some constituents of engine exhaust, certain vehicle components, certain fluids contained in vehicles and certain products of component wear contain or emit chemicals known to the State of California to cause cancer and birth defects or other reproductive harm. PERCHLORATE Certain components in your vehicle such as airbag modules, safety belt pretensioners and remote control batteries may contain perchlorate material. Special handling may apply for service or vehicle end of life disposal. For more information visit: 10 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Introduction Scheduled Maintenance and Mechanical Repairs MOBILE COMMUNICATIONS EQUIPMENT One of the best ways for you to make sure that your vehicle provides years of service is to have it maintained in line with our recommendations using parts that conform to the specifications detailed in this Owner’s Manual. Genuine Ford and Motorcraft parts meet or exceed these specifications. Using mobile communications equipment is becoming increasingly important in the conduct of business and personal affairs. However, you must not compromise your own or others’ safety when using such equipment. Mobile communications can enhance personal safety and security when appropriately used, particularly in emergency situations. Safety must be paramount when using mobile communications equipment to avoid negating these benefits. Mobile communication equipment includes, but is not limited to, cellular phones, pagers, portable email devices, text messaging devices and portable two-way radios. Collision Repairs We hope that you never experience a collision, but accidents do happen. Genuine Ford replacement collision parts meet our stringent requirements for fit, finish, structural integrity, corrosion protection and dent resistance. During vehicle development we validate these parts deliver the intended level of protection as a whole system. A great way to know for sure you are getting this level of protection is to use genuine Ford replacement collision parts. WARNING Driving while distracted can result in loss of vehicle control, crash and injury. We strongly recommend that you use extreme caution when using any device that may take your focus off the road. Your primary responsibility is the safe operation of your vehicle. We recommend against the use of any hand-held device while driving and encourage the use of voice-operated systems when possible. Make sure you are aware of all applicable local laws that may affect the use of electronic devices while driving. Warranty on Replacement Parts Genuine Ford and Motorcraft replacement parts are the only replacement parts that benefit from a Ford Warranty. Damage caused to your vehicle as a result of the failure of non-Ford parts may not be covered by the Ford Warranty. For additional information, refer to the terms and conditions of the Ford Warranty. EXPORT UNIQUE OPTIONS SPECIAL NOTICES For your particular global region, your vehicle may be equipped with features and options that are different from the features and options that are described in this Owner’s Manual. A market unique supplement may be supplied that complements this book. By referring to the market unique supplement, if provided, you can properly identify those features, recommendations and specifications that If converting or modifying your vehicle from production specification, refer to the Body and Equipment Mounting Manual at www.etis.ford.com/fordservice. 11 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Introduction are unique to your vehicle. This Owner’s Manual is written primarily for the U.S. and Canadian Markets. Features or equipment listed as standard may be different on units built for Export. Refer to this Owner’s Manual for all other required information and warnings. 12 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Child Safety GENERAL INFORMATION WARNINGS requirements of law. Ford recommends checking with a NHTSA Certified Child Passenger Safety Technician (CPST) and consult your pediatrician to make sure your child seat is appropriate for your child, and is compatible with and properly installed in your vehicle. To locate a child seat fitting station and CPST, contact the NHTSA toll free at 1-888-327-4236 or go to http://www.nhtsa.dot.gov. In Canada, check with your local St. John Ambulance office for referral to a CPST or for further information, contact your provincial ministry of transportation, locate your local St. John Ambulance office by searching for St. John Ambulance on the internet, or Transport Canada at 1-800-333-0371 (http://www.tc.gc.ca). Failure to properly restrain children in safety seats made especially for their height, age, and weight may result in an increased risk of serious injury or death to your child. See the following sections for directions on how to properly use safety restraints for children. WARNINGS Always make sure your child is secured properly in a device that is appropriate for their height, age and weight. Child safety restraints must be bought separately from your vehicle. Failure to follow these instructions and guidelines may result in an increased risk of serious injury or death to your child. All children are shaped differently. The recommendations for safety restraints are based on probable child height, age and weight thresholds from National Highway Traffic Safety Administration and other safety organizations, or are the minimum 13 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Child Safety Recommendations for Safety Restraints for Children Child Child size, height, weight, or age Recommended restraint type Infants or toddlers Children weighing 40 lb (18 kg) or less (generally age four or younger). Use a child safety seat (sometimes called an infant carrier, convertible seat, or toddler seat). Small children Children who have outgrown or no longer properly fit in a child safety seat (generally children who are less than 4 ft. 9 in. (1.45 m) tall, are greater than age four and less than age 12, and between 40 lb (18 kg) and 80 lb (36 kg) and upward to 100 lb (45 kg) if recommended by your child restraint manufacturer). Use a belt-positioning booster seat. Larger children Children who have outgrown or no longer properly fit in a belt-positioning booster seat (generally children who are at least 4 ft. 9 in. (1.45 m) tall or greater than 80 lb (36 kg) or 100 lb (45 kg) if recommended by child restraint manufacturer). • • • You are required by law to properly use safety seats for infants and toddlers in the United States and Canada. Many states and provinces require that small children use approved booster seats until they reach age eight, a height of 4 feet 9 inches (1.45 meters) tall, or 80 pounds (36 kilograms). Check your local and state or provincial laws for specific requirements about the safety of children in your vehicle. When possible, always properly restrain children 12 years of age and under in a rear seating position of your vehicle. Accident statistics suggest that children are safer when properly restrained in the rear seating positions than in a front seating position. INSTALLING CHILD SEATS Child Seats E142594 14 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Use a vehicle safety belt having the lap belt snug and low across the hips, shoulder belt centered across the shoulder and chest, and seat back upright. Child Safety • Use a child safety seat (sometimes called an infant carrier, convertible seat, or toddler seat) for infants, toddlers, or children weighing 40 pounds (18 kilograms) or less (generally age four or younger). • Using Lap and Shoulder Belts Place the vehicle seat upon which the child seat will be installed in the upright position. Put the safety belt in the automatic locking mode. See Step 5. Your vehicle does not require the use of a locking clip. Perform the following steps when installing the child seat with combination lap and shoulder belts: WARNINGS Airbags can kill or injure a child in a child seat. Never place a rear-facing child seat in front of an active airbag. If you must use a forward-facing child seat in the front seat, move the seat upon which the child seat is installed all the way back. Note: Although the child seat illustrated is a forward facing child seat, the steps are the same for installing a rear facing child seat. Airbags can kill or injure a child in a child seat. Children 12 and under should be correctly restrained in the rear seat whenever possible. Depending on where you secure a child restraint, and depending on the child restraint design, you may block access to certain safety belt buckle assemblies and LATCH lower anchors, rendering those features potentially unusable. To avoid risk of injury, occupants should only use seating positions where they are able to be correctly restrained. E142528 1. When installing a child safety seat with combination lap and shoulder belts: • Use the correct safety belt buckle for that seating position. • Insert the belt tongue into the correct buckle until you hear a distinct click and feel it latch. Make sure the tongue is securely fastened in the buckle. • Keep the buckle release button pointing up and away from the safety seat, with the tongue between the child seat and the release button, to prevent accidental unbuckling. E142529 2. Pull down on the shoulder belt and then grasp the shoulder belt and lap belt together. 15 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Position the child safety seat in a seat with a combination lap and shoulder belt. Child Safety E142530 E142875 3. While holding the shoulder and lap belt portions together, route the tongue through the child seat according to the child seat manufacturer's instructions. Be sure the belt webbing is not twisted. 5. To put the retractor in the automatic locking mode, grasp the shoulder portion of the belt and pull downward until all of the belt is pulled out. Note: The automatic locking mode is available on the front passenger and rear seats. 6. Allow the belt to retract to remove slack. The belt will click as it retracts to indicate it is in the automatic locking mode. 7. Try to pull the belt out of the retractor to make sure the retractor is in the automatic locking mode (you should not be able to pull more belt out). If the retractor is not locked, unbuckle the belt and repeat Steps 5 and 6. E142531 4. Insert the belt tongue into the correct buckle (the buckle closest to the direction the tongue is coming from) for that seating position until you hear a distinct click and feel the latch engage. Make sure the tongue is latched securely by pulling on it. E142533 16 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Child Safety Using Lower Anchors and Tethers for Children (LATCH) 8. Remove remaining slack from the belt. Force the seat down with extra weight, for example, by pressing down or kneeling on the child restraint while pulling up on the shoulder belt in order to force slack from the belt. This is necessary to remove the remaining slack that will exist once the extra weight of the child is added to the child restraint. It also helps to achieve the correct snugness of the child seat to your vehicle. Sometimes, a slight lean toward the buckle will additionally help to remove remaining slack from the belt. 9. Attach the tether strap (if the child seat is equipped). WARNINGS Never attach two child safety seats to the same anchor. In a crash, one anchor may not be strong enough to hold two child safety seat attachments and may break, causing serious injury or death. Depending on where you secure a child restraint, and depending on the child restraint design, you may block access to certain safety belt buckle assemblies or LATCH lower anchors, rendering those features potentially unusable. To avoid risk of injury, occupants should only use seating positions where they are able to be correctly restrained. The LATCH system is composed of three vehicle anchor points: two lower anchors located where seat back and seat cushion meet (called the seat bight) and one top tether anchor located behind that seating position. LATCH compatible child safety seats have two rigid or webbing mounted attachments that connect to the two lower anchors at the LATCH equipped seating positions in your vehicle. This type of attachment method eliminates the need to use safety belts to attach the child seat, however the safety belt can still be used to attach the child seat. For forward-facing child seats, the top tether strap must also be attached to the correct top tether anchor, if a top tether strap has been provided with your child seat. E142534 10. Before placing the child in the seat, forcibly move the seat forward and back to make sure the seat is securely held in place. To check this, grab the seat at the belt path and attempt to move it side to side and forward and back. There should be no more than 1 inch (2.5 centimeters) of movement for correct installation. Ford recommends checking with a NHTSA Certified Child Passenger Safety Technician to make certain the child restraint is correctly installed. In Canada, check with your local St. John Ambulance office for referral to a Certified Passenger Seat Technician. 17 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Child Safety E184881 E178553 Your vehicle has LATCH lower anchors for child seat installation at the seating positions marked with the child seat symbol. E178551 E177639 E178552 18 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Child Safety The LATCH anchors are located at the rear section of the rear seat between the cushion and seat back above the symbols as shown. Follow the child seat manufacturer's instructions to correctly install a child seat with LATCH attachments. Follow the instructions on attaching child safety seats with tether straps. Combining Safety Belt and LATCH Lower Anchors for Attaching Child Safety Seats When used in combination, either the safety belt or the LATCH lower anchors may be attached first, provided a correct installation is achieved. Attach the tether strap afterward, if included with the child seat. Attach LATCH lower attachments of the child seat only to the anchors shown. Using Tether Straps Many forward-facing child safety seats include a tether strap which extends from the back of the child safety seat and hooks to an anchoring point called the top tether anchor. Tether straps are available as an accessory for many older safety seats. Use of Inboard Lower Anchors from the Outboard Seating Positions (Center Seating Use) WARNING The standardized spacing for LATCH lower anchors is 11 inches (28 centimeters) center to center. Do not use LATCH lower anchors for the center seating position unless the child seat manufacturer's instructions permit and specify using anchors spaced at least as far apart as those in your vehicle. Contact the manufacturer of your child seat for information about ordering a tether strap, or to obtain a longer tether strap if the tether strap on your safety seat does not reach the appropriate top tether anchor in your vehicle. Once the child safety seat has been installed using either the safety belt, the lower anchors of the LATCH system, or both, you can attach the top tether strap. Do not attach a child seat to any lower anchor if an adjacent child seat is attached to that anchor. Each time you use the safety seat, check that the seat is correctly attached to the lower anchors and tether anchor, if applicable. Tug the child seat from side to side and forward and back where it is secured to your vehicle. The seat should move less than one inch when you do this for a correct installation. The tether strap anchors in your vehicle are in the following positions (shown from top view): If the safety seat is not anchored correctly, the risk of a child being injured in a crash greatly increases. E184881 19 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Child Safety E178553 E178551 Perform the following steps to install a child safety seat with tether anchors: Note: If you install a child seat with rigid LATCH attachments, do not tighten the tether strap enough to lift the child seat off your vehicle seat cushion when the child is seated in it. Keep the tether strap just snug without lifting the front of the child seat. Keeping the child seat just touching your vehicle seat gives the best protection in a severe crash. Front Passenger Seating Position 1. Adjust the front passenger seat fully forward. 2. Route the child safety seat tether strap over the back of the seat, under the head restraint and between the head restraint posts. E178552 20 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Child Safety 4. Clip the tether strap to the anchor as shown. 5. Adjust the front passenger seat full rearward. 6. Tighten the child safety seat tether strap according to the manufacturer's instructions. If your child restraint system is equipped with a tether strap, and the child restraint manufacturer recommends its use, Ford also recommends its use. Rear Seats 1. Route the child safety seat tether strap over the back of the seat, under the head restraint and between the head restraint posts. E178096 3. Locate the correct anchor on the back panel of the rear seat for the selected seating position. The anchors are labeled with the tether strap symbol and are partially covered by the gap panel. Pull the panel back to fully expose the anchors. E177640 21 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Child Safety 2. Locate the correct anchor on the back panel of the rear seat for the selected seating position. The anchors are labeled with the tether strap symbol and are partially covered by the gap panel. Pull the panel back to fully expose the anchors. 3. Clip the tether strap to the anchor as shown. 4. Tighten the child safety seat tether strap according to the manufacturer's instructions. If your child restraint system is equipped with a tether strap, and the child restraint manufacturer recommends its use, Ford also recommends its use. E142595 • • • BOOSTER SEATS WARNING • Never place, or allow a child to place, the shoulder belt under a child's arm or behind the back because it reduces the protection for the upper part of the body and may increase the risk of injury or death in a crash. • Can the child sit all the way back against their vehicle seat back with knees bent comfortably at the edge of the seat cushion? Can the child sit without slouching? Does the lap belt rest low across the hips? Is the shoulder belt centered on the shoulder and chest? Can the child stay seated like this for the whole trip? Always use booster seats in conjunction with your vehicle lap and shoulder belt. Types of Booster Seats Use a belt-positioning booster seat for children who have outgrown or no longer properly fit in a child safety seat (generally children who are less than 4 feet 9 inches (1.45 meters) tall, are greater than age four (4) and less than age twelve (12), and between 40 pounds (18 kilograms) and 80 pounds (36 kilograms) and upward to 100 pounds (45 kilograms) if recommended by your child restraint manufacturer). Many state and provincial laws require that children use approved booster seats until they reach age eight, a height of 4 feet 9 inches (1.45 meters) tall, or 80 pounds (36 kilograms). E68924 Booster seats should be used until you can answer YES to ALL of these questions when seated without a booster seat: • 22 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Backless booster seats Child Safety If your backless booster seat has a removable shield, remove the shield. If a vehicle seating position has a low seat back or no head restraint, a backless booster seat may place your child's head (as measured at the tops of the ears) above the top of the seat. In this case, move the backless booster to another seating position with a higher seat back or head restraint and lap and shoulder belts, or consider using a high back booster seat. • Children and booster seats vary in size and shape. Choose a booster that keeps the lap belt low and snug across the hips, never up across the stomach, and lets you adjust the shoulder belt to cross the chest and rest snugly near the center of the shoulder. The following drawings compare the ideal fit (center) to a shoulder belt uncomfortably close to the neck and a shoulder belt that could slip off the shoulder. The drawings also show how the lap belt should be low and snug across the child's hips. E70710 E142596 23 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 High back booster seats If, with a backless booster seat, you cannot find a seating position that adequately supports your child's head, a high back booster seat would be a better choice. Child Safety E142597 WARNINGS warnings provided by your vehicle manufacturer. A safety seat that is improperly installed or utilized, is inappropriate for your child's height, age, or weight or does not properly fit the child may increase the risk of serious injury or death. If the booster seat slides on the vehicle seat upon which it is being used, placing a rubberized mesh sold as shelf or carpet liner under the booster seat may improve this condition. Do not introduce any item thicker than this under the booster seat. Check with the booster seat manufacturer's instructions. Never let a passenger hold a child on his or her lap while your vehicle is moving. The passenger cannot protect the child from injury in a crash, which may result in serious injury or death. CHILD SEAT POSITIONING WARNINGS Airbags can kill or injure a child in a child seat. Never place a rear-facing child seat in front of an active airbag. If you must use a forward-facing child seat in the front seat, move the vehicle seat upon which the child seat is installed all the way back. When possible, all children age 12 and under should be properly restrained in a rear seating position. If all children cannot be seated and restrained properly in a rear seating position, properly restrain the largest child in the front seat. Never use pillows, books, or towels to boost a child. They can slide around and increase the likelihood of injury or death in a crash. Always restrain an unoccupied child seat or booster seat. These objects may become projectiles in a crash or sudden stop, which may increase the risk of serious injury. Never place, or allow a child to place, the shoulder belt under a child's arm or behind the back because it reduces the protection for the upper part of the body and may increase the risk of injury or death in a crash. Always carefully follow the instructions and warnings provided by the manufacturer of any child restraint to determine if the restraint device is appropriate for your child's size, height, weight, or age. Follow the child restraint manufacturer's instructions and warnings provided for installation and use in conjunction with the instructions and To avoid risk of injury, do not leave children or pets unattended in your vehicle. 24 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Child Safety Recommendations for attaching child safety restraints for children Restraint type Combined weight of child and child restraint seat Use any attachment method as indicated below by X LATCH (lower anchors and top tether anchor) LATCH (lower anchors only) Rear facing Up to 65 lb child seat (29.5 kg) Safety belt Safety belt Safety belt and LATCH only and top (lower tether anchors anchor and top tether anchor) X X Rear facing Over 65 lb child seat (29.5 kg) Forward facing child seat Up to 65 lb (29.5 kg) Forward facing child seat Over 65 lb (29.5 kg) X X X X X X Note: The child seat must rest tightly against the vehicle seat upon which it is installed. It may be necessary to lift or remove the head restraint. See Seats (page 95). CHILD SAFETY LOCKS WARNING You cannot open the rear doors from inside if you have put the child safety locks on. E176718 A child safety lock is on the rear edge of each rear door. You must set the child safety lock separately on each door. Left-Hand Side Turn it counterclockwise to switch the child lock on and clockwise to switch it off. 25 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Child Safety Right-Hand Side Turn it clockwise to switch the child lock on and counterclockwise to switch it off. 26 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Safety Belts PRINCIPLE OF OPERATION WARNINGS When possible, all children 12 years old and under should be properly restrained in a rear seating position. Failure to follow this could seriously increase the risk of injury or death. WARNINGS Always drive and ride with the seat backrest upright and the lap belt snug and low across the hips. Safety belts and seats can become hot in a vehicle that has been closed up in sunny weather; they could burn a small child. Check seat covers and buckles before you place a child anywhere near them. To reduce the risk of injury, make sure children sit where they can be properly restrained. Never let a passenger hold a child on his or her lap while your vehicle is moving. The passenger cannot protect the child from injury in a crash which may result in serious injury or death. Front and rear seat occupants, including pregnant women, should wear safety belts for optimum protection in an accident. All occupants of the vehicle, including the driver, should always properly wear their safety belts, even when an airbag supplemental restraint system is provided. Failure to properly wear your safety belt could seriously increase the risk of injury or death. All seating positions in this vehicle have lap and shoulder safety belts. All occupants of the vehicle should always properly wear their safety belts, even when an airbag supplemental restraint system is provided. It is extremely dangerous to ride in a cargo area, inside or outside of a vehicle. In a crash, people riding in these areas are more likely to be seriously injured or killed. Do not allow people to ride in any area of your vehicle that is not equipped with seats and safety belts. Be sure everyone in your vehicle is in a seat and using a safety belt properly. The safety belt system consists of: • Lap and shoulder safety belts. • Shoulder safety belt with automatic locking mode, (except driver safety belt). • Height adjuster at the front outboard seating positions. • Safety belt pretensioner at the front outboard seating positions. In a rollover crash, an unbelted person is significantly more likely to die than a person wearing a safety belt. Each seating position in your vehicle has a specific safety belt assembly which is made up of one buckle and one tongue that are designed to be used as a pair. 1) Use the shoulder belt on the outside shoulder only. Never wear the shoulder belt under the arm. 2) Never swing the safety belt around your neck over the inside shoulder. 3) Never use a single belt for more than one person. 27 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 • Safety belt warning light and chime. • Crash sensors and monitoring system with readiness indicator. Safety Belts The safety belt pretensioners at the front seating positions are designed to tighten the safety belts when activated. In frontal and near-frontal crashes, side crashes and rollovers, the safety belt pretensioners may be activated alone or, if the crash is of sufficient severity, together with the front airbags. 2. To unfasten, press the release button and remove the tongue from the buckle. Using Safety Belts During Pregnancy WARNING Always ride and drive with your seat back upright and the safety belt properly fastened. The lap portion of the safety belt should fit snug and be positioned low across the hips. The shoulder portion of the safety belt should be positioned across the chest. Pregnant women should also follow this practice. See the following figure. FASTENING THE SAFETY BELTS The front outboard and rear safety restraints in the vehicle are combination lap and shoulder belts. E142587 1. Insert the safety belt tongue into the proper buckle (the buckle closest to the direction the tongue is coming from) until you hear a snap and feel it latch. Make sure the tongue is securely fastened in the buckle. E170730 Pregnant women should always wear their safety belt. The lap belt portion of a combination lap and shoulder belt should be positioned low across the hips below the belly and worn as tight as comfort will allow. The shoulder belt should be positioned to cross the middle of the shoulder and the center of the chest. E142588 28 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Safety Belts Safety Belt Locking Modes Automatic Locking Mode WARNINGS After any vehicle crash, the safety belt system at all passenger seating positions must be checked by an authorized dealer to verify that the automatic locking retractor feature for child seats is still functioning properly. In addition, all safety belts should be checked for proper function. In this mode, the shoulder belt is automatically pre-locked. The safety belt will still retract to remove any slack in the shoulder belt. The automatic locking mode is not available on the driver safety belt. When to Use the Automatic Locking Mode This mode should be used any time a child safety seat, except a booster, is installed in passenger front or rear seating positions. Children 12 years old and under should be correctly restrained in a rear seating position whenever possible. See Child Safety (page 13). Safety belt and retractor assemblies must be replaced if the safety belt assembly automatic locking retractor feature, or any other safety belt function is not operating correctly when checked by an authorized dealer. Failure to replace the safety belt and retractor assembly could increase the risk of injury in a crash. How to Use the Automatic Locking Mode All safety belts in your vehicle are combination lap and shoulder belts. The driver safety belt has the first type of locking mode, and the front outboard passenger and rear seat safety belts have both types of locking modes described as follows: Vehicle Sensitive Mode This is the normal retractor mode, which allows free shoulder belt length adjustment to your movements and locking in response to vehicle movement. For example, if the driver brakes suddenly or turns a corner sharply, or the vehicle receives an impact of approximately 5 mph (8 km/h) or more, the combination safety belts will lock to help reduce forward movement of the driver and passengers. E142591 1. Buckle the combination lap and shoulder belt. 2. Grasp the shoulder portion and pull downward until the entire safety belt is pulled out. Allow the safety belt to retract. As the safety belt retracts, you will hear a clicking sound. This indicates the safety belt is now in the automatic locking mode. In addition, the retractor is designed to lock if the webbing is pulled out too quickly. If this occurs, let the safety belt retract slightly and pull webbing out again in a slow and controlled manner. 29 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Safety Belts How to Disengage the Automatic Locking Mode 1 Unbuckle the combination lap and shoulder belt and allow it to retract completely to disengage the automatic locking mode and return the safety belt to the vehicle sensitive (emergency) locking mode. 2 Safety Belt Extension Assembly WARNING 2 Do not use extensions to change the fit of the shoulder belt across the torso. If the safety belt is too short when fully extended, a safety belt extension assembly can be obtained from an authorized dealer. E165022 1. Press the button. 2. Slide the height adjuster up or down. 3. Release the button and pull down on the height adjuster to make sure it is locked in place. Only use extensions manufactured by the same supplier as the safety belt. Manufacturer identification is located at the end of the webbing on the label or the retractor behind the trim. Only use an extension if the safety belt is too short for you when fully extended. SAFETY BELT WARNING LAMP AND INDICATOR CHIME SAFETY BELT HEIGHT ADJUSTMENT This lamp illuminates and an audible warning will sound if the driver's safety belt has not been fastened when the vehicle's ignition is turned on. WARNING Position the safety belt height adjuster so that the safety belt rests across the middle of your shoulder. Failure to adjust the safety belt correctly could reduce its effectiveness and increase the risk of injury in a crash. 30 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 3 Safety Belts Conditions of operation If... Then... The driver's safety belt is not buckled before the ignition switch is turned to the on position... The safety belt warning light illuminates 12 minutes and the warning chime sounds 4-8 seconds. The driver's safety belt is buckled while the indicator light is illuminated and the warning chime is sounding... The safety belt warning light and warning chime turn off. The driver's safety belt is buckled before The safety belt warning light and indicator the ignition switch is turned to the on posichime remain off. tion... SAFETY BELT MINDER Belt-Minder® This feature supplements the safety belt warning function by providing additional reminders by intermittently sounding a chime and illuminating the safety belt warning light when the driver seat is occupied and the safety belt is unbuckled. If... Then... The driver safety belt is buckled before the The Belt-Minder feature will not turn on. ignition is switched on or less than two minutes have elapsed since the ignition was switched on. The driver safety belt is not buckled when the vehicle has reached at least 6 mph (9.7 km/h) and two minutes have elapsed since the ignition was switched on. The Belt-Minder feature is turned on - the safety belt warning light illuminates and the warning chime sounds for six seconds every 25 seconds, repeating for about five minutes or until the driver safety belt is buckled. The driver safety belt becomes unbuckled for about one minute while the vehicle is traveling at least 6 mph (9.7 km/h) and more than two minutes have elapsed since the ignition was switched on. The Belt-Minder feature is turned on - the safety belt warning light illuminates and the warning chime sounds for six seconds every 25 seconds, repeating for about five minutes or until the driver safety belt is buckled. 31 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Safety Belts Switching the Belt-Minder on and off • WARNING • While the system allows you to switch it off, this system is designed to improve your chances of being safely belted and surviving a crash. We recommend you leave the system switched on. To reduce the risk of injury, do not switch the system on or off while driving your vehicle. CHILD RESTRAINT AND SAFETY BELT MAINTENANCE Inspect the vehicle safety belts and child safety seat systems periodically to make sure they work properly and are not damaged. Inspect the vehicle and child seat safety belts to make sure there are no nicks, tears or cuts. Replace if necessary. All vehicle safety belt assemblies, including retractors, buckles, front safety belt buckle assemblies, buckle support assemblies (slide bar-if equipped), shoulder belt height adjusters (if equipped), shoulder belt guide on seat back (if equipped), child safety seat LATCH and tether anchors, and attaching hardware, should be inspected after a crash. Read the child restraint manufacturer's instructions for additional inspection and maintenance information specific to the child restraint. Read Steps 1 - 4 thoroughly before proceeding with the programming procedure. The system can be switched on and off by carrying out the following procedure: Before following the procedure, make sure that: • The parking brake is set. • The transmission selector lever is in position park (P). • The ignition is switched off. • The driver safety belt is unbuckled. 1. Switch the ignition on. Do not start the engine. 2. Wait until the safety belt warning light turns off (about one minute). After Step 2, wait an additional five seconds before proceeding with Step 3. Once Step 3 is started, the procedure must be completed within 30 seconds. 3. Buckle then unbuckle the driver safety belt three times at a moderate speed, ending in the unbuckled state. After Step 3, the safety belt warning light will illuminate. 4. While the safety belt warning light is illuminated, buckle then unbuckle the driver safety belt. After Step 4, the safety belt warning light will flash for confirmation. Ford Motor Company recommends that all safety belt assemblies in use in vehicles involved in a crash be replaced. However, if the crash was minor and an authorized dealer finds that the belts do not show damage and continue to operate properly, they do not need to be replaced. Safety belt assemblies not in use during a crash should also be inspected and replaced if either damage or improper operation is noted. Properly care for safety belts. See Vehicle Care (page 227). 32 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 This will disable the feature if it is currently enabled. This will enable the feature if it is currently disabled. Supplementary Restraints System PRINCIPLE OF OPERATION CANADA/UNITED STATES OF AMERICA WARNINGS If the airbag has deployed, the airbag will not function again and must be replaced immediately. If the airbag is not replaced, the unrepaired area will increase the risk of injury in a crash. WARNINGS Airbags do not inflate slowly or gently, and the risk of injury from a deploying airbag is the greatest close to the trim covering the airbag module. The airbags are a supplemental restraint system and are designed to work with the safety belts to help protect the driver and right front passenger from certain upper body injuries. Airbags do not inflate slowly; there is a risk of injury from a deploying airbag. All occupants of your vehicle, including the driver, should always properly wear their safety belts, even when an airbag supplemental restraint system is provided. Failure to properly wear your safety belt could seriously increase the risk of injury or death. Note: You will hear a loud bang and see a cloud of harmless powdery residue if an airbag deploys. This is normal. Always transport children 12 years old and under in the back seat and always properly use appropriate child restraints. Failure to follow this could seriously increase the risk of injury or death. The airbags inflate and deflate rapidly upon activation. After airbag deployment, it is normal to notice a smoke-like, powdery residue or smell the burnt propellant. This may consist of cornstarch, talcum powder (to lubricate the bag) or sodium compounds (for example, baking soda) that result from the combustion process that inflates the airbag. Small amounts of sodium hydroxide may be present which may irritate the skin and eyes, but none of the residue is toxic. Never place your arm over the airbag module as a deploying airbag can result in serious arm fractures or other injuries. Airbags can kill or injure a child in a child seat. Never place a rear-facing child seat in front of an active airbag. If you must use a forward-facing child seat in the front seat, move the seat upon which the child seat is installed all the way back. While the system is designed to help reduce serious injuries, contact with a deploying airbag may also cause abrasions or swelling. Temporary hearing loss is also a possibility as a result of the noise associated with a deploying airbag. Because airbags must inflate rapidly and with considerable force, there is the risk of death or serious injuries such as fractures, facial and eye injuries or internal injuries, particularly to occupants who are not properly restrained or are otherwise out of position at the time of airbag deployment. Thus, it is extremely important that occupants be properly restrained as far away from the airbag module as possible while maintaining vehicle control. Do not attempt to service, repair, or modify the airbag supplemental restraint systems or its fuses as you could be seriously injured or killed. Contact your authorized dealer as soon as possible. Several airbag system components get hot after inflation. Do not touch them after inflation as this may result in serious injury. 33 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Supplementary Restraints System Routine maintenance of the airbags is not required. DRIVER AND PASSENGER AIRBAGS Passenger Airbag On and Off Switch (If Equipped) WARNINGS Never place your arm or any objects over an airbag module. Placing your arm over a deploying airbag can result in serious arm fractures or other injuries. Objects placed on or over the airbag inflation area may cause those objects to be propelled by the airbag into your face and torso causing serious injury. WARNINGS Even with Advanced Restraints Systems, children 12 and under should be properly restrained in a rear seating position. Failure to follow this could seriously increase the risk of injury or death. The front passenger airbag is not designed to offer protection to an occupant in the center seating position. Airbags can kill or injure a child in a child seat. Never place a rear-facing child seat in front of an active airbag. If you must use a forward-facing child seat in the front seat, move the seat upon which the child seat is installed all the way back. An airbag ON and OFF switch may be installed in this vehicle. Before driving, always look at the face of the switch to be sure the switch is in the proper position in accordance with these instructions and warnings. Failure to put the switch in a proper position can increase the risk of serious injury or death in a crash. E151127 The driver and front passenger airbags will deploy during significant frontal and near frontal crashes. E181532 The driver and passenger front airbag system consists of: • Driver and passenger airbag modules. • Crash sensors and monitoring system with readiness indicator. See Crash Sensors and Airbag Indicator (page 42). High-series vehicles (if equipped) The front passenger airbag on and off switch has indicators that will illuminate, indicating that the front passenger frontal airbag is either on or off. The indicator lamp is located on the radio. 34 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Supplementary Restraints System Note: The passenger airbag status indicator OFF and ON lamps will illuminate for a short period of time when the ignition is first turned on to confirm it is functional. Switch position Passenger airbag status indicator Passenger airbag Off OFF: Lit Disabled ON: Unlit On OFF: Unlit Enabled ON: Lit WARNINGS An infant in a rear-facing seat faces a high risk of serious or fatal injuries from a deploying passenger airbag. Rear facing infant seats should never be placed in the front seats, unless the passenger airbag is turned off. E170613 Low-series vehicles (if equipped) The front passenger airbag on and off switch has an indicator that will illuminate and stay lit to remind you that the front passenger frontal airbag is off. The indicator lamp is located by the radio. Note: The indicator lamp will illuminate for a short period of time when the ignition is first turned on to confirm it is functional. Turning the Passenger Airbag Off WARNINGS If the light fails to illuminate when the passenger airbag switch is off and the ignition is on, have the passenger airbag switch serviced at your authorized dealer immediately. In order to avoid inadvertent activation of the switch, always remove the ignition key from the passenger airbag on and off switch. 35 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Supplementary Restraints System 2. When the ignition is turned on, the pass airbag off light illuminates briefly, momentarily shuts off and then turns back on. This indicates that the passenger airbag is deactivated. Turning the Passenger Airbag Back On WARNINGS The safety belts for the driver and right front passenger seating positions have been specifically designed to function together with the airbags in certain types of crashes. When you turn off your airbag, you not only lose the protection of the airbag, you also may reduce the effectiveness of your safety belt system, which was designed to work with the airbag. If you are not a passenger who meets the requirements stated in the National Highway Traffic Safety Administration or Transport Canada deactivation criteria turning off the airbag can increase the risk of serious injury or death in a crash. E181523 If your vehicle has rear seats, always transport children who are 12 years and under in the rear seat. Always use safety belts and child restraints correctly. Do not place a child in a rear facing infant seat in the front seat unless your vehicle is equipped with an airbag on and off switch and the passenger airbag is turned off. This is because the back of the infant seat is too close to the inflating airbag and the risk of a fatal injury to the infant when the airbag inflates is substantial. If the pass airbag off light is illuminated when the passenger airbag switch is on and the ignition is on, have the passenger airbag switch serviced at your authorized dealer immediately. E181522 1. Insert the ignition key, turn the switch to OFF and hold in OFF while removing the key. The passenger airbag remains off until you turn it back on. 36 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Supplementary Restraints System you are losing the very significant risk reducing benefits of the airbag and you are also reducing the effectiveness of the safety belts, because safety belts in modern vehicles are designed to work as a safety system with the airbags. National Highway Traffic Safety Administration Deactivation Criteria (Excluding Canada) WARNING This vehicle has special energy management safety belts for the driver and right front passenger. These particular belts are specifically designed to work with airbags to help reduce the risk of injury in a crash. The energy management safety belt is designed to give or release additional belt webbing in some accidents to reduce concentration of force on an occupant's chest and reduce the risk of certain bone fractures and injuries to underlying organs. In a crash, if the airbag is turned off, this energy management safety belt might permit the person wearing the belt to move forward enough to incur a serious or fatal injury. The more severe the crash, and the heavier the occupant, the greater the risk is. Be sure the airbag is turned on for any person who does not qualify under the National Highway Traffic Safety Administration deactivation criteria. E181521 1. Insert the ignition key and turn the switch to ON. 2. The pass airbag off light will briefly illuminate when the ignition is turned to on. This indicates that the passenger airbag is operational. The passenger side airbag should always be on (the pass airbag off light should not be illuminated) unless the passenger meets the requirements stated either in Category 1, 2 or 3 of the National Highway Traffic Safety Administration or Transport Canada deactivation criteria which follows. The vast majority of drivers and passengers are much safer with an airbag than without. To do their job and reduce the risk of life threatening injuries, airbags must open with great force, and this force can pose a potentially deadly risk in some situations, particularly when a front seat passenger is not using the safety belt correctly. The most effective way to reduce the risk of unnecessary airbag injuries without reducing the overall safety of your vehicle is to make sure all passengers are correctly restrained in the vehicle, especially in the front seat. This provides the protection of safety belts and permits the airbags to provide the additional protection they were designed to provide. If you choose to deactivate your airbag, 1. Infant. An infant (less than 1 year old) must ride in the front seat because: 37 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Supplementary Restraints System • • • Transport Canada Deactivation Criteria (Canada Only) the vehicle has no rear seat; the vehicle has a rear seat too small to accommodate a rear-facing infant seat; or the infant has a medical condition which, according to the infant's physician, makes it necessary for the infant to ride in the front so that the driver can constantly monitor the child's condition. WARNING This vehicle has special energy management safety belts for the driver and right front passenger. These particular belts are specifically designed to work with airbags to help reduce the risk of injury in a crash. The energy management safety belt is designed to give or release additional belt webbing in some accidents to reduce concentration of force on an occupant's chest and reduce the risk of certain bone fractures and injuries to underlying organs. In a crash, if the airbag is turned off, this energy management safety belt might permit the person wearing the belt to move forward enough to incur a serious or fatal injury. The more severe the crash, and the heavier the occupant, the greater the risk is. Be sure the airbag is turned on for any person who does not qualify under the National Highway Traffic Safety Administration deactivation criteria. 2. Child age 1 to 12. A child age 1 to 12 must ride in the front seat because: • • • the vehicle has no rear seat; although children ages 1 to 12 ride in the rear seat(s) whenever possible, children ages 1 to 12 sometimes must ride in the front because no space is available in the rear seat(s) of the vehicle; or the child has a medical condition which, according to the child's physician, makes it necessary for the child to ride in the front seat so that the driver can constantly monitor the child's condition. 1. Infant: An infant (less than 1 year old) must ride in the front seat because: 3. Medical condition. A passenger has a medical condition which, according to his or her physician: • • • • causes the passenger airbag to pose a special risk for the passenger; makes the potential harm from the passenger airbag in a crash greater than the potential harm from turning off the airbag and allowing the passenger, even if belted, to hit the dashboard or windshield in a crash. • my vehicle has no rear seat; the rear seat in my vehicle cannot accommodate a rear-facing infant seat; the infant has a medical condition which, according to the infant's physician, makes it necessary for the infant to ride in the front seat so that the driver can monitor the infant's condition. 2. Child age 12 or under: A child age 12 or under must ride in the front seat because: 38 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Supplementary Restraints System • • • After all occupants have adjusted their seats and put on safety belts, it is very important that they continue to sit properly. Properly seated occupants sit upright, lean against the seat back, and center themselves on the seat cushion, with their feet comfortably extended on the floor. Sitting improperly can increase the chance of injury in a crash event. For example, if an occupant slouches, lies down, turns sideways, sits forward, leans forward or sideways, or puts one or both feet up, the chance of injury during a crash is greatly increased. my vehicle has no rear seat; although children age 12 and under ride in the rear seat whenever possible, children age 12 and under have no option but to sometimes ride in the front seat because rear seat space is insufficient; the child has a medical condition that, according to the child's physician, makes it necessary for the child to ride in the front seat so that the driver can monitor the child's condition. 3. Medical condition: A passenger has a medical condition that, according to his or her physician: • • Children and Airbags poses a special risk for the passenger if the airbag deploys; and makes the potential harm from the passenger airbag deployment greater than the potential harm from turning off the airbag and experiencing a crash without the protection offered by the airbag WARNING Airbags can kill or injure a child in a child seat. Never place a rear-facing child seat in front of an active airbag. If you must use a forward-facing child seat in the front seat, move the seat upon which the child seat is installed all the way back. Proper Driver and Front Passenger Seating Adjustment WARNING The National Highway Traffic Safety Administration recommends a minimum distance of at least 10 inches (25 centimeters) between an occupant’s chest and the driver airbag module. E142846 To properly position yourself away from the airbag: • Move your seat to the rear as far as you can while still reaching the pedals comfortably. • Recline the seat slightly (one or two degrees) from the upright position. Children must always be properly restrained. Accident statistics suggest that children are safer when properly restrained in the rear seating positions than in the front seating position. Failure to follow these instructions may increase the risk of injury in a crash. 39 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Supplementary Restraints System If two adults and a child occupy a Regular Cab, properly restrain the child in the center front unless doing so would interfere with driving your vehicle. This provides lap and shoulder belt protection for all occupants, and airbag protection for the adults. A child or infant properly restrained in the center front seat should not incur risk of serious injury from the airbags. The side airbags are located on the outboard side of the seatbacks of the front seats. In certain sideways crashes, the airbag on the side affected by the crash will be inflated. The airbag was designed to inflate between the door panel and occupant to further enhance the protection provided occupants in side impact crashes. SIDE AIRBAGS (If Equipped) WARNINGS Do not place objects or mount equipment on or near the airbag cover, on the side of the seatbacks (of the front seats), or in front seat areas that may come into contact with a deploying airbag. Failure to follow these instructions may increase the risk of personal injury in the event of a crash. E152533 The system consists of the following: • A label or embossed side panel indicating that side airbags are found on your vehicle. • Side airbags located inside the seatback of the driver and front passenger seats. Do not use accessory seat covers. The use of accessory seat covers may prevent the deployment of the side airbags and increase the risk of injury in an accident. Do not lean your head on the door. The side airbag could injure you as it deploys from the side of the seatback. ·Crash sensors and monitoring system with readiness indicator. See Crash Sensors and Airbag Indicator (page 42). Do not attempt to service, repair, or modify the airbag, its fuses or the seat cover on a seat containing an airbag as you could be seriously injured or killed. Contact your authorized dealer as soon as possible. The design and development of the side airbag system included recommended testing procedures that were developed by a group of automotive safety experts known as the Side Airbag Technical Working Group. These recommended testing procedures help reduce the risk of injuries related to the deployment of side airbags. If the side airbag has deployed, the airbag will not function again. The side airbag system (including the seat) must be inspected and serviced by an authorized dealer. If the airbag is not replaced, the unrepaired area will increase the risk of injury in a crash. 40 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Supplementary Restraints System The Safety Canopy will deploy during significant side crashes or when a certain likelihood of a rollover event is detected by the rollover sensor. The Safety Canopy is mounted to the roof side rail behind the headliner and above each row of seats. In certain sideways crashes or rollover events, the Safety Canopy will be activated, regardless of which seats are occupied. The Safety Canopy is designed to inflate between the side window area and occupants to further enhance protection provided in side impact crashes and rollover events. SAFETY CANOPY™ (If Equipped) WARNINGS Do not place objects or mount equipment on or near the headliner at the side rail that may come into contact with a deploying curtain airbag. Failure to follow these instructions may increase the risk of personal injury in the event of a crash. Do not lean your head on the door. The safety canopy could injure you as it deploys from the headliner. Do not attempt to service, repair, or modify the safety canopy, its fuses, the pillar trims, or the headliner on a vehicle with a safety canopy as you could be seriously injured or killed. Contact your authorized dealer as soon as possible. All occupants of your vehicle including the driver should always wear their safety belts even when an airbag supplemental restraint system and safety canopy are provided. Failure to wear your safety belt correctly could seriously increase the risk of personal injury or death. E75004 The system consists of the following: • Safety canopy airbags located above the trim panels over the front and rear side windows identified by a label or wording on the headliner or roof-pillar trim. • A flexible headliner which opens above the side doors to allow safety canopy deployment To reduce risk of personal injury, do not obstruct or place objects in the deployment path of the safety canopy. If a safety canopy deploys it will not function again. The safety canopy, including the pillar trims and headliner, must be inspected and serviced by an authorized dealer. If the safety canopy is not replaced, the unrepaired area will increase the risk of personal injury in a crash. • 41 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 The crash sensors and monitoring system have a readiness indicator. See Crash Sensors and Airbag Indicator (page 42). Supplementary Restraints System The supplemental restraint system control module also monitors the readiness of the above safety devices plus the crash sensors. The readiness of the supplemental restraint system is indicated by a warning lamp in the instrument cluster or by a backup tone if the warning lamp is not working. Routine maintenance of the airbags is not required. Children 12 years old and under should always be properly restrained in the rear seats. The safety canopy will not interfere with children restrained using a properly installed child or booster seat because it is designed to inflate downward from the headliner above the doors along the side window opening. The design and development of the safety canopy included recommended testing procedures that were developed by a group of automotive safety experts known as the Side Airbag Technical Working Group. These recommended testing procedures help reduce the risk of personal injury related to the deployment of a safety canopy. If a fault is present in the supplemental restraint system it is indicated by one or more of the following: The warning lamp will not illuminate when you switch the ignition on. • CRASH SENSORS AND AIRBAG INDICATOR • WARNING If the above occurs, even intermittently, have the system checked by an authorized dealer immediately. Unless repaired, the system may not operate correctly in the event of a crash. Do not modify the front end of your vehicle. Adding equipment to the front of the vehicle, including the frame, bumper, front body structure or recovery hook may affect the performance of the airbag system, increasing the risk of personal injury. The safety belt pretensioners and the front airbags are designed to deploy when the vehicle sustains longitudinal deceleration sufficient to cause the supplemental restraint system control module to deploy a safety device. The vehicle has a collection of crash sensors which provide information to the supplemental restraint system control module. The system will deploy the front safety belt pretensioners, driver airbag, passenger airbag, seat mounted side airbags or safety canopy based on the type of crash, for example frontal impact or side impact. The supplemental restraint system control module will deploy the appropriate safety devices. The fact that the safety belt pretensioners or front airbags did not deploy for all front seat occupants in a crash does not mean there is a fault with the system. The supplemental restraint system control module determines crash conditions, severity and safety belt usage to deploy the appropriate safety devices. 42 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 The warning lamp will either flash or stay illuminated. A series of five beeps will be heard. The tone pattern will repeat periodically until the fault, the warning lamp or both are repaired. Supplementary Restraints System • • • • The design of the front airbags is to deploy only in frontal and near-frontal crashes, for example not rollovers, side impacts or rear impacts, unless the crash causes sufficient longitudinal deceleration. The design of the safety belt pretensioners is to deploy only in frontal and near-frontal crashes, and may also deploy if a safety canopy deploys. The design of the side airbags is to deploy only in certain side impact crashes. Side airbags may deploy in other types of crashes if your vehicle experiences sufficient sideways motion or deformation. The design of the safety canopy is to deploy only in certain side impact crashes or rollover events. The safety canopy may deploy in other types of crashes if your vehicle experiences sufficient sideways motion or deformation, or the likelihood of a rollover event. AIRBAG DISPOSAL Contact your authorized dealer as soon as possible. Airbags must be disposed of by qualified personnel. 43 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Keys and Remote Controls • • PRINCIPLE OF OPERATION The remote control allows you to: • remotely lock or unlock the vehicle doors • unlock the doors without actively using a key or remote control (intelligent access only) • remotely open the power liftgate (if equipped) • remotely start or stop the engine (if equipped) • arm and disarm the anti-theft system • activate the panic alarm. The radio frequency used by your remote control can also be used by other short distance radio transmissions, for example amateur radios, medical equipment, wireless headphones, remote controls and alarm systems. If the frequencies are jammed, you will not be able to use your remote control. You can lock and unlock the doors with the key. Note: Make sure to lock your vehicle before leaving it unattended. Note: If you are in range, the remote control will operate if you press any button unintentionally. GENERAL INFORMATION ON RADIO FREQUENCIES REMOTE CONTROL This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC Rules and with Industry Canada license-exempt RSS standard(s). Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) This device may not cause harmful interference, and (2) This device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation. Integrated Key head Transmitter (If Equipped) Note: Changes or modifications not expressively approved by the party responsible for compliance could void the user's authority to operate the equipment. The term IC before the radio certification number only signifies that Industry Canada technical specifications were met. E177585 Use the key blade to start your vehicle and unlock or lock the driver door from outside your vehicle. The transmitter portion functions as the remote control. The typical operating range for your transmitter is approximately 33 feet (10 meters). Vehicles with the remote start feature will have a greater range. One of the following could cause a decrease in operating range: • weather conditions • nearby radio towers 44 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 structures around the vehicle other vehicles parked next to your vehicle Keys and Remote Controls Integrated Key head Transmitter E138615 E138619 Note: Your vehicle’s keys came with a security label that provides important vehicle key cut information. Keep the label in a safe place for future reference. 1. Twist a thin coin in the slot of the transmitter near the key ring to remove the battery cover. 2. Remove the old battery. Programming a New Remote Control See an authorized dealer. Replacing the Battery The remote control uses one coin type three volt lithium battery CR2032 or equivalent. E138620 Note: Refer to local regulations when disposing of transmitter batteries. 3. Insert the new battery. Refer to the instructions inside the transmitter for the correct orientation of the battery. Press the battery down to make sure it is fully in the housing. 4. Snap the battery cover back onto the transmitter. Note: Do not wipe off any grease on the battery terminals or on the back surface of the circuit board. Note: Replacing the battery will not delete the transmitter from the vehicle. The transmitter should operate normally. Car Finder Press the lock button on the key twice within three seconds. The horn sounds and the direction indicators will flash. We recommend you use this method to locate your vehicle, rather than using the panic alarm. 45 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Keys and Remote Controls Note: If locking was not successful or if any door or the liftgate is open, or if the hood is open on vehicles with a perimeter alarm or remote start, the horn will sound and the direction indicators will not flash. Sounding a Panic Alarm Note: The alarm will only operate when the ignition is off. E138624 Press the button to turn on the alarm. Press the button again or switch the ignition on to turn off. REPLACING A LOST KEY OR REMOTE CONTROL You can purchase replacement keys or remote controls from an authorized dealer. Authorized dealers can program remote controls for your vehicle. See Remote Control (page 44). To re-program the passive anti-theft system see an authorized dealer. 46 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 MyKey™ Configurable Settings PRINCIPLE OF OPERATION With an admin key, you can configure certain MyKey settings when you first create a MyKey and before you recycle the key or restart the engine. You can also change the settings afterward with an admin key. MyKey allows you to program keys with restricted driving modes to promote good driving habits. All but one of the keys can be activated with these restricted modes. Any keys that remain unprogrammed are referred to as administrator keys or admin keys. They can be used to: • • • • create a MyKey program configurable MyKey settings clear all MyKey features. When you have created a MyKey, you can access the following information by using the information display to determine: • • • How many admin keys and MyKeys are programmed to your vehicle. The total distance your vehicle traveled with a MyKey. • Note: Switch the ignition on to use the system. Note: All MyKeys are programmed to the same settings. You cannot program them individually. Non-configurable Settings • The following settings cannot be changed by an admin key user: • • • • Belt-Minder. You cannot disable this feature. The audio system will mute when the front seat passengers’ safety belts are not fastened. Early low fuel. The low-fuel warning activates earlier, giving the MyKey user more time to refuel. Driver assist features, if equipped on your vehicle, are forced on: parking aid and blind spot information system (BLIS) with cross traffic alert. Satellite radio adult content restrictions. CREATING A MYKEY You can program a MyKey using the information display control on the steering wheel. See Information Displays (page 79). Insert the key you want to program into the ignition and switch the ignition on. 47 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 A vehicle speed limit can be set. Warnings will be shown in the display followed by an audible tone when your vehicle reaches the set speed. You cannot override the set speed by fully depressing the accelerator pedal or by setting cruise control. Vehicle speed minders of 45, 55 or 65 mph (75, 90 or 105 km/h). Once you select a speed, it will be shown in the display, followed by an audible tone when the preselected vehicle speed is exceeded. Audio system maximum volume of 45%. A message will be shown in the display when you attempt to exceed the limited volume. Also, the speed-sensitive or compensated automatic volume control will be disabled. Always on setting. When this is selected, you will not be able to turn off Advance Trac, 911 Assist or the do not disturb feature (if your vehicle is equipped with these features). MyKey™ Press the left arrow button to access the main menu and scroll to: Message Action and Description Settings Press the OK button. MyKey Press the OK button. Create MyKey When prompted, hold the OK button until you see a message informing you to label this key as a MyKey. The key will be restricted at your vehicle's next start. Make sure you label the key so you can distinguish it from the admin keys. You can also program configurable settings for the key(s). Refer to the following Programming/Changing Configurable Settings. Programming/Changing Configurable Settings Switch the ignition on using an admin key or fob. Use the information display to access the configurable MyKey settings, scroll to: Message Action and Description Settings Press the OK button. MyKey Use the up and down arrow buttons to scroll to a configurable feature. Press the OK or right arrow button to make a selection. Choose your applicable setting. Note: You can clear or change your MyKey settings at any time during the same key cycle as you created the MyKey. Once you switch the ignition off you will need an admin key to change or clear your MyKey settings. Switch the ignition on using an admin key or fob. CLEARING ALL MYKEYS You can clear or change your MyKey settings using the information display control on the steering wheel. See Information Displays (page 79). 48 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 MyKey™ To clear all MyKeys of all MyKey settings, press the left arrow button to access the main menu and scroll to: Message Action and Description Settings Press the OK button. MyKey Press the OK button. Clear MyKey Press and hold the OK button until the following message displays. All MyKeys Cleared Note: When you clear your MyKeys, you remove all restrictions and return all MyKeys to their original admin key status. 49 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 MyKey™ You can find information on programmed MyKey(s) using the information display control on the steering wheel. See Information Displays (page 79). CHECKING MYKEY SYSTEM STATUS To find information on a programed MyKey(s), press the left arrow button to access the main menu and scroll to: Message Description Settings Press the OK button. MyKey Press the OK button. Select one of the following: MyKey Dist. Tracks the distance when drivers use a MyKey. The only way to delete the accumulated distance is by using an admin key to clear your MyKey. If the distance does not accumulate as expected, then the intended user is not using the MyKey, or an admin key user recently cleared and then recreated a MyKey. {0} MyKeys Indicates the number of MyKeys programed to your vehicle. Use this feature to detect how many MyKeys you have for your vehicle and determine when a MyKey has been deleted. {0} Admin Keys Indicates how many admin keys are programed to your vehicle. Use this feature to determine how many unrestricted keys you have for your vehicle, and detect if an additional MyKey has been programed. 50 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 MyKey™ 2. Start your vehicle using your remote start fob. 3. See Clearing All MyKeys (page 48). Follow Steps 1-3. USING MYKEY WITH REMOTE START SYSTEMS Vehicles With Ford-Approved Aftermarket Remote Start Systems After clearing your MyKeys, you can create a new MyKey. See Creating a MyKey (page 47). When using a Ford-approved aftermarket remote start system, the vehicle recognizes the remote start system as an additional admin key. It is the vehicle’s default setting. You can also program the remote start as a MyKey. As a result, the MyKey system status menu display includes the remote start system as an additional key in the total count of programed keys. See Checking MyKey System Status (page 50). Note: For vehicles with Intelligent Access keys (push-button start), you cannot program the remote start system as a MyKey. Always treat the remote start fob as you would any other admin key. Vehicles With Non-Ford-Approved Aftermarket Remote Start Systems MyKey is not compatible with non-Ford-approved aftermarket remote start systems. If you choose to install a remote start system, see an authorized dealer for a Ford-approved remote start system. When you start your vehicle with a Ford-approved aftermarket remote start system, the system stalls the engine after you open the door or shift your vehicle into gear. This is intentional. When you restart your vehicle, it reads the Key or intelligent Key fob status instead of the remote start system status. The following information may help if you choose to install a non-Ford-approved remote start system. The actions provided below do not make MyKey compatible with non-Ford-approved remote start systems, but may help you retain some MyKey functions. As an added precaution, owners of vehicles fitted with traditional keys may want to program the remote start system as a MyKey, if the MyKey driver uses the remote start fob. That way, when the MyKey driver starts the vehicle with the remote start system, the MyKey restrictions remain active. When using a non-Ford-approved remote start system, the vehicle may recognize the remote start system as an additional admin key with its associated privileges. If you restart the engine by inserting a key into the ignition cylinder and recycling the ignition completely, then you may retain some MyKey functions. This action forces your vehicle to read the traditional key instead of the remote start fob and then uses the MyKey associated privileges. With a Ford-approved aftermarket remote start system, it is possible to program all keys as MyKeys unintentionally. If this happens, then the remote start fob is the admin key. If you want to have only one key as a MyKey, or do not want to have any MyKeys, then you need to use your remote start to clear all MyKeys. In that case, follow these steps: 1. Note: The MyKey system status menu display may include the remote start system as an additional key in the total count of programed keys. See Checking MyKey System Status (page 50). Enter your vehicle and close all doors. 51 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 MyKey™ As an added precaution, owners of vehicles fitted with traditional keys may want to program the remote start system as a MyKey, if the MyKey driver uses the remote start fob. That way, when the MyKey driver starts the vehicle with the remote start system, the MyKey restrictions remain active. 1. Enter your vehicle and close all doors. 2. Start your vehicle using your non-Ford-approved remote start fob. 3. See Clearing All MyKeys (page 48). Follow Steps 1-3. After clearing your MyKeys, you can create a new MyKey. See Creating a MyKey (page 47). With a non-Ford-approved aftermarket remote start system, it is possible to program all keys as MyKeys unintentionally. If this happens, then the remote start fob is the admin key. If you want to have only one key as a MyKey, or do not want to have any MyKeys, then you need to use your remote start to clear all MyKeys. In that case, follow these steps: Note: For vehicles with Intelligent Access keys (push-button start), you cannot program the remote start system as a MyKey. Always treat the remote start fob as you would any other admin key. MYKEY TROUBLESHOOTING Condition Potential Causes I cannot create a MyKey. · The key or fob used to start the vehicle does not have admin privileges. · The key or fob used to start the vehicle is the only admin key (there always has to be at least one admin key). · Vehicles with push-button start: The intelligent access key fob is not positioned correctly next to the steering column. See Ignition Switch (page 106). · SecuriLock passive anti-theft system is disabled or in unlimited mode. · The vehicle has been started using a remote start system that is not programmed with admin privileges. See Using MyKey With Remote Start Systems (page 51). I cannot program the configurable settings. · The key or fob used to start your vehicle does not have admin privileges. · No MyKeys are created. See Creating a MyKey (page 47). 52 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 MyKey™ Condition Potential Causes · The vehicle has been started using a remote start system that is not programmed with admin privileges. See Using MyKey With Remote Start Systems (page 51). I cannot clear the MyKeys. · The key or fob used to start your vehicle does not have admin privileges. · No MyKeys are created. See Creating a MyKey (page 47). · The vehicle has been started using a remote start system that is not programmed with admin privileges. See Using MyKey With Remote Start Systems (page 51). I lost the only admin key. Purchase a new key from your authorized dealer. I lost a key Program a spare key. See Passive Anti-Theft System (page 59). I accidentally programmed all keys as MyKeys. · The vehicle has a remote start system that is recognized as an admin key. Clear all MyKeys by using the remote start. See Using MyKey With Remote Start Systems (page 51). · The vehicle's system does not recognize any programmed MyKeys. See Creating a MyKey (page 47). MyKey total includes one additional key. · An unknown key or fob has been created as a MyKey. · The vehicle has a remote start system. See Using MyKey With Remote Start Systems (page 51). Admin key total includes one additional · An unknown key or fob has been programmed key. to the vehicle as an admin key. · The vehicle has a remote start system. See Using MyKey With Remote Start Systems (page 51). MyKey distances do not accumulate. · The MyKey user is not using the MyKey. · An admin key holder cleared the MyKeys and created new MyKeys. · The key system has been reset. No MyKey functions with the Intelligent · An admin fob is present at vehicle start. Access key. · No MyKeys are created. See Creating a MyKey (page 47). 53 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Locks LOCKING AND UNLOCKING Note: The liftgate does not automatically open. Note: Make sure you have locked your vehicle before leaving it unattended. Note: The liftgate unlocks if all the doors are unlocked. Note: Do not leave the keys in your vehicle. Reprogramming the Unlocking Function Locking You can reprogram the unlocking function so that only the driver door unlocks. See Remote Control (page 44). Locking With the Key Turn the top of the key toward the rear of your vehicle. Locking and Unlocking Confirmation Locking With the Remote Control Press the button. When you lock the doors, the direction indicators flash twice. When you unlock the doors, the direction indicators flash once and a tone sounds. Note: You can lock the driver door with the key. Use the key when the remote control is not functioning. Locking and Unlocking the Doors From Inside Unlocking (If Equipped) B Unlocking With the Key Turn the top of the key toward the front of your vehicle. Unlocking With the Remote Control Press the button. A Note: You can unlock the driver door with the key. Use the key when the remote control is not functioning. E148829 Note: When you leave your vehicle unattended for several weeks, the remote control turns off. Lock. B Unlock. You can see the door lock status in the instrument panel. The lamp illuminates when you lock your vehicle. Note: Unlock your vehicle and start the engine using the key. Unlocking and starting your vehicle once enables the remote control. Unlocking the Rear Cargo Doors Press the button. 54 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 A Locks Opening and Closing the Sliding Door Opening the Sliding Door 1 2 E172313 1. Pull the door handle to release the door check feature. 2. Slide the door to close. Opening and Closing the Double Rear Doors E148804 Pull the interior door handle to open the door. Closing the Sliding Door 2 1 E148805 E171966 55 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Locks Unlocking and Opening the Double Rear Doors From Inside E148806 E175828 1. Lift the locking button up. E178366 E175955 1. Slide the lever to release the catch. 2. Fully open the cargo door. 2. Push the inner release lever down to open the door. 56 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Locks E148806 E179501 Rear Emergency Exit Pull the interior handle up to open the door in an emergency. Wagon and Bus Automatic Locking You can set your vehicle's doors to lock automatically when you exceed 5 mph (8 km/h). You can switch this on in the information display. See Information Displays (page 79). If you have switched automatic locking on, either use the interior door unlock button or switch the ignition off and use the key or remote control to unlock the rear or sliding door. Automatic Re-Locking The doors re-lock automatically if you do not open a door within 45 seconds of unlocking your vehicle with the remote control. The door locks and the alarm returns to its previous state. E179502 Automatic Unlocking You can switch this function on using the information display. See Information Displays (page 79). If you have switched this function on, the automatic unlocking feature unlocks all doors within 10 minutes of the end of a drive cycle, when the driver door is opened and the ignition is off. 57 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Locks One-Stage Unlocking The locks on van, bus or wagon and Kombi have two zones, cabin and cargo. For van and Kombi, the cargo area includes the rear doors and the sliding door. For bus or wagon, the cargo area includes the rear doors. You can switch on this function using the information display. See Information Displays (page 79). If you have switched on this function, you unlock all doors including the rear doors and the sliding door. • Note: When you unlock the doors, the direction indicators flash once. • You unlock all of the doors when you: • Pull either interior handle. • Turn the key in the driver door lock. • Press the unlock button on the remote control once. • Press the interior unlock button once. If you now open a door within the unlocked zone, the other doors in that zone automatically lock. Configurable Unlocking Configurable unlocking is set when you purchase your vehicle. It allows you to select which doors unlock when you press, once or twice, the unlock button or the cargo area unlock button on your remote control. You cannot switch this feature back on if you had it switched off. See an authorized dealer for further information. Two-Stage Unlocking Note: When you unlock the doors, the direction indicators flash once. You unlock the front doors when you: • Pull either interior handle. • Turn the key in the driver door lock. • Press the unlock button on the remote control once. • Press the interior unlock button once. You unlock the front doors and cargo area when you: • Turn the key in the driver door lock to the unlock position twice within three seconds. • Press the unlock button on the remote control twice within three seconds. • Press the interior unlock button twice within three seconds. Zone Re-Locking If you enable zone re-locking and open one door, all other doors remain locked. See an authorized dealer for further information. 58 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Exit your vehicle and press the lock button. Press the unlock button or the cargo area unlock button once to open the respective zone. Security Automatic Disarming PASSIVE ANTI-THEFT SYSTEM Switching the ignition on with a correctly coded key disarms the engine immobilization system. Note: The system is not compatible with non-Ford aftermarket remote start systems. Use of these systems may result in vehicle starting problems and a loss of security protection. Replacement Keys The integrated keyhead transmitter functions as a programmed ignition key that operates all the locks and starts your vehicle, as well as a remote control. Note: Metallic objects, electronic devices or a second coded key on the same key chain may cause vehicle starting problems if they are too close to the key when starting the engine. Prevent these objects from touching the coded key while starting the engine. Switch the ignition off, move all objects on the key chain away from the coded key and restart the engine if a problem occurs. If your keys are lost or stolen and you do not have a spare correctly coded key, you will need to have your vehicle towed to an authorized dealer. You need to erase the coded keys from your vehicle and program new coded keys. Store an extra correctly coded key away from the vehicle in a safe place to help prevent any inconveniences. See an authorized dealer to purchase additional spare or replacement keys. Note: Do not leave a duplicate coded key in the vehicle. Always take your keys and lock all doors when leaving the vehicle. SecuriLock® Programming a Spare Integrated Keyhead Transmitter The system is an engine immobilization system. It is designed to help prevent the engine from being started unless a correctly coded key for your vehicle is used. Using an incorrectly coded key may prevent the engine from starting. A message may appear in the information display. You can program your own integrated keyhead transmitter or standard SecuriLock coded keys to your vehicle. This procedure will program both the engine immobilizer keycode and the remote entry portion of the remote control to your vehicle If you are unable to start the engine with a correctly coded key, a malfunction has happened and a message may appear in the information display. Only use integrated keyhead transmitters or standard SecuriLock keys. You must have two previously programmed correctly coded keys and the new unprogrammed key readily accessible. See an authorized dealer to have the spare key programmed if two previously programmed correctly coded keys are not available. Automatic Arming The engine immobilization system arms immediately after you switch the ignition off. Read and understand the entire procedure before you begin. 1. 59 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Insert the first previously programmed correctly coded key into the ignition. Security 2. Switch the ignition from off to on. Keep the ignition on for at least three seconds, but no more than 10 seconds. 3. Switch the ignition off and remove the first correctly coded key from the ignition. 4. After three seconds but within 10 seconds of switching the ignition off, insert the second previously correctly coded key into the ignition. 5. Switch the ignition from off to on. Keep the ignition on for at least three seconds, but no more than 10 seconds. 6. Switch the ignition off and remove the second previously programmed correctly coded key from the ignition. 7. After three seconds but within 10 seconds of switching the ignition off and removing the previously programmed correctly coded key, insert the new unprogrammed key into the ignition. 8. Switch the ignition from off to on. Keep the ignition on for at least six seconds. 9. Remove the newly programmed correctly coded key from the ignition. ANTI-THEFT ALARM (If Equipped) Alarm System The perimeter alarm is a deterrent against unauthorized access to your vehicle through the doors, luggage compartment and the hood. It also protects the audio unit. Triggering the Alarm Once armed, the alarm is triggered in any of the following ways: • • • If the alarm is triggered, the horn will sound for 30 seconds and the hazard warning flasher will flash for five minutes. Any further attempts to perform one of the above will trigger the alarm again. Arming the Alarm If the key has been successfully programmed it will start the engine and operate the remote entry system (if the new key is an integrated keyhead transmitter). To arm the alarm, lock your vehicle. See Locks (page 54). Disarming the Alarm If the key was not successfully programmed, wait 10 seconds and repeat Steps 1 through 8. If you are still unsuccessful, take your vehicle to an authorized dealer. Disarm and silence the alarm by unlocking the doors with the key and switching the ignition on with a correctly coded key within 12 seconds, or by unlocking the doors or the cargo area with the remote control. Note: You can program a maximum of eight coded keys to your vehicle. All eight can be integrated keyhead transmitters. 60 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 If someone opens a door, cargo area or the hood without a valid key or remote control. If someone removes the audio or navigation system. If you switch the ignition on without a valid key. Steering Wheel ADJUSTING THE STEERING WHEEL WARNING Do not adjust the steering wheel when your vehicle is moving. Note: Make sure that you are sitting in the correct position. See Sitting in the Correct Position (page 95). 3 E95179 2 3. Lock the steering column. AUDIO CONTROL - VEHICLES WITHOUT: TOUCHSCREEN DISPLAY 1 2 A D E95178 1. Unlock the steering column. 2. Adjust the steering wheel to the desired position. C B E129463 61 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 A Volume up B Seek up or next C Volume down D Seek down or previous Steering Wheel Seek, Next or Previous VOICE CONTROL - VEHICLES WITHOUT: TOUCHSCREEN DISPLAY Press the seek button to: • Tune the radio to the next or previous stored preset. • Play the next or the previous track. Press and hold the seek button to: • Tune the radio to the next station up or down the frequency band. • Seek through a track. AUDIO CONTROL - VEHICLES WITH: TOUCHSCREEN DISPLAY Select the required source on the audio unit. E129464 You can operate the following functions with the control: Pull the control to select or deselect voice control. See SYNC™ (page 300). A VOICE CONTROL - VEHICLES WITH: TOUCHSCREEN DISPLAY E B D C E129462 A Volume up B Seek up or next C Volume down D Seek down or previous E Mode E161798 Pull the control to select or deselect voice control. See MyFord Touch™ (page 349). See MyFord Touch™ (page 349). Press M to select the audio source. 62 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Steering Wheel MyFord Touch® Controls (If Equipped) INFORMATION DISPLAY CONTROL Your steering wheel controls may also have these additional features. Press to go to the home screen. E142613 Press to go to the information screen. E142608 See MyFord Touch™ (page 349). CRUISE CONTROL E130248 See Information Displays (page 79). E142437 See Cruise Control (page 147). 63 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Wipers and Washers Intermittent Wipe WINDSHIELD WIPERS Defrost the windshield before you switch the windshield wipers on. A B Do not operate the windshield wipers on a dry windshield. This may scratch the glass, damage the wiper blades or cause the wiper motor to overheat. Always use the windshield washers before you switch the windshield wipers on. C D C E169314 B A Short wipe interval. B Intermittent wipe. C Long wipe interval. Use the rotary control to adjust the intermittent wipe interval. A E169313 AUTOWIPERS A Single wipe. B Intermittent wipe. C Normal wipe. D High-speed wipe. Defrost the windshield before you switch the windshield wipers on. Do not operate the windshield wipers on a dry windshield. This may scratch the glass, damage the wiper blades or cause the wiper motor to overheat. Always use the windshield washers before you switch the windshield wipers on. Note: Make sure you switch the windshield wipers off before entering a car wash. Note: If streaks or smears appear on the windshield, clean the windshield and the wiper blades. If that does not resolve the issue, install new wiper blades. 64 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Wipers and Washers A Keep the outside of the windshield clean. The rain sensor is very sensitive and the wipers may operate if dirt, mist or insects hit the windshield. B Note: Make sure you switch the windshield wipers off before entering a car wash. Note: If streaks or smears appear on the windshield, clean the windshield and the wiper blades. If that does not resolve the issue, install new wiper blades. C E169314 A High sensitivity. B On. C Low sensitivity. Note: If you switch autolamps and autowipers on, the headlamps will automatically turn on when the windshield wipers continuously operate. WINDSHIELD WASHERS During wet or winter driving conditions where ice, snow or a salty road mist is present, inconsistent or unexpected wiping or smearing may occur. In these conditions, you can do the following: • Lower the sensitivity of the autowipers to reduce the amount of smearing on the windshield. • Switch to normal or high-speed wipe. • Switch autowipers off. Autowipers uses a rain sensor located in the area around the interior mirror. The wipers will operate when the rain sensor detects water on the windshield. The rain sensor will continue to monitor the amount of water on the windshield and automatically adjust the speed of the wipers. E169316 Pull the lever toward you to operate the windshield washers. When you release the lever, wiping will continue for a short period of time. Note: Do not operate the washers when the washer reservoir is empty. This may cause the washer pump to overheat. Use the rotary control to adjust the sensitivity of the autowipers. When you select low sensitivity, the wipers will operate when the sensor detects a large amount of water on the windshield. When you select high sensitivity, the wipers will operate when the sensor detects a small amount of water on the windshield. Note: Do not operate the windshield washers for more than 10 seconds at a time. 65 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Lighting GENERAL INFORMATION LIGHTING CONTROL Condensation in Lamp Assemblies Lighting Control Positions Exterior lamps have vents to accommodate normal changes in air pressure. A Condensation can be a natural by-product of this design. When moist air enters the lamp assembly through the vents, there is a possibility that condensation can occur when the temperature is cold. When normal condensation occurs, a fine mist can form on the interior of the lens. The fine mist eventually clears and exits through the vents during normal operation. B C D E175211 Clearing time may take as long as 48 hours under dry weather conditions. Examples of acceptable condensation are: • The presence of a fine mist (no streaks, drip marks or large droplets). • A fine mist covers less than 50% of the lens. A Off. B Position lamps, instrument panel lamps, license plate lamps. C Headlamps. D Autolamps. High Beams Examples of unacceptable condensation are: • A water puddle inside the lamp. • Streaks, drip marks or large droplets present on the interior of the lens. If you see any unacceptable condensation, have your vehicle checked by an authorized dealer. E163718 Push the lever forward to switch the high beams on. Push the lever forward again or pull the lever toward you to switch the high beams off. 66 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Lighting Headlamp Flasher E163719 Pull the lever slightly toward the steering wheel. E142451 When the lighting control is in the autolamps position, the headlamps automatically turn on in low light situations or when the wipers activate. Parking Lamps Select position B on the lighting control to switch the parking lamps on. The headlamps will remain on for a period of time after you switch the ignition off. Use the information display controls to adjust the period of time that the headlamps remain on. Note: Prolonged use of the parking lamps will cause the battery to run out of charge. AUTOLAMPS (If Equipped) Note: If you switch autolamps on, you can only switch the high beam headlamps on once autolamps has turned the headlamps on. WARNING The autolamps switch position may not turn on the headlamps in all low visibility conditions, for example fog. Make sure the headlamps are switched to auto or on, during all low visibility conditions. Failure to do so may result in a crash. Windshield Wiper Activated Rain Lights The windshield wiper activated rain lights turn on within 10 seconds when you switch the windshield wipers on and the lighting control is in the autolamps position. They turn off approximately 60 seconds after you switch the windshield wipers off. The rain lights will not turn on by wiper activation: • During a mist wipe. • When the wipers are on to clear washer fluid during a wash condition. • If the wipers are in intermittent mode. 67 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Lighting Switching the Rain Lights On and Off control on the steering wheel. See General Information (page 79). See Information Messages (page 84). You can switch the rain light feature on and off using the information display To switch the rain lights feature on and off, scroll to: Message Action and Description Settings Press the OK button. Lighting Press the OK button. Rain Light Choose your applicable setting. DAYTIME RUNNING LAMPS (If INSTRUMENT LIGHTING DIMMER Equipped) WARNING The daytime running lamp system does not turn on the rear lamps and may not provide adequate lighting during low visibility driving conditions. Make sure the headlamps are switched to auto or on, during all low visibility conditions. Failure to do so may result in a crash. E175219 When you switch the ignition on and the lighting control is in the off, autolamps or parking lamp position, the daytime running lamps will automatically turn on whenever the headlamps are off. They automatically turn off when the headlamps turn on. Press it repeatedly or press it and hold it until the desired level is reached. Note: If you disconnect the battery or it loses charge the instrument lighting will return to its brightest setting. 68 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Lighting If you set the switch to position B, the courtesy lamps will automatically turn on when you unlock your vehicle or open a door. If you leave a door open with the ignition switched off, they will automatically turn off after a short period of time to prevent the vehicle battery from losing charge. To switch them back on, switch the ignition on for a short period of time. DIRECTION INDICATORS The courtesy lamps will automatically turn on when you switch the ignition off. They will automatically turn off after a short period of time to prevent the vehicle battery from losing charge. E162681 Push the lever up or down to use the direction indicators. INTERIOR LAMPS If you set the switch to position C with the ignition switched off, the courtesy lamps will turn on. They will automatically turn off after a short period of time to prevent the vehicle battery from losing charge. To switch them back on, switch the ignition on for a short period of time. Courtesy Lamp Reading Lamps Note: Tap the lever up or down to make the direction indicators flash three times to indicate a lane change. A B C E112208 If you switch the ignition off, the reading lamps will automatically turn off after a short period of time to prevent the vehicle battery from losing charge. To switch them back on, switch the ignition on for a short period of time. E112207 A Off B Door contact C On 69 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Windows and Mirrors Driver Side One-Touch Up POWER WINDOWS Lift the switch fully and release it. Press or lift it again to stop the window. WARNINGS To avoid risk of injury, do not leave children or pets unattended in your vehicle. Bounce-Back The window will automatically stop and reverse some distance if it detects an obstacle while closing. When closing the power windows, you should verify they are free of obstructions and make sure that children and pets are not in the proximity of the window openings. Overriding the Bounce-Back Feature WARNING When you override the bounce-back feature the window will not reverse if it detects an obstacle. Take care when closing the windows to avoid personal injury or damage to your vehicle. To override this protection feature when there is a resistance, for example in winter: 1. Close the window twice until it reaches the point of resistance and let it reverse. 2. Close the window a third time to the point of resistance. The bounce-back feature is now disabled and you can close the window manually. The window will go past the point of resistance and you can close it fully. E146043 Press the switch to open the window. The window will stop if you release the switch before the window fully opens. Lift the switch to close the window. The window will stop if you release the switch before the window fully closes. If the window does not close after the third attempt the system requires service. Note: You may hear a pulsing noise when just one of the windows is open. Lower the opposite window slightly to reduce this noise. Resetting the Bounce-Back Feature WARNING Accessory Delay (If Equipped) The bounce-back feature remains turned off until it is reset. You can use the window switches for several minutes when you switch the ignition off or until you open either front door. 1. Lift and hold the switch until the window is fully closed. 2. Release the switch. 3. Lift the switch again for one more second. Driver Side One-Touch Down Press the switch fully and release it. Press again or lift it to stop the window. 70 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Windows and Mirrors 4. Release the switch. 5. Lift the switch again for one more second. 6. Open the window and then try to close using the one-touch feature. 7. Repeat the procedure if the window does not close using the one-touch feature. Note: If you have disconnected the battery, you must reset the bounce-back memory. E71281 EXTERIOR MIRRORS Move the controller in the direction of the arrows to adjust the mirror. Power Exterior Mirrors Fold-Away Exterior Mirrors Push the mirror toward the door window glass. Make sure that you fully engage the mirror in its support when you unfold it. WARNING Do not adjust the mirrors when your vehicle is moving. This could result in the loss of control of your vehicle, serious personal injury or death. INTERIOR MIRROR WARNING B Do not adjust the mirror when your vehicle is moving. C A Note: Do not clean the housing or glass of any mirror with harsh abrasives, fuel or other petroleum or ammonia-based cleaning products. You can adjust the interior mirror to your preference. Some mirrors also have a second pivot point. This lets you move the mirror head up or down and from side to side. E71280 A Left-hand mirror. B Off. C Right-hand mirror. Pull the tab below the mirror toward you to reduce glare at night. Auto-Dimming Mirror (If Equipped) Note: Do not block the sensors on the front and back of the mirror. Mirror performance may be affected. A rear center passenger or raised rear center head restraint may also block light from reaching the sensor. 71 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Windows and Mirrors The mirror will dim automatically to reduce glare when bright lights are detected from behind your vehicle. It will automatically return to normal reflection when you select reverse gear to make sure you have a clear view when backing up. REAR QUARTER WINDOWS Opening the Rear Windows (If Equipped) 1 2 E170036 1. Press the unlock button to release the catch. Note: Depending on the lock type fitted, you will have to either press the unlock buttons together or down to release the catch. 2. Hold the catch and push the window open. Make sure the catch engages. Closing the Rear Windows 1. Hold and pull the catch to close the window. 2. Press the catch to engage the lock. 72 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Instrument Cluster GAUGES E184961 A Information display. See Information Displays (page 79). B Speedometer. C Engine coolant temperature gauge. D Tripmeter reset and distance to empty toggle button. E Fuel gauge. F Tachometer. Vehicle Settings and Personalization Information Display See General Information (page 79). Odometer Engine Coolant Temperature Gauge Registers the distance your vehicle has traveled. WARNING Outside Air Temperature Never remove the coolant reservoir cap while the engine is running or hot. Shows the outside air temperature. Trip Computer At normal operating temperature, the needle will remain in the center section. See Trip Computer (page 82). 73 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Instrument Cluster If the needle enters the red section, the engine is overheating. Stop your vehicle as soon as it is safe to do so and switch the engine off. Determine the cause once the engine has cooled down. See Engine Coolant Check (page 206). The needle should move toward F when you refuel your vehicle. If the needle points to E after adding fuel, this indicates your vehicle needs service soon. Note: Do not restart the engine until the cause of overheating has been determined and resolved. • After refueling some variability in needle position is normal: Tripmeter Reset and Distance to Empty (If Equipped) • Press the button to change between the tripmeter and distance to empty information. Press and hold the button to reset the tripmeter. • Fuel Gauge Note: The fuel gauge may vary slightly when your vehicle is moving or on a gradient. It may take a short time for the needle to reach F after leaving the gas station. This is normal and depends upon the slope of pavement at the gas station. The fuel amount dispensed into the tank is a little less or more than the gauge indicated. This is normal and depends upon the slope of pavement at the gas station. If the gas station nozzle shuts off before the tank is full, try a different gas pump nozzle. Low Fuel Reminder A low fuel reminder triggers when the fuel gauge needle is at 1/16th. Switch the ignition on. The fuel gauge will indicate approximately how much fuel is in the fuel tank. The arrow adjacent to the fuel pump symbol indicates on which side of your vehicle the fuel filler door is located. Variations: Driving type (fuel economy conditions) Fuel gauge position Distance-to-empty Highway driving 1/16th 35 miles to 80 miles (56 km to 129 km) Severe duty driving (trailer towing, extended idle) 1/16th 35 miles (56km) 74 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Instrument Cluster If it illuminates when your vehicle is moving, make sure the parking brake is disengaged. If the parking brake is disengaged, this indicates low brake fluid level or a brake system fault. Have the system checked by an authorized dealer. WARNING LAMPS AND INDICATORS The following warning lamps and indicators will alert you to a vehicle condition that may become serious. Some lamps will illuminate when you start your vehicle to make sure they work. If any lamps remain on after starting your vehicle, refer to the respective system warning lamp for further information. Battery If it illuminates when you are driving, this indicates a malfunction. Switch off all unnecessary electrical equipment. Have the system checked by an authorized dealer. Note: Some warning indicators appear in the information display and function the same as a warning lamp but do not illuminate when you start your vehicle. Diesel Warning Lamps (If Equipped) Anti-Lock Brake System The following warning lamps are unique for vehicles equipped with a diesel engine. If it illuminates when you are driving, this indicates a malfunction. Your vehicle will continue to have normal braking without Anti-lock brake system function. Have the system checked by an authorized dealer. Exhaust Emission Fluid If it illuminates when you are driving, this indicates the diesel E163176 exhaust fluid is low. See Selective Catalytic Reduction System (page 117). Brake System WARNINGS Driving your vehicle with the warning lamp on is dangerous. A significant decrease in braking performance may occur. It will take you longer to stop your vehicle. Have the system checked by an authorized dealer. If it illuminates when you are driving, and the diesel exhaust fluid is at a sufficient level, this indicates a system malfunction. Have your vehicle checked by an authorized dealer. Driving extended distances with the parking brake engaged can cause brake failure and the risk of personal injury. It illuminates when you switch the ignition on, wait until it extinguishes before starting the E138644 Glow Plug engine. It illuminates when you engage the parking brake and the ignition is on. 75 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Instrument Cluster Water In Fuel All Vehicles It will illuminate if there is excess water in the fuel filter. Drain off the water immediately. See Draining the Fuel Filter Water Trap (page 210). If it illuminates after draining the water, this indicates a fuel filter service is required. Have your vehicle checked by an authorized dealer immediately. If either lamp illuminates when the engine is running, this indicates a malfunction. The engine will continue to run but it may have limited power. If either lamp flashes when you are driving, reduce the speed of your vehicle immediately. If it continues to flash, avoid heavy acceleration or deceleration. Have your vehicle checked by an authorized dealer. Direction Indicator WARNING Have this checked immediately. Flashes during operation. A sudden increase in the rate of flashing warns of a failed indicator bulb. See Changing a Bulb (page 217). If both lamps illuminate when the engine is running, stop your vehicle as soon as it is safe to do so. You may notice a reduction in vehicle speed caused by reduced engine power. Switch the ignition off and attempt to restart the engine. Have your vehicle checked by an authorized dealer. Door Ajar It illuminates when you switch the ignition on and remains on if any door or the hood is open. Front Airbag Engine Coolant Temperature If it fails to illuminate when you start your vehicle, continues to flash or remains on, this indicates a malfunction. Have your vehicle checked by an authorized dealer. If it illuminates when you are driving, this indicates a malfunction. Stop your vehicle as soon as it is safe to do so and switch the engine off. Have your vehicle checked by an authorized dealer. High Beam It will illuminate when you switch the headlamp high beam on. It will flash when you use the headlamp flasher. Engine Warning Lamps Malfunction Indicator Lane Departure It will illuminate when you switch the system off. Service Required It will illuminate when the system is not available and may indicate a system malfunction. Have your vehicle checked by an authorized dealer. 76 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Instrument Cluster Safety Belt Minder Low Fuel Level If it illuminates when you are driving, refuel as soon as possible. It will illuminate and a chime will sound to remind you to fasten your safety belt. See Safety Belt Minder (page 31). Low Tire Pressure Warning Stability Control It will illuminate if the tire pressure in one or more tires is below the correct pressure. See Tire Pressure Monitoring System (page 251). It will illuminate for a short period of time when you switch E138639 the ignition on. If it illuminates when you are driving, this indicates a malfunction. During a malfunction, the system turns off. Have your vehicle checked by an authorized dealer as soon as possible. Message Center Warning It will illuminate when a new message is stored in the information display. It will be red or amber in color depending on the severity of the message and will remain on until the cause of the message has been rectified. See Information Messages (page 84). Note: While driving, it flashes when the system is operating. Transmission Tow/Haul E161509 Oil Pressure If the warning lamp flashes continuously, this indicates a malfunction and damage to the transmission could occur. Have your vehicle checked by an authorized dealer as soon as possible. WARNING If it illuminates when you are driving do not continue your journey, even if the oil level is correct. Have your vehicle checked by an authorized dealer. AUDIBLE WARNINGS AND INDICATORS If it stays on after starting the engine or illuminates when you are driving, this indicates a malfunction. Stop your vehicle as soon as it is safe to do so and switch the engine off. Check the engine oil level. See Engine Oil Check (page 204). Airbag Secondary Warning Sounds when there is a fault with the airbag system and the airbag warning lamp. Park Lamp Door Ajar It will illuminate when you switch the headlamp low beam or the side and tail lamps on. Sounds when a door is not fully closed and your vehicle is moving. 77 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 It will illuminate when you switch the system on. See Automatic Transmission (page 133). Instrument Cluster Exterior Lamps On Sounds when you remove the key from the ignition and open the driver door, and you have left the headlamps or parking lamps on. Gearshift Lever not in Park (P) Sounds when the driver door is open, the key is in the ignition and the gearshift lever is not in park (P). Key in Ignition Sounds when the driver door is open and the key is in the ignition. Parking Brake On Sounds when the parking brake is on and your vehicle is moving. If the warning chime continues to sound when you release the parking brake, have the system checked by an authorized dealer. Safety Belt Minder WARNINGS The safety belt minder remains in stand-by mode when the front safety belts have been fastened. It will sound if either safety belt is unfastened. Do not sit on top of a fastened safety belt to prevent the safety belt minder from coming on. The occupant protection system will only provide optimum protection when you use the safety belt correctly. Sounds when a safety belt is unfastened in an occupied seat and your vehicle is moving. 78 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Information Displays Information Display Controls GENERAL INFORMATION WARNING Driving while distracted can result in loss of vehicle control, crash and injury. We strongly recommend that you use extreme caution when using any device that may take your focus off the road. Your primary responsibility is the safe operation of your vehicle. We recommend against the use of any hand-held device while driving and encourage the use of voice-operated systems when possible. Make sure you are aware of all applicable local laws that may affect the use of electronic devices while driving. E138659 • You can control various systems on your vehicle using the information display controls on the steering wheel. • The information display shows the corresponding information. • • Press the up and down arrow buttons to scroll through and highlight the options within a menu. Press the right arrow button to enter a submenu. Press the left arrow button to exit a submenu. Press the OK button to choose and confirm settings or messages. Menu Structure - Information Display You can access the menu using the information display control. Note: Some options may appear slightly different or not at all if the items are optional. Trip computer 1 Message Trip computer Dist to empty Trip odometer Trip Timer 79 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Information Displays Message Average Fuel All values 1 See Trip Computer (page 82). See Gauges (page 73). Information Message Driver Alert DEF level Engine Hours Idle: Engine Hours Running: Trailer Brake Gain: System check Settings Message Driver Assist Action Driver Alert Off Trailer Brake Electric Elec.-Hydraulic Lane Keeping Sensitivity Intensity Lighting Display Hdlamp Delay Manual or xx Seconds Rain Light Choose your applicable setting Language Choose your applicable setting 80 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Information Displays Message Chimes Convenience Action Measure unit Choose your applicable setting Distance Choose your applicable setting Temp unit Choose your applicable setting Information Off Warning Off Locks Autolock Autounlock Global Unlock Custom locking System Reset Hold OK to Reset System to Factory Default Menu Structure - Information and Entertainment Display System Check All active warnings will display first if applicable. The system check menu may appear different based upon equipment options and current vehicle status. Use the up and down arrow buttons to scroll through the list. See Information Messages (page 84). You can access the menu using the information and entertainment display control. Note: Some options may appear slightly different or not at all if the items are optional. SYNC-Media allows you to access the SYNC features. SYNC-Phone Message Dial a number Phone Redial Phonebook Call History Incoming calls Outgoing calls 81 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Information Displays Message Missed calls Speed Dial Text messaging BT Devices Phone settings Set as master Phonebook pref. Set ringtone Phone status Text msg notify Emerg. Assist. SYNC-Menu Message SYNC-Settings Bluetooth on Set defaults Master reset System info Voice settings Browse USB SYNC-Apps All Values TRIP COMPUTER Indicates all the respective trip, distance, time and average fuel consumption information. Resetting the Trip Computer Press and hold OK on the current screen to reset the respective trip, distance, time and average fuel consumption information. Average Fuel Consumption Indicates the average fuel consumption since the function was last reset. 82 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Information Displays Distance to Empty Trip Timer Indicates the approximate distance your vehicle will travel on the fuel remaining in the tank. Changes in driving pattern may cause the value to vary. Registers the elapsed time of individual journeys or the total time since the function was last reset. Outside Air Temperature PERSONALIZED SETTINGS Shows the outside air temperature. Measure Units Trip Odometer You can choose personalized settings using the information display control on the steering wheel. See Information Displays (page 79). Registers the distance traveled of individual journeys. To swap between imperial and metric units, scroll to: Message Action and Description Display Press the OK button. Measure unit Choose your applicable setting. Press the OK button. Swapping between imperial and metric units will affect the following displays: • Average fuel consumption. • Distance to empty. • Odometer. • Outside temperature units. • Trip odometer. Switching Chimes Off or On You can switch chimes off or on using the information display control on the steering wheel. See Information Displays (page 79). 83 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Information Displays To switch chimes off or on, scroll to: Message Action Warning Choose your applicable setting. Press the OK button. Information Choose your applicable setting. Press the OK button. Note: The default setting is on. Note: You cannot switch safety warning message chimes off. You need to confirm certain messages before you can access the menus. The information display will automatically remove other messages after a short period of time. INFORMATION MESSAGES Note: Depending on your vehicle options and instrument cluster type, not all of the messages will display or be available. The information display may abbreviate or shorten certain messages. The message indicator illuminates to supplement some messages. The message indicator will be red or amber depending on the severity of the relevant system condition. The message indicator will remain on until a system repair is completed. E130248 Press the OK button to acknowledge and remove some messages from the information display. A system-specific symbol with a message indicator may supplement some messages. Airbag Message Description and Action Airbag fault Service now The system has detected a fault that requires service. 84 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Information Displays Battery and Charging System Message Description and Action Electrical system overvoltage Stop safely Stop your vehicle as soon as it is safe to do so and switch the ignition off. The system has detected a fault that requires service. Battery low See manual Switch off all unnecessary electrical systems and devices. The system has detected a fault that requires service. Diesel Exhaust Fluid Message Description and Action DEF level low Range XXX Indicates the approximate distance remaining before the mi Refill now diesel exhaust fluid tank will be empty. Refill the diesel exhaust fluid tank as soon as possible. DEF level empty YY MPH Indicates the approximate distance remaining before the diesel exhaust fluid tank will be empty and when it will restrict max in XXX mi your vehicle speed. Refill the diesel exhaust fluid tank as soon as possible. DEF level empty Speed limited to YY MPH Indicates that the diesel exhaust fluid tank is empty and that your vehicle speed is being restricted. Refill the diesel exhaust fluid tank as soon as possible. DEF level empty YY MPH Indicates that the diesel exhaust fluid tank is empty and that your vehicle speed will be restricted when you restart your max Upon restart vehicle. Refill the diesel exhaust fluid tank as soon as possible. DEF level empty Engine idled soon Indicates that the diesel exhaust fluid tank is empty and that the engine will soon be restricted to idle operation. DEF level empty Engine idled See manual Indicates that the diesel exhaust fluid tank is empty and that the engine is restricted to idle operation. DEF fault YY MPH max in Indicates that your vehicle speed will soon be restricted. The XXXX mi system has detected a fault that requires service. DEF fault Speed limited to YY MPH Indicates that your vehicle speed is restricted. The system has detected a fault that requires service. DEF fault Engine idled soon Indicates that the engine will soon be restricted to idle operation. The system has detected a fault that requires service. 85 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Information Displays Message DEF fault Engine idled See manual Description and Action Indicates that the engine is restricted to idle operation. The system has detected a fault that requires service. DEF level empty YY MPH Indicates that your vehicle speed will be restricted when you max Upon restart restart your vehicle. The system has detected a fault that requires service. Note: When filling the diesel exhaust fluid tank from empty, there may be a short period before the increased diesel exhaust fluid level is registered. The system must register the increased diesel exhaust fluid level before your vehicle will return to full power. Door Open Message Driver door ajar Description and Action Stop your vehicle as soon as it is safe to do so and close the door. Driver side rear door ajar Stop your vehicle as soon as it is safe to do so and close the door. Passenger door ajar Stop your vehicle as soon as it is safe to do so and close the door. Passenger side rear door Stop your vehicle as soon as it is safe to do so and close the ajar door. Hood open Stop your vehicle as soon as it is safe to do so and close the hood. Rear load compartment door ajar Stop your vehicle as soon as it is safe to do so and close the door. Emergency rear door ajar Stop your vehicle as soon as it is safe to do so and close the door. Engine Message Description and Action Engine fault Service now The system has detected a fault that requires service. High engine temperature Stop your vehicle as soon as it is safe to do so, allow the Stop safely engine to cool and then check the coolant level. If the warning remains on when you have checked the coolant level, the system has detected a fault that requires service. See Engine Coolant Check (page 206). 86 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Information Displays Lighting Message Description and Action Brake lamp Bulb fault Indicates that a brake lamp bulb has burned out. See Maintenance (page 200). Low beam Bulb fault Indicates that a low beam headlamp bulb has burned out. See Maintenance (page 200). Headlamp fault Service required The system has detected a fault that requires service. Maintenance Message Description and Action Oil change required The engine oil has exceeded the service time or distance limit. Renew the engine oil and oil filter as soon as possible. See Engine Oil Check (page 204). Brake fluid level low Service now The system has detected a fault that requires service. See Brake Fluid Check (page 210). Washer fluid level low Refill the washer fluid reservoir as soon as possible. See Washer Fluid Check (page 210). Parking Aid Message Parking aid fault Service required Description and Action The system has detected a fault that requires service. See Parking Aid (page 143). Parking Brake Message Park brake applied Description and Action The parking brake is applied and your vehicle speed is above 3 mph (5 km/h). If the warning remains on when you have released the parking brake, the system has detected a fault that requires service. 87 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Information Displays Starting System Message Description and Action Press brake to start Press the brake pedal before you start the engine. Cranking time exceeded Indicates that the engine has failed to start. Tire Pressure Monitoring System Message Description and Action Low Tire Pressure The tire pressure is low in one or more tires, check the tire pressures. See Tire Pressure Monitoring System (page 251). Tire Pressure Monitor Fault The system has detected a fault that requires service. Tire Pressure Sensor Fault The system has detected a fault that requires service or the spare tire is in use. See Tire Pressure Monitoring System (page 251). Water in Fuel Message Water detected in fuel Service required Description and Action Drain off the water immediately. See Draining the Fuel Filter Water Trap (page 210). 88 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Climate Control Air Conditioning PRINCIPLE OF OPERATION The system directs air through the evaporator for cooling. The evaporator extracts humidity from the air to help keep the windows free of mist. The system directs the resulting condensation to the outside of your vehicle, which may cause a small pool to form under your vehicle. This is normal. Outside Air Keep the air intakes in front of the windshield free from obstruction (such as snow or leaves) to allow the climate control system to function effectively. Recirculated Air Note: The air conditioning operates only when the temperature is above 39°F (4°C). WARNING Prolonged use of recirculated air may cause the windows to mist up. If the windows mist up, follow the settings for demisting the windshield. Note: When you use air conditioning, your vehicle uses more fuel. AIR VENTS The air currently in the passenger compartment recirculates. Outside air does not enter your vehicle. To close a vent, slide the airflow direction adjuster down. Heating Center Air Vents Heating performance depends on the temperature of the engine coolant. General Information on Controlling the Interior Climate Fully close all the windows. Warming the Interior Direct the air toward your feet. In cold or humid weather conditions, direct some of the air toward the windshield and the door windows. E169287 Cooling the Interior Direct the air toward your face. 89 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Climate Control Side Air Vent E169288 MANUAL CLIMATE CONTROL A B C D E E147011 A Fan speed control: Controls the volume of air circulated in your vehicle. Adjust to select the desired fan speed or switch off. If you switch the fan off, the windshield may fog up. B Recirculated air: Press the button to switch between outside air and recirculated air. When you select recirculated air, the button illuminates and the air currently in the passenger compartment recirculates. This can reduce the time needed to cool the interior and reduce unwanted odors from entering your vehicle. C Temperature control: Controls the temperature of the air circulated in your vehicle. Adjust to select the desired temperature. If you select MAX A/C, the system distributes recirculated air through the instrument panel air vents. This mode is more economical and efficient than normal air conditioning. Turn the temperature control to maximum heat to turn the auxiliary heater on 90 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Climate Control D Air conditioning: Press the button to switch the air conditioning on or off. To improve air conditioning when starting your vehicle, drive with the windows open for two to three minutes. E Air distribution control: Adjust to select the desired air distribution. Note: Keep the air intakes in front of the windshield free from obstruction (such as snow or leaves) to allow the climate control system to function effectively. Select to distribute air through the instrument panel air vents. Select to distribute air through the instrument panel air vents and footwell air vents. Note: To reduce fogging of the windshield during humid weather, adjust the air distribution control to the windshield air vents position. Increase the temperature and fan speed and press the A/C button to improve clearing, if required. Select to distribute air through the footwell air vents. Select to distribute air through the windshield air vents and footwell air vents. Heating the Interior Quickly • Select to distribute air through the windshield air vents. You can also use this setting to defog or clear the windshield of a thin covering of ice. You can also increase the temperature and fan speed to improve clearing. • • Recommended Settings for Heating HINTS ON CONTROLLING THE INTERIOR CLIMATE • General Hints • Note: Prolonged use of recirculated air may cause the windows to fog up. • Note: A small amount of air may be felt from the footwell air vents regardless of the air distribution setting. Adjust the fan speed to the second speed setting. Adjust the temperature control to the midway point of the hot settings. Adjust the air distribution control to the footwell and windshield air vents position. Cooling the Interior Quickly Note: To reduce humidity build-up inside your vehicle, do not drive with the system switched off or with recirculated air always switched on. • Note: Do not place objects under the front seats as this may interfere with the airflow to the rear seats. • • 91 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Adjust the fan speed to the highest speed setting. Adjust the temperature control to the highest setting. Adjust the air distribution control to the footwell air vents position. Adjust the fan speed to the highest speed setting. Adjust the temperature control to the MAX A/C position. Adjust the air distribution control to the instrument panel air vents position. Climate Control Recommended Settings for Cooling Side Window Defogging in Cold Weather • • • • Adjust the fan speed to the second speed setting. Adjust the temperature control to the midway point of the cold settings. Adjust the air distribution control to the instrument panel air vents position. • • Vehicle Stationary for Extended Periods During Extreme High Ambient Temperatures • • • • • • • Apply the parking brake. Move the transmission selector lever to position P or neutral. Adjust the temperature control to the MAX A/C position. Adjust the fan speed to the lowest speed setting. Maximum Cooling Performance in Instrument Panel or Instrument Panel and Footwell Positions • • • 92 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Adjust the air distribution control to the instrument panel and windshield air vents positions. Press the A/C button. Adjust the temperature control to the desired setting. Adjust the fan speed to the highest setting. Direct the instrument panel side air vents toward the side windows. Close the instrument panel vents. Adjust the temperature control to the lowest setting. Press the A/C and recirculated air buttons. Adjust the fan speed to the highest setting initially and then adjust it to suit the desired comfort level. Climate Control REAR PASSENGER CLIMATE CONTROLS A B E175829 A Fan speed control: Controls the volume of air circulated in your vehicle. Adjust to select the desired fan speed or switch off. B Temperature and air distribution control: Controls the temperature of the air circulated in your vehicle. Adjust to select the desired temperature and distribution. Cool air distributes through the top air vents and warm air distributes through the footwell air vents. Note: Switch the air conditioning on to cool the air through the rear air vents. Note: Make sure that the engine is running before switching the heated rear window on. HEATED WINDOWS AND MIRRORS Note: Do not use razor blades or sharp objects to clean the inside of the heated rear window. Do not use razor blades or sharp objects to remove decals from of the inside of the heated rear window. The vehicle warranty does not cover damage to the heated rear window grid lines. Heated Rear Window (If Equipped) E72507 Heated Exterior Mirrors The heated rear window button is located on the instrument panel. Press the button to clear the heated rear window of thin ice and fog. Press the button again to switch the heated rear window off. It will turn off automatically after a short period of time. 93 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Climate Control The heated exterior mirrors will clear the mirror glass of thin ice and fog. They will turn off automatically after a short period of time. Note: Do not use razor blades or sharp objects to remove ice from the mirror glass or attempt to adjust the mirror glass when it is frozen in place. The vehicle warranty does not cover damage to the mirror glass or mirror assembly. Note: Do not clean the mirror glass or mirror assembly with harsh abrasives, fuel or other petroleum-based cleaning products. Note: On vehicles without a heated exterior mirror switch, they will turn on automatically when you switch the heated rear window on. 94 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Seats • SITTING IN THE CORRECT POSITION WARNINGS Do not recline the seat backrest too far as this can cause the occupant to slide under the safety belt, resulting in serious injury in the event of a crash. • Sitting improperly, out of position or with the seat backrest reclined too far, can result in serious injury or death in the event of a crash. Always sit upright against your seat backrest, with your feet on the floor. • • • Do not place objects higher than the seat backrest to reduce the risk of serious injury in the event of a crash or during heavy braking. Adjust the head restraint so that the top of it is level with the top of your head and as far forward as possible. Make sure that you remain comfortable. Keep sufficient distance between yourself and the steering wheel. We recommend a minimum of 10 inches (25 centimeters) between your breastbone and the airbag cover. Hold the steering wheel with your arms slightly bent. Bend your legs slightly so that you can press the pedals fully. Position the shoulder strap of the safety belt over the center of your shoulder and position the lap strap tightly across your hips. Make sure that your driving position is comfortable and that you can maintain full control of your vehicle. HEAD RESTRAINTS WARNING The adjustable head restraint is a safety device. Whenever possible it should be installed and correctly adjusted when the seat is occupied. An incorrectly adjusted head restraint may provide reduced protection to an occupant during certain rear impacts. E68595 When you use them properly, the seat, head restraint, safety belt and airbags will provide optimum protection in the event of a crash. We recommend that you follow these guidelines: • Sit in an upright position with the base of your spine as far back as possible. • Do not recline the seat backrest more than 30 degrees. 95 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Seats Raising the Head Restraint The head restraint consists of: Lift the head restraint up. Lowering the Head Restraint 1. Press and hold button C. 2. Push the head restraint down. Removing the Head Restraint WARNING Do not remove the head restraint from an occupied seat. E138642 A Energy absorbing head restraint. B Steel stems. C Guide sleeve adjust and unlock button. D Guide sleeve unlock and remove button. 1. Lift the head restraint up until it reaches its highest position. 2. Press and hold buttons C and D. 3. Remove the head restraint. Installing the Head Restraint WARNING Adjusting the Head Restraint Install head restraints correctly to help minimize the risk of neck injury in the event of a crash. WARNINGS Adjust the head restraints for all passengers before you drive your vehicle. This will help minimize the risk of neck injury in the event of a crash. Do not adjust the head restraints when your vehicle is moving. 1. Align the steel stems into the guide sleeves and push the head restraint down until in locks. 2. Adjust the head restraint. Do not adjust the head restraints when your vehicle is moving. Adjust the head restraint so that the top of it is level with the top of your head. Note: Adjust the seat backrest to an upright driving position before adjusting the head restraint. Adjust the head restraint so that the top of it is level with the top of your head and as far forward as possible. Make sure that you remain comfortable. If you are extremely tall, adjust the head restraint to its highest position. 96 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Seats Note: The driver seat has removable stop bolts on the track to enable access to the vehicle battery. See Changing the 12V Battery (page 213). MANUAL SEATS Moving the Seat Backward or Forward Adjusting the Lumbar Support WARNINGS Do not place cargo or any objects behind the seat backrest before returning it to the original position. Pull on the seat backrest to make sure that it has fully latched after returning the seat backrest to its original position. An unlatched seat may become dangerous if you stop suddenly or have a crash. Do not adjust the driver seat when your vehicle is moving. This may result in sudden seat movement, causing the loss of control of your vehicle. Make sure the driver seat fully locks into place by rocking it backward and forward. E146386 1. Rotate the handle clockwise or counter clockwise to attain the desired lumbar support. Recline Adjustment WARNINGS Do not adjust the driver seat backrest when your vehicle is moving. This may result in sudden seat movement, causing the loss of control of your vehicle. Do not adjust the recliner from inside your vehicle if the seat is unoccupied. The seat back may move suddenly and cause personal injury. E177638 1. Lift the handle. 2. Move the seat backward or forward to attain the desired position. 3. Release the handle. 97 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Seats Adjusting the Armrest 1 3 E95256 2 1. Raise the armrest fully. 2. Lower the armrest to the stowed position. 3. Raise the armrest to attain the desired position. E175474 1. Lift the handle. 2. Move the seat back backward or forward to attain the desired position. 3. Release the handle. POWER SEATS WARNINGS Do not adjust the driver seat when your vehicle is moving. Do not place cargo or any objects behind the seat backrest before returning it to the original position. The driver seat has removable stop bolts on the track to enable access to the vehicle battery. See Changing the 12V Battery (page 213). 98 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Seats E138647 Power Lumbar REAR SEATS WARNINGS Do not use the bench seats as a bed when your vehicle is moving. Failure to follow this warning could result in serious personal injury or death. Do not place objects on a folded seat. Hard objects may become projectiles in a crash or sudden stop, which may increase the risk of serious personal injury. Note: Rear seat arrangements vary depending on the vehicle. E138648 99 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Seats Recline Adjustment Removing Seats, 12 & 15 Passenger Vehicles WARNINGS When reclining the seat backrest forward and backward, take care not to get your hands caught between the seat backrest and the frame, catches or mechanism. Failure to take care may result in personal injury. WARNINGS Seats can weigh up to 132 lb (60 kg). Do not attempt to lift or carry a seat on your own. Do not use the release handles to lift or carry the seat. Make sure that any cargo or objects are not trapped behind the seat backrest. Make sure the safety belts are not trapped in any way when unfolding the seat backrest up. Failure of an occupant to be able to use a trapped safety belt increases the risk of serious personal injury or death. Make sure that the seat backrest is fully engaged in its catch. A seat backrest which is not fully engaged in its catch could move in the event of an accident. This may result in serious personal injury or death. E172224 With the seat occupied, pull the lever or strap to recline or raise the seat backrest. 100 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Seats 3. Pull the seat backward to release the seat frame front catches. 4. Remove the seat. Note: Two persons must carry out this procedure. Note: You can only remove seats that have integral release handles. Note: The seat back does not fold forward. 1 Installing the Seats WARNINGS Make sure that the floor catches are free from foreign material before installing the seats. 2 Make sure that you securely fasten the seat catches when installing. Check the latches are correctly engaged by checking the red latch indicators. 3 E173870 1. Pull the release handles up. 2. Tilt the seat forward to release the seat frame rear catches. E178062 101 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Seats 1. Align the seat frame front catches. 2. Push the seat forward to engage the seat frame front catches. 3. Align the seat frame rear catches. 4. Allow the seat to drop under its own weight for the last 6-8 in (15-20 cm). 102 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Auxiliary Power Points Auxiliary Power Point Locations WARNINGS Do not use the power points for operating a cigar lighter element. Do not insert objects other than an accessory plug into the power points. Run the engine for full capacity use of the power points. Note: Do not use the power points over the vehicle capacity of 12 volt DC 180 watt or a fuse may blow. E185878 Note: Do not hang any accessory from the accessory plug. Auxiliary Power Point locations may be: • On the instrument panel. • Inside the floor console storage compartment. • Inside the cargo area. Note: Always keep the power point caps closed when not in use. Note: Incorrect use of the power points can cause damage not covered by the vehicle warranty. Note: Do not keep electrical devices or adaptors plugged in to the auxiliary power point when not in use. To prevent the battery from running out of charge: • Do not use the power points for longer than necessary when the engine is not running. • Do not leave devices plugged in overnight or when your vehicle is in park (P) for extended periods of time. AC Power Point WARNING Do not use any extension cord with the AC power point, since it will defeat the safety protection design provided by the cap and twist tab. Doing so may cause the power point to overload due to powering multiple devices that can reach beyond the 150 watt load limit and could result in fire or personal injury. Note: The power point turns off after 30 minutes if you switched the ignition on without the engine running. 103 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Auxiliary Power Points • • • Compressor-driven refrigerators. Medical or measuring equipment that must process precise data. Appliances requiring an extremely stable power supply, for example: • Microcomputer-controlled electric blankets. • Touch-sensor lamps. CIGAR LIGHTER E143941 Use the AC power point for powering electrical devices that require up to 150 watts. You can find it under the parking brake lever. Note: Do not keep electrical devices or adaptors plugged in to the AC power point when not in use. When the green indicator light, located on the AC power point, is: • On — AC power point is ready to supply power. • Off — AC power point is not ready to supply power or you ignition is not switched on. • Flashing — AC power point is in fault mode. E103382 Press the element in to use the cigar lighter. It will pop out automatically. Note: Do not press and hold the cigar lighter element. If you exceed the 150 watts limit, then the AC power point temporarily turns off. The indicator light flashes if the power point detects overloading, overheating, or shorting conditions. For overloaded or shorted conditions, unplug your device and switch the ignition off then back on. For an overheated condition, let the system cool down and switch the ignition off then back on. The AC power point is not suitable for use with all electrical devices, for example: • Tube type televisions. • Vacuum cleaners. • Power tools. 104 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Storage Compartments CUP HOLDERS WARNINGS Do not place hot drinks in the cup holders when your vehicle is moving. Make sure that cups placed in the holders do not obstruct your vision while driving. OVERHEAD CONSOLE Overhead Storage Compartments Overhead Console E171160 WARNING Do not place heavy objects in the overhead console. Heavy objects may become projectiles in a crash or sudden stop and may increase the risk of serious injury. E169074 BOTTLE HOLDER WARNING Do not place glass objects in the bottle holder. 105 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Starting and Stopping the Engine GENERAL INFORMATION IGNITION SWITCH WARNINGS Extended idling at high engine speeds can produce very high temperatures in the engine and exhaust system, creating the risk of fire or other damage. Do not park, idle or drive your vehicle on dry grass or other dry ground cover. The emission system heats up the engine compartment and exhaust system, creating the risk of fire. E72128 0(off) - The ignition is off. Note: When you switch the ignition off and leave your vehicle, do not leave your key in the ignition. This could cause your vehicle battery to lose charge. Do not start the engine in a closed garage or in other enclosed areas. Exhaust fumes can be toxic. Always open the garage door before you start the engine. I (accessory) - Allows the electrical accessories such as the radio to operate while the engine is not running. If you smell exhaust fumes inside your vehicle, have your vehicle checked by an authorized dealer immediately. Do not drive your vehicle if you smell exhaust fumes. Note: Do not leave the ignition key in position I or II (without the engine running) for too long to avoid vehicle battery losing charge. II (on) - All electrical circuits operational. Warning lamps and indicators are illuminated. If you disconnect the battery, your vehicle may exhibit some unusual driving characteristics for approximately 5 miles (8 kilometers) after you reconnect it. This is because the engine management system must realign itself with the engine. You can disregard any unusual driving characteristics during this period. III (start) - cranks the engine. Release the key as soon as the engine starts. STARTING A GASOLINE ENGINE The powertrain control system meets all Canadian interference-causing equipment standard requirements regulating the impulse electrical field or radio noise. Before starting the engine check the following: • When you start the engine, avoid pressing the accelerator pedal before and during operation. Only use the accelerator pedal when you have difficulty starting the engine. • • • 106 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Make sure all occupants have fastened their safety belts. Make sure the headlamps and electrical accessories are off. Make sure the parking brake is on. Move the transmission selector lever to position park (P). Starting and Stopping the Engine Flooded Engine When you start the engine, the idle speed increases, this helps to warm up the engine. If the engine idle speed does not slow down automatically, have your vehicle checked by an authorized dealer. 1. Move the transmission selector lever to position P. 2. Fully depress the accelerator pedal and hold it there. 3. Start the engine. Note: If the engine does not start, repeat the cold or hot engine procedure. Note: You can only operate the starter for a limited period of time, for example 10 seconds. The number of start attempts is limited to approximately six. If you exceed this limit, the system will not allow you to try again until a period of time has elapsed, for example 30 minutes. STARTING A DIESEL ENGINE 1. Fully press the brake pedal. 2. Turn the ignition key to position II to switch the ignition on. 3. Turn the ignition key to position III to start your vehicle. Release the key when the engine starts. Note: Do not touch the accelerator pedal. WARNINGS Do not use starting fluid, for example ether, in the air intake system (see air filter decal). Starting fluids could cause immediate explosive damage to the engine. Failure to follow this warning could result in fire, serious personal injury or death. Engine Idle Speed after Starting Do not add gasoline, gasohol, alcohol or Kerosene to diesel fuel. This action creates a serious fire hazard and will result in poor engine performance. Engine damage caused by the use of incorrect fuel is not covered by the vehicle warranty. The speed at which the engine idles immediately after starting will adjust automatically to minimize vehicle emissions and maximize cabin comfort and fuel economy. The idle speed will vary depending on certain factors. These include vehicle component and ambient temperatures as well as electrical and climate system demands. Note: Avoid shutting the engine down after an extensive idling period. Drive your vehicle for several miles with the engine at normal operating temperatures under a moderate load. Cold or Hot Engine Engine Glow Plugs If the engine does not start within 10 seconds, wait for a short period and try again. If the engine does not start after three attempts, wait 10 seconds and follow the flooded engine procedure. The powertrain control and glow plug control modules operate the glow plug system. When you switch the ignition on the glow plug control module immediately energizes the glow plugs. The glow plug control module using the engine coolant temperature, barometric pressure sensor If you have difficulty starting the engine when the temperature is below -13°F (-25°C), press the accelerator pedal to the mid-way point of its travel and try again. 107 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Starting and Stopping the Engine 4. Release the key. Note: You may need to crank the engine for up to 10 seconds when the outside air temperature is 5°F (-15°C) or below. and the environmental temperature sensor will determine how long the glow plugs stay energized. The required time for the glow plugs to remain energized will decrease as the engine coolant temperature, barometric pressure and the environmental temperature increases. Note: Engine power may be reduced for 15 seconds when the engine oil temperature is -9°F (-23°C) or below. This is to allow the turbocharger to be lubricated. When you switch the ignition on, the glow plug indicator lamp will illuminate if glow plug heat is necessary as a starting aid. Wait until the glow plug indicator lamp turns off before starting the engine. The lamp should always momentarily illuminate when the engine is cold and you switch the ignition on. Note: If the engine fails to start after a number of attempts, the system will not allow you to operate the starter for a short period of time, for example 30 minutes. Failure to Start If the engine does not crank with the ignition key turned to position III while the brake pedal is fully depressed, do the following: Cold Weather Operation In cold weather below 32°F (0°C), the engine may slowly increase to a higher idle speed if left idling in park (P). As the engine warms-up, the engine sound level decreases due to the activation of powertrain control module controlled sound reduction features. 1. Switch the ignition off. 2. Release the brake pedal. Note: Make sure the parking brake is fully applied. It is recommended that the engine block heater be used for starting when the temperature is -9°F (-23°C) or colder. See Engine Block Heater (page 109). 3. Fully depress the brake pedal. 4. Turn the ignition key to position II and wait until the glow plug indicator lamp turns off. Note: Do not press the accelerator pedal. Note: Idling in cold weather does not heat the engine to its normal operating temperature. Long periods of idling, especially in cold weather, can cause a buildup of deposits which can cause engine damage. 5. Turn the ignition key to position III until the engine starts. 6. Release the key. Starting a Cold or Hot Engine DIESEL PARTICULATE FILTER Note: Do not press the accelerator pedal. The filter forms part of the emissions reduction system on your vehicle. It filters harmful diesel particulates (soot) from the exhaust gas. 1. Fully depress the brake pedal. 2. Turn the ignition key to position II and wait until the glow plug indicator lamp turns off. Note: Do not press the accelerator pedal. 3. Turn the ignition key to position III until the engine starts. 108 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Starting and Stopping the Engine Regeneration You must carry out occasional trips with the following conditions to assist the regeneration process: • Drive your vehicle in more favorable conditions, which you will find at higher vehicle speeds in normal driving, on a main road or freeway for a minimum of 20 minutes. This drive may include short stops that will not affect the regeneration process. • Avoid prolonged idling and always observe speed limits and road conditions. • Do not switch the ignition off. • Select a suitable gear to ideally maintain engine speed between 1500 and 3000 RPM. WARNING Do not park or idle your vehicle over dry leaves, dry grass or other combustible materials. The regeneration process creates very high exhaust gas temperatures and the exhaust will radiate a considerable amount of heat during and after regeneration and after you have switched the engine off. This is a potential fire hazard. Note: Avoid running out of fuel. Note: During regeneration at low speed or engine idle, you may smell a hot metallic odor and could notice a clicking metallic sound. This is due to the high temperatures reached during regeneration and is normal. SWITCHING OFF THE ENGINE Note: Changes in the engine or exhaust sound may be heard during the regeneration process. Vehicles With a Turbocharger WARNING Note: After you have switched your engine off the fans may continue to run for a short period of time. Do not switch the engine off when it is running at high speed. If you do, the turbocharger will continue running after the engine oil pressure has dropped to zero. This will lead to premature turbocharger bearing wear. The diesel particulate filter on your vehicle requires periodic regeneration to maintain its correct function. Your vehicle will carry out this process automatically. If your journeys meet one of the following conditions: • You drive only short distances. • You frequently switch the ignition on and off. • Your journeys contain a high level of acceleration and deceleration. Release the accelerator pedal. Wait until the engine has reached idle speed and then switch it off. ENGINE BLOCK HEATER (If Equipped) WARNINGS Failure to follow engine block heater instructions could result in property damage or serious personal injury. 109 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Starting and Stopping the Engine • WARNINGS Do not use your heater with ungrounded electrical systems or two-pronged adapters. There is a risk of electrical shock. • Note: The heater is most effective when outdoor temperatures are below 0°F (-18°C). • The heater acts as a starting aid by warming the engine coolant. This allows the climate control system to respond quickly. The equipment includes a heater element (installed in the engine block) and a wire harness. You can connect the system to a grounded 120-volt AC electrical source. Using the Engine Block Heater Make sure the receptacle terminals are clean and dry prior to use. Clean them with a dry cloth if necessary. The heater uses 0.4 to 1.0 kilowatt-hours of energy per hour of use. The system does not have a thermostat. It achieves maximum temperature after approximately three hours of operation. Using the heater longer than three hours does not improve system performance and unnecessarily uses electricity. We recommend that you do the following for a safe and correct operation: • Use a 16-gauge outdoor extension cord that is product certified by Underwriter’s Laboratory (UL) or Canadian Standards Association (CSA). This extension cord must be suitable for use outdoors, in cold temperatures, and be clearly marked Suitable for Use with Outdoor Appliances. Do not use an indoor extension cord outdoors. This could result in an electric shock or become a fire hazard. • Use as short an extension cord as possible. • Do not use multiple extension cords. • Make sure that when in operation, the extension cord plug and heater cord plug connections are free and clear of water. This could cause an electric shock or fire. • Make sure your vehicle is parked in a clean area, clear of combustibles. • Make sure the heater, heater cord and extension cord are firmly connected. 110 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Check for heat anywhere in the electrical hookup once the system has been operating for approximately 30 minutes. Make sure the system is unplugged and properly stowed before driving your vehicle. Make sure the protective cover seals the prongs of the block heater cord plug when not in use. Make sure the heater system is checked for proper operation before winter. Fuel and Refueling • SAFETY PRECAUTIONS WARNINGS Do not overfill the fuel tank. The pressure in an overfilled tank may cause leakage and lead to fuel spray and fire. The fuel system may be under pressure. If you hear a hissing sound near the fuel filler door (Easy Fuel capless fuel system), do not refuel until the sound stops. Otherwise, fuel may spray out, which could cause serious personal injury. • Automotive fuels can cause serious injury or death if misused or mishandled. • Flow of fuel through a fuel pump nozzle can produce static electricity. This can cause a fire if you are filling an ungrounded fuel container. • Fuel ethanol and gasoline may contain benzene, which is a cancer-causing agent. When refueling always shut the engine off and never allow sparks or open flames near the filler neck. Never smoke or use a cell phone while refueling. Fuel vapor is extremely hazardous under certain conditions. Avoid inhaling excess fumes. • Observe the following guidelines when handling automotive fuel: • • Extinguish all smoking materials and any open flames before refueling your vehicle. Always turn off the vehicle before refueling. 111 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Automotive fuels can be harmful or fatal if swallowed. Fuel such as gasoline is highly toxic and if swallowed can cause death or permanent injury. If fuel is swallowed, call a physician immediately, even if no symptoms are immediately apparent. The toxic effects of fuel may not be visible for hours. Avoid inhaling fuel vapors. Inhaling too much fuel vapor of any kind can lead to eye and respiratory tract irritation. In severe cases, excessive or prolonged breathing of fuel vapor can cause serious illness and permanent injury. Avoid getting fuel liquid in your eyes. If fuel is splashed in the eyes, remove contact lenses (if worn), flush with water for 15 minutes and seek medical attention. Failure to seek proper medical attention could lead to permanent injury. Fuels can also be harmful if absorbed through the skin. If fuel is splashed on the skin, clothing or both, promptly remove contaminated clothing and wash skin thoroughly with soap and water. Repeated or prolonged skin contact with fuel liquid or vapor causes skin irritation. Be particularly careful if you are taking “Antabuse” or other forms of disulfiram for the treatment of alcoholism. Breathing gasoline vapors, or skin contact could cause an adverse reaction. In sensitive individuals, serious personal injury or sickness may result. If fuel is splashed on the skin, promptly wash skin thoroughly with soap and water. Consult a physician immediately if you experience an adverse reaction. Fuel and Refueling • FUEL QUALITY - GASOLINE Note: Use of any fuel other than recommended fuel can cause powertrain damage, impair the emission control system or cause loss of vehicle performance. Any damage to vehicle that is caused by use of fuel not recommended will not be covered under warranty. • • Fuels containing metallic based additives, including manganese-based compounds. Fuels containing the octane booster additive, methylcyclopentadienyl manganese tricarbonyl (MMT) Leaded fuel (The use of leaded fuel is prohibited by law). Octane Recommendations Choosing the Right Fuel Without a Flex Fuel Vehicle (If Equipped) Use only UNLEADED gasoline or UNLEADED gasoline blended with a maximum of 85% ethanol (E-85) in your Flex Fuel Vehicle (FFV). If your vehicle is flex fuel capable, the fuel fill inlet will have a yellow housing. E161513 Do not use: • • • • • Do not be concerned if your engine sometimes knocks lightly. However, if it knocks heavily under most driving conditions while you are using fuel with the recommended octane rating, see your authorized dealer to prevent any engine damage. Fuel containing more than 15% ethanol or E-85 fuel. Fuel with methanol. Fuels containing metallic based additives, including manganese-based compounds. Fuels containing the octane booster additive, methylcyclopentadienyl manganese tricarbonyl (MMT) Leaded fuel (The use of leaded fuel is prohibited by law). 3.5L V6 EcoBoost We recommend regular unleaded gasoline with a pump (R+M)/2 octane rating of 87. Some stations offer fuels posted as regular with an octane rating below 87, particularly in high altitude areas. We do not recommend fuels with an octane rating below 87. To provide improved performance, we recommend premium fuel for severe duty usage, such as trailer tow. Choosing the Right Fuel With a Flex Fuel Vehicle (If Equipped) Use only UNLEADED gasoline or UNLEADED gasoline blended with a maximum of 85% ethanol (E-85) in your Flex Fuel Vehicle (FFV). If your vehicle is flex fuel capable, it will have a yellow bezel placed over the fuel fill inlet. Do not use: • • Fuels containing more than 85% ethanol or E-100 fuel. Fuel with methanol. 112 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Fuel and Refueling 3.7L Engine Note: Do not blend used engine oil with diesel fuel under any circumstances. Blending used oil with the fuel will significantly increase your vehicle’s exhaust emissions and reduce engine life due to increased internal wear. We recommend regular unleaded gasoline with a pump (R+M)/2 octane rating of 87. Some stations offer fuels posted as regular with an octane rating below 87, particularly in high altitude areas. We do not recommend fuels with an octane rating below 87. Fuel Requirements - Choosing The Right Fuel: Vehicles Operated Where Ultra-Low Sulfur Diesel Fuel Is Not Required FUEL QUALITY - DIESEL Use only a diesel engine configured for use with high sulfur diesel fuel in markets with diesel fuel that has sulfur content greater than 15 ppm. Using low sulfur diesel fuel (16–500 ppm) or high sulfur diesel fuel (greater than 500 ppm) in a diesel engine designed to use only ultra-low sulfur diesel fuel may result in damage to engine emission control devices and the after-treatment system, potentially rendering your vehicle inoperable. Fuel Requirements - Choosing the Right Fuel: Vehicles Operated Where Ultra-Low Sulfur Diesel Fuel is Required (United States/Canada/Puerto Rico/U.S. Virgin Islands and Other Locales) WARNINGS Only use Ultra-Low Sulfur Diesel fuel (ULSD) containing a maximum of 15 ppm sulfur and up to 20% biodiesel (B20). These fuels should meet the diesel specifications defined by American Society for Testing and Materials (ASTM) D975 for diesel and by ASTM D7467 for B6-B20 blends, or an equivalent local market specification. For the engine to operate reliably on low sulfur or high sulfur diesel fuel, the engine must be a factory built high sulfur engine (available as a dealer order option for select markets) or an ultra-low sulfur diesel fuel configured engine that has been retrofitted for high sulfur diesel fuel using Ford Motor Company dealer service parts. Failure to use retrofit components other than those available through your authorized dealer will result in coolant system damage, engine overheating, selective catalyst reduction system or diesel particulate filter damage and possible base engine damage. Do not mix diesel with oil, kerosene, paraffin, gasoline or other liquids to diesel. This can cause damage to the fuel system. Do not use home heating oil, agricultural fuel, raw fats, oils, waste cooking greases, biodiesel fuels greater than 20% or any diesel fuel not intended for highway use. Vehicles with engines configured for use with high sulfur diesel fuel are only available for sale in countries where ultra-low sulfur diesel fuel is generally not available or mandated by the government. Vehicles originally sold in a ultra-low sulfur diesel fuel market that are subsequently The vehicle warranty will not cover damage caused by using an improper type of fuel or fuel additive. 113 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Fuel and Refueling exported to non ultra-low sulfur diesel fuel markets will need to be retrofitted (at the customer’s expense using Ford authorized dealer service parts) in order to be reliably operated on non ultra-low sulfur diesel fuel. To help achieve acceptable engine performance and durability when using biodiesel in your vehicle: • Confirm the biodiesel content of the fuel to be B20 (20% biodiesel) or less by checking the label on the fuel pump. • Only use biodiesel fuel of good quality that complies with applicable industry standards ASTM D975 for diesel and ASTM D7467 for B6-B20 blends. • Follow the recommended service maintenance intervals. See Normal Scheduled Maintenance (page 436). • Do not store biodiesel fuel in the fuel tank for more than one month. • Do not use raw oils, fats or waste cooking greases. Biodiesel You may operate your vehicle on diesel fuels containing up to 20% biodiesel, also known as B20. Biodiesel fuel is a chemically converted product from renewable fuel sources, such as vegetable oils, animal fats and waste cooking greases. System Messages Message LOW FUEL PRESSURE Action and Description Consider changing brands or reducing biodiesel content if you have cold temperature fuel gelling issues or this message frequently appears. Biodiesel content is often indicated with the letter B followed by the percent of biodiesel in the fuel. For example, B20 indicates a fuel containing 20% biodiesel. Ask the service station attendant to confirm the biodiesel content of a diesel fuel if you do not see a label on the fuel pump. Use of biodiesel in concentrations greater than 20% may cause damage to your vehicle, including engine and/or exhaust after-treatment hardware (exhaust catalyst and particulate filter) failures. When using biodiesel in concentrations greater than 20%, this can also cause fuel filter restrictions that may result in a lack of power or damage to fuel system components, including fuel pump and fuel injector failures. See Special Operating Conditions Scheduled Maintenance (page 438). . Biodiesel fuels degrade more easily than diesel fuels not containing biodiesel and should not be stored in the fuel tank for more than one month. If you plan to park or store your vehicle for more than one month, then you should empty your vehicle fuel tank of biodiesel fuel. You should fill the tank with a pure petroleum-based diesel fuel and run your vehicle for a minimum of 30 minutes. Look for a label on the fuel pump to confirm the amount of biodiesel contained in a diesel fuel. Biodiesel fuel blends with greater than 5% must be labeled. 114 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Fuel and Refueling If you intend to store your vehicle for more than two months, we recommend that you seek advice from an authorized dealer. During cold weather, if you have problems operating on biodiesel, you may need to use a diesel fuel with lower biodiesel content, try another brand, or discontinue the use of biodiesel. If your vehicle has run out of fuel: • Normally, adding five liters of fuel is enough to restart the engine. If your vehicle is on a steep grade, more fuel may be required. • You may need to cycle the ignition from off to on several times after refueling to allow the fuel system to pump the fuel from the tank to the engine. On restarting, cranking time will take a few seconds longer than normal. Diesel Fuel Additives Filling a Portable Fuel Container It should not be necessary to add any aftermarket additives to your fuel if you use a high quality diesel fuel that conforms to ASTM industry specifications. Aftermarket additives can damage the fuel injector system or engine. Use the following guidelines to avoid electrostatic charge build-up when filling an ungrounded fuel container: Use Motorcraft® cetane booster or an equivalent cetane booster additive if you suspect fuel has low cetane. Use Motorcraft® anti-gel & performance improver or an equivalent additive if there is fuel gelling during cold weather. • Note: Degraded or oxidized biodiesel can damage fuel system seals and plastics and corrode steel parts. • • • Do not use alcohol-based additives to improve cetane quality, to prevent fuel gelling or any other use. The use of alcohol additives may result in damage to the fuel injectors and system. Adding Fuel From a Portable Fuel Container WARNINGS Do not insert the nozzle of a fuel container or an aftermarket funnel into the fuel system filler neck. This may damage the fuel system filler neck or its seal and cause fuel to run onto the ground. Your warranty may not cover repairs needed to correct the effects of using an aftermarket product that does not meet Ford specifications in your fuel. RUNNING OUT OF FUEL Do not prise or push open a capless fuel system. This may damage the fuel system or its seal and cause fuel to run onto the ground. Avoid running out of fuel, this can cause damage not covered by the vehicle warranty. 115 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Only use an approved fuel container to transfer fuel to your vehicle. Place the container on the ground when filling. Do not fill a fuel container while it is inside your vehicle (including the cargo area). Keep the fuel pump nozzle in contact with the fuel container while filling. Do not use a device that holds the fuel pump nozzle lever in the fill position. Fuel and Refueling 6. Replace the fuel filler cap and close the fuel filler door. 7. Clean the plastic funnel and place it back in your vehicle or correctly dispose of it. Extra plastic funnels can be purchased from an authorized dealer if you choose to dispose of it. WARNINGS Do not dispose of fuel in the household refuse or the public sewage system. Use an authorized waste disposal facility. When refueling the vehicle fuel tank from a fuel container, use the plastic funnel included with your vehicle. CATALYTIC CONVERTER Note: The specifically designed plastic funnel included with your vehicle will work safely with the fuel system. WARNING Do not park or idle your vehicle over dry leaves, dry grass or other combustible materials. The exhaust will radiate a considerable amount of heat during use, and after you have switched the engine off. This is a potential fire hazard. Driving with a Catalytic Converter WARNINGS Avoid running out of fuel. Do not crank the engine for long periods. Do not run the engine when a spark plug lead is disconnected. E156223 Do not push-start or tow-start your vehicle. Use booster cables. See Jump Starting the Vehicle (page 1. The plastic funnel is located in the glove box. 2. Open the fuel filler door fully until it engages and remove the fuel filler cap. Note: Capless fuel systems do not have a fuel filler cap. 178). Do not switch the ignition off when driving. 3. Insert the plastic funnel into the filler neck. 4. Add fuel to your vehicle from the fuel container. 5. Remove the plastic funnel from the filler neck. 116 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Fuel and Refueling Continued driving without refilling the fluid will result in: • Vehicle speed being limited. Prior to this occurring a message will appear in the information display. • Further vehicle operation without refilling the diesel exhaust fluid will cause the engine to run at idle speed. SELECTIVE CATALYTIC REDUCTION SYSTEM WARNINGS You must refill the diesel exhaust fluid tank when it is low. If it is not refilled, vehicle speed will be limited to 50 mph (80 km/h). Drive with caution and refill the fluid tank as soon as possible. Note: You must add a minimum of 3.2 qt (3 L) for your vehicle to exit the run at idle speed mode. If the diesel exhaust fluid becomes contaminated your vehicle will be limited to idle speed operation. Replace the fluid immediately. Filling the Diesel Exhaust Fluid Tank WARNINGS Do not allow diesel exhaust fluid to come into contact with eyes, skin or clothing. Should the fluid come into contact with eyes, flush them with plenty of water and contact a physician. Clean affected skin with soap and water. If swallowed, drink plenty of water and contact a physician immediately. Tampering with or disabling the selective catalytic reduction system will result in severe vehicle performance limitation. Vehicle speed will be limited to 6 mph (10 km/h). Your vehicle has a selective catalytic reduction system to help reduce exhaust emission levels by injecting diesel exhaust fluid into the exhaust system. Refill the diesel exhaust fluid tank in a well-ventilated area. When removing the tank cap or a diesel exhaust fluid container cap, ammonia vapor may escape. Ammonia vapor is an irritant to the eyes, skin and mucous membranes. Inhaling ammonia vapor can cause burning to the eyes, throat and nose resulting in watering eyes or severe coughing. Diesel Exhaust Fluid Level For the system to operate correctly, you must maintain the diesel exhaust fluid level. A warning lamp will illuminate when the diesel exhaust fluid E163176 level is low and needs to be refilled. See Warning Lamps and Indicators (page 75). Do not put diesel exhaust fluid in the fuel tank. This can cause engine damage not covered by the vehicle warranty. The warning lamp will illuminate approximately 500 mi (800 km) before the diesel exhaust fluid tank is empty. Refill the tank as soon as possible. Note: If the warning lamp illuminates when your vehicle is moving, and the diesel exhaust fluid is at a sufficient level, this indicates a system malfunction. Have your vehicle checked by an authorized dealer as soon as possible. 117 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Fuel and Refueling Note: Immediately wash off any diesel exhaust fluid that has spilled on to a painted surface with soapy water. Filling the Diesel Exhaust Fluid Tank Using a Fuel Station Pump Filling the diesel exhaust fluid tank using a pump is similar to a refuelling your vehicle. The diesel exhaust fluid pump nozzle will shut off automatically when the tank is full. Note: Some filling stations utilize a magnetic mechanism in the pump nozzle that may prevent refilling the diesel exhaust fluid tank. To overcome this issue you will need to locate another filling station or use a refill container. E172245 Filling the Diesel Exhaust Fluid Tank Using a Container The diesel exhaust fluid tank filler neck is located below the fuel filler neck and has a blue cap. Fill the tank using a fluid pump at a diesel exhaust fluid filling station or a diesel exhaust fluid container. We recommend Motorcraft® diesel exhaust fluid, the containers are spill proof and stop the flow of fluid when the tank is full. The capacity of the diesel exhaust fluid tank is 21 liters. The following procedure applies to Motorcraft diesel exhaust fluid or similar fluid containers. Always follow the manufacturer's instructions. 1. 2. 3. ) E163354 E163354 4. You must only use diesel exhaust fluid that is certified by the American Petroleum Institute (API). Note: You must open the fuel filler door before you can open the diesel exhaust fluid filler door. 5. 118 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Remove the diesel exhaust fluid container cap. Place the spout on to the container and tighten it until you feel a strong resistance. Remove the diesel exhaust fluid tank filler cap. Insert the spout in to the filler neck until the seal on the spout seats on to the filler neck. Pour the fluid in to the tank. When the tank is full the fluid will stop flowing automatically. Return the container to the vertical position slightly below the diesel exhaust fluid filler neck. Allow any fluid remaining in the spout to drain back in to the container. Remove the spout from the diesel exhaust fluid filler neck. Replace the diesel exhaust fluid tank cap. Fuel and Refueling 6. Remove the spout from the diesel exhaust fluid container and replace the cap. Note: If there is diesel exhaust fluid left in the container retain it for later use. The spout is re-useable. Wash the spout with clean water prior to storage. Do not use the diesel exhaust fluid spout with any other fluid. Note: If the vehicle speed becomes limited or the engine will only run at idle speed, normal vehicle operation will not resume until you have the system repaired. To service a contaminated or inoperative system, see an authorized dealer. Filling the Diesel Exhaust Fluid Tank in Cold Climates Diesel Exhaust Fluid Guidelines Note: You must add a minimum of 3.2 qt (3 L) for your vehicle to exit the run at idle speed mode. • Diesel exhaust fluid may freeze if the ambient temperature is below 12°F (-11°C). Your vehicle has a preheating system which allows diesel exhaust fluid to operate below 12°F (-11°C). If you do not use your vehicle for an extended period when the ambient temperature is below 12°F (-11°C), the fluid in the tank may freeze. If the tank is overfilled and the fluid freezes it may damage the tank. This is not covered by the vehicle warranty. • • • • • Contaminated Diesel Exhaust Fluid or Inoperative Selective Catalytic Reduction System • • If the system becomes contaminated or inoperative, the E163176 diesel exhaust fluid warning lamp will illuminate and a message will appear in the information display. Approximate Diesel Exhaust Fluid Usage The chart below illustrates the approximate diesel exhaust fluid usage for the given distances traveled under various driving conditions. Usage may vary depending on: • Driving style. • Towing a trailer. • Vehicle load. • Engine idling time. Continued driving without replacing the fluid or not having the system repaired will result in: • Vehicle speed being limited. Prior to this occurring a message will appear in the information display. • Further vehicle operation without replacing contaminated diesel exhaust fluid will cause the engine to run at idle speed. 119 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Do not put diesel exhaust fluid in the vehicle fuel tank. Do not overfill the diesel exhaust fluid tank. Do not dilute diesel exhaust fluid with water or any other liquid. Do not re-use a diesel exhaust fluid container. Do not store in direct sunlight. Store at temperatures between 23°F (-5°C) and 68°F (20°C). Do not store a diesel exhaust fluid container in your vehicle. Diesel exhaust fluid is non-flammable, non-toxic, colorless and water-soluble. Fuel and Refueling Driving conditions Approximate diesel exhaust fluid usage per tank mi (km) Primary trailer tow, aggressive driving 1100–4100 (1,770–6,600) City drive 4100–6500 (6,600–10,460) Steady highway drive 6500–10500 (10,460–16,900) Do not attempt to start the engine if you have refueled the fuel tank with the incorrect fuel. This can cause damage not covered by the vehicle warranty. Have your vehicle checked by an authorized dealer immediately. REFUELING WARNINGS When refueling always shut the engine off and never allow sparks or open flames near the filler neck. Never smoke or use a cell phone while refueling. Fuel vapor is extremely hazardous under certain conditions. Avoid inhaling excess fumes. If you use a high pressure spray to wash your vehicle, only spray the fuel tank filler door briefly from a distance not less than 8 in (200 mm). Do not attempt to refuel using a fuel pump nozzle that does not fit through both closing flaps of the capless fuel filler neck. Wait at least 10 seconds before removing the fuel pump nozzle to allow any residual fuel to drain into the fuel tank. Stop refueling after the fuel pump nozzle automatically shuts off for the second time. Failure to follow this will fill the expansion space in the fuel tank and could lead to fuel overflowing. Do not remove the fuel pump nozzle from its fully inserted position when refueling. E162791 Note: The front door must be open before you can open and close the fuel tank filler door. Do not overfill the fuel tank. The pressure in an overfilled tank may cause leakage and lead to fuel spray and fire. Note: Capless fuel systems do not have a fuel tank filler cap. 1. 120 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Fully open the fuel tank filler door until it engages. Fuel and Refueling 3. Hold the fuel pump nozzle in position B during refueling. Holding the fuel pump nozzle in position A may affect the flow of fuel and shut off the fuel pump nozzle before the fuel tank is full. A E139202 Note: When you insert the correct size fuel pump nozzle into a capless fuel system, a spring loaded inhibitor will open. This helps to avoid refueling with the incorrect fuel. Note: The capless fuel system accommodates standard non-commercial fuel pump nozzle sizes up to 1 in (25 mm) diameter. E162792 4. Operate the fuel pump nozzle within the area shown. 2. Insert the fuel pump nozzle up to the first notch on the nozzle A. Keep it resting on the cover of the fuel tank filler pipe opening. A E154765 E139203 5. Slightly raise the fuel pump nozzle and remove it slowly. 6. Close the fuel tank filler door. B 121 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Fuel and Refueling Calculating Fuel Economy FUEL CONSUMPTION Do not measure fuel economy during the first 1000 mi (1,600 km) of driving (this is the engine break-in period). A more accurate measurement is obtained after 2500 mi (4,000 km). Also, fuel expense, frequency of fill ups or fuel gauge readings are not accurate ways to measure fuel economy. We derive CO2 and fuel consumption figures in laboratory tests according to Regulation (EC) 715/2007 or CR (EC) 692/2008 and subsequent amendments. They are intended as a comparison between makes and models of vehicles. They are not intended to represent the real world fuel consumption you may get from your vehicle. 1. Real world fuel consumption is governed by many factors, for example driving style, high speed driving, stop-start driving, air conditioning usage, the accessories fitted, payload and towing. 2. 3. The advertised capacity is the indicated capacity and the empty reserve combined. Indicated capacity is the difference in the amount of fuel in the fuel tank and when the fuel gauge indicates empty. Empty reserve is the amount of fuel in the fuel tank after the fuel gauge indicates empty. 4. 5. Note: The amount of fuel in the empty reserve varies and should not be relied upon to increase driving range. When refueling your vehicle after the fuel gauge indicates empty, you might not be able to refuel the full amount of the advertised capacity due to the empty reserve still present in the fuel tank. Keep a record for at least one month and record the type of driving (city or freeway). This provides an accurate estimate of your vehicle’s fuel economy under current driving conditions. Additionally, keeping records during summer and winter show how temperature impacts fuel economy. In general, your vehicle will use more fuel in cold temperatures. Filling the Fuel Tank EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEM For consistent results when refueling: • • Switch the ignition off. Allow no more than two automatic shut-offs when refueling. WARNINGS Do not park, idle, or drive your vehicle in dry grass or other dry ground cover. The emission system heats up the engine compartment and exhaust system, which can start a fire. Results are most accurate when the refueling method is consistent. 122 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Fill the fuel tank completely and record the initial odometer reading. Each time you fill the fuel tank, record the amount of fuel added. After at least three fill ups, fill the fuel tank and record the current odometer reading. Subtract your initial odometer reading from the current odometer reading. Calculate fuel economy by dividing miles traveled by gallons used (For Metric: Multiply liters used by 100, then divide by kilometers traveled). Fuel and Refueling • • • • WARNINGS An incorrectly operating or damaged exhaust system may result in entry of harmful and potentially lethal fumes into the passenger compartment. If you smell exhaust fumes inside your vehicle, have an authorized dealer inspect your vehicle immediately. Do not drive if you smell exhaust fumes. Do not make any unauthorized changes to your vehicle or engine. By law, vehicle owners and anyone who manufactures, repairs, services, sells, leases, trades vehicles, or supervises a fleet of vehicles are not permitted to intentionally remove an emission control device or prevent it from working. Information about your vehicle’s emission system is on the Vehicle Emission Control Information Decal located on or near the engine. This decal also lists engine displacement. Your vehicle has various emission control components and a catalytic converter that will enable your vehicle to comply with applicable exhaust emission standards. To make sure that the catalytic converter and other emission control components continue to work correctly: • Use only the specified fuel listed. • Avoid running out of fuel. • Do not switch the ignition off when your vehicle is moving, especially at high speeds. • Have the items listed in scheduled maintenance information carried out according to the specified schedule. Please see your warranty information for complete details. On-Board Diagnostics (OBD-II) Your vehicle has an on-board diagnostics system (OBD-II) that monitors the engine’s emission control system. This system protects the environment by making sure that your vehicle continues to meet government emission standards. The OBD-II system also assists an authorized dealer in correctly servicing your vehicle. The scheduled maintenance items listed in scheduled maintenance information are essential to the life and performance of your vehicle and to its emissions system. When the service engine soon indicator illuminates, the OBD-II system has detected a malfunction. Temporary malfunctions may cause the service engine soon indicator to illuminate. If you use parts other than Ford, Motorcraft or Ford-authorized parts for maintenance replacements, or for service of components affecting emission control, such non-Ford parts should be the equivalent to genuine Ford Motor Company parts in performance and durability. Examples of temporary malfunctions are: • The vehicle has run out of fuel. • Poor fuel quality or water in the fuel. • The engine may misfire or run rough. • The fuel filler door may not have been closed correctly. See Refueling (page 120). • Driving through deep water. The electrical system may be wet. Illumination of any of the following warning lamps, indicators or vehicle symptoms could indicate that the emission control system is not working correctly. • Coolant temperature warning lamp. • Charging system warning lamp. • Service engine soon indicator. 123 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Fluid leaks. Strange odors. Excessive exhaust smoke. Loss of engine power. Fuel and Refueling If the vehicle engine or transmission has just been serviced or the battery has recently run out of charge or been replaced, the OBD-II system may indicate that your vehicle is not ready for I/M testing. To determine if the vehicle is ready for I/M testing, switch the ignition on for 15 seconds without cranking the engine. If the service engine soon indicator flashes on and off eight times, it means that your vehicle is not ready for I/M testing; if the service engine soon indicator illuminates and remains on, it means that your vehicle is ready for I/M testing. You can correct these temporary malfunctions by filling the fuel tank with good quality fuel, correctly closing the fuel filler door or letting the electrical system dry out. After three driving cycles without these or any other temporary malfunctions present, the service engine soon indicator should not illuminate. A driving cycle consists of a cold engine startup followed by mixed city or highway driving. No additional vehicle service is required. If the service engine soon indicator remains on, have your vehicle serviced at the first available opportunity. Although some malfunctions detected by the OBD-II may not have symptoms that are apparent, continued driving with the service engine soon indicator on can result in increased emissions, lower fuel economy, reduced engine and transmission smoothness, and lead to more costly repairs. The OBD-II system monitors the emission control system during normal driving. A complete check may take several days. If your vehicle is not ready for I/M testing, you may need to: • Drive on an expressway or highway for a steady 15 minutes, followed by 20 minutes of stop-and-go driving with at least four 30-second idle periods. • Allow your vehicle to sit for at least eight hours without starting the engine. Then complete the above driving cycle. Readiness for Inspection/Maintenance (I/M) Testing Some state/provincial and local governments may have Inspection/Maintenance (I/M) programs to inspect the emission control equipment on your vehicle. Failure to pass this inspection could prevent you from getting a vehicle registration. The engine must warm up to its normal operating temperature. Do not switch the ignition off until the above driving cycle is complete. If your vehicle is still not ready for I/M testing, you will have to repeat the above driving cycle. If the service engine soon indicator is on or the bulb does not work, you may need to have your vehicle serviced. See On-Board Diagnostics (OBD-II). Diesel Exhaust System: Oxidation Catalyst And Diesel Particulate Filter System Your vehicle is fitted with a diesel particulate filter. The diesel particulate filter is an inline filter in the exhaust system that reduces carbon emissions by trapping exhaust particles before they reach the tailpipe. The diesel particulate filter looks similar to a traditional exhaust catalyst, except it is larger, and is part of the exhaust system under the vehicle. The filter couples Your vehicle may not pass the I/M test if the service engine soon indicator is on or not working properly (bulb is burned out), or if the OBD-II system has determined that some of the emission control systems have not been properly checked. In this case, your vehicle is not ready for I/M testing. 124 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Fuel and Refueling to a diesel oxidation catalyst that reduces the amount of harmful exhaust emitted from the tailpipe. As soot gathers in the system it begins to restrict the filter. The soot that gathers inside the filter is cleaned in two different ways, passive regeneration and active regeneration. Both methods occur automatically and require no actions from the driver. During either one of these regeneration methods, you may notice a change in exhaust tone. At certain times, the information display will display various messages related to the diesel particulate filter. Active Regeneration Once the diesel particulate filter is full of exhaust particles, the engine control module will command the exhaust system to clean the diesel particulate filter through a process called active regeneration. Active regeneration requires the engine computer to raise the exhaust temperature to eliminate the particles. During cleaning, the particles convert to harmless gasses. Once cleaned the diesel particulate filter will then be ready to continue trapping exhaust particles. The regeneration process operates more efficiently when you drive your vehicle at a steady speed of 30 mph (48 km/h) or above for approximately 20 minutes to complete the process. The frequency and duration of regeneration will fluctuate by how you drive your vehicle, outside air temperature, and altitude. For most driving, regeneration frequency will vary from 100 mi (160 km) - 310 mi (500 km) between occurrences and each occurrence will last between 10 and 20 minutes. You can usually reduce the duration of regeneration if you maintain a constant speed above 30 mph (48 km/h). Diesel Particulate Filter Maintenance Failure to carry out active or operator commanded regeneration when advised could result in a clogged diesel particulate filter. If the diesel particulate filter fills beyond the regeneration threshold, your vehicle will disable the ability for active and operator commanded regeneration. This could result in irreversible damage to the diesel particulate filter requiring replacement that the Ford Warranty may not cover. If your vehicle is not fitted with operator commanded regeneration, check with an authorized dealer for availability. When the engine control module detects that the diesel particulate filter is nearly full of particulates, and you are not driving your vehicle in a manner to allow effective automatic cleaning, the information display will show the following messages as a reminder for you to drive in a manner to clean the diesel particulate filter. If you drive your vehicle in a manner to allow effective automatic cleaning, the information display will show a cleaning exhaust filter message, which is the normal regeneration process. Passive Regeneration During passive regeneration, the exhaust system temperature and constituents automatically clean the diesel particulate filter, or reduce the soot level, by oxidizing the soot. Cleaning occurs naturally during normal engine operating conditions, at varying levels depending on driving conditions. 125 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Fuel and Refueling System Messages Message Action and Description Exhaust filter overloaded You must maintain the diesel particulate filter for it to continue to function correctly. Drive in a manner to clean the Drive to clean diesel particulate filter. Do not disregard a system maintenance message. The Ford Warranty may not cover damage caused to your vehicle as a result of disregarding these messages. Exhaust filter at limit Clean now You must maintain the diesel particulate filter for it to continue to function correctly. Drive in a manner to clean the diesel particulate filter. Do not disregard a system maintenance message. The Ford Warranty may not cover damage caused to your vehicle as a result of disregarding these messages. sufficiently clean the diesel particulate filter system. Operator commanded regeneration allows you to manually start diesel particulate filter cleaning while the engine is idling. If you are not sure whether your vehicle is fitted with this feature, contact an authorized dealer. You can also choose operator commanded regeneration to clean the exhaust system at this point. See the following Operator Commanded Regeneration. If you are not able to drive in a manner that allows effective automatic cleaning or you choose to carry out regeneration of the diesel particulate filter while the engine is idling, then operator commanded regeneration must be carried out. When to Carry Out Operator Commanded Regeneration Use the operator commanded regeneration feature when the following message appears in the information display and: Operator Commanded Regeneration (If Equipped) If your vehicle is operated with significant stationary operation, low speed drive cycles less than 25 mph (40 km/h), short drive cycles, drive time less than 15 minutes or the vehicle does not fully warm up, passive and active regeneration may not • • 126 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 You are not able to drive in a manner that allows effective automatic cleaning. You choose to manually start cleaning the diesel particulate filter while the engine is idling. Fuel and Refueling System Message Message Action and Description Exhaust filter overloaded You must maintain the diesel particulate filter for it to continue to function correctly. Do not disregard a system Drive to clean maintenance message. The Ford Warranty may not cover damage caused to your vehicle as a result of disregarding this message. How to Start Operator Commanded Regeneration Operator Commanded Regeneration Precautions and Safe Exhaust Position WARNING WARNING Stay clear of exhaust tip during regeneration. You or others can be burned. Failure to comply with the following instructions for operator commanded regeneration may result in fire, serious injury, death or property damage. Note: You cannot use the operator commanded regeneration until the diesel particulate filter load percentage has reached 100 percent. The diesel particulate filter load percentage will fluctuate up and down when driving your vehicle due to active and passive regenerations. Before you start operator commanded regeneration, do the following: • You must park your vehicle outside of any structure. • Move the gearshift lever to park (P) with the parking brake set on stable, level ground. • Your vehicle must be 9.8 ft (3 m) 16.4 ft (5 m) away from any obstructions and must be away from materials that can easily combust or melt, for example, paper, leaves, petroleum products, fuels, plastics and other dry organic material. • Make sure there is a minimum of 2.6 gal (12 L) of fuel in the fuel tank. • Make sure all fluids are at the correct levels. • Make sure that the louvers located at the tip of the exhaust are clear of any obstructions as they are used to introduce fresh air into the tailpipe to cool the exhaust gas as it leaves. Note: During the use of operator commanded regeneration, you may observe a light amount of white smoke. This is normal. You cannot use the operator commanded regeneration if the service engine soon light is illuminated. Using the Information Display You can start operator commanded regeneration using the information display. See General Information (page 79). 127 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Fuel and Refueling To start operator commanded regeneration, run the engine at normal operating temperature and scroll to: Message Action and Description Settings Press the OK button. Exhaust Filter Press the OK button. Full OK = Cleaning Select one of the following: Exhaust Filter Full Exhaust Filter Overloaded Press the OK button and then follow the prompts regarding exhaust position as needed to initiate operator commanded regeneration. Be sure to understand each prompt. If you are not sure what is being asked by each prompt, contact an authorized dealer. The display will confirm the operation has started and when it has finished. Press the OK button and then follow the prompts regarding exhaust position as needed to initiate operator commanded regeneration. Be sure to understand each prompt. If you are not sure what is being asked by each prompt, contact an authorized dealer. The display will confirm the operation has started and when it has finished. If the diesel particulate filter is near or at saturation, a message requesting permission to initiate filter cleaning will display. Message Exhaust Filter At Limit Action and Description Press the OK button and then follow the prompts regarding exhaust position as needed to initiate operator commanded regeneration. Be sure to understand each prompt. If you are not sure what is being asked by each prompt, contact an authorized dealer. The display will confirm the operation has started and when it has finished. It is not necessary to open the hood on the engine compartment. Once operator commanded regeneration is complete, the engine rpm and fan will return to normal idling. The exhaust system will remain very hot for several minutes even after regeneration is complete. Do not reposition Once operator commanded regeneration starts, engine rpm will rise to approximately 2,000 - 2,500 rpm and the cooling fan will increase speed; you will hear a change in audible sound due to the fan and engine speed increase. 128 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Fuel and Refueling the vehicle over materials that could burn until the exhaust system has had sufficient time to cool. Depending on the amount of soot collected by the diesel particulate filter, ambient temperature, and altitude, operator commanded regeneration may last up to 30 minutes. When the system is at the point of over saturation, the service engine soon light will illuminate and the following message will appear. System Message Message Exhaust filter over limit Service now Action and Description You will not be able to allow cleaning. You must have your vehicle serviced by an authorized dealer. sufficiently clean the diesel particulate filter system. You can switch off automatic regeneration until better driving conditions are available, for example steady high driving. You can then switch automatic regeneration back on to clean the diesel particulate filter. Operator Commanded Regeneration with Automatic Regeneration Control (If Equipped) If your vehicle is operated with significant stationary operation, low speed drive cycles less than 25 mph (40 km/h), short drive cycles, drive time less than 15 minutes or the vehicle does not fully warm up, passive and active regeneration may not Switching the Automatic Regeneration Control On and Off To switch the automatic regeneration control on and off, scroll to: Message Action and Description Information Press the OK button. Driver Assist Press the OK button. Auto Exh.Clean Uncheck the box to switch automatic regeneration off. Check the box to switch automatic regeneration on. When you switch automatic regeneration off, one of the following warning messages may be displayed. Exhaust Filter Full Clean Soon The diesel particulate filter is full and you should switch the automatic regeneration control on as soon as possible. Exhaust Filter Overloaded Clean Now The diesel particulate filter is overloaded you must switch the automatic regeneration control on as soon as possible. Exhaust filter at limit Clean now You must clean the diesel particulate filter immediately. Failing to do so would cause the diesel particulate filter to become blocked. 129 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Fuel and Refueling How to Interrupt or Cancel Operator Commanded Regeneration Service engine soon indicator. If you need to cancel the operator commanded regeneration, press the brake pedal or switch the ignition off to stop the procedure. Depending on the amount of time you allowed the operator commanded regeneration to operate, soot may not have had sufficient time to be eliminated, but the exhaust system and exhaust gas may still be hot. If you shut your vehicle off during operator commanded regeneration, you will notice turbo flutter. This is a normal consequence caused by shutting off a diesel engine during boosted operation and is considered normal. Resonator and Tailpipe Assembly Maintenance WARNINGS Failure to maintain the functional holes, in the tailpipe section of the exhaust, clean and free of debris or foreign material may result in the holes becoming blocked or plugged. Do not modify or remove the tail-pipe section. Blocked or plugged holes or removal/modification of the system could result in elevated exhaust gas temperatures which may result in vehicle/property damage or personal injury. Filter Service and Maintenance Over time, a slight amount of ash will build up in the diesel particulate filter, which is not removed during the regeneration process. The filter may need to be removed for ash cleaning at approximately 119900 mi (193,000 km) or greater, actual mileage can vary greatly depending upon engine and vehicle operating conditions. The filter may need to be replaced at approximately 248500 mi (400,000 km) depending upon vehicle operating conditions. The normal operating temperature of the exhaust system is very high. Never work around or attempt to repair any part of the exhaust system until it has cooled. Use special care when working around the diesel oxidation catalytic converter and/or the diesel particulate filter (DPF). The diesel oxidation catalytic converter and/or the DPF heats up to a high temperature after only a short period of engine operation and can stay hot even after the engine is turned off. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury. In both cases, the engine control system will set a service light to inform you to have your vehicle checked by an authorized dealer. Note: Additions of aftermarket devices or modifications to the exhaust system can reduce the effectiveness of the exhaust system as well as cause damage to the exhaust system or engine. These actions may also affect your vehicle’s warranty. See the Warranty Guide for more information. If there are any issues with the diesel particulate filter, the engine control system will turn on a service light to inform you to have your vehicle checked by an authorized dealer. Powertrain fault indicator. 130 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Fuel and Refueling The diesel resonator tail-pipe assembly is a uniquely functioning device that accompanies the diesel particulate filter assembly. The tail-pipe assembly serves multiple functions. First, it serves as an acoustic device to attenuate exhaust noise. Second, it provides an exit path for the exhaust from your vehicle. It also helps control the temperature of the exhaust during diesel particulate filter regeneration events. The visible holes in each leg of the twin tip and the holes under the shield just inboard of the right rear tire(s) are functional. You need to keep the holes clear of mud, debris or foreign material to maintain proper function of the exhaust system. Clean and remove debris or foreign material if present as needed. Spraying with a hose during regular washing of your vehicle should help keep holes clean and clear of debris or foreign material. Tampering with emissions control systems (including related sensors and the Diesel Exhaust Fluid (DEF) injection system) can result in reduced engine power and the illumination of the service engine soon light. Tampering With a Noise Control System Federal law prohibits the following acts: • The removal or rendering inoperative by any person other than for purposes of maintenance, repair or replacement of any device or element of design incorporated into any new vehicle for the purpose of noise control prior to its sale or delivery to the ultimate purchaser or while it is in use • The use of the vehicle after such device or element of design has been removed or rendered inoperative by any person. Emission Control System Laws WARNING The U.S. Environmental Protection Agency may presume to constitute tampering as follows: • Removal of hood blanket, fender apron absorbers, fender apron barriers, underbody noise shields or acoustically absorptive material. • Tampering or rendering inoperative the engine speed governor, to allow engine speed to exceed manufacturer’s specifications. Do not remove or alter the original equipment floor covering or insulation between it and the metal floor of the vehicle. The floor covering and insulation protect occupants of the vehicle from the engine and exhaust system heat and noise. On vehicles with no original equipment floor covering insulation, do not carry passengers in a manner that permits prolonged skin contact with the metal floor. Provide adequate insulation. Failure to follow these instructions may result in fire or personal injury. The complexity of the diesel engine makes it so you are not encouraged to carry-out maintenance other than the services described in this Owner's Manual. In the U.S. federal law and certain state laws prohibit removing or rendering inoperative emission control system(s). Similar federal or provincial laws may apply in Canada. Ford recommends against any vehicle modification without determining applicable law. 131 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Fuel and Refueling If the engine does not start, runs rough, experiences a decrease in engine performance, experiences excess fuel consumption or produces excessive exhaust smoke, check for the following: • A plugged or disconnected air inlet system hose. • A plugged engine air filter element. • Water in the fuel filter and water separator. • A clogged fuel filter. • Contaminated fuel. • Air in the fuel system, due to loose connections. • An open or pinched sensor hose. • Incorrect engine oil level. • Incorrect fuel for climatic conditions. • Incorrect engine oil viscosity for climactic conditions. Note: If these checks do not help you correct the concern, have your vehicle checked by an authorized dealer. Noise Emissions Warranty, Prohibited Tampering Acts and Maintenance On January 1, 1978, Federal regulation became effective governing the noise emission on trucks over 10,000 lbs. (4,536 kg) GVWR (Gross Vehicle Weight Rating). The preceding statements concerning prohibited tampering acts and maintenance, and the noise warranty found in the Warranty Guide, are applicable to complete chassis cabs over 10,000 lbs. (4,536 kg) GVWR. 132 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Transmission AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION WARNINGS Always set the parking brake fully and make sure you shift the gearshift lever to park (P). Switch the ignition off and remove the key whenever you leave your vehicle. + Manual upshift - Manual downshift Tow/Haul (T/H) (If Equipped) Tow/Haul delays transmission upshift to reduce the frequency of transmission shifting. Do not apply the brake pedal and accelerator pedal simultaneously. Applying both pedals simultaneously for more than three seconds will limit engine rpm, which may result in difficulty maintaining speed in traffic and could lead to serious injury. The system provides engine braking in all forward gears when the gearshift lever is in drive (D). Engine braking helps you to slow and control your vehicle when descending a grade. Depending on trailer load and driving conditions, the transmission may downshift when descending a grade. Downshifting will depend on the amount of vehicle braking applied. Understanding the Gearshift Lever Positions of the Automatic Transmission Switching Tow/Haul On and Off To switch tow/haul on, press the T/H button. The tow haul E161509 indicator lamp will illuminate in the instrument cluster. 1. Shift the gearshift lever to drive (D). 2. Press the button. The instrument cluster will display the indicator lamp. 3. Press the button again to switch the system off. The transmission will return to normal drive (D) mode. Park (P) E175317 T/H WARNINGS Do not shift the gearshift lever to park (P) when your vehicle is moving. This can cause damage to the transmission not covered by the vehicle warranty, and can result in a crash or serious injury. Tow/Haul button P Park R Reverse N Neutral D Drive M Manual shifting 133 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Transmission WARNINGS Apply the parking brake, shift the gearshift lever to park (P) and switch the ignition off before leaving your vehicle. Make sure that the gearshift lever fully latches into position. The transmission shifts to the appropriate gear for optimum performance based on ambient temperature, road gradient, vehicle load and your input. When the gearshift lever is in this position, it will lock the transmission. The engine does not transmit power to the driven wheels. You can start the engine with the gearshift lever in this position. Note: You can temporarily override the selected gear by pressing the + or - buttons on the side of the gearshift lever. Note: A warning tone will sound if you open the driver door and you have not shifted the gearshift lever to park (P). WARNING Note: A shift will occur only when your vehicle speed and the engine speed are appropriate. Manual (M) Do not hold the + or - buttons permanently in. Reverse (R) Shift the gearshift lever to manual (M) to allow your vehicle to move forward and allow you to shift manually through the forward gears. Press the + or - buttons on the side of the gearshift lever to shift manually through the forward gears. The instrument cluster will display the selected gear, and a shift indicator arrow to assist optimum shifting. WARNINGS Do not shift the gearshift lever to reverse (R) when your vehicle is moving. This can cause damage to the transmission not covered by the vehicle warranty, and can result in a crash or serious injury. Always come to a complete stop before shifting the gearshift lever out of reverse (R). • • Press the + button to upshift. Press the - button to downshift. Shift the gearshift lever to reverse (R) to allow your vehicle to move backward. You can skip gears by pressing a button repeatedly at short intervals. Neutral (N) Upshift at the recommended shift speeds according to the following chart: When the gearshift lever is in this position, the transmission does not lock. The engine does not transmit power to the driven wheels. You can start the engine with the gearshift lever in this position. Upshifts when accelerating (recommended for best fuel economy) Upshift from: Vehicle speed mph ( km/h): 1-2 15 (24) Drive (D) Shift the gearshift lever to drive (D) to allow your vehicle to move forward and shift automatically through the forward gears. 134 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 2-3 25 (40) 3-4 40 (64) Transmission If Your Vehicle Gets Stuck In Mud or Snow Upshifts when accelerating (recommended for best fuel economy) Upshift from: Vehicle speed mph ( km/h): 4-5 45 (72) 5-6 50 (80) If your vehicle is stuck in mud or snow, shift between drive (D) and reverse (R) pressing lightly on the accelerator pedal in each gear. Stop between shifts in a steady pattern to rock your vehicle. Note: Do not rock your vehicle if the engine is not at normal operating temperature, damage to the transmission may occur. Note: Engine damage may occur if you maintain an excessive engine speed without shifting. Note: Do not rock your vehicle for more than a minute, damage to the transmission or tires may occur and the engine may overheat. Hints on Driving with an Automatic Transmission WARNING Brake-Shift Interlock Do not idle the engine for long periods in drive (D) with the brakes applied. WARNINGS Do not drive your vehicle until you verify that the brake lamps are working. Putting Your Vehicle in Gear This procedure requires you to shift the gearshift lever out of park (P) causing your vehicle to roll. Make sure you fully set the parking brake before attempting to shift the gearshift lever out of park (P). 1. Start the engine. 2. Press the brake pedal. 3. Shift the gearshift lever to drive (D), reverse (R) or manual (M). 4. Release the parking brake. 5. Release the brake pedal and press the accelerator pedal. If you release the parking brake and the brake warning lamp remains illuminated, the brakes may not be working correctly. The system has detected a fault that requires service. Stopping Your Vehicle 1. Release the accelerator pedal and press the brake pedal. 2. Apply the parking brake. 3. Shift the gearshift lever to neutral (N) or park (P). 4. Switch the ignition off. Your vehicle has a brake-shift interlock feature. This prevents you from shifting the gearshift lever from the park (P) position, unless the brake pedal is pressed. In the event of an electrical malfunction, or if the vehicle battery has run out of charge, use the following procedure to shift the gearshift lever from the park (P) position. 1. 135 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Apply the parking brake and switch the ignition off. Transmission E182198 2. Use a suitable tool, for example a screwdriver, to carefully remove the housing cover. E174827 4. Move the white lever toward the rear of your vehicle. 5. Shift the gearshift lever out of park (P) and into neutral (N). 6. Replace the gearshift lever housing cover, apply the brake pedal, switch the ignition on and release the parking brake. Note: See an authorized dealer as soon as possible. 3 E182199 3. Locate the white lever, situated on the left hand side of the gearshift lever. 136 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Brakes Anti-lock Brake System GENERAL INFORMATION This system helps you maintain steering control during emergency stops by keeping the brakes from locking. Note: Occasional brake noise is normal. If a metal-to-metal, continuous grinding or continuous squeal sound is present, the brake linings may be worn-out. Have the system checked by an authorized dealer. If your vehicle has continuous vibration or shudder in the steering wheel while braking, have it checked by an authorized dealer. This lamp momentarily illuminates when you turn the ignition on. If the light does not illuminate during start up, remains on or flashes, the system may be disabled. Have the system checked by an authorized dealer. Note: Brake dust may accumulate on the wheels, even under normal driving conditions. Some dust is inevitable as the brakes wear and does not contribute to brake noise. See Cleaning the Alloy Wheels (page 230). If the system is disabled, normal braking is still effective. If the brake warning lamp illuminates when you release the parking brake, have the system checked by an authorized dealer. See Warning Lamps and Indicators (page 75). Wet brakes result in reduced braking efficiency. Gently press the brake pedal a few times when driving from a car wash or standing water to dry the brakes. HINTS ON DRIVING WITH ANTI-LOCK BRAKES Note: When the system is operating, the brake pedal will pulse and may travel further. Maintain pressure on the brake pedal. You may also hear a noise from the system. This is normal. Brake Over Accelerator In the event the accelerator pedal becomes stuck or entrapped, apply steady and firm pressure to the brake pedal to slow the vehicle and reduce engine power. If you experience this condition, apply the brakes and bring your vehicle to a safe stop. Move the gearshift lever to park (P), switch the engine off and apply the parking brake. Inspect the accelerator pedal for any interference. If none are found and the condition persists, have your vehicle towed to the nearest authorized dealer. The anti-lock braking system will not eliminate the risks when: • You drive too closely to the vehicle in front of you. • Your vehicle is hydroplaning. • You take corners too fast. • The road surface is poor. Brake Assist Brake assist detects when you brake rapidly by measuring the rate at which you press the brake pedal. It provides maximum braking efficiency as long as you press the pedal, and can reduce stopping distances in critical situations. 137 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Brakes Note: Do not press the release button while pulling the parking brake lever up. PARKING BRAKE Center Parking Brake E172225 To apply the parking brake: 1. Press the foot brake pedal firmly. 2. Pull the parking brake lever up to its fullest extent. To release the parking brake: 1. Press the foot brake pedal firmly. 2. Pull the parking brake lever up slightly. 3. Press the release button and push the parking brake lever down. Note: If you park your vehicle facing uphill turn the steering wheel away from the curb. Note: If you park your vehicle facing downhill turn the steering wheel toward the curb. 138 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Traction Control Note: A MyKey can be set up to prevent the MyKey user from switching the traction control system off. See MyKey™ (page 47). PRINCIPLE OF OPERATION The traction control system helps avoid drive wheel spin and loss of traction. If your vehicle begins to slide, the system applies the brakes to individual wheels and, when needed, reduces engine power at the same time. If the wheels spin when accelerating on slippery or loose surfaces, the system reduces engine power in order to increase traction. E179110 USING TRACTION CONTROL Press the traction control button located on the instrument panel. It illuminates when you switch the system off. In certain situations, for example stuck in snow or mud, it may be beneficial for you to switch the traction control system off. This allows the wheels to spin with full engine power. AdvanceTrac with RSC Features Button functions Electronic stability control off warning lamp Roll stability control Electronic stability control Traction control system Default at Illuminated engine start-up during bulb check Enabled Enabled Enabled Button pressed momentarily Illuminated Enabled Enabled Disabled Button pressed again after deactivation Not illuminated Enabled Enabled Enabled 1 1 Engine traction control and two-wheel spin brake traction control functions are disabled. Single-wheel spin traction control is always enabled. 139 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Traction Control WARNING If a malfunction occurs within the AdvanceTrac system, the traction control off lamp will illuminate. Make sure the traction control system was not manually switched off using the traction control button. If the traction control lamp stays on, have the system checked by an authorized dealer immediately. Operating your vehicle with traction control disabled could lead to an increased risk of loss of vehicle control, vehicle rollover, personal injury and death. The traction control lamp temporarily illuminates on engine start-up and flashes when a driving condition turns the traction control system on. E138639 The traction control off lamp temporarily illuminates on engine start-up and stays on when you switch the traction control system off, or if a malfunction occurs in the traction control system. 140 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Stability Control The AdvanceTrac with Roll Stability Control system helps you keep control of your vehicle when on a slippery surface. The electronic stability control portion of the system helps avoid skids and lateral slides and roll stability control helps avoid a vehicle rollover. The traction control system helps avoid drive wheel spin and loss of traction. See Using Traction Control (page 139). PRINCIPLE OF OPERATION WARNINGS Vehicle modifications involving braking system, aftermarket roof racks, suspension, steering system, tire construction and wheel and tire size may change the handling characteristics of your vehicle and may adversely affect the performance of the AdvanceTrac system. In addition, installing any stereo loudspeakers may interfere with and adversely affect the AdvanceTrac system. Install any aftermarket stereo loudspeaker as far as possible from the front center console, the tunnel, and the front seats in order to minimize the risk of interfering with the AdvanceTrac sensors. Reducing the effectiveness of the AdvanceTrac system could lead to an increased risk of loss of vehicle control, vehicle rollover, personal injury and death. B B B A Remember that even advanced technology cannot defy the laws of physics. It’s always possible to lose control of a vehicle due to inappropriate driver input for the conditions. Aggressive driving on any road condition can cause you to lose control of your vehicle increasing the risk of personal injury or property damage. Activation of the AdvanceTrac system is an indication that at least some of the tires have exceeded their ability to grip the road; this could reduce the operator’s ability to control the vehicle potentially resulting in a loss of vehicle control, vehicle rollover, personal injury and death. If your AdvanceTrac system activates, SLOW DOWN. A A E72903 141 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 B A Vehicle without AdvanceTrac with RSC skidding off its intended route. B Vehicle with AdvanceTrac with RSC maintaining control on a slippery surface. Stability Control USING STABILITY CONTROL AdvanceTrac® with Roll Stability Control™ (RSC®) The system automatically activates when you start your vehicle. The AdvanceTrac with RSC system cannot be completely turned off, but the electronic stability control and roll stability control portions of the system are disabled when the transmission is in position R. You can turn off the traction control portion of the system independently. See Using Traction Control (page 139). 142 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Parking Aids Note: The outer sensors may detect the side walls of a garage. If the distance between the outer sensors and the side wall remains constant for three seconds, the alert will turn off. As you continue the inner sensors will detect objects directly behind your vehicle. PRINCIPLE OF OPERATION WARNINGS The system does not relieve you of your responsibility to drive with due care and attention. If your vehicles has a non-Ford approved trailer tow module the system may not correctly detect objects. PARKING AID The sensors may not detect objects with surfaces that absorb ultrasonic waves. WARNINGS The parking aid system can only assist you to detect objects when your vehicle is moving at parking speeds. To help avoid personal injury you must take care when using the parking aid system. The system does not detect objects that are moving away from your vehicle. They will only be detected shortly after they start to move toward your vehicle. Traffic control systems, inclement weather, air brakes, external motors and fans may affect the correct operation of the sensing system.This may cause reduced performance or false alerts. Take particular care when reversing with a tow ball arm or a rear fitted accessory. For example, a bicycle carrier. The rear parking aid will only indicate the approximate distance from the rear bumper to an object. The system may not detect small or moving objects, particularly those close to the ground. The sensors may not detect objects in heavy rain or other conditions that cause disruptive reflections. The system warns you of objects that are within the detection zone of the bumper areas. When you switch the ignition on, the system automatically turns on. The system becomes active when you shift into reverse (R) and the speed of your vehicle is 10 mph (16 km/h) or less. If you use a high pressure spray to wash your vehicle, only spray the sensors briefly from a distance not less than eight inches (20 centimeters). Note: If your vehicle has a tow ball arm, switch the system off when you connect trailer lamps (or lighting boards) to the 13-pin socket through a Ford approved trailer tow module. Note: Keep the sensors free from dirt, ice or snow. Do not clean with sharp objects. Note: The system may emit false alerts if it detects a signal using the same frequency as the sensors or if your vehicle is fully loaded. 143 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Parking Aids The system detects objects when you shift into reverse (R) and: • Your vehicle is moving toward a stationary object at a speed of 3 mph (5 km/h) or less. • Your vehicle is stationary but an object is approaching your vehicle at a speed of 3 mph (5 km/h) or less. • Your vehicle is moving at a speed of 3 mph (5 km/h) or less, and an object is approaching your vehicle at a speed of 3 mph (5 km/h) or less. Note: The rate of the tone increases as your vehicle moves closer to an object. E130178 A When the parking aid system sounds a tone, the audio system may reduce the set volume. When the warning ends, the audio system returns to the previously set volume. Rear detection zone: Up to 72 in (183 cm) from the rear bumper. Note: Accessories that block the detection zone of the system may create false alerts. Note: Keep the sensors free from snow, ice and large accumulations of dirt. Note: Volume reduction is not a standard feature of all audio systems. Note: If your vehicle sustains damage leaving the sensors misaligned, this will cause inaccurate measurements or false alerts. Switching the Parking Aid System Off A tone will sound in the following manner when objects are near the rear bumper: • Objects detected by the rear sensors produce a low-pitched tone. • An alert will only sound for three seconds if an object is further than 10 in (25 cm) from the side of your vehicle. E177143 Press the button to switch the system off. The system remains off until you switch the ignition off. The button is located on the instrument panel. REAR VIEW CAMERA WARNINGS Objects in the display are closer than they appear. 144 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Parking Aids Using the Display WARNINGS The operation of the camera may vary depending on the ambient temperature, vehicle and road conditions. WARNING Objects above the camera may not be visible. Check the area behind your vehicle when necessary. Do not place objects in front of the camera. The lines show a projected vehicle path and the approximate distance from the rear bumper to an object. The camera may not detect objects that are very close to your vehicle. Distance markers are only a guide and are calculated for unloaded vehicles on an even road surface. E170301 The camera is on the rear cargo door. Switching the Rear View Camera On Switch the ignition on and shift into reverse (R). The image will display in the interior mirror or in the information and entertainment display. The camera may not operate correctly in any of the following conditions: • Dark areas. • Intense light areas. • If there is a sudden change to the ambient temperature. • If the camera is wet. • If the camera is dirty. • If the camera is obstructed. 145 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Parking Aids C D B C C Green - 24 inches to 35 inches (0.6 meter to 0.9 meter). B D Black - center line of the projected vehicle path. Note: The green line is extended from 35 in (0.9 m) up to a distance of 126 in (3.2 m). Note: When reversing with a trailer the camera will show the direction of your vehicle and not the direction of the trailer. A A Note: When reversing with a trailer the screen does not display the lines. Switching the Rear View Camera Off Move the gearshift lever from reverse (R). Note: The system will automatically switch once your vehicle speed has reached approximately 5 mph (8 km/h) or after a short period of time. Vehicles with Parking Aid The display will show a colored distance bar. This indicates the approximate distance from the rear bumper to an object. These are color coded as follows: • Red - up to 12 in (0.3 m). • Amber - 12 in (0.3 m) to 24 in (0.6 m). • Green - 24 in (0.6 m) to 71 in (1.8 m). E142132 A Red - up to 12 inches (0.3 meter). B Amber - 12 inches to 24 inches (0.3 meter to 0.6 meter). 146 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Cruise Control PRINCIPLE OF OPERATION WARNING The system does not relieve you of your responsibility to drive with due care and attention. Cruise control allows you to control your speed using the switches on the steering wheel. You can use cruise control when you exceed approximately 20 mph (30 km/h). E142437 The cruise controls are located on the steering wheel. USING CRUISE CONTROL WARNINGS Do not use cruise control in heavy traffic, on winding roads or when the road surface is slippery. This could result in loss of vehicle control, serious injury or death. Switching Cruise Control On When you are going downhill, your vehicle speed may increase above the set speed. The system will not apply the brakes. Change down a gear to assist the system in maintaining the set speed. Failure to do so could result in loss of vehicle control, serious injury or death. Setting a Speed Press and release ON. The indicator will display in the instrument cluster. E71340 1. Accelerate to the desired speed. 2. Press and release SET+. 3. Take your foot off the accelerator pedal. Changing the Set Speed Note: Cruise control will disengage if your vehicle speed decreases more than 10 mph (16 km/h) below your set speed while driving uphill. • • • Press and hold SET+ or SET-. Release the control when you reach the desired speed. Press and release SET+ or SET-. The set speed will change in approximately 1 mph (2 km/h) increments. Press the accelerator or brake pedal until you reach the desired speed. Press and release SET+. Canceling the Set Speed Pull CAN toward you and release, or tap the brake pedal. The set speed will not be erased. 147 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Cruise Control Resuming the Set Speed Pull RES toward you and release. Switching Cruise Control Off Note: You will erase the set speed if you switch the system off. Press and release OFF or switch the ignition off. 148 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Driving Aids SPEED LIMITER WARNINGS The system may not operate in areas during roadwork construction. Engine Speed Limiter Engine speed is limited to protect the engine. The system may not operate on roads with sharp bends or narrow lanes. Vehicle Speed Limiter - Fixed Do not carry out windshield repairs in the immediate area surrounding the sensor. The system prevents you from driving faster than a programmed speed. If your vehicle has a suspension kit not approved by us, the system may not function correctly. DRIVER ALERT Principle of Operation Note: Keep the windshield free from obstructions such as bird droppings, insects and snow or ice. WARNINGS The system does not relieve you of your responsibility to drive with due care and attention. Note: The system assists you when driving on fast main roads and freeways. At all times you are responsible for controlling your vehicle, supervising the system and intervening if required. Note: The system calculates an alertness level at vehicle speeds above approximately 40 mph (65 km/h). The system automatically monitors your driving behavior. If the sensor becomes blocked the system may not function. The system is designed to alert you if it detects that you are becoming drowsy or if your driving deteriorates. Take regular rest breaks as required and do not wait for the system to warn you if you feel tired. Take rest breaks only where it is safe to do so. Using Driver Alert Certain driving styles and behavior may result in the system issuing a warning even if you are not feeling Note: The system will remain on or off depending on how it was last set. Switching the System On and Off Switch the system on using the information display. See Information Displays (page 79). tired. In cold and severe weather conditions the system may not function. Rain, snow, spray and large contrasts in lighting can all influence the sensor. The system will calculate your alertness level based upon your driving behavior in relation to the lane markings and other factors. The system will not operate if the sensor cannot track the road lane markings. 149 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Driving Aids System Warnings Alertness level is critical, indicating that you should take a rest as soon as it is safe to do so. Note: The system will not issue warnings below approximately 40 mph (65 km/h). The status bar will travel from left to right as the calculated alertness level decreases. As the rest icon is approached the color turns from green to yellow and then finally red when a rest break must be taken. The warning system has two stages: 1. A temporary warning is issued to advise you to take a rest. This message only appears for a short time. 2. If you do not rest and the system continues to detect that your driving deteriorates, it will issue a further warning. This will remain in the information display until you cancel it. See Information Messages (page 84). • • • Green: No rest required. Yellow: First (temporary) warning. Red: Second warning. Your alertness level will be shown in grey if: • the camera sensor cannot track the road lane markings • your vehicle speed drops below approximately 40 mph (65 km/h). Press OK on the steering wheel control to remove the warning. System Display When active the system will run automatically in the background and only issue warnings if required. You can view the status at any time using the information display. See General Information (page 79). Resetting the System You can reset the system by: • switching the ignition off and on • stopping your vehicle and then opening and closing the driver's door. The alertness level is shown by six steps as a colored bar. LANE KEEPING SYSTEM Lane Keeping Alert Principle of Operation WARNINGS The system does not relieve you of your responsibility to drive with due care and attention. E131358 Alertness level is fine, no rest required. At all times you are responsible for controlling your vehicle, supervising the system and intervening if required. If the sensor becomes blocked the system may not function. E131359 150 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Driving Aids The system will automatically detect and track the lane markings on the road. If your vehicle unintentionally drifts toward the road lane markings, you will see a warning in the information display. There is also a warning given in the form of a vibration felt through the steering wheel. WARNINGS The sensor may incorrectly track lane markings such as other structures or objects. This can result in a false or missed warning. In cold and severe weather conditions the system may not function. Rain, snow, spray and large contrasts in lighting can all influence the sensor. Note: The vibration intensity from the steering wheel may decease depending on the quality of the road surface. Using Lane Keeping Alert The system will not operate if the sensor cannot track the road lane markings. Switching the System On and Off The system may not operate in areas during roadwork construction. The system may not operate on roads with sharp bends or narrow lanes. Do not carry out windshield repairs in the immediate area surrounding the sensor. E132099 Turn the system on and off using the button on the direction indicator stalk. If your vehicle has a suspension kit not approved by us, the system may not function correctly. Press the button twice to turn the system on. Press the button once to turn the system off. Note: Keep the windshield free from obstructions such as bird droppings, insects and snow or ice. Note: The system may assist you when driving on fast main roads and freeways. Note: When you switch the system off, a warning indicator will remain illuminated in the information display. See Warning Lamps and Indicators (page 75). Note: The system may not operate during hard braking or acceleration and when you are intentionally steering your vehicle. Note: The system status and settings will remain unchanged when you switch the ignition on and off. Note: The system will operate with a minimum of one tracked lane marking. Setting the Steering Wheel Vibration Level Note: The system will only operate above vehicle speeds of approximately 40 mph (65 km/h). The system has three intensity levels which you can set using the information display. See (page 79). The sensor is located behind the interior mirror. It continuously monitors conditions to alert you of unintentional lane drifting at high speeds. 151 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Driving Aids Setting the System Sensitivity • You can adjust how quickly the system warns you of a dangerous situation. The system has two sensitivity levels which you can set using the information display. See (page 79). • • • System Warnings If you apply direct steering, accelerate fast or brake hard. Your vehicle speed is outside the operating limits. If there is an anti-lock brake or stability control intervention. Narrow lane width. If the lane markings in the display turn red or you feel a vibration through the steering wheel you must take immediate and safe action to align your vehicle. Correct any unintended lane drift immediately. E152382 A column of lane markings are displayed either side of the vehicle graphic. The lane markings are color coded as follows: • Green: The system is ready to warn you of any unintentional lane departure. • Red: Your vehicle is approaching or is too close to the detected lane boundary. Take immediate safe action to reposition your vehicle. • Gray: The system will suppress the relevant lane boundary. Instances where a lane boundary may be suppressed: • The sensor may not detect the lane markings on the road. • You turn the direction indicator for that side of your vehicle on. 152 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Load Carrying vehicle will provide maximum return of vehicle design performance. Before loading your vehicle, familiarize yourself with the following terms for determining your vehicle’s weight ratings, with or without a trailer, from the vehicle’s Tire Label or Safety Compliance Certification Label: Base Curb Weight - is the weight of the vehicle including a full tank of fuel and all standard equipment. It does not include passengers, cargo, or optional equipment. Vehicle Curb Weight - is the weight of your new vehicle when you picked it up from your authorized dealer plus any aftermarket equipment. LOAD RETAINING FIXTURES Securing Cargo E175810 Note: The number of load retaining fixtures may vary depending on your vehicle model. LOAD LIMIT Vehicle Loading - with and without a Trailer This section will guide you in the proper loading of your vehicle, trailer or both, to keep your loaded vehicle weight within its design rating capability, with or without a trailer. Properly loading your PAYLOAD E143816 153 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Load Carrying Payload - is the combined weight of cargo and passengers that the vehicle is carrying. The maximum payload for your vehicle can be found on the Tire Label on the B-Pillar or the edge of the driver door (vehicles exported outside the US and Canada may not have a Tire Label). Look for “THE COMBINED WEIGHT OF OCCUPANTS AND CARGO SHOULD NEVER EXCEED XXX kg OR XXX lb.” for maximum payload. The payload listed on the Tire Label is the maximum payload for the vehicle as built by the assembly plant. If you install any aftermarket or authorized-dealer installed equipment on the vehicle, you must subtract the weight of the equipment from the payload listed on the Tire Label in order to determine the new payload. WARNING The appropriate loading capacity of your vehicle can be limited either by volume capacity (how much space is available) or by payload capacity (how much weight the vehicle should carry). Once you have reached the maximum payload of your vehicle, do not add more cargo, even if there is space available. Overloading or improperly loading your vehicle can contribute to loss of vehicle control and vehicle rollover. Example only: E142516 154 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Load Carrying E142517 CARGO E143817 GAWR (Gross Axle Weight Rating) - is the maximum allowable weight that can be carried by a single axle (front or rear). These numbers are shown on the Safety Compliance Certification Label. The label shall be affixed to either the door hinge pillar, door-latch post, or the door edge that meets the door-latch post, next to the driver's seating position. The total load on each axle must never exceed its Gross Axle Weight Rating. Cargo Weight - includes all weight added to the Base Curb Weight, including cargo and optional equipment. When towing, trailer tongue load or king pin weight is also part of cargo weight. GAW (Gross Axle Weight) - is the total weight placed on each axle (front and rear) including vehicle curb weight and all payload. 155 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Load Carrying Note: For trailer towing information refer to the RV and Trailer Towing Guide available at an authorized dealer. GVW E143818 Safety Compliance Certification Label. The label shall be affixed to either the door hinge pillar, door-latch post, or the door edge that meets the door-latch post, next to the driver's seating position. The Gross Vehicle Weight must never exceed the Gross Vehicle Weight Rating. GVW (Gross Vehicle Weight) is the Vehicle Curb Weight, plus cargo, plus passengers. GVWR (Gross Vehicle Weight Rating) - is the maximum allowable weight of the fully loaded vehicle (including all options, equipment, passengers and cargo). It is shown on the Example only: E142523 156 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Load Carrying E142524 WARNING Exceeding the Safety Compliance Certification Label vehicle weight rating limits could result in substandard vehicle handling or performance, engine, transmission and/or structural damage, serious damage to the vehicle, loss of control and personal injury. GCW GVW E143819 GCWR (Gross Combined Weight Rating) - is the maximum allowable weight of the vehicle and the loaded trailer, including all cargo and passengers, that the vehicle can handle without risking damage. (Important: The towing vehicle’s braking system is rated GCW (Gross Combined Weight) - is the Gross Vehicle Weight plus the weight of the fully loaded trailer. 157 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Load Carrying Examples: For a 5000 pound (2268 kilogram) conventional trailer, multiply 5000 by 0.10 and 0.15 to obtain a proper tongue load range of 500 to 750 pounds (227 to 340 kilograms). For an 11500 pound (5216 kilogram) fifth wheel trailer, multiply by 0.15 and 0.25 to obtain a proper king pin load range of 1725 to 2875 pounds (782 to 1304 kilograms). for operation at Gross Vehicle Weight Rating, not at Gross Combined Weight Rating.) Separate functional brakes should be used for safe control of towed vehicles and for trailers where the Gross Combined Weight of the towing vehicle plus the trailer exceed the Gross Vehicle Weight Rating of the towing vehicle. The Gross Combined Weight must never exceed the Gross Combined Weight Rating. Maximum Loaded Trailer Weight - is the highest possible weight of a fully loaded trailer the vehicle can tow. It assumes a vehicle with mandatory options, driver and front passenger weight (150 pounds [68 kilograms] each), no cargo weight (internal or external) and a tongue load of 10–15% (conventional trailer) or king pin weight of 15–25% (fifth wheel trailer). Consult an authorized dealer (or the RV and Trailer Towing Guide available at an authorized dealer) for more detailed information. Tongue Load or Fifth Wheel King Pin Weight - refers to the amount of the weight that a trailer pushes down on a trailer hitch. WARNINGS Do not exceed the GVWR or the GAWR specified on the Safety Compliance Certification Label. Do not use replacement tires with lower load carrying capacities than the original tires because they may lower the vehicle’s GVWR and GAWR limitations. Replacement tires with a higher limit than the original tires do not increase the GVWR and GAWR limitations. Exceeding any vehicle weight rating limitation could result in serious damage to the vehicle and/or personal injury. Steps for determining the correct load limit: 1. Locate the statement "The combined weight of occupants and cargo should never exceed XXX kg or XXX lb." on your vehicle’s placard. 158 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Load Carrying 2. Determine the combined weight of the driver and passengers that will be riding in your vehicle. 3. Subtract the combined weight of the driver and passengers from XXX kg or XXX lb. 4. The resulting figure equals the available amount of cargo and luggage load capacity. For example, if the “XXX” amount equals 1,400 lb. and there will be five 150 lb. passengers in your vehicle, the amount of available cargo and luggage load capacity is 650 lb. (1400-750 (5 x 150) = 650 lb.) 5. Determine the combined weight of luggage and cargo being loaded on the vehicle. That weight may not safely exceed the available cargo and luggage load capacity calculated in Step 4. 6. If your vehicle will be towing a trailer, load from your trailer will be transferred to your vehicle. Consult this manual to determine how this reduces the available cargo and luggage load capacity of your vehicle. The following gives you a few examples on how to calculate the available amount of cargo and luggage load capacity: *Suppose your vehicle has a 1400-pound (635-kilogram) cargo and luggage capacity. You decide to go golfing. Is there enough load capacity to carry you, four of your friends and all the golf bags? You and four friends average 220 pounds (99 kilograms) each and the golf bags weigh approximately 30 pounds (13.5 kilograms) each. The calculation would be: 1400 (5 x 220) - (5 x 30) = 1400 - 1100 - 150 = 150 pounds. Yes, you have enough load capacity in your vehicle to transport four friends and your golf bags. In metric units, the calculation would be: 635 kilograms - (5 x 99 kilograms) (5 x 13.5 kilograms) = 635 - 495 67.5 = 72.5 kilograms. *Suppose your vehicle has a 1400-pound (635-kilogram) cargo and luggage capacity. You and one of your friends decide to pick up cement from the local home improvement store to finish that patio you have been planning for the past two years. Measuring the inside of the vehicle with the rear seat folded down, you have room for twelve 100-pound (45-kilogram) bags of cement. Do you have enough load capacity to transport the cement to your home? If you and your friend each weigh 220 pounds (99 kilograms), the calculation would be: 1400 (2 x 220) - (12 x 100) = 1400 - 440 - 1200 = - 240 pounds. No, you do not have enough cargo capacity to carry that much weight. In metric units, the calculation would 159 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Load Carrying be: 635 kilograms - (2 x 99 kilograms) - (12 x 45 kilograms) = 635 - 198 - 540 = -103 kilograms. You will need to reduce the load weight by at least 240 pounds (104 kilograms). If you remove three 100-pound (45-kilogram) cement bags, then the load calculation would be: 1400 - (2 x 220) - (9 x 100) = 1400 - 440 900 = 60 pounds. Now you have the load capacity to transport the cement and your friend home. In metric units, the calculation would be: 635 kilograms - (2 x 99 kilograms) - (9 x 45 kilograms) = 635 - 198 - 405 = 32 kilograms. The above calculations also assume that the loads are positioned in your vehicle in a manner that does not overload the Front or the Rear Gross Axle Weight Rating specified for your vehicle on the Safety Compliance Certification Label. The label shall be affixed to either the door hinge pillar, door-latch post, or the door edge that meets the door-latch post, next to the driver's seating position. 160 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Towing TOWING A TRAILER Load Placement WARNINGS Do not exceed the Gross Vehicle Weight Rating or the Gross Axle Weight Rating specified on the certification label. Towing trailers beyond the maximum recommended gross trailer weight exceeds the limit of the vehicle and could result in engine damage, transmission damage, structural damage, loss of vehicle control, vehicle rollover and personal injury. To help minimize how trailer movement affects your vehicle when driving: • Load the heaviest items closest to the trailer floor. • Load the heaviest items centered between the left and right side trailer tires. • Load the heaviest items above the trailer axles or just slightly forward toward the trailer tongue. Do not allow the final trailer tongue weight to go above or below 10-15% of the loaded trailer weight. • Select a tow bar with the correct rise or drop. When both the loaded vehicle and trailer are connected, the trailer frame should be level, or slightly angled down toward your vehicle, when viewed from the side. When driving with a trailer or payload, a slight takeoff vibration or shudder may be present due to the increased payload weight. Additional information regarding correct trailer loading and setting your vehicle up for towing is located in another chapter of this Owner's Manual. See Load Limit (page 153). You can also find the information in the RV & Trailer Towing Guide. See an authorized dealer. Your vehicle may have electrical items, for example fuses or relays, related to towing. See Fuses (page 187). Your vehicle's load capacity designation is by weight, not by volume, so you cannot necessarily use all available space when loading your vehicle. Towing a trailer places an extra load on your vehicle's engine, transmission, axle, brakes, tires and suspension. Inspect these components periodically during, and after, any towing operation. 161 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Towing RECOMMENDED TOWING WEIGHTS TRAILER SWAY CONTROL (If Equipped) Note: Make sure to take into consideration trailer frontal area. Vehicles equipped with the Trailer Tow Package or the Heavy Duty Payload Package should not exceed 55 ft² (5.1 m²) trailer frontal area. Note: Exceeding this limitation may significantly reduce the performance of your towing vehicle. Selecting a trailer with a low aerodynamic drag and rounded front design helps optimize performance and fuel economy. Note: For high altitude operation, reduce the gross combined weight by 2% per 1000 ft (300 m) starting at the 1000 ft (300 m) elevation point. Note: Certain states require electric trailer brakes for trailers over a specified weight. Be sure to check state regulations for this specified weight. The maximum trailer weights listed may be limited to this specified weight, as your vehicle's electrical system may not include the wiring connector needed to use electric trailer brakes. Your vehicle may tow a trailer provided the maximum trailer weight is less than or equal to the maximum trailer weight listed for your vehicle configuration on the following charts. WARNING Switching off trailer sway control increases the risk of loss of vehicle control, serious injury or death. We do not recommend disabling this feature except in situations where speed reduction may be detrimental, for example ascending a grade, and the driver has significant trailer towing experience and can control trailer sway to maintain safe operation. This feature applies your vehicle's brakes at individual wheels and, if necessary, reduces engine power. If the trailer begins to sway, the stability control light flashes and a message appears in the information display. Message Trailer sway Reduce speed Action Slow your vehicle down, then pull safely to the side of the road and check for correct tongue load and trailer load distribution. See Load Carrying (page 153). Note: This feature does not prevent trailer sway, but reduces it once it begins. Note: This feature cannot stop all trailers from swaying. Note: In some cases, if vehicle speed is too high, the system may turn on multiple times to gradually reduce vehicle speed. 162 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Towing Van and Chassis Cab Powertrain Axle Ratio Maximum GCWR Maximum Loaded * Trailer Weight 3.2L Power Stroke Diesel 3.31 10600 lb (4808 kg) 4750 lb (2155 kg) 3.2L Power Stroke Diesel 3.73 13500 lb (6123 kg) 7500 lb (3402 kg) 3.5L V6 GTDI 3.31 11200 lb (5080 kg) 5700 lb (2585 kg) 3.5L V6 GTDI 3.73 12600 lb (5715 kg) 7150 lb (3243 kg) 3.7L V6 TiVCT 3.73 10800 lb (4899 kg) 5350 lb (2427 kg) 3.7L V6 TiVCT 4.10 12000 lb (5450 kg) 6700 lb (3039 kg) * Calculated with SAE J2807 method. Wagon Powertrain Axle Ratio Maximum GCWR Maximum Loaded * Trailer Weight 3.2L Power Stroke Diesel 3.31 10600 lb (4808 kg) 4200 lb (1905 kg) 3.2L Power Stroke Diesel 3.73 11200 lb (5080 kg) 4650 lb (2109 kg) 3.5L V6 GTDI 3.31 11200 lb (5080 kg) 5150 lb (2336 kg) 3.7L V6 TiVCT 3.73 10800 lb (4899 kg) 4800 lb (2177 kg) 3.7L V6 TiVCT 4.10 11200 lb (5080 kg) 5200 lb (2359 kg) * Calculated with SAE J2807 method. 163 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Towing Calculating the Maximum Loaded Trailer Weight for Your Vehicle ESSENTIAL TOWING CHECKS Follow these guidelines for safe towing: • Do not tow a trailer until your vehicle has covered at least 1000 mi (1,600 km). See Breaking-In (page 173). • Consult your local motor vehicle laws for towing a trailer. • See the instructions included with towing accessories for the correct installation and adjustment specifications. • Service your vehicle more frequently if you tow a trailer. See Scheduled Maintenance (page 433). • If you use a rental trailer, follow the instructions the rental agency gives you. 1. Start with the gross combined weight rating for your vehicle model and axle ratio. See the previous charts. 2. Subtract all of the following that apply to your vehicle: • Vehicle curb weight • Hitch hardware weight, such as a draw bar, ball, locks or weight distributing hardware • Driver weight • Passenger(s) weight • Payload, cargo and luggage weight • Aftermarket equipment weight. This equals the maximum loaded trailer weight for this combination. Note: The trailer tongue load is considered part of the payload for your vehicle. Reduce the total payload by the final trailer tongue weight. Note: Consult an authorized dealer to determine the maximum trailer weight allowed for your vehicle if you are not sure. For load specification terms found on the tire label, Safety Compliance label and instructions on calculating your vehicle's maximum load. See Load Limit (page 153). Remember to account for the trailer tongue weight as part of your vehicle load when calculating the total vehicle weight. Trailer Towing Connector (If Equipped) E163167 Your vehicle is fitted with both a 7 pin and 4 pin trailer wiring connector. 164 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Towing When attaching the trailer wiring connector to your vehicle, only use a correctly fitting connector that works with the vehicle and trailer functions. Some seven-position connectors may have the SAE J2863 logo, which confirms that it is the correct wiring connector and works correctly with your vehicle. Color To connect the safety chains, cross the chains under the trailer tongue and allow enough slack for turning tight corners. Do not allow the chains to drag on the ground. Trailer Brakes (If Equipped) WARNING Do not connect trailer hydraulic brake systems directly to the vehicle brake system. Your vehicle may not have enough braking power and your chances of having a crash greatly increase. Function Yellow Left turn signal and brake lamp. White Ground (-). Blue Electric brakes. Green Right turn signal and brake lamp. Orange Battery (+). Brown Running lamps. Grey Reverse lamps. Electric, manual, automatic or surge-type trailer brakes are safe if you install them correctly and adjust them to the manufacturer's specifications. Trailer brakes must meet local and federal regulations. The rating for the tow vehicle's braking system operation is at the gross vehicle weight rating, not the gross combined weight rating. Separate functioning brake systems are required for safe control of towed vehicles and trailers weighing more than 1500 lb (680 kg) when loaded. Tow Hitch Do not use a tow hitch that either clamps on to the bumper or attaches to the axle. You must distribute the load in your trailer so that between 10% and 15% of the total weight of the trailer is on the tongue. Integrated Trailer Brake Controller WARNING Weight Distributing Hitches The Ford trailer brake controller has been verified to be compatible with trailers having electric-actuated drum brakes (one to four axles) and electric-over-hydraulic brakes. It will not turn on the hydraulic surge-style trailer brakes. It is the responsibility of the customer to make sure that the trailer brakes are adjusted appropriately, functioning normally and all electric connections are correctly made. Failure to do so may result in loss of vehicle control, crash or serious injury. A weight distribution hitch is not recommended for use with your vehicle. Safety Chains WARNING Do not attach safety chains to the bumper. Always connect the safety chains to the frame or hook retainers of your vehicle's tow hitch. 165 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Towing 1. B A Press the + and - buttons to adjust the brake controller's power output to the trailer brakes in 0.5 increments. You can increase the gain setting to 10 (maximum trailer braking) or decrease it to zero (no trailer braking). Pressing and holding a button raises or lowers the setting continuously. The gain setting displays in the information display as: E166403 Message A Manual control lever. B Gain adjustment buttons. Trailer Brake Gain: When used correctly, the trailer brake controller assists in smooth and effective trailer braking by powering the trailer’s electric or electric-over-hydraulic brakes with a proportional output based on the towing vehicle’s brake pressure Note: Using the manual control lever illuminates the trailer's brake lamps and your vehicle's brake lamps, except the center high-mounted brake lamp, if you make the correct electrical connection to the trailer. Slide the manual control lever to the left to turn on the trailer's electric brakes. They work independently of the tow vehicle's braking system. See the following; Procedure for adjusting the gain setting for instructions on correct use of this feature. If you use the manual control while the brake is also applied, the greater of the two inputs determines the power sent to the trailer brakes. 166 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Towing The controller shows gain setting, output bar graph and the trailer connectivity status in the information display as follows: Message Trailer Brake Gain: No Trailer Trailer Brake Gain: Output: Action and Description Displays the current gain setting during a given ignition cycle and when adjusting the gain setting. This also displays if you use the manual control lever or make gain adjustments with no trailer connected. Displays when you press your vehicle's brake pedal, or upon use of the manual control lever. Bar indicators illuminate in the information display to indicate the amount of power going to the trailer brakes relative to the brake pedal or manual control input. One bar indicates the least amount of output; six bars indicate maximum output. Trailer Connected Displays when the system senses a correct trailer wiring connection during a given ignition cycle. For example a trailer with electric trailer brakes. Trailer Disconnected Displays when the system senses a trailer connection and then a disconnection, either intentional or unintentional, during a given ignition cycle, this is accompanied by a single audible tone. It also displays if a vehicle or trailer-wiring fault occurs causing the trailer to appear disconnected. This message can also display if you use the manual control lever without a trailer connected. 1. Make sure the trailer brakes are in good working condition, functioning normally and correctly adjusted. See a trailer dealer if necessary. 2. Hook up the trailer and make the electrical connections according to the trailer manufacturer's instructions. 3. Use the gain adjustment + and buttons to increase or decrease the gain setting to the desired starting point. A gain setting of six is a good starting point for heavier loads. 4. In a traffic-free environment, tow the trailer on a dry, level surface at a speed of 20-25 mph (30-40 km/h) and slide the manual control lever completely. Procedure for Adjusting the Gain Setting The gain setting sets the trailer brake controller for the specific towing condition. You should change the setting as towing conditions change. Changes to towing conditions include trailer load, vehicle load, road conditions and weather. The gain should be set to provide the maximum trailer braking assistance while making sure the trailer wheels do not lock when using the brakes. Locked trailer wheels may lead to trailer instability. Note: Only carry out this procedure in a traffic-free environment at speeds of approximately 20-25 mph (30-40 km/h). 167 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Towing 5. If the trailer wheels lock, indicated by squealing tires, reduce the gain setting. If the trailer wheels turn freely, increase the gain setting. Repeat steps four and five until the gain setting is at a point just below trailer wheel lock. If towing a heavier trailer, trailer wheel lock may not be attainable even with the maximum gain setting of 10. System Warning Messages Message Action and Description Trailer Brake Module Fault Displays in response to faults sensed by the trailer brake controller, accompanied by a single tone. If this message appears, contact an authorized dealer as soon as possible for diagnosis and repair. The controller may still function, but performance may be degraded. Wiring Fault on Trailer Displays when there is a short circuit on the electric brake output wire. If the message displays, accompanied by a single tone, with no trailer connected, the problem is with your vehicle wiring between the trailer brake controller and the 7pin connector. If the message only displays with a trailer connected, the problem is with the trailer wiring. Consult a trailer dealer for assistance. This can be a short to ground, for example a chaffed wire, short to voltage, for example a pulled pin on trailer emergency breakaway battery or the trailer brakes may be drawing too much current. Note: An authorized dealer can diagnose the trailer brake controller to determine exactly which trailer fault has occurred. However, the Ford Warranty does not cover this diagnosis if the fault is with the trailer. • Points to Remember • • • Do not attempt removal of the trailer brake controller without consulting the Workshop Manual. Damage to the unit may result. Adjust gain setting before using the trailer brake controller for the first time. Adjust gain setting, using the procedure above, whenever road, weather and trailer or vehicle loading conditions change from when the gain was initially set. • 168 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Only use the manual control lever for correct adjustment of the gain during trailer setup. Misuse, such as application during trailer sway, could cause instability of trailer or tow vehicle. Avoid towing in adverse weather conditions. The trailer brake controller does not provide anti-lock control of the trailer wheels. Trailer wheels can lock up on slippery surfaces, resulting in instability of trailer or tow vehicle. Towing • • • • • The trailer brake controller is fitted with a feature that reduces output at vehicle speeds below 11 mph (18 km/h) so trailer and vehicle braking is not jerky or harsh. This feature is only available when applying the brakes using your vehicle's brake pedal, not the controller. The controller interacts with the brake control system and powertrain control system of your vehicle to provide the best performance on different road conditions. Your vehicle's brake system and the trailer brake system work independently of each other. Changing the gain setting on the controller does not affect the operation of your vehicle's brake system whether you attach a trailer or not. When you switch the engine off, the controller output is disabled and the display and module shut down. The controller module and display turn on when you switch the ignition on. The trailer brake controller is only a factory-installed or dealer-installed item. Ford is not responsible for warranty or performance of the controller due to misuse or customer installation. Trailer lamps are required on most towed vehicles. Make sure all running lamps, brake lamps, turn signals and hazard warning lamps are working. Before Towing a Trailer Practice turning, stopping and backing up to get the feel of your vehicle-trailer combination before starting on a trip. When turning, make wider turns so the trailer wheels clear curbs and other obstacles. When Towing a Trailer • • • • • Trailer Lamps WARNING • Never connect any trailer lamp wiring to the vehicle's tail lamp wiring; this may damage the electrical system resulting in fire. Contact an authorized dealer as soon as possible for assistance in correct trailer tow wiring installation. Additional electrical equipment may be required. • 169 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Do not drive faster than 70 mph (113 km/h) until you drive your vehicle at least 495 mi (800 km). See Breaking-In (page 173). Do not make full-throttle starts. Check the tow hitch, electrical connections and trailer wheel lug nuts thoroughly after you have traveled 50 mi (80 km). When stopped in congested or heavy traffic during hot weather, place the gearshift in position park (P) to aid engine and transmission cooling and to help A/C performance. Turn off the speed control with heavy loads or on hilly terrain. The speed control may turn off automatically when you are towing on long, steep grades. Shift to a lower gear when driving down a long or steep hill. Do not apply the brakes continuously, as they may overheat and become less effective. If the transmission is fitted with a Grade Assist, Tow/Haul feature, use this feature when towing. This provides engine braking and helps eliminate excessive transmission shifting for optimum fuel economy and transmission cooling. Towing • • • • Note: Reconnect the wiring to the trailer after the trailer is removed from the water. If your vehicle is fitted with AdvanceTrac with roll stability control (RSC), this system may turn on during typical cornering maneuvers with a heavily loaded trailer. This is normal. Turning the corner at a slower speed while towing may reduce this tendency. If you are towing a trailer frequently in hot weather, hilly conditions, at the gross combined weight rating (or any combination of these factors), consider refilling your vehicle's rear axle with synthetic gear lubricant (if the axle is not already filled with it). See Scheduled Maintenance (page 433). Allow more distance for stopping with a trailer attached. Anticipate stops and brake gradually. Avoid parking on a grade. However, if you must park on a grade: • Turn the steering wheel to point your vehicle tires away from traffic flow. • Set your vehicle parking brake. • Place the automatic transmission in position park (P). • Place wheel chocks in front of and at the back of the trailer wheels. (trailer wheel chocks are not included with your vehicle.) Exceeding these limits may allow water to enter vehicle components: • Causing internal damage to the components. • Affecting driveability, emissions, and reliability. Replace the rear axle lubricant anytime the rear axle has been submerged in water. Water may have contaminated the rear axle lubricant, which is not normally checked or changed unless a leak is suspected or other axle repair is required. TRANSPORTING THE VEHICLE Launching or Retrieving a Boat or Personal Water Craft (PWC) When backing down a ramp during boat launching or retrieval: • Do not allow the static water level to rise above the bottom edge of the rear bumper. • Do not allow waves to break higher than 6 in (15 cm) above the bottom edge of the rear bumper. E143886 Note: Disconnect the wiring to the trailer before backing the trailer into the water. 170 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Towing If you need to have your vehicle towed, contact a professional towing service or, if you are a member of a roadside assistance program, your roadside assistance service provider. TOWING THE VEHICLE ON FOUR WHEELS We recommend the use of a wheel lift and dollies or flatbed equipment to tow your vehicle. Do not tow with a slingbelt. Ford Motor Company has not approved a slingbelt towing procedure. Vehicle damage may occur if towed incorrectly, or by any other means. If your vehicle is disabled and you have no access to a tow dolly, car-hauling trailer or a flatbed transport vehicle, it can only be flat-towed with all wheels on the ground under the following conditions: • Your vehicle is facing forward so that it is towed in a forward direction. • The transmission selector lever is placed in position N. If the transmission gear shift lever cannot be moved to position N, it may need to be overridden. See Automatic Transmission (page 133). • Maximum speed is 35 mph (56 km/h). • Maximum distance is 50 miles (80 kilometers). Emergency Towing Ford Motor Company produces a towing manual for all authorized tow truck operators. Have your tow truck operator refer to this manual for proper hook-up and towing procedures for your vehicle. It is acceptable to have your two-wheel drive vehicle towed with the front wheels on the ground (without dollies) and the rear wheels off the ground. We recommend towing a four-wheel drive vehicle with all wheels off the ground, such as using a wheel lift and dollies or flatbed equipment. However, it is acceptable to use a wheel lift to raise the rear of your vehicle so long as, depending on vehicle configuration, you perform the following before towing. Drive off slowly and smoothly without jerking the vehicle that is being towed. Tow ropes or rigid towing bars must be placed on the same side. For example; right hand rear towing point to right hand front towing point. You must use a tow rope or rigid towing bar that is of the correct strength for the weight of the towing vehicle and the vehicle that is being towed. Note: Using a rigid towing bar is the safest way to tow a vehicle. The weight of the vehicle that is being towed must not exceed the weight of the towing vehicle. Recreational Vehicle Towing Follow these guidelines to prevent damage to your vehicle’s transmission if you have a need for recreational vehicle towing. For example; towing your vehicle behind a motorhome. 171 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Towing Your vehicle cannot be flat-towed with all wheels on the ground beyond the limits set out above as vehicle or transmission damage may occur. See Emergency Towing. You must place your vehicle on a car-hauling trailer, or place the front wheels of your vehicle on a tow dolly. If you are using a tow dolly, follow the instructions specified by the equipment provider. Note: Put your vehicle's climate control system in recirculated air mode to prevent exhaust fumes from entering the vehicle. See Climate Control (page 89). 172 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Driving Hints 5. Have your vehicle checked by an authorized dealer as soon as possible. BREAKING-IN You need to break in new tires for approximately 300 miles (480 kilometers). During this time, your vehicle may exhibit some unusual driving characteristics. The engine also needs to break in. Avoid hard accelerations and driving too fast for the first 1000 miles (1600 kilometers). If possible, avoid carrying heavy loads up steep grades during the break-in period. ECONOMICAL DRIVING Fuel economy is affected by several things such as how you drive, the conditions you drive under and how you maintain your vehicle. There are some things to keep in mind that may improve your fuel economy: • Accelerate and slow down in a smooth, moderate fashion. • Drive at steady speeds. • Anticipate stops; slowing down may eliminate the need to stop. • Combine errands and minimize stop-and-go driving. • When running errands, go to the furthest destination first and then work your way back home. • Close the windows for high-speed driving. • Drive at reasonable speeds. (Traveling at 65 mph/105 kph uses about 15% less fuel than traveling at 75 mph/121 kph). • Keep the tires properly inflated and use only the recommended size. • Use the recommended engine oil. • Perform all regularly scheduled maintenance. REDUCED ENGINE PERFORMANCE WARNING Continued operation will increase the engine temperature and cause the engine to shut down completely. If the engine coolant temperature gauge needle moves to the upper limit position, the engine is overheating. See Gauges (page 73). You must only drive your vehicle for a short distance if the engine overheats. The distance you can travel depends on ambient temperature, vehicle load and terrain. The engine will continue to operate with limited power for a short time. If the engine temperature continues to rise, the fuel supply to the engine will reduce. The air conditioning will switch off and the engine cooling fan will operate continually. There are also some things you may want to avoid doing because they reduce your fuel economy: • Avoid sudden or hard accelerations. • Avoid revving the engine before turning off the car. • Avoid long idle periods. • Do not warm up your vehicle on cold mornings. 1. Reduce your speed gradually and stop your vehicle as soon as it is safe to do so. 2. Switch the engine off immediately to prevent severe engine damage. 3. Wait for the engine to cool down. 4. Check the coolant level. See Engine Coolant Check (page 206). 173 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Driving Hints • • • • • • When driving in water, maintain a low speed and do not stop your vehicle. After driving through water and as soon as it is safe to do so: • Depress the brake pedal lightly to check that the brakes are functioning correctly. • Check that the horn works. • Check that your vehicle's lamps are fully operational. • Check the power assistance of the steering system. Reduce the use of air conditioning and heat. Avoid using speed control in hilly terrain. Do not rest your foot on the brake pedal while driving. Avoid carrying unnecessary weight (approximately 1 mpg [0.4 kilometers/liter] is lost for every 400 lbs [180 kilograms] of weight carried). Avoid adding particular accessories to your vehicle (e.g. bug deflectors, rollbars/light bars, running boards, ski racks). Avoid driving with the wheels out of alignment. FLOOR MATS WARNINGS Always use floor mats that are designed to fit the foot well of your vehicle. Only use floor mats that leave the pedal area unobstructed. Only use floor mats that are firmly secured to retention posts so that they cannot slip out of position and interfere with the pedals or impair safe operation of your vehicle in other ways. COLD WEATHER PRECAUTIONS The functional operation of some components and systems can be affected at temperatures below -13°F (-25°C). DRIVING THROUGH WATER Pedals that cannot move freely can cause loss of vehicle control and increase the risk of serious personal injury. WARNINGS Drive through water in an emergency only and not as part of normal driving. Always make sure that the floor mats are properly attached to the retention posts in the carpet that are supplied with your vehicle. Floor mats must be properly secured to both retention posts to make sure mats do not shift out of position. Engine damage can occur if water enters the air filter. In an emergency, you can drive your vehicle through water to a maximum depth of 8 inches (200 millimeters) and at a maximum speed of 6 mph (10 km/h). You must take extra care when driving through flowing water. Never place floor mats or any other covering in the vehicle foot well that cannot be properly secured to prevent them from moving and interfering with the pedals or the ability to control the vehicle. 174 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Driving Hints WARNINGS Never place floor mats or any other covering on top of already installed floor mats. Floor mats should always rest on top of vehicle carpeting surface and not another floor mat or other covering. Additional floor mats or any other covering will reduce the pedal clearance and potentially interfere with pedal operation. Check attachment of floor mats on a regular basis. Always properly reinstall and secure floor mats that have been removed for cleaning or replacement. Always make sure that objects cannot fall into the driver foot well while the vehicle is moving. Objects that are loose can become trapped under the pedals causing a loss of vehicle control. Failure to properly follow floor mat installation or attachment instructions can potentially cause interference with pedal operation causing a loss of vehicle control. E142666 To install floor mats, position the floor mat so that the eyelet is over the retention post and press down to lock in. To remove the floor mat, reverse the installation procedure. 175 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Roadside Emergencies Roadside Assistance includes up to $200 for a towed trailer if the disabled eligible vehicle requires service at the nearest authorized dealer. If the towing vehicle is operational but the trailer is not, then the trailer does not qualify for any roadside services. ROADSIDE ASSISTANCE Vehicles Sold in the United States: Getting Roadside Assistance To fully assist you should you have a vehicle concern, Ford Motor Company offers a complimentary roadside assistance program. This program is separate from the New Vehicle Limited Warranty. The service is available: • • Vehicles Sold in the United States: Using Roadside Assistance Complete the roadside assistance identification card and place it in your wallet for quick reference. This card is in the owner's information portfolio in the glove compartment. 24 hours a day, seven days a week. For the coverage period listed on the Roadside Assistance Card included in your Owner's Manual portfolio. United States Ford vehicle customers who require Roadside Assistance, call 1-800-241-3673. Roadside Assistance covers: • A flat tire change with a good spare, if provided with the vehicle (except vehicles supplied with a tire inflation kit). • Battery jump start. • Lock-out assistance (key replacement cost is the customer's responsibility). • Fuel delivery — independent service contractors, if not prohibited by state, local or municipal law, shall deliver up to 2 gal (7.6 L) of gasoline or 4 gal (18.9 L) of diesel fuel to a disabled vehicle. Roadside Assistance limits fuel delivery service to two no-charge occurrences within a 12-month period. • Winch out — available within 100 ft (30.5 m) of a paved or county maintained road, no recoveries. • Towing — Ford eligible vehicles towed to an authorized dealer within 35 mi (56 km) of the disablement location or to the nearest authorized dealer. If a member requests a tow to an authorized dealer that is more than 35 mi (56 km) from the disablement location, the member shall be responsible for any mileage costs in excess of 35 mi (56 km). If you need to arrange roadside assistance for yourself, Ford Motor Company reimburses a reasonable amount for towing to the nearest dealership within 35 mi (56 km). To obtain reimbursement information, United States Ford vehicle customers call 1-800-241-3673. Customers need to submit their original receipts. Vehicles Sold in Canada: Getting Roadside Assistance Canadian customers who require roadside assistance, call 1-800-665-2006. Vehicles Sold in Canada: Using Roadside Assistance For your convenience, you may complete the roadside assistance identification card found in the centerfold of your warranty guide and retain for future reference. 176 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Roadside Emergencies Canadian roadside coverage and benefits may differ from the U.S. coverage. If you require more information, please refer to the coverage section of your warranty guide, call us in Canada at 1-800-665-2006, or visit our website at www.ford.ca. The hazard warning button is located on the instrument panel. Switch the hazard warning flashers on when your vehicle is creating a safety hazard. Sykes Assistance Services Corporation administers the Roadside Assistance program. You must receive covered services in Canada or the continental United States. Coverage extends to vehicles that use public, non-seasonal, annually traveled roadways. Roadside Assistance coverage does not extend to vehicles involved in cross-country driving, logging, autocross and any other form of off-road use. Well maintained roads and surfaces help ensure safe travel for the supplier, and allow their representatives to perform service as per the standard operating procedures. Press the button again to switch the hazard warning flashers off. Press the button to switch the hazard warning flashers on. The front and rear direction indicators will flash. Note: Prolonged use of the hazard warning flashers will cause the battery to run out of charge. There may be insufficient power to restart the engine. FUEL SHUTOFF WARNING Failure to inspect and, if necessary, repair fuel leaks after a collision may increase the risk of fire and serious injury. Ford Motor Company recommends that the fuel system be inspected by an authorized dealer after any collision. In Remote Locations If our supplier cannot take your vehicle by road to the nearest authorized dealership, transportation by rail or water may be necessary. The program covers a tow to the dock or rail terminal and also to the dealership at the end of the trip. In the event of a moderate to severe collision, this vehicle includes a fuel pump shutoff feature that stops the flow of fuel to the engine. Not every impact will cause a shutoff. For rail or water transportation, however, contact your authorized dealer to confirm if you are eligible for additional coverage before you authorize or pay for the service. Should your vehicle shut off after a collision, you may restart your vehicle. For vehicles equipped with a key system: 1. Switch off the ignition. 2. Switch on the ignition. 3. Repeat Steps 1 and 2 to re-enable the fuel pump. Call the Ford Roadside Assistance at 1-800-665-2006 for additional information. HAZARD WARNING FLASHERS Note: When you try to restart your vehicle after a fuel shutoff, the vehicle makes sure that various systems are safe to restart. Once your vehicle determines that the systems are safe, then the vehicle will allow you to restart. E71943 177 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Roadside Emergencies Note: In the event that your vehicle does not restart after your third attempt, contact an authorized dealer. The positive (+) access terminal is next to the fuse box, under a red cap. To access the positive (+) terminal, lift the red cap up. JUMP STARTING THE VEHICLE WARNINGS The gases around the battery can explode if exposed to flames, sparks or lit cigarettes. An explosion could result in personal injury or vehicle damage. Batteries contain sulfuric acid which can burn skin, eyes and clothing, if contacted. Use only an adequate-sized cable with insulated clamps. E145290 Preparing Your Vehicle The negative (-) terminal is a post, located on the driver side, near the hood hinge. It is a grounding connection point, so you will need to remove the rubber covering first. Note: Do not attempt to push-start your automatic transmission vehicle. Automatic transmissions do not have push-start capability. Attempting to push-start a vehicle with an automatic transmission may cause transmission damage. Note: Use only a 12-volt supply to start your vehicle. Note: Do not disconnect the battery of the disabled vehicle as this could damage the vehicle's electrical system. Park the booster vehicle close to the hood of the disabled vehicle, making sure the two vehicles do not touch, and switch off all accessories. E183998 Your vehicle has a positive (+) access terminal and a negative (-) grounding connection point that you can access under the hood, even though the actual battery is under the driver seat. You can jump your vehicle using these points. 178 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Roadside Emergencies Connecting the Jumper Cables 3. Connect the negative (-) cable to the negative (-) terminal of the assisting battery. 4. Make the final connection of the negative (-) cable to the grounding connection point of the vehicle with the discharged battery. WARNING Do not attach the cables to fuel lines, engine rocker covers, the intake manifold or electrical components as grounding points. Stay clear of moving parts. To avoid reverse polarity connections, make sure that you correctly identify the positive (+) and negative (-) terminals on both the disabled and booster vehicles before connecting the cables. WARNING Do not connect the end of the second cable to the negative (-) terminal of the battery to be jumped. A spark may cause an explosion of the gases that surround the battery. Note: In the illustration, the bottom vehicle represents the booster vehicle. Jump Starting 1. Start the engine of the booster vehicle and rev the engine moderately, or press the accelerator gently to keep your engine speed between 2000 and 3000 rpms, as shown in your tachometer. 2. Start the engine of the disabled vehicle. 3. Once you start the disabled vehicle, run both vehicle engines for an additional three minutes before disconnecting the jumper cables. 1 3 4 Removing the Jumper Cables 2 Remove the jumper cables in the reverse order that they were connected. E142664 1. Connect the positive (+) jumper cable to the positive (+) access terminal of the vehicle with the discharged battery. 2. Connect the other end of the positive (+) cable to the positive (+) terminal of the assisting battery. 179 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Roadside Emergencies POST-CRASH ALERT SYSTEM The system flashes the turn signal lamps and sounds the horn (intermittently) in the event of a serious impact that deploys an airbag (front, side, side curtain or Safety Canopy) or the safety belt pretensioners. 4 2 The horn and lamps will turn off when: • You press the hazard control button. • You press the panic button on the remote entry transmitter (if equipped). • Your vehicle runs out of power. 1 3 E142665 1. Remove the jumper cable from the grounding connection point of the vehicle with the discharged battery. 2. Remove the jumper cable on the negative (-) terminal of the booster vehicle's battery. 3. Remove the jumper cable from the positive (+) terminal of the booster vehicle's battery. 4. Remove the jumper cable from the positive (+) access terminal of the vehicle with the discharged battery. After you start the disabled vehicle and remove the jumper cables, allow your vehicle to idle for several minutes so the battery can recharge. 180 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Customer Assistance These are some of the items that can be found online: • U.S. dealer locator by Dealer Name, City/State or Zip Code. • Owner Manuals. • Maintenance Schedules. • Recalls. • Ford Extended Service Plans. • Ford Genuine Accessories. • Service specials and promotions. GETTING THE SERVICES YOU NEED Warranty repairs to your vehicle must be performed by an authorized dealer. While any authorized dealer handling your vehicle line will provide warranty service, we recommend you return to your selling authorized dealer who wants to ensure your continued satisfaction. Please note that certain warranty repairs require special training and equipment, so not all authorized dealers are authorized to perform all warranty repairs. This means that, depending on the warranty repair needed, you may have to take your vehicle to another authorized dealer. In Canada: Mailing address Customer Relationship Centre Ford Motor Company of Canada, Limited P.O. Box 2000 Oakville, Ontario L6K 0C8 A reasonable time must be allowed to perform a repair after taking your vehicle to the authorized dealer. Repairs will be made using Ford or Motorcraft® parts, or remanufactured or other parts that are authorized by Ford. Telephone 1-800-565-3673 (FORD) Online www.ford.ca Away From Home Twitter If you are away from home when your vehicle needs service, contact the Ford Customer Relationship Center or use the online resources listed below to find the nearest authorized dealer. @FordServiceCA (English Canada) @FordServiceQC (Quebec) Additional Assistance If you have questions or concerns, or are unsatisfied with the service you are receiving, follow these steps: In the United States: Mailing address 1. Contact your Sales Representative or Service Advisor at your selling/servicing authorized dealer. 2. If your inquiry or concern remains unresolved, contact the Sales Manager, Service Manager or Customer Relations Manager. 3. If you require assistance or clarification on Ford Motor Company policies, please contact the Ford Customer Relationship Center. Ford Motor Company Customer Relationship Center P.O. Box 6248 Dearborn, MI 48121 Telephone 1-800-392-3673 (FORD) (TDD for the hearing impaired: 1-800-232-5952) Online Additional information and resources are available online at www.fordowner.com 181 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Customer Assistance In order to help us serve you better, please have the following information available when contacting a Customer Relationship Center: • Vehicle Identification Number. • Your telephone number (home and business). • The name of the authorized dealer and city where located. • The vehicle’s current odometer reading. California Civil Code Section 1793.22(b) presumes that the manufacturer has had a reasonable number of attempts to conform the vehicle to its applicable express warranties if, within the first 18 months of ownership of a new vehicle or the first 18000 miles (29 000 km), whichever occurs first: 1. Two or more repair attempts are made on the same non-conformity likely to cause death or serious bodily injury OR 2. Four or more repair attempts are made on the same nonconformity (a defect or condition that substantially impairs the use, value or safety of the vehicle) OR 3. The vehicle is out of service for repair of nonconformities for a total of more than 30 calendar days (not necessarily all at one time). In some states, you must directly notify Ford in writing before pursuing remedies under your state’s warranty laws. Ford is also allowed a final repair attempt in some states. In the United States, a warranty dispute must be submitted to the BBB AUTO LINE before taking action under the Magnuson-Moss Warranty Act, or to the extent allowed by state law, before pursuing replacement or repurchase remedies provided by certain state laws. This dispute handling procedure is not required prior to enforcing state created rights or other rights which are independent of the Magnuson-Moss Warranty Act or state replacement or repurchase laws. In the case of 1 or 2 above, the consumer must also notify the manufacturer of the need for the repair of the nonconformity at the following address: Ford Motor Company 16800 Executive Plaza Drive Mail Drop 3NE-B Dearborn, MI 48126 You are required to submit your warranty dispute to BBB AUTO LINE before asserting in court any rights or remedies conferred by California Civil Code Section 1793.22(b). You are also required to use BBB AUTO LINE before exercising rights or seeking remedies created by the Federal Magnuson-Moss Warranty Act, 15 U.S.C. sec. 2301 et seq. If you choose to seek redress by pursuing rights and remedies not created by California Civil Code Section 1793.22(b) or the Magnuson-Moss Warranty Act, resort to BBB AUTO LINE is not required by those statutes. IN CALIFORNIA (U.S. ONLY) California Civil Code Section 1793.2(d) requires that, if a manufacturer or its representative is unable to repair a motor vehicle to conform to the vehicle’s applicable express warranty after a reasonable number of attempts, the manufacturer shall be required to either replace the vehicle with one substantially identical or repurchase the vehicle and reimburse the buyer in an amount equal to the actual price paid or payable by the consumer (less a reasonable allowance for consumer use). The consumer has the right to choose whether to receive a refund or replacement vehicle. 182 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Customer Assistance already taken to try to resolve them. A Customer Claim Form will be mailed that will need to be completed, signed and returned to the BBB along with proof of ownership. Upon receipt, the BBB will review the claim for eligibility under the Program Summary Guidelines. THE BETTER BUSINESS BUREAU (BBB) AUTO LINE PROGRAM (U.S. ONLY) Your satisfaction is important to Ford Motor Company and to your dealer. If a warranty concern has not been resolved using the three-step procedure outlined earlier in this chapter in the Getting the Services you need section, you may be eligible to participate in the BBB AUTO LINE program. You can get more information by calling BBB AUTO LINE at 1-800-955-5100, or writing to: BBB AUTO LINE 3033 Wilson Boulevard, Suite 600 Arlington, Virginia 22201 The BBB AUTO LINE program consists of two parts – mediation and arbitration. During mediation, a representative of the BBB will contact both you and Ford Motor Company to explore options for settlement of the claim. If an agreement is not reached during mediation or you do not want to participate in mediation, and if your claim is eligible, you may participate in the arbitration process. An arbitration hearing will be scheduled so that you can present your case in an informal setting before an impartial person. The arbitrator will consider the testimony provided and make a decision after the hearing. BBB AUTO LINE applications can also be requested by calling the Ford Motor Company Customer Relationship Center at 1-800-392-3673. Note: Ford Motor Company reserves the right to change eligibility limitations, modify procedures, or to discontinue this process at any time without notice and without obligation. UTILIZING THE MEDIATION/ARBITRATION PROGRAM (CANADA ONLY) Disputes submitted to the BBB AUTO LINE program are usually decided within forty days after you file your claim with the BBB. You are not bound by the decision, and may reject the decision and proceed to court where all findings of the BBB Auto Line dispute, and decision, are admissible in the court action. Should you choose to accept the BBB AUTO LINE decision, Ford is then bound by the decision, and must comply with the decision within 30 days of receipt of your acceptance letter. For vehicles delivered to authorized Canadian dealers. In those cases where you continue to feel that the efforts by Ford of Canada and the authorized dealer to resolve a factory-related vehicle service concern have been unsatisfactory, Ford of Canada participates in an impartial third party mediation/arbitration program administered by the Canadian Motor Vehicle Arbitration Plan (CAMVAP). The CAMVAP program is a straight forward and relatively speedy alternative to resolve a disagreement when all other efforts to produce a settlement have failed. This procedure is without cost to you and is designed to eliminate the need for lengthy and expensive legal proceedings. BBB AUTO LINE Application: Using the information provided below, please call or write to request a program application. You will be asked for your name and address, general information about your new vehicle, information about your warranty concerns, and any steps you have 183 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Customer Assistance In the CAMVAP program, impartial third-party arbitrators conduct hearings at mutually convenient times and places in an informal environment. These impartial arbitrators review the positions of the parties, make decisions and, when appropriate, render awards to resolve disputes. CAMVAP decisions are fast, fair, and final as the arbitrator’s award is binding on both you and Ford of Canada. If your vehicle must be serviced while you are traveling or living in Asia-Pacific Region, Sub-Saharan Africa, U.S. Virgin Islands, Central America, the Caribbean, and Israel, contact the nearest authorized dealer. If the authorized dealer cannot help you, contact: FORD MOTOR COMPANY Customer Relationship Center 1555 Fairlane Drive Fairlane Business Park #3 Allen Park, Michigan 48101 U.S.A. Telephone: (313) 594-4857 Fax: (313) 390-0804 Email: [email protected] CAMVAP services are available in all Canadian territories and provinces. For more information, without charge or obligation, call your CAMVAP Provincial Administrator directly at 1-800-207-0685 or visit www.camvap.ca. For customers in Guam, the Commonwealth of the Northern Mariana Islands (CNMI), America Samoa, and the U.S. Virgin Islands, please feel free to call our Toll-Free Number: (800) 841-FORD (3673). GETTING ASSISTANCE OUTSIDE THE U.S. AND CANADA Before exporting your vehicle to a foreign country, contact the appropriate foreign embassy or consulate. These officials can inform you of local vehicle registration regulations and where to find unleaded fuel. If your vehicle must be serviced while you are traveling or living in Puerto Rico, contact the nearest authorized dealer. If the authorized dealer cannot help you, contact: FORD MOTOR COMPANY Customer Relationship Center 1555 Fairlane Drive Fairlane Business Park #3 Allen Park, Michigan 48101 U.S.A. Telephone: (800) 841-FORD (3673) FAX: (313) 390-0804 Email: [email protected] www.ford.com.pr If you cannot find unleaded fuel or can only get fuel with an anti-knock index lower than is recommended for your vehicle, contact our Customer Relationship Center. The use of leaded fuel in your vehicle without proper conversion may damage the effectiveness of your emission control system and may cause engine knocking or serious engine damage. Ford Motor Company or Ford of Canada is not responsible for any damage caused by use of improper fuel. Using leaded fuel may also result in difficulty importing your vehicle back into the United States. If your vehicle must be serviced while you are traveling or living in the Middle East, contact the nearest authorized dealer. If the authorized dealer cannot help you, contact: 184 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Customer Assistance FORD MOTOR COMPANY Customer Relationship Center 1555 Fairlane Drive Fairlane Business Park #3 Allen Park, Michigan 48101 U.S.A. Telephone: +971 4 3326084 Toll-Free Number of the Kingdom of Saudi Arabia: 800 8971409 Local Telephone Number of Kuwait: 24810575 FAX: +971 4 3327299 Email: [email protected] www.me.ford.com Monday-Friday 8:00 a.m. - 6:00 p.m. EST Helm, Incorporated can also be reached by their website: www.helminc.com (Items in this catalog may be purchased by credit card, check or money order.) Obtaining a French Owner’s Manual French Owner’s Manual can be obtained from your authorized dealer or by contacting Helm, Incorporated using the contact information listed previously in this section. If you buy your vehicle in North America and then relocate to any of the above locations, register your vehicle identification number (VIN) and new address with Ford Motor Company Export Operations & Global Growth Initiatives by emailing [email protected]. REPORTING SAFETY DEFECTS (U.S. ONLY) If you are in another foreign country, contact the nearest authorized dealer. In the event your inquiry is unresolved, communicate your concern with the dealership’s Sales Manager, Service Manager or Customer Relations Manager. If you require additional assistance or clarification, please contact the respective Customer Relationship Center as previously listed. E142557 If you believe that your vehicle has a defect which could cause a crash or could cause injury or death, you should immediately inform the National Highway Traffic Safety Administration (NHTSA) in addition to notifying Ford Motor Company. If NHTSA receives similar complaints, it may open an investigation, and if it finds that a safety defect exists in a group of vehicles, it may order a recall and remedy campaign. However, NHTSA cannot become involved in individual problems between you, your dealer, or Ford Motor Company. Customers in the U.S. should call 1-800-392-3673. ORDERING ADDITIONAL OWNER'S LITERATURE To order the publications in this portfolio, contact Helm, Incorporated at: HELM, INCORPORATED 47911 Halyard Drive Plymouth, Michigan 48170 Attention: Customer Service Or to order a free publication catalog, call toll free: 1-800-782-4356 185 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Customer Assistance To contact NHTSA, you may call the Vehicle Safety Hotline toll-free at 1-888-327-4236 (TTY: 1-800-424-9153); go to http://www.safercar.gov; or write to: Administrator 1200 New Jersey Avenue, Southeast Washington, D.C. 20590 You can also obtain other information about motor vehicle safety from http://www.safercar.gov. REPORTING SAFETY DEFECTS (CANADA ONLY) If you believe that your vehicle has a defect which could cause a crash or could cause injury or death, you should immediately inform Transport Canada. Transport Canada Contact Information Website http://www.tc.gc.ca/eng/roadsafety/menu.htm Phone 1–800–333–0510 186 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Fuses This is located behind the removable trim panel. FUSE BOX LOCATIONS Engine Compartment Fuse Box Pre-fuse Box This is located under the driver's seat. Body Control Module Fuse Box E146726 For item location: See Under Hood Overview (page 201). E152512 Passenger Compartment Fuse Box This is located behind the removable trim panel. E152513 187 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Fuses FUSE SPECIFICATION CHART Engine Compartment Fuse Box E148826 Fuse Fuse rating F1 10A Selective Catalytic Reduction - Diesel. Circuits protected F2 15A Selective Catalytic Reduction - Diesel. F3 15A Selective Catalytic Reduction - Diesel. F4 10A Selective Catalytic Reduction - Diesel. 188 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Fuses Fuse Fuse rating Circuits protected F5 3A Diesel particulate filter vaporizer. Glow plug monitor. F6 3A Anti-lock brake system. Stability assist. Ignition. F7 7.5A Powertrain control module. F8 20A Cooling fan - Gasoline. F9 30A Left-hand windshield wiper. F10 30A Right-hand windshield wiper. F11 10A Air conditioning clutch. F12 20A Diesel particulate filter vaporizer glow plug. F13 - F14 3A F15 - Not used. F16 - Not used. F17 - Not used. F18 40A Anti-lock brake system. Stability assist pump. Not used. Selective Catalytic Reduction - ignition - Diesel. F19 30A Starter solenoid. F20 60A Glow plugs. F21 60A Ignition relay 3. F22 40A Selective Catalytic Reduction relay feed. F22 40A Electric vacuum pump relay feed. F23 10A PROTECTED CIRCUIT FUSE. F24 10A Fuel injection pump - Diesel. F24 20A Fuel injection pump - Gasoline. F25 15A Throttle control unit - Diesel. F25 10A PROTECTED CIRCUIT FUSE - Gasoline. 189 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Fuses Fuse Fuse rating Circuits protected F26 20A F27 - F28 7.5A Crankcase sensor - Diesel. F28 10A Injection power - Gasoline 3.7L. F29 3A Ignition feed - Audio - Gasoline. F29 7.5A Crank case ventilation heater – Diesel. F30 60A Single cooling fan. F30 40A Twin cooling fan. F31 40A Twin cooling fan 2 - Gasoline. F32 30A Windshield wiper motor. F32 60A Windshield dual wiper motors. Start-Stop auxiliary water pump. PROTECTED CIRCUIT FUSE. Not used. F33 20A F34 - F35 20A Powertrain control system supply - Gasoline. F35 15A Powertrain control system supply - Diesel. F36 20A Mass air flow sensor - Gasoline. F36 15A Mass air flow sensor . NOX sensor 1, 2 - Diesel. F37 7.5A Volume Control Valve. F38 20A Air conditioning clutch - Gasoline. F38 7.5A Air conditioning clutch - Diesel. F39 10A UEGO, VAP PUMP, EBYPASS, EDF, HEDF - Gasoline. F39 15A UEGO, VAP PUMP, EBYPASS, EDF, HEDF - Diesel. Not used. 190 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Fuses Relay Circuits switched R1 Ignition 3. R2 Not used. R3 Not used. R4 Not used. R5 Cooling fan - Gasoline. R6 Windshield wiper - on and off. R7 Windshield wiper - low and high speed. R8 Electrical Vacuum Pump - Gasoline. R9 Starter motor. R10 Air conditioning clutch. R11 Fuel vaporizer system glow plug. R12 Fuel injection pump. R13 Not used. R14 Not used. R15 Low and high speed cooling fan. R16 Selective Catalytic Reduction - Diesel. R17 Powertrain control module. R18 High speed cooling fan. 191 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Fuses Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel E148827 Fuse Fuse rating Circuits protected F1 10A Airbag module. F2 4A Anti-lock brake system with electronic stability control. Parking brake. F3 - F4 10A Not used. Trailer tow back-up lamp relay. F5 20A Cutaway body connectors. F6 - Not used. F7 - Not used. F8 40A AC power outlet socket. F9 30A Trailer brake module. F10 30A Driver power seat. F11 30A Passenger power seat. F12 30A Trailer tow park lamp relay. 192 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Fuses Fuse Fuse rating Circuits protected F13 25A Anti-lock brake system with electronic stability control valves. F14 5A Powertrain control module B+ relay. F15 40A Powertrain control module power relay. F16 40A Body control module power feed. F17 40A Ignition relay 3. F18 40A Modified vehicle connections. F19 - F20 5A Heated exterior mirror relay. Not used. F21 10A Modified vehicle ignition connections. F22 15A Passenger compartment fuse panel. F23 7.5A Air conditioning control module. F24 10A Cutaway body connectors. F25 7.5A Interior lighting. F26 10A Heated exterior mirrors. F27 20A Heated rear window. F28 20A Heated rear window. F29 10A Rear parking aid camera. Lane keeping system. Electro mirror. F30 - Not used. F31 10A Trailer brake ignition feed. F32 10A Interior lighting. F33 - Not used. F34 - Not used. F35 5A F36 20A Power folding mirrors. Horn. F37 7.5A SYNC module. 193 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Fuses Fuse Fuse rating F38 5A Circuits protected Blower motor. Horn relay. Windshield wiper relay. F39 7.5A Remote keyless entry. Battery. Power windows. Rear heating, ventilation and air conditioning. F40 40A Front blower motor. F41 40A Rear blower motor. F42 40A Heated rear window. F43 30A Trailer socket. F44 60A Auxiliary power points. F45 40A Trailer connectors B+ supply. F46 30A Power windows. F47 20A Cigar lighter socket. F48 20A Rear auxiliary power points. F49 20A Front auxiliary power points. F50 60A Ignition relay 1. F51 60A Ignition relay 2. F52 40A Modified vehicle connections. F53 40A Modified vehicle connections. Relay Circuits switched R1 Not used (spare). R2 Auxiliary power points. R3 Trailer tow parking lamp. R4 Ignition 2. R5 Power windows. R6 Ignition 1. 194 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Fuses Relay Circuits switched R7 Horn. R8 Trailer tow back-up lamp. R9 Front blower motor. R10 Rear blower motor. R11 Heated rear window. Heated exterior mirrors. R12 Not used. R13 Modified vehicle connections. Pre-fuse Box E148828 Fuse Fuse rating Circuits protected F1 470A Engine compartment fuse box. Starter motor. Alternator. F2 100A Passenger compartment fuse panel. Body control module fuse box. F3 40A Powertrain control module. Anti-lock brake system. F4 200A Passenger compartment fuse panel. 195 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Fuses Fuse Fuse rating Circuits protected F5 100A Passenger compartment fuse panel. F6 80A Positive temperature coefficient heater. F7 - Not used. F8 100A Engine junction box feed. F9 100A Passenger compartment fuse panel. F10 60A Passenger compartment fuse panel supply. F11 60A Passenger compartment fuse panel supply. F12 60A Auxiliary power point 1. F13 60A Auxiliary power point 2. F14 60A Auxiliary power point 3. 196 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Fuses Body Control Module E148830 Fuse Fuse rating Circuits protected F1 15A Central locking system 2. F2 15A Central locking system 1. F3 15A Ignition switch. F4 5A Parking assist control module. Brake transmission shift interlock. F5 5A Rain sensor module. F6 15A Windshield washer pump. F7 - Not used. 197 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Fuses Fuse Fuse rating Circuits protected F8 - F9 10A Right-hand high beam. F10 10A Left-hand high beam. F11 25A Right-hand exterior lamps. Left-hand position lamps. F12 - F13 15A On-board diagnostic. Battery saver. F14 25A Turn signal indicator. Power windows delayed accessory. Lane departure sensor heated windshield pad. F15 25A Left-hand exterior lamps. Right-hand position lamps. High mounted stoplamp. F16 20A Audio unit. Navigation unit. F17 7.5A Instrument panel cluster. Heater control. F18 10A Headlamp switch module. Steering wheel module. Stoplamp switch supply. Not used. Not used. F19 5A Front control/display interface module. F20 5A Ignition passive anti-theft system. F21 3A Accessory relay, customer access feed. WARNINGS CHANGING A FUSE Switch the ignition and all electrical equipment off before attempting to change a fuse. WARNINGS Do not modify the electrical system of your vehicle in any way. Have repairs to the electrical system and the replacement of relays and high current fuses carried out by an authorized dealer. Always replace a fuse with one that has the specified amperage rating. Using a fuse with a higher amperage rating can cause severe wire damage and could start a fire. 198 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Fuses E142430 If electrical components in your vehicle are not working, a fuse may have blown. A break in the fuse wire will indicate a blown fuse. Check the appropriate fuses before replacing any electrical components. 199 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Maintenance Working with the Engine Off GENERAL INFORMATION Set the parking brake and shift to P (Park). 2. Turn off the engine and remove the key (if equipped). 3. Block the wheels. 1. Have your vehicle serviced regularly to help maintain its roadworthiness and resale value. There is a large network of Ford authorized dealers that are there to help you with their professional servicing expertise. We believe that their specially trained technicians are best qualified to service your vehicle properly and expertly. They are supported by a wide range of highly specialized tools developed specifically for servicing your vehicle. Working with the Engine On WARNING To reduce the risk of vehicle damage and/or personal burn injuries, do not start your engine with the air cleaner removed and do not remove it while the engine is running. To help you service your vehicle, we provide scheduled maintenance information which makes tracking routine service easy. See Scheduled Maintenance (page 433). 1. Set the parking brake and shift to P (Park). 2. Block the wheels If your vehicle requires professional service, your authorized dealer can provide the necessary parts and service. Check your warranty information to find out which parts and services are covered. OPENING AND CLOSING THE HOOD Use only recommended fuels, lubricants, fluids and service parts conforming to specifications. Motorcraft® parts are designed and built to provide the best performance in your vehicle. Opening the Hood Precautions • • • • Do not work on a hot engine. Make sure that nothing gets caught in moving parts. Do not work on a vehicle with the engine running in an enclosed space, unless you are sure you have enough ventilation. Keep all open flames and other burning material (such as cigarettes) away from the battery and all fuel related parts. E175221 1. Pull the hood release lever. 2. Slightly lift the hood. 200 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Maintenance E135852 E87786 3. Move the catch to the left to release the hood. 4. Open the hood and support it with the hood strut. Closing the Hood 1. Remove the hood strut from the catch and secure it correctly in the clip. 2. Lower the hood and allow it to drop under its own weight for the last 8-12 in (20-30 cm). Note: Make sure that the hood is correctly closed. UNDER HOOD OVERVIEW - 3.5L A B H G F E174601 201 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 C D E Maintenance A Air cleaner. See Changing the Engine Air Filter (page 223). B Engine oil dipstick . See Engine Oil Dipstick (page 204). C Brake fluid reservoir . See Brake Fluid Check (page 210). D Engine coolant reservoir . See Engine Coolant Check (page 206). E Engine compartment fuse box. See Fuses (page 187). F Engine oil filler cap . See Engine Oil Check (page 204). G Power steering fluid reservoir . See Power Steering Fluid Check (page 210). H * * * * * * * Washer fluid reservoir . See Washer Fluid Check (page 210). The filler caps and the engine oil dipstick are colored for easy identification. UNDER HOOD OVERVIEW - 3.7L C B A H F G D E E174602 A Air cleaner. See Changing the Engine Air Filter (page 224). B Engine oil dipstick . See Engine Oil Dipstick (page 204). C Brake fluid reservoir . See Brake Fluid Check (page 210). D Engine coolant reservoir . See Engine Oil Check (page 204). E Engine compartment fuse box. See Fuses (page 187). F Engine oil filler cap . See Engine Oil Check (page 204). * * * * 202 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Maintenance G H * * Power steering fluid reservoir . See Power Steering Fluid Check (page 210). * Washer fluid reservoir . See Washer Fluid Check (page 210). The filler caps and the engine oil dipstick are colored for easy identification. UNDER HOOD OVERVIEW - 3.2L POWER STROKE DIESEL B A H C D E F G E174603 A Air cleaner. See Changing the Engine Air Filter (page 225). B Engine oil dipstick . See Engine Oil Dipstick (page 204). C Engine oil filler cap . See Engine Oil Check (page 204). D Brake and clutch fluid reservoir . See Brake Fluid Check (page 210). E Engine coolant reservoir . See Engine Coolant Check (page 206). * * * F Engine compartment fuse box. See Fuses (page 187). G Power steering fluid reservoir . See Power Steering Fluid Check (page 210). H * * * * Washer fluid reservoir . See Washer Fluid Check (page 210). The filler caps and the engine oil dipstick are colored for easy identification. 203 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Maintenance ENGINE OIL DIPSTICK - 3.2L POWER STROKE DIESEL ENGINE OIL DIPSTICK - 3.5L A B A B E71362 E174604 A Minimum B Maximum A Minimum B Maximum ENGINE OIL CHECK ENGINE OIL DIPSTICK - 3.7L A 1. Make sure that your vehicle is on level ground. 2. Switch off the engine and wait 10 minutes for the oil to drain into the oil pan. 3. Remove the dipstick and wipe it with a clean, lint free cloth. Replace the dipstick and remove it again to check the oil level. B If the oil level is at the minimum mark, add oil immediately. See Capacities and Specifications (page 265). E174604 A Minimum B Maximum Note: Check the oil level before starting the engine. Note: Make sure that the oil level is between the minimum and the maximum marks. Note: Do not use oil additives or other engine treatments. Under certain conditions, they could damage the engine. Note: The oil consumption of new engines reaches its normal level after approximately 3000 mi (5,000 km). 204 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Maintenance Adding Engine Oil WARNINGS Do not remove the oil filter when the engine is running. WARNINGS Only add oil when the engine is cold. If the engine is hot, wait 10 minutes for the engine to cool down. 1. Remove the oil pan drain plug and wait for the oil to drain into a suitable container. 2. Renew the oil filter. 3. Reinstall the oil pan drain plug. 4. Refill the engine with new oil that meets Ford specifications. See Capacities and Specifications (page 265). Note: Do not add oil further than the maximum mark. Oil levels above the maximum mark may cause engine damage. Do not remove the filler cap when the engine is running. 1. Remove the engine oil filler cap. 2. Add engine oil that meets Ford specifications. See Capacities and Specifications (page 265). 3. Replace the engine oil filler cap. Turn it until you feel a strong resistance. Note: Do not add oil further than the maximum mark. Oil levels above the maximum mark may cause engine damage. Note: Soak up any spillage with an absorbent cloth immediately. Note: Soak up any spillage with an absorbent cloth immediately. 5. Reset the Intelligent Oil Life Monitor. See Resetting the Oil Life Monitoring System. CHANGING THE ENGINE OIL AND OIL FILTER Engine Lubrication for Severe Service Operation WARNINGS Prolonged and repeated skin contact with mineral oil will result in the removal of natural fats from the skin, leading to dryness, irritation and dermatitis. In addition, used engine oil contains potentially harmful contaminants, which may cause skin cancer. If skin contact occurs, wash the area thoroughly with soap or skin cleanser and water immediately. The following conditions define severe service operation. The Intelligent Oil Life Monitor will determine engine oil and oil filter change intervals. • Frequent or extended idling. • Frequent low-speed operation at 25 mph (40 km/h) or less. • Frequent severe dust condition operation. • Frequent off-road operation. • Sustained ambient temperatures of -9°F (-23°C) or below. • Sustained ambient temperatures of 100°F (38°C) or above. • Sustained towing operation above 1000 mi (1,600 km). Do not dispose of engine oils or oil filters in the household refuse or the public sewage system. Use an authorized waste disposal facility. Do not remove the oil pan drain plug when the engine is running. 205 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Maintenance • • Resetting the Oil Life Monitoring System Sustained high-speed driving at Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (maximum loaded weight for vehicle operation). Sustained use of diesel fuel other than ultra-low sulfur diesel (ULSD). The indicator lamp will illuminate when the engine oil and oil filter requires changing. To reset the Oil Life Monitoring System, switch the ignition on, do not start the engine and scroll to: Message Action and Description Oil change required Fully press the accelerator and brake pedals. Keep both pedals fully pressed. Oil reset in prog. The information display will show this message after a short period of time. Oil reset complete The information display will show this message after a short period of time. Release the accelerator and brake pedals and switch the ignition off. Note: For best results, coolant concentration should be tested with a refractometer, for example Robinair® coolant and battery refractometer 75240. We do not recommend the use of hydrometers or coolant test strips for measuring coolant concentrations. ENGINE COOLANT CHECK Checking the Engine Coolant When the engine is cold, check the concentration and level of the engine coolant at the intervals listed in the scheduled maintenance information. See Scheduled Maintenance (page 433). Note: Automotive fluids are not interchangeable. Do not use engine coolant, antifreeze or windshield washer fluid outside of its specified function and vehicle location. Note: Make sure that the level is between the MIN and MAX marks on the coolant reservoir. Adding Engine Coolant WARNINGS Do not add engine coolant when the engine is hot. Steam and scalding liquids released from a hot cooling system can burn you badly. Also, spilling coolant on hot engine parts can burn you. Note: Coolant expands when it is hot. The level may extend beyond the MAX mark. Note: If the level is at the MIN mark, below the MIN mark, or empty, add coolant immediately. See Adding Engine Coolant in this chapter. Do not put engine coolant in the windshield washer fluid reservoir. If sprayed on the windshield, engine coolant could make it difficult to see through the windshield. The coolant concentration should be maintained within 48% to 50%, which equates to a freeze point between -29.2°F (-34°C) and -34.5°F (-37°C). 206 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Maintenance • WARNINGS Do not add coolant further than the MAX mark. To reduce the risk of personal injury, make sure the engine is cool before unscrewing the coolant pressure relief cap. The cooling system is under pressure; steam and hot liquid can come out forcefully when the cap is loosened slightly. • Note: Do not use stop leak pellets, cooling system sealants or additives as they can cause damage to the engine cooling or heating systems. The vehicle warranty does not cover this damage. Note: During normal vehicle operation, the engine coolant may change color from orange to pink or light red. As long as the engine coolant is clear and uncontaminated, this color change does not indicate that the engine coolant has degraded or that you drain the engine coolant, flush the system or replace the engine coolant. • • Do not mix different colors or types of coolant in your vehicle. Make sure the correct coolant is used. Mixing of engine coolants may harm the engine’s cooling system. The use of incorrect coolant may harm engine and cooling system components and may void the warranty. Use prediluted engine coolant meeting the Ford specification. See Capacities and Specifications (page 265). In case of emergency, you can add a large amount of water without engine coolant in order to reach a vehicle service location. In this instance, you must have the cooling system drained, chemically cleaned with Motorcraft Premium Cooling System Flush, and refilled with engine coolant as soon as possible. Water alone (without engine coolant) can cause engine damage, for example corrosion, overheating or freezing. Do not use alcohol, methanol, brine or any engine coolants mixed with alcohol or methanol antifreeze. Alcohol and other liquids can cause engine damage, for example overheating or freezing. Do not add extra inhibitors or additives to the coolant. These can be harmful and compromise the corrosion protection of the engine coolant. Unscrew the cap slowly. Any pressure will escape as you unscrew the cap. Whenever you add coolant, check the coolant level in the coolant reservoir the next few times you drive the vehicle. If necessary, add enough prediluted engine coolant to bring the coolant level to the correct level. Recycled Engine Coolant We do not recommend the use of recycled engine coolant since a Ford-approved recycling process is not yet available. 207 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Maintenance Used engine coolant should be disposed of in an appropriate manner. Follow your community’s regulations and standards for recycling and disposing of automotive fluids. How Fail-Safe Cooling Works If the engine begins to overheat, the engine coolant temperature gauge will move to the red area and: The coolant temperature warning light will illuminate. Severe Climates If you drive in extremely cold climates: • It may be necessary to have a Ford authorized dealer increase the coolant concentration above 50%. • A coolant concentration of 60% will provide improved freeze point protection. Engine coolant concentrations above 60% will decrease the overheat protection characteristics of the engine coolant and may cause engine damage. The service engine soon indicator will illuminate. If the engine reaches a preset over-temperature condition, the engine will automatically switch to alternating cylinder operation. Each disabled cylinder acts as an air pump and cools the engine. When this occurs the vehicle will still operate. However: • The engine power will be limited. • This will disable the air conditioning system. If you drive in extremely hot climates: • It may be necessary to have a Ford authorized dealer decrease the coolant concentration to 40%. • A coolant concentration of 40% will provide improved overheat protection. Engine coolant concentrations below 40% will decrease the corrosion or freeze protection characteristics of the engine coolant and may cause engine damage. Continued operation will increase the engine temperature and the engine will completely shut down, causing steering and braking effort to increase. Once the engine temperature cools, the engine can be re-started. Take your vehicle to an authorized dealer as soon as possible to minimize engine damage. Vehicles driven year-round in non-extreme climates should use prediluted engine coolant for optimum cooling system and engine protection. When Fail-Safe Mode Is Turned On WARNING Fail-safe mode is for use during emergencies only. Operate the vehicle in fail-safe mode only as long as necessary to bring the vehicle to rest in a safe location and seek immediate repairs. When in fail-safe mode, the vehicle will have limited power, will not be able to maintain high-speed operation, and may completely shut down and lose power steering assist, and power brake assist, which may increase the possibility of a crash resulting in serious injury. What You Should Know About FailSafe Cooling If you deplete the engine coolant supply, this feature allows you to temporarily drive your vehicle before you incur incremental component damage. The fail-safe distance depends on ambient temperatures, vehicle load and terrain. 208 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Maintenance The engine is capable of completely shutting down automatically to prevent engine damage, if this situation occurs: amount of speed reduction will depend on the vehicle loading, towing, grade, ambient temperature and other factors. If this occurs, there is no need to pull off the road. You can continue to drive your vehicle while this message is active. 1. Stop your vehicle as soon as it is safe to do so and switch the ignition off. 2. Have your vehicle towed to an authorized dealer. 3. If this is not possible, wait a short period for the engine to cool. 4. Check the coolant level and replenish if low. 5. Re-start the engine and take your vehicle to an authorized dealer. Note: Driving the vehicle without repairing the engine problem increases the chance of engine damage. Take your vehicle to an authorized dealer as soon as possible. The air conditioning may also cycle on and off during severe operating conditions to protect overheating of the engine. When the engine coolant temperature decreases normal operating temperature, the air conditioning will turn on. If you notice any of the following: • • • Engine Fluid Temperature Management (If Equipped) 1. WARNING To reduce the risk of a crash and injury, be prepared that the vehicle speed may reduce and the vehicle may not be able to accelerate with full power until the fluid temperature reduces. 2. 3. When towing a trailer the vehicle’s engine may temporarily reach a higher temperature during severe operating conditions, for example ascending a long or steep grade in hot ambient temperatures. 4. 5. You may notice a reduction in vehicle speed caused by reduced engine power. The design of your vehicle allows it to enter this mode if certain high-temperature and high-load conditions take place in order to manage the engine fluid temperatures. The The engine coolant temperature gauge moves fully into the red area. The coolant temperature warning light illuminates. The service engine soon indicator illuminates. Stop your vehicle as soon as it is safe to do so and place the vehicle in park (P). Leave the engine running until the coolant temperature gauge needle moves away from the red area. After several minutes, if this does not happen, follow the remaining steps. Switch the engine off and wait for it to cool before checking the coolant level. If the coolant level is normal, you may restart the engine and continue on. If the coolant is low, add coolant, restart the engine and take your vehicle to an authorized dealer. AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION FLUID CHECK Note: Transmission fluid should be checked by an authorized dealer. If required, fluid should be added by an authorized dealer. The automatic transmission does not have a transmission fluid dipstick. 209 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Maintenance Adding Power Steering Fluid Have an authorized dealer check and change the transmission fluid and filter at the correct service interval. See Scheduled Maintenance (page 433). Your transmission does not consume fluid. However, the fluid level should be checked if the transmission is not working properly, (i.e., if the transmission slips or shifts slowly) or if you notice some sign of fluid leakage. 1. Remove the filler cap. 2. Add power steering fluid to the MAX mark. Do not overfill. 3. Replace the filler cap. Turn it until you feel a strong resistance. WASHER FLUID CHECK Do not use supplemental transmission fluid additives, treatments or cleaning agents. The use of these materials may affect transmission operation and result in damage to internal transmission components. Note: The reservoir supplies the front and rear washer systems. When adding fluid, use a mixture of washer fluid and water to help prevent freezing in cold weather and improve the cleaning capability. We recommend that you use only high quality washer fluid. BRAKE FLUID CHECK For information on fluid dilution, refer to the product instructions. Fluid levels between the MIN and MAX lines are within the normal operating range; there is no need to add fluid. If the fluid levels are outside of the normal operating range, the performance of the system could be compromised; seek service from your authorized dealer immediately. DRAINING THE FUEL FILTER WATER TRAP WARNING Do not dispose of fuel in the household refuse or the public sewage system. Use an authorized waste disposal facility. POWER STEERING FLUID CHECK WARNING Your vehicle is fitted with a diesel fuel conditioner module located behind the fuel tank. A warning lamp will illuminate and a message will be displayed when approximately 3.38 (100 ml) of water accumulates in the module. If you allow the water level to exceed this level, the water may pass through to the engine and may cause fuel injection equipment damage. Do not allow the fluid to touch your skin or eyes. This could cause serious personal injury. Rinse the affected areas immediately with plenty of water and consult a physician. If the power steering fluid level is not between the MAX and MIN marks, add power steering fluid that meets the correct specification. See Capacities and Specifications (page 271). Note: To drain the fuel filter water trap, access the underside of your vehicle. 210 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Maintenance 3 2 E177378 E184430 1 2. Disconnect the electrical connector. 3. Rotate the housing counterclockwise to the unlock position. 4. Remove the housing and filter. 5. Replace the housing seal and lubricate. 6. Insert the new filter into housing and refit aligning the arrows in the unlock position. 1. Attach a tube to the drain plug and place the end of the tube into a suitable container. 2. Loosen the drain plug by turning counterclockwise one to two turns and allow the water to drain. Note: The drain plug will rise when opening. 3. Tighten the drain plug by turning clockwise until you feel a strong resistance. Note: The drain plug will lower when closing. When you start the engine the water in fuel indicator lamp turns off after a short period of time. Changing the Fuel Filter Note: To drain the fuel filter, access the underside of your vehicle. 1. Drain the fuel from the filter housing. 211 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 2 Maintenance If the Engine Does Not Start or Runs Rough 1 7 E177379 1. Remove the Schrader valve cap. 2. Attach suitable tool with a tube to the Schrader valve and place the end of the tube into a suitable container. 3. Open the Schrader valve. 4. Switch the ignition on until a steady stream of fuel can be seen coming out of the tube. 5. Switch the ignition off. 6. Remove the tool from the Schrader valve. 7. Refit the Schrader valve cap. 8. Switch the ignition on for at least 30 seconds then switch the ignition off. 9. Repeat this process three times. 10. Start the engine. E184789 7. Rotate the housing clockwise aligning the arrows in the lock position. 8. Purge air from the system. Note: Only add fuel that meets the Ford specification. See Fuel and Refueling (page 111). Purging Air From the Fuel System 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. Switch the ignition on for at least 30 seconds then switch the ignition off. Repeat this process six times. Start the engine and maintain engine speed at 1500 RPM. Wait 20 seconds. If the engine is running smoothly, reduce the engine speed to idle. Check for leaks. Switch the ignition off. FUEL FILTER - GASOLINE Your vehicle is equipped with a lifetime fuel filter that is integrated with the fuel tank. Regular maintenance or replacement is not needed. 212 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Maintenance CHANGING THE 12V BATTERY Removing the Battery WARNINGS You must replace your vehicle battery with one of exactly the same specification. 2 Make sure the battery box is correctly sealed. Your vehicle battery is heavy; take care when lifting and removing. E152529 Note: If you have power seats and the battery has no charge, jump-start your vehicle to move the seat. See Jump Starting the Vehicle (page 178). 2. Unhook the cover flap and tuck it under the seat valance. 4 Note: Where applicable you must reprogram the audio system using the keycode. The battery is located inside your vehicle under the driver's seat. 3 E146781 3. Remove the cover on both sides. 4. Remove the seat runner bolts on both sides. Slide the seat fully forward, making sure the arm rest is folded up. See Seats (page 95). 1 E152526 1. Remove the cover trim by pulling up the tabs with your fingers. 213 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Maintenance 5 8 6 E146773 5. Remove the battery clamp bolts. 6. Remove the battery clamp and cover. E162775 8. Remove the cable securing clips from the cover. Release the retaining clips and remove the cover. 7 9 E162774 7. Remove the battery terminal cover. E162776 9. Disconnect the battery. Installing the Battery WARNING Make sure that you securely fasten the seat runner bolts before installing the covers. 214 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Maintenance Note: The windshield wiper blades are different in length. If you install wiper blades of the wrong length, the rain sensor may not work correctly. Install in the reverse order. CHECKING THE WIPER BLADES ADJUSTING THE HEADLAMPS Vertical Aim Adjustment If your vehicle has been involved in a crash, have the aim of the headlamp beam checked by an authorized dealer. Headlamp Aiming Target E142463 Run the tip of your fingers over the edge of the blade to check for roughness. Clean the wiper blades with washer fluid or water applied with a soft sponge or cloth. CHANGING THE WIPER BLADES Changing the Windshield Wiper Blades E142592 Lift the wiper arm. 2 A 8 feet (2.4 meters) B Ground to the center of the headlamp bulb C 25 feet (7.6 meters) D Horizontal reference line Vertical Aim Adjustment Procedure 1 1. Park your vehicle on level ground approximately 25 feet (7.6 meters) from a wall or screen. 2. Measure the distance from the ground to the center of the headlamp bulb and mark an 8 foot (2.4 meter) long horizontal reference line on the wall or screen at this height. E72899 1. Press the locking button. 2. Remove the wiper blade. 3. Install in the reverse order. Make sure that the wiper blade locks into place. 215 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Maintenance Note: To see a clearer light pattern while adjusting one headlamp, you may want to block the light from the other headlamp. 5. Locate the vertical adjuster on each headlamp. Use a suitable tool, for example a screwdriver or hexagonal socket, to turn the adjuster clockwise or counterclockwise to adjust the vertical aim of the headlamp. The horizontal edge of the brighter light should touch the horizontal reference line. 6. Close the hood and switch off the lamps. 3. Switch on the low beam headlamps and open the hood. Horizontal Aim Adjustment The horizontal aim of the headlamp beam on your vehicle is not adjustable. E142465 REMOVING A HEADLAMP 4. On the wall or screen you will observe a flat zone of high intensity light located at the top of the beam pattern. If the top edge of the flat zone of high intensity light is not on the horizontal reference line, adjust the aim of the headlamp beam. WARNING Switch all of the lamps and the ignition off. Failure to follow this warning could result in serious personal injury. 1. Open the hood. See Opening and Closing the Hood (page 200). 2 E169198 2. Remove the screws. E164485 216 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Maintenance WARNINGS Bulbs become hot when in use. Let them cool down before you remove them. Use the correct specification bulb. See Bulb Specification Chart (page 221). The following instructions describe how to remove the bulbs. Install in the reverse order unless otherwise stated. E169199 Note: LED lamps are not serviceable. See an authorized dealer. 3. Pull the headlamp toward the front of your vehicle to disengage it from its locating points and then lift the headlamp up. Headlamp A B C D E175739 E169200 4. Disconnect the electrical connectors. Note: When you install the headlamp, make sure that you correctly attach the electrical connector. Note: When you install the headlamp, make sure that you correctly engage its locating points. Parking lamp and direction indicator lamp. B Headlamp high beam. C Headlamp low beam and daytime running lamp. D Side marker lamp. Note: You may have to remove a cover to gain access to the bulb. CHANGING A BULB WARNINGS Switch all of the lamps and the ignition off. Failure to follow this warning could result in serious personal injury. 217 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 A Maintenance Headlamp Low Beam and Daytime Running Lamp Side Marker Lamp 2 3 2 E175740 E175742 1. Remove the headlamp. See Removing a Headlamp (page 216). 2. Turn the bulb holder counterclockwise and remove it. 3. Remove the bulb by pulling it straight out. 3 4 1. Remove the headlamp. See Removing a Headlamp (page 216). 2. Remove the cover. 3. Turn the bulb counterclockwise and remove it. 4. Disconnect the electrical connector. Note: Do not touch the bulb glass. Parking Lamp and Direction Indicator Lamp Note: You cannot separate the bulb from the bulb holder. Headlamp High Beam 3 3 2 E175741 1. Remove the headlamp. See Removing a Headlamp (page 216). 2. Turn the bulb holder counterclockwise and remove it. 3. Remove the bulb by pulling it straight out. E175743 1. 2 Remove the headlamp. See Removing a Headlamp (page 216). 2. Remove the cover. 3. Turn the bulb counterclockwise and remove it. 218 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 4 Maintenance Side Direction Indicator (If Equipped) 4. Disconnect the electrical connector. Note: Do not touch the bulb glass. 4 Note: You cannot separate the bulb from the bulb holder. 1 Front Clearance Lamp 2 E169209 1. 1 2. 3. 4. 5. 5 3 Remove the large mirror glass. Tilt the mirror glass fully up, pull the mirror glass toward you from the bottom. Remove the small mirror glass. Tilt the mirror glass fully down, pull the mirror glass toward you from the top. Remove the screws. Remove the lamp lens. Remove the bulb. Rear Lamps 2 2 E181397 1. Carefully remove the lamp. 2. Turn the bulb holder counterclockwise and remove it. 3. Remove the bulb by pulling it straight out. 1 E175758 1. Remove the screws. 2. Remove the lamp. 219 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Maintenance License Plate Lamp 3 2 1 3 E175745 E72789 3. Turn the bulb holder counterclockwise and remove it. 1. Carefully release the spring clip. 2. Remove the lamp. 3. Turn the bulb holder counterclockwise and remove it. Pull the bulb straight out 4 A Interior Lamp Vehicles with Interior Sensors B 2 C E175746 A Tail and brake lamp. B Reversing lamp. C Rear clearance lamp. 1 4. Remove the bulb by pulling it straight out. Central High Mounted Brake Lamp E154370 This is not a serviceable item, see an authorized dealer if it fails. 1. Carefully remove the lens. 2. Remove the bulb. 220 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Maintenance Reading Lamps Vehicles without Interior Sensors Vehicles with Interior Sensors 2 3 1 2 1 2 E99453 1. Carefully remove the lamp. 2. Turn the bulb holder counterclockwise and remove it. 3. Remove the bulb. E72786 1. Carefully remove the lamp. 2. Turn the bulb holder counterclockwise and remove it. Sun Visor Mirror Lamp 3 E73939 E72785 1. Carefully remove the lamp. 2. Remove the bulb. 3. Remove the bulb. BULB SPECIFICATION CHART Exterior Lamps Lamp Specification Power (watt) Brake, tail and direction indicator lamp 3057K 26/6 Front clearance lamp (Exterior mirror) Front direction indicator lamp 221 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 W5W 5 3457NAK 21 Maintenance Lamp Specification Power (watt) W5W 5 168 5 High beam headlamp and Daytime running lamp 9005 60 License plate lamp Front I.D. lamp Front side marker lamp W5W 5 Low beam headlamp H11 55 Rear clearance lamp 168 5 Reversing lamp 3057K 26 Side direction indicator W5W 5 Note: If your vehicle is fitted with LED lamps these are not serviceable items, see an authorized dealer if they fail. Interior Lamps Lamp Specification Power (watt) W6W 6 Festoon 6 211 Festoon 10 W6W 6 211 Festoon 10 Front interior lamp Front interior lamp - with category 1 alarm Luggage compartment lamp Map reading lamp Side door entrance lamp Note: If your vehicle is fitted with LED lamps these are not serviceable items, see an authorized dealer if they fail. 222 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Maintenance 2. Clean the area around the air tube to air filter cover connection to prevent debris from entering the system and then loosen the bolt on the air tube clamp so the clamp is no longer snug to the air tube. It is not necessary to completely remove the clamp. Pull the air tube off from the air filter cover. 3. Release the clamps that secure the air filter cover to the air filter housing. CHANGING THE ENGINE AIR FILTER - 3.5L WARNING To reduce the risk of vehicle damage and personal burn injuries, do not start your engine with the air cleaner removed and do not remove it while the engine is running. Note: Failure to use the correct air filter element may result in severe engine damage. The vehicle warranty may be void for any damage to the engine if the correct air filter element is not used. Only use the specified air filter. See Capacities and Specifications (page 265). Change the air filter element at the proper interval. See Scheduled Maintenance (page 433). 1 E174669 4. Carefully lift the air filter housing cover. Remove the air filter element from the air filter housing. 5. Install a new air filter element. 6. Replace the air filter housing cover. Engage the clamps that secure the air filter housing cover to the air filter housing. Be careful not to crimp the filter element edges between the air filter housing and cover. Make sure that the tabs on the edge are correctly aligned into the slots. 7. Slip the air tube onto the air filter cover and snugly tighten the bolt on the air tube clamp, but do not overtighten. 8. Reconnect the mass air flow sensor electrical connector to the outlet tube. Make sure the locking tab on the connector is in the locked position. 2 3 E174608 1. Disconnect the mass air flow sensor electrical connector and cable from the air filter cover. 223 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Maintenance 2. Clean the area around the air tube to air filter cover connection to prevent debris from entering the system and then loosen the bolt on the air tube clamp so the clamp is no longer snug to the air tube. It is not necessary to completely remove the clamp. Pull the air tube off from the air filter cover. 3. Release the clamps that secure the air filter cover to the air filter housing. CHANGING THE ENGINE AIR FILTER - 3.7L WARNING To reduce the risk of vehicle damage and personal burn injuries, do not start your engine with the air cleaner removed and do not remove it while the engine is running. Note: Failure to use the correct air filter element may result in severe engine damage. The vehicle warranty may be void for any damage to the engine if the correct air filter element is not used. Only use the specified air filter. See Capacities and Specifications (page 265). Change the air filter element at the proper interval. See Scheduled Maintenance (page 433). 1 E174669 4. Carefully lift the air filter housing cover. Remove the air filter element from the air filter housing. 5. Install a new air filter element. 6. Replace the air filter housing. Engage the clamps that secure the air filter housing cover to the air filter housing. Be careful not to crimp the filter element edges between the air filter housing and cover. Make sure that the tabs on the edge are correctly aligned into the slots. 7. Slip the air tube onto the air filter cover and snugly tighten the bolt on the air tube clamp, but do not overtighten. 8. Reconnect the mass air flow sensor electrical connector to the outlet tube. Make sure the locking tab on the connector is in the locked position. 2 3 E174608 1. Disconnect the mass air flow sensor electrical connector and cable from the air filter cover. 224 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Maintenance Only use the specified air filter. See Capacities and Specifications (page 265). CHANGING THE ENGINE AIR FILTER - 3.2L POWER STROKE DIESEL Change the air filter element and foam filler at the proper interval. See Scheduled Maintenance (page 433). WARNING To reduce the risk of vehicle damage and personal burn injuries, do not start your engine with the air cleaner removed and do not remove it while the engine is running. 1 2 Note: Failure to use the correct air filter element may result in severe engine damage. The vehicle warranty may be void for any damage to the engine if the correct air filter element is not used. 3 Note: After operating the vehicle up to 200 mi (320 km) in heavy snowfall, we recommend that you open the hood at the earliest opportunity and clear the snow and ice from air filter housing. Do not remove the foam filter. E174609 1. Disconnect the mass air flow sensor electrical connector and cable from the air filter cover. 2. Clean the area around the air tube to air filter cover connection to prevent debris from entering the system and then loosen the bolt on the air tube clamp so the clamp is no longer snug to the air tube. It is not necessary to completely remove the clamp. Pull the air tube off from the air filter cover. 3. Release the clamps that secures the air filter cover to the air filter housing. E177563 The foam filler must be in place at all times. 225 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Maintenance 3 5 E177562 4. Carefully lift the air filter housing cover. Remove the air filter element from the air filter housing. 5. Install a new air filter element. Make sure that the groove seal on the pleated paper filter traps both sides of the vertical partition of the air box. 6. Replace the air filter housing. Engage the clamps that secure the air filter housing cover to the air filter housing. Be careful not to crimp the filter element edges between the air filter housing and cover. Make sure that the tabs on the edge are correctly aligned into the slots. 7. Slip the air tube onto the air filter cover and snugly tighten the bolt on the air tube clamp, but do not overtighten. 8. Reconnect the mass air flow sensor electrical connector to the outlet tube. Make sure the locking tab on the connector is in the locked position. 226 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Vehicle Care CLEANING PRODUCTS WARNINGS Prior to using a car wash facility check the suitability of it for your vehicle. For best results, use the following products or products of equivalent quality: • Motorcraft Bug and Tar Remover (ZC-42) • Motorcraft Custom Bright Metal Cleaner (ZC-15) • Motorcraft Detail Wash (ZC-3-A) • Motorcraft Dusting Cloth (ZC-24) • Motorcraft Engine Shampoo and Degreaser (U.S. only) (ZC-20) • Motorcraft Engine Shampoo (Canada only) (CXC-66-A) • Motorcraft Multi-Purpose Cleaner (Canada only) (CXC-101) • Motorcraft Premium Glass Cleaner (Canada only) (CXC-100) • Motorcraft Premium Quality Windshield Washer Fluid (Canada only) [CXC-37-(A, B, D or F)] • Motorcraft Premium Windshield Wash Concentrate with Bitterant (U.S. only) (ZC-32-B2) • Motorcraft Professional Strength Carpet & Upholstery Cleaner (ZC-54) • Motorcraft Premium Leather and Vinyl Cleaner (ZC-56) • Motorcraft Spot and Stain Remover (U.S. only) (ZC-14) • Motorcraft Ultra-Clear Spray Glass Cleaner (ZC-23) • Motorcraft Wheel and Tire Cleaner (ZC-37-A) Some car wash installations use water at high pressure. This could damage certain parts of your vehicle. Remove the aerial before using an automatic car wash. Switch the heater blower off to prevent contamination of the fresh air filter. We recommend that you wash your vehicle with a sponge and lukewarm water containing a car shampoo. Cleaning the Headlamps WARNINGS Do not scrape the headlamp lenses or use abrasives, alcoholic solvents or chemical solvents to clean them. Do not wipe the headlamps when they are dry. Cleaning the Rear Window WARNING Do not scrape the inside of the rear window or use abrasives or chemical solvents to clean it. Use a clean, lint free cloth or a damp chamois leather to clean the inside of the rear window. CLEANING THE EXTERIOR Cleaning the Chrome Trim WARNINGS Do not use abrasives or chemical solvents. Use soapy water. WARNINGS If you use a car wash with a waxing cycle, make sure that you remove the wax from the windshield. 227 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Vehicle Care • WARNINGS Do not apply cleaning product to hot surfaces and do not leave cleaning product on chrome surfaces for a period of time exceeding that which is recommended. Industrial-strength (heavy-duty) cleaners, or cleaning chemicals, may cause damage over a period of time. Body Paintwork Preservation • • WARNINGS Do not polish your vehicle in strong sunshine. Do not allow polish to touch plastic surfaces. It could be difficult to remove. CLEANING THE ENGINE Engines are more efficient when they are clean because grease and dirt buildup keep the engine warmer than normal. Do not apply polish to the windshield or rear window. This could cause the wipers to become noisy and they may not clear the window properly. When washing: • Take care when using a power washer to clean the engine. The high-pressure fluid could penetrate the sealed parts and cause damage. • Do not spray a hot engine with cold water to avoid cracking the engine block or other engine components. • Spray Motorcraft Engine Shampoo and Degreaser on all parts that require cleaning and pressure rinse clean. In Canada, use Motorcraft Engine Shampoo. • Never wash or rinse the engine while it is hot or running; water in the running engine may cause internal damage. We recommend that you wax the paintwork once or twice a year. WAXING Regular waxing is necessary to protect your car's paint from the elements. We recommend that you wash and wax the painted surface once or twice a year. When washing and waxing, park your vehicle in a shaded area out of direct sunlight. Always wash your vehicle before applying wax. • • • Use a quality wax that does not contain abrasives. Follow the manufacturer’s instructions to apply and remove the wax. Apply a small amount of wax in a back-and-forth motion, not in circles. 228 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Do not allow wax to come in contact with any non-body (low-gloss black) colored trim. The wax will discolor or stain the parts over time. • Roof racks. • Bumpers. • Grained door handles. • Side moldings. • Mirror housings. • Windshield cowl area. Do not apply wax to glass areas. After waxing, your car's paint should feel smooth, and be free of streaks and smudges. Vehicle Care • • Safety Belts Never wash or rinse any ignition coil, spark plug wire or spark plug well, or the area in and around these locations. Cover the battery, power distribution box, and air filter assembly to prevent water damage when cleaning the engine. WARNINGS Do not use abrasives, or chemical solvents to clean them. Do not allow moisture to penetrate the safety belt retractor mechanism. CLEANING THE WINDOWS AND WIPER BLADES Clean them with interior cleaner or water applied with a soft sponge. Let them dry naturally, away from artificial heat. Car wash chemicals and environmental fallout can result in windshield and wiper blade contamination. Dirty windshield and wipers will result in poor windshield wiper operation. Keep the windshield and wiper blades clean to maintain windshield wiper performance. Instrument Cluster Screens, LCD Screens and Radio Screens WARNING Do not use abrasives, alcoholic solvents or chemical solvents to clean them. To clean the windshield and wiper blades: • Clean the windshield with a non-abrasive glass cleaner. • For windshields contaminated with tree sap, chemicals, wax or bugs, clean the entire windshield using steel wool (no greater than 0000 grade) in a circular motion and rinse with water. • Clean the wiper blades with isopropyl rubbing alcohol or windshield washer fluid. Rear Windows WARNING Do not use any abrasive materials to clean the interior of the rear windows. Note: Do not install stickers or labels to the interior of the rear windows. Note: Do not use razor blades or other sharp objects to clean or remove decals from the inside of the heated rear window. The vehicle warranty does not cover damage caused to the heated rear window grid lines. CLEANING THE INSTRUMENT PANEL AND INSTRUMENT CLUSTER LENS WARNING CLEANING THE INTERIOR Do not use chemical solvents or strong detergents when cleaning the steering wheel or instrument panel to avoid contamination of the airbag system. Note: Do not allow air fresheners and hand sanitizers to spill on interior surfaces. If a spill occurs, wipe off immediately. Damage may not be covered by your warranty. 229 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Vehicle Care Clean the instrument panel and cluster lens with a clean, damp, white cotton cloth, then use a clean and dry white cotton cloth to dry these areas. • • • • 4. Remove the soaked cloth and if it is not soiled badly, use this cloth to clean the area by using a rubbing motion for 60 seconds. 5. Following this, wipe area dry with a clean, white, cotton cloth. Avoid cleaners or polishes that increase the gloss of the upper portion of the instrument panel. The dull finish in this area helps protect you from undesirable windshield reflection. Be certain to wash or wipe your hands clean if you have been in contact with certain products such as insect repellent and suntan lotion in order to avoid possible damage to the interior painted surfaces. Do not use household or glass cleaners as these may damage the finish of the instrument panel, interior trim and cluster lens. Do not allow air fresheners and hand sanitizers to spill onto interior surfaces. If a spill occurs, wipe off immediately. Damage may not be covered by your warranty. REPAIRING MINOR PAINT DAMAGE You should repair paintwork damage caused by stones from the road or minor scratches as soon as possible. A choice of products are available from an authorized dealer. Remove particles such as bird droppings, tree sap, insect deposits, tar spots, road salt and industrial fallout before repairing paint chips. Always read and follow the manufacturer’s instructions before using the products. CLEANING THE ALLOY WHEELS If a staining liquid like coffee or juice has been spilled on the instrument panel or on interior trim surfaces, clean as follows: Note: Do not apply a cleaning chemical to warm or hot wheel rims and covers. 1. Wipe up spilled liquid using a clean, white, cotton cloth. 2. Wipe the surface with a damp, clean, white cotton cloth. For more thorough cleaning, use a mild soap and water solution. If the spot cannot be completely cleaned by this method, the area may be cleaned using a commercially available cleaning product designed for automotive interiors. 3. If necessary, apply more soap and water solution or cleaning product to a clean, white, cotton cloth and press the cloth onto the soiled area. Allow this to set at room temperature for 30 minutes. Note: Some automatic car washes may cause damage to the finish on your wheel rims and covers. Note: Industrial-strength or heavy-duty cleaners in combination with brush agitation to remove brake dust and dirt, could wear away the clear coat finish over a period time. Note: Do not use hydrofluoric acid-based or high caustic-based wheel cleaners, steel wool, fuels or strong household detergents. Note: If you intend parking your vehicle for an extended period after cleaning the wheels with a wheel cleaner, drive your vehicle for a few minutes before doing so. This will reduce the risk of increased corrosion of the brake discs. 230 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Vehicle Care Body Alloy wheels and wheel covers are coated with a clear coat paint finish. To maintain their condition we recommend that you: • • • • • Clean the wheels weekly using Motorcraft Wheel and Tire Cleaner. Apply using manufacturer's instructions. Use a sponge to remove heavy deposits of dirt and brake dust accumulation. Rinse thoroughly with a strong stream of water when you have completed the cleaning process. To remove tar and grease, use Motorcraft Bug and Tar Remover. • • • • VEHICLE STORAGE • • If you plan on storing your vehicle for 30 days or more, read the following maintenance recommendations to make sure your vehicle stays in good operating condition. Engine • We engineer and test all motor vehicles and their components for reliable, regular driving. Under various conditions, long-term storage may lead to degraded engine performance or failure unless you use specific precautions to preserve engine components. • General • • • • Store all vehicles in a dry, ventilated place. Protect from sunlight, if possible. If vehicles are stored outside, they require regular maintenance to protect against rust and damage. • The engine oil and filter should be changed prior to storage because used engine oil contains contaminates that may cause engine damage. Start the engine every 15 days for a minimum of 15 minutes. Run at fast idle with the climate controls set to defrost until the engine reaches normal operating temperature. With your foot on the brake, shift through all the gears while the engine is running. We recommend that you change the engine oil before you use your vehicle again. Fuel system • 231 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Wash your vehicle thoroughly to remove dirt, grease, oil, tar or mud from exterior surfaces, rear-wheel housing and the underside of front fenders. Periodically wash your vehicle if it is stored in exposed locations. Touch-up exposed or primed metal to prevent rust. Cover chrome and stainless steel parts with a thick coat of auto wax to prevent discoloration. Re-wax as necessary when you wash your vehicle. Lubricate all hood, door and trunk lid hinges, and latches with a light grade oil. Cover interior trim to prevent fading. Keep all rubber parts free from oil and solvents. Fill the fuel tank with high-quality fuel until the first automatic shutoff of the fuel pump nozzle. Vehicle Care Cooling system • • • Protect against freezing temperatures. When removing your vehicle from storage, check coolant fluid level. Confirm that there are no cooling system leaks and that fluid is at the recommended level. • • Battery • • • Check and recharge as necessary. Keep connections clean. If storing your vehicle for more than 30 days without recharging the battery, we recommend that you disconnect the battery cables to maintain battery charge for quick starting. • • Note: It is necessary to reset memory features if battery cables are disconnected. Contact an authorized dealer if you have any concerns or issues. Brakes • Make sure the brakes and parking brake release fully. Tires • Maintain recommended air pressure. Miscellaneous • • Make sure all linkages, cables, levers and pins under your vehicle are covered with grease to prevent rust. Move vehicles at least 25 ft (7.5 m) every 15 days to lubricate working parts and prevent corrosion. Removing Vehicle From Storage When your vehicle is ready to come out of storage, do the following: • Wash your vehicle to remove any dirt or grease film build-up on window surfaces. • Check windshield wipers for any deterioration. 232 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Check under the hood for any foreign material that may have collected during storage such as mice or squirrel nests. Check the exhaust for any foreign material that may have collected during storage. Check tire pressures and set tire inflation per the Tire Label. Check brake pedal operation. Drive your vehicle 15 ft (4.5 m) back and forth to remove rust build-up. Check fluid levels (including coolant, oil and gas) to make sure there are no leaks, and fluids are at recommended levels. If you remove the battery, clean the battery cable ends and inspect. Wheels and Tires How Your Vehicle Differs from Other Vehicles GENERAL INFORMATION Notice to Utility Vehicle, Van and Truck Owners Sport-utility vehicles, vans and trucks can differ from some other vehicles in a few noticeable ways. Your vehicle may be: WARNINGS Utility vehicles have a significantly higher rollover rate than other types of vehicles. To reduce the risk of serious injury or death from a rollover or other crash you must avoid sharp turns and abrupt maneuvers, drive at safe speeds for the conditions, keep tires properly inflated, never overload or improperly load your vehicle, and make sure every passenger is properly restrained. In a rollover crash, an unbelted person is significantly more likely to die than a person wearing a seat belt. All occupants must wear seat belts. Children and infants must use appropriate restraints to minimize the risk of injury or ejection. E145299 • • E145298 Utility vehicles and trucks handle differently than passenger cars in the various driving conditions that are encountered on streets, highways and off-road. Utility vehicles and trucks are not designed for cornering at speeds as high as passenger cars any more than low-slung sports cars are designed to perform satisfactorily under off-road conditions. • 233 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Higher - to allow higher load carrying capacity and to allow it to travel over rough terrain without getting hung up or damaging underbody components. Shorter - to give it the capability to approach inclines and drive over the crest of a hill without getting hung up or damaging underbody components. All other things held equal, a shorter wheelbase may make your vehicle quicker to respond to steering inputs than a vehicle with a longer wheelbase. Narrower - to provide greater maneuverability in tight spaces, particularly in off-road use. Wheels and Tires As a result of the above dimensional differences, sport-utility vehicles, vans and trucks often will have a higher center of gravity and a greater difference in center of gravity between the loaded and unloaded condition. Tire Quality Grades apply to new pneumatic passenger car tires. The tire Quality Grades can be found where applicable on the tire sidewall between tread shoulder and maximum section width. For example: Treadwear 200 Traction AA Temperature A. They do not apply to deep tread, winter-type snow tires, space-saver or temporary use spare tires, light truck or LT type tires, tires with nominal rim diameters of 10 to 12 inches or limited production tires as defined in Title 49 Code of Federal Regulations Part 575.104 (C)(2). Tire Quality Grades are determined by standards that the United States Department of Transportation has set. These differences that make your vehicle so versatile also make it handle differently than an ordinary passenger car. United States Department of Transportation Tire Quality Grades TIRE CARE The United States of America Department of Transportation requires Ford Motor Company to give you the following information about tire grades exactly as the government has written it. E166373 Information About Uniform Tire Quality Grades Treadwear The treadwear grade is a comparative rating based on the wear rate of the tire when tested under controlled conditions on a specified government test course. For example, a tire graded 150 would wear 1½ times as well on the government course as a tire E142542 234 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Wheels and Tires graded 100. The relative performance of tires depends upon the actual conditions of their use, however, and may depart significantly from the norm due to variations in driving habits, service practices, and differences in road characteristics and climate. The temperature grades are A (the highest), B and C, representing the tire’s resistance to the generation of heat and its ability to dissipate heat when tested under controlled conditions on a specified indoor laboratory test wheel. Sustained high temperature can cause the material of the tire to degenerate and reduce tire life, and excessive temperature can lead to sudden tire failure. The grade C corresponds to a level of performance which all passenger car tires must meet under the Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standard No. 139. Grades B and A represent higher levels of performance on the laboratory test wheel than the minimum required by law. Traction AA A B C WARNING The traction grade assigned to this tire is based on straight-ahead braking traction tests, and does not include acceleration, cornering, hydroplaning or peak traction characteristics. The traction grades, from highest to lowest are AA, A, B, and C. The grades represent the tire’s ability to stop on wet pavement as measured under controlled conditions on specified government test surfaces of asphalt and concrete. A tire marked C may have poor traction performance. Glossary of Tire Terminology • • Temperature A B C WARNING The temperature grade for this tire is established for a tire that is correctly inflated and not overloaded. Excessive speed, under-inflation, or excessive loading, either separately or in combination, can cause heat buildup and possible tire failure. • 235 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Tire label: A label showing the OE (Original Equipment) tire sizes, recommended inflation pressure and the maximum weight the vehicle can carry. Tire Identification Number (TIN): A number on the sidewall of each tire providing information about the tire brand and manufacturing plant, tire size and date of manufacture. Also referred to as DOT code. Inflation pressure: A measure of the amount of air in a tire. Wheels and Tires • • • • • • • Standard load: A class of P-metric or Metric tires designed to carry a maximum load at set pressure. For example: for P-metric tires 35 psi (2.4 bar) or 36 psi (2.5 bar) depending on tire size and for Metric tires 36 psi (2.5 bar). Increasing the inflation pressure beyond this pressure will not increase the tire capability. Extra load: A class of P-metric or Metric tires designed to carry a heavier maximum load at 42 psi (2.9 bar). Increasing the inflation pressure beyond this pressure will not increase the tire’s load carrying capability. bar Metric unit of atmospheric pressure. kPa: Kilopascal, a metric unit of air pressure. PSI: Pounds per square inch, a standard unit of air pressure. Cold tire pressure: The tire pressure when the vehicle has been stationary and out of direct sunlight for an hour or more and prior to the vehicle being driven for 1 mi (1.6 km). • • • • • Information Contained on the Tire Sidewall United States of America, and Canada Federal regulations require tire manufacturers to place standardized information on the sidewall of all tires. This information identifies and 236 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Recommended inflation pressure: The cold inflation pressure found on the Safety Compliance Certification Label (affixed to either the door hinge pillar, door-latch post, or the door edge that meets the door-latch post, next to the driver seating position) or Tire Label located on the B-Pillar or the edge of the driver door. B-pillar: The structural member at the side of the vehicle behind the front door. Bead area of the tire: Area of the tire next to the rim. Sidewall of the tire: Area between the bead area and the tread. Tread area of the tire: Area of the perimeter of the tire that contacts the road when mounted on the vehicle. Rim: The metal support (wheel) for a tire or a tire and tube assembly upon which the tire beads are seated. Wheels and Tires describes the fundamental characteristics of the tire and also provides a United States of America DOT Tire Identification Number for safety standard certification and in case of a recall. C D B E F G H A I P Type Tires P215/65R15 95H is an example of a tire size, load index and speed rating. The definitions of these items are listed below. Note: Tire size, load index and speed rating for your vehicle may be different from the following example. L K E142543 A B C D 237 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 J M P: Indicates a tire, designated by the Tire and Rim Association, that may be used for service on cars, sport utility vehicles, minivans and light trucks. 215: Indicates the nominal width of the tire in millimeters from sidewall edge to sidewall edge. In general, the larger the number, the wider the tire. 65: Indicates the aspect ratio which gives the tire's ratio of height to width. R: Indicates a radial type tire. Wheels and Tires E F G 15: Indicates the wheel or rim diameter in inches. If you change the wheel size, you will have to purchase new tires to match the new wheel diameter. 95: Indicates the tire's load index. It is an index that relates to how much weight a tire can carry. You may find this information in the Owner’s Guide. If not, contact a local tire dealer. H: Indicates the tire's speed rating. The speed rating denotes the speed at which a tire is designed to be driven for extended periods of time under a standard condition of load and inflation pressure. The tires on your vehicle may operate at different conditions for load and inflation pressure. These speed ratings may need to be adjusted for the difference in conditions. The ratings range from 81 mph (130 kph) to 186 mph (299 kph). These ratings are listed in the following chart. H I J 238 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 United States of America DOT Tire Identification Number (TIN): This begins with the letters DOT and indicates that the tire meets all federal standards. The next two numbers or letters are the plant code designating where it was manufactured, the next two are the tire size code and the last four numbers represent the week and year the tire was built. For example, the numbers 317 mean the 31st week of 1997. After 2000 the numbers go to four digits. For example, 2501 means the 25th week of 2001. The numbers in between are identification codes used for traceability. This information is used to contact customers if a tire defect requires a recall. M+S or M/S: Mud and Snow, AT: All Terrain, AS: All Season. Tire Ply Composition and Material Used: Indicates the number of plies or the number of layers of rubber-coated fabric in the tire tread and sidewall. Tire Wheels and Tires K L manufacturers also must indicate the ply materials in the tire and the sidewall, which include steel, nylon, polyester, and others. Maximum Load: Indicates the maximum load in kilograms and pounds that can be carried by the tire. Refer to the Safety Compliance Certification Label (affixed to either the door hinge pillar, door-latch post, or the door edge that meets the door-latch post, next to the driver seating position), for the correct tire pressure for your vehicle. Treadwear, Traction and Temperature Grades:Treadwear The treadwear grade is a comparative rating based on the wear rate of the tire when tested under controlled conditions on a specified government test course. For example, a tire graded 150 would wear one and one-half times as well on the government course as a tire graded 100. Traction: The traction grades, from highest to lowest are AA, A, B, and C. The grades represent the tire's ability to stop on wet pavement M 239 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 as measured under controlled conditions on specified government test surfaces of asphalt and concrete. A tire marked C may have poor traction performance. Temperature: The temperature grades are A (the highest), B and C, representing the tire's resistance to the generation of heat and its ability to dissipate heat when tested under controlled conditions on a specified indoor laboratory test wheel. Maximum Inflation Pressure: Indicates the tire manufacturer's maximum permissible pressure or the pressure at which the maximum load can be carried by the tire. This pressure is normally higher than the manufacturer's recommended cold inflation pressure, which can be found on the Safety Compliance Certification Label (affixed to either the door hinge pillar, door-latch post, or the door edge that meets the door-latch post, next to the driver seating position), or Tire Label which is located on the B-Pillar or the edge of Wheels and Tires Letter rating mph ( km/h) M 81 mph (130 km/h) Note: If the tire size does not begin with a letter, this may mean it is designated by either ETRTO (European Tire and Rim Technical Organization) or JATMA (Japan Tire Manufacturing Association). You may not find this information on all tires because it is not required by federal law. Note: The tire suppliers may have additional markings, notes or warnings, for example standard load, radial tubeless, etc. N 87 mph (140 km/h) T Type Tires Q 99 mph (159 km/h) R 106 mph (171 km/h) S 112 mph (180 km/h) T 118 mph (190 km/h) U 124 mph (200 km/h) H 130 mph (210 km/h) V 149 mph (240 km/h) T145/80D16 is an example of a tire size. T type tires have some additional information beyond those of P type tires. The definitions of these items are listed below. Note: The temporary tire size for your vehicle may be different from this example. Tire Quality Grades do not apply to this type of tire. W 168 mph (270 km/h) the driver door. The cold inflation pressure should never be set lower than the recommended pressure on the vehicle label. Tire speed ratings Y 186 mph (299 km/h) Note: For tires with a maximum speed capability over 149 mph (240 km/h), tire manufacturers sometimes use the letters ZR. For those with a maximum speed capability over 186 mph (299 km/h), tire manufacturers always use the letters ZR. 240 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Wheels and Tires C B A C D E D E 80: Indicates the aspect ratio which gives the tire's ratio of height to width. Numbers of 70 or lower indicate a short sidewall. D: Indicates a diagonal type tire. R: Indicates a radial type tire. 16: Indicates the wheel or rim diameter in inches. If you change the wheel size, you will have to purchase new tires to match the new wheel diameter. Additional Information for LT Type Tires LT235/85 R16 is an example of a tire size. LT type tires have some additional information beyond those of P type tires. The definitions of these items are listed below. Note: Tire Quality Grades do not apply to this type of tire. E142545 A B T: Indicates a type of tire, designated by the Tire and Rim Association, that is intended for temporary service on cars, sport-utility vehicles, minivans and light trucks. 145: Indicates the nominal width of the tire in millimeters from sidewall edge to sidewall edge. In general, the larger the number, the wider the tire. 241 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Wheels and Tires C B C A D D E142544 A B B LT: Indicates a tire, designated by the Tire and Rim Association (T&RA), that is intended for service on light trucks. Load Range and Load Inflation Limits: Indicates the tire's load-carrying capabilities and its inflation limits. United States of America DOT Tire Identification Number (TIN) United States of America, and Canada Federal regulations require tire manufacturers to place standardized information on the sidewall of all tires. This information identifies and describes the fundamental characteristics of the tire and also provides a United States of America DOT Tire Identification Number for safety standard certification and in case of a recall. This begins with the letters DOT and indicates that the tire meets all federal standards. The next two numbers or letters are the plant code designating where it was manufactured, the next two are the tire size code and the last 242 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Maximum Load Dual lb (kg) at psi (kPa) cold: Indicates the maximum load and tire pressure when the tire is used as a dual, defined as four tires on the rear axle (a total of six or more tires on the vehicle). Maximum Load Single lb (kg) at psi (kPa) cold: Indicates the maximum load and tire pressure when the tire is used as a single, defined as two tires (total) on the rear axle. Wheels and Tires four numbers represent the week and year the tire was built. For example, the numbers 317 mean the 31st week of 1997. After 2000 the numbers go to four digits. For example, 2501 means the 25th week of 2001. The numbers in between are identification codes used for traceability. This information is used to contact customers if a tire defect requires a recall. Safe operation of your vehicle requires that the tires are correctly inflated. Every day before you drive, check the tires. If one looks lower than the others, use a tire gauge to check pressure of all tires and adjust if required. At least once a month and before long trips inspect each tire including the spare tire. Check the tire pressure with a tire pressure gauge. Inflate all tires to the correct inflation pressure. You are strongly urged to buy a reliable tire pressure gauge, as automatic service station gauges may be inaccurate. We recommend the use of a digital or dial-type tire pressure gauge rather than a stick-type tire pressure gauge. Use the recommended cold inflation pressure for optimum tire performance and wear. Under-inflation or over-inflation may cause uneven treadwear patterns Always inflate the tires to the recommended inflation pressure even if it is less than the maximum inflation pressure information found on the tire. The recommended tire inflation pressure is found on the Safety Compliance Certification Label (affixed to either the door hinge pillar, door-latch post, or the door edge that meets the door-latch post, next to the driver seating Location of the Tire Label You will find a Tire Label containing tire inflation pressure by tire size and other important information located on the B-Pillar or the edge of the driver door. Inflating the Tires WARNING Under-inflation is the most common cause of tire failures and may result in severe tire cracking, tread separation or blowout, with unexpected loss of vehicle control and increased risk of injury. Under-inflation increases sidewall flexing and rolling resistance, resulting in heat buildup and internal damage to the tire. It also may result in unnecessary tire stress, irregular wear, loss of vehicle control and accidents. A tire can lose up to half of its air pressure and not appear to be flat! 243 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Wheels and Tires position), or Tire Label which is located on the B-Pillar or the edge of the driver door. Failure to follow the tire pressure recommendations can cause uneven treadwear patterns and adversely affect the way your vehicle handles Note: Do not reduce tire pressure to change the ride characteristics of your vehicle. If you do not maintain the tire pressures as specified by Ford, your vehicle may experience a condition known as shimmy. This will cause severe vibration and oscillations in the steering wheel when your vehicle travels over a bump or dip in the road and is unable to dampen out by itself. Significantly under-inflated tires, incorrect tire usage or any vehicle modifications such as lift-kits can cause your vehicle to shimmy. If your vehicle begins to shimmy, slowly reduce the speed of your vehicle by pressing the brake pedal or releasing the accelerator pedal. As your vehicle speed reduces the shimmy will cease. The maximum inflation pressure is the tire manufacturer's maximum permissible pressure or the pressure at which the maximum load can be carried by the tire. This pressure is normally higher than the manufacturer’s recommended cold inflation pressure, which can be found on the Safety Compliance Certification Label (affixed to either the door hinge pillar, door-latch post, or the door edge that meets the door-latch post, next to the driver seating position), or Tire Label which is located on the B-Pillar or the edge of the driver door. The cold inflation pressure should never be set lower than the recommended pressure on the Safety Compliance Certification Label or Tire Label. When weather temperature changes occur, tire inflation pressures also change. A 10°F (6°C) temperature drop can cause a corresponding drop of 10 psi (0.7 bar) in inflation pressure. Check the tire pressures frequently and adjust them to the correct pressure which can be found on the Safety Compliance Certification Label or Tire Label. To check the tire pressures: 1. Make sure the tires are cool, meaning they are not hot from driving even a mile. 2. Remove the cap from the valve on one tire, then firmly press the tire gauge onto the valve and measure the tire pressure. 3. Add enough air to reach the recommended tire pressure. 4. Replace the valve cap. 5. Repeat this procedure for each tire, including the spare. 244 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Wheels and Tires 6. Visually inspect the tires to make sure there are no nails or other objects embedded that could poke a hole in the tire and cause an air leak. 7. Check the sidewalls to make sure there are no gouges, cuts or bulges. Note: If you are checking tire pressure when the tire is hot, for example you have driven more than 1.0 mi (1.6 km), never bleed or reduce tire pressure. The tires are hot from driving and it is normal for pressures to increase above recommended cold pressures. A hot tire at or below recommended cold inflation pressure could be significantly under-inflated. Note: If you have to drive a distance to get air for the tires, check and record the tire pressure first and add the appropriate air pressure when you get to the pump. It is normal for tires to heat up and the tire pressure to increase as you drive. Note: If you over inflate the tire, release air by pressing on the metal stem in the center of the valve. Then recheck the pressure with your tire gauge. Note: Some spare tires operate at a higher inflation pressure than the other tires. For T-type mini-spare tires, refer to the Dissimilar spare wheel and tire assembly information for a description. Store and maintain at 60 psi (4.15 bar). For full-size and dissimilar spare tires, refer to the Dissimilar spare wheel and tire assembly information for a description. Store and maintain at the higher of the front and rear inflation pressure as shown on the Tire Label. Inspecting the Tires and Wheel Valve Stems Periodically inspect the tire treads for uneven or excessive wear and remove objects, for example stones, nails or glass that may be wedged in the tread grooves. Check the tire and valve stems for holes, cracks, or cuts that may permit air leakage and repair or replace the tire and replace the valve stem. Inspect the tire sidewalls for cracking, cuts, bruises and other signs of damage or excessive wear. If internal damage to the tire is suspected, have the tire removed and inspected in case it needs to be repaired or replaced. For your safety, tires that are damaged or show signs of excessive wear should not be used because they are more likely to blow out or fail. 245 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Wheels and Tires Tire Damage Incorrect or inadequate vehicle maintenance can cause tires to wear abnormally. Inspect all the tires, including the spare, frequently, and replace them if one or more of the following conditions exist: Periodically inspect the tire treads and sidewalls for damage, for example bulges in the tread or sidewalls, cracks in the tread groove or separation in the tread or sidewall. If damage is observed or suspected have the tire inspected by a tire professional. Tires can be damaged during off-road use, so inspection after off-road use is also recommended. Tire Wear Tire Age WARNING Tires degrade over time depending on many factors, for example weather, storage conditions, and conditions of use, for example load, speed and inflation pressures the tires experience throughout their lives. E142546 When the tread is worn down to 0.08 in (2 mm), tires must be replaced to help prevent your vehicle from skidding and hydroplaning. Built-in treadwear indicators, or wear bars, which look like narrow strips of smooth rubber across the tread will appear on the tire when the tread is worn down to 0.08 in (2 mm). When the tire tread wears down to the same height as these wear bars, the tire is worn out and must be replaced. In general, tires should be replaced after six years regardless of tread wear. However, heat caused by hot climates or frequent high loading conditions can accelerate the aging process and may require tires to be replaced more frequently. You should replace the spare tire when you replace the road tires or after six years due to aging even if it has not been used. 246 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Wheels and Tires Tire Replacement Requirements WARNINGS Always inflate steel carcass tires with a remote air fill with the person inflating standing at a minimum of 12.1 ft (3.7 m) away from the wheel and tire assembly. WARNINGS Only use replacement tires and wheels that are the same size, load index, speed rating and type, (for example P-metric versus LT-metric or all-season versus all-terrain) as those originally provided by Ford. The recommended tire and wheel size may be found on either the Safety Compliance Certification Label (affixed to either the door hinge pillar, door-latch post, or the door edge that meets the door-latch post, next to the driver seating position), or the Tire Label which is located on the B-Pillar or edge of the driver door. If this information is not found on these labels, then you should contact an authorized dealer as soon as possible. Use of any tire or wheel not recommended by Ford can affect the safety and performance of your vehicle, which could result in an increased risk of loss of vehicle control, vehicle rollover, personal injury and death. Additionally the use of non-recommended tires and wheels could cause steering, suspension, axle, transfer case or power transfer unit failure. If you have questions regarding tire replacement, contact an authorized dealer as soon as possible. Your vehicle is fitted with tires designed to provide a safe ride and handling capability. We recommend that the two front tires or two rear tires generally be replaced as a pair. Note: The wheel valve stems must also be replaced when the road tires are replaced on your vehicle. Fitting Replacement Tires WARNINGS When mounting replacement tires and wheels, you should not exceed the maximum pressure indicated on the sidewall of the tire to set the beads without additional precautions listed below. If the beads do not seat at the maximum pressure indicated, re-lubricate and try again. For mounting pressures above 20 psi (1.38 bar) greater than the maximum pressure on the tire sidewall, the tire should be replaced by a tire professional. 247 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Wheels and Tires Tire Safety Practices For mounting pressures up to 1.38 bar greater than the maximum pressure on the tire sidewall, the following precautions must be taken: • Make sure that you have the correct tire and wheel size. • Lubricate the tire bead and wheel bead seat area. • Stand at a minimum of 12.1 ft (3.7 m) away from the wheel and tire assembly. • Use eye and ear protection. WARNINGS If your vehicle is stuck in snow, mud, sand, etc., do not rapidly spin the tires. Spinning the tires can tear the tire and cause an explosion. A tire can explode in as little as three to five seconds. Do not spin the wheels at over 35 mph (56 km/h). The tires may fail and injure a passenger or bystander. Tire Pressure Monitoring System (If Equipped) Driving habits have a great deal to do with your tire mileage and safety: • Observe posted speed limits. • Avoid fast starts, stops and turns. • Avoid potholes and objects on the road. • Do not run over curbs or hit the tire against a curb when parking. The use of wheels or tires not recommended by Ford Motor Company may affect the operation of the tire pressure monitoring system. If the tire pressure monitoring system indicator is flashing, the tire pressure monitoring system is malfunctioning. The replacement tire might be incompatible with the tire pressure monitoring system, or a component of the tire pressure monitoring system may be damaged. See Tire Pressure Monitoring System (page 251). The tire pressure sensors mounted in the wheels (originally installed on your vehicle) are not designed to be used in aftermarket wheels. Highway Hazards No matter how carefully you drive there is always the possibility that you may eventually have a flat tire on the highway. Drive slowly to the closest safe area out of traffic. This may further damage the flat tire, but your safety is more important. 248 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Wheels and Tires If you feel a sudden vibration or ride disturbance while driving, or you suspect a tire or your vehicle has been damaged, immediately reduce your speed. Drive with caution until you can safely pull off the road. Stop and inspect the tires for damage. If a tire is under-inflated or damaged, deflate it, remove wheel and replace it with the spare tire and wheel. If you cannot detect a cause, have the vehicle towed to the nearest repair facility or tire dealer to have the vehicle inspected. Tire Rotation WARNING If the tire label shows different tire pressures for the front and rear tires and the vehicle is fitted with a tire pressure monitoring system, the settings for the system sensors need to be reset. Always carry out the system reset procedure after tire rotation. If the system is not reset, it may not provide a low tire pressure warning when necessary. See Tire Pressure Monitoring System (page 251). Tire and Wheel Alignment Rotating the tires at the recommended interval detailed in the Scheduled Maintenance chapter will help the tires wear more evenly, providing better tire performance and longer tire life. Sometimes irregular tire wear can be corrected by rotating the tires. Note: After rotating the tires the inflation pressure must be checked and adjusted to the vehicle requirements. Note: If the tires show uneven wear ask an authorized dealer to check for and correct any wheel misalignment, tire imbalance or mechanical problem involved before tire rotation. A bad jolt from hitting a curb or pothole can cause the front end of your vehicle to become misaligned or cause damage to the tires. If your vehicle seems to pull to one side when you are driving, the wheels may be out of alignment. Have an authorized dealer check the wheel alignment periodically. Wheel misalignment in the front or the rear can cause uneven and rapid treadwear of the tires and should be corrected by an authorized dealer. Front-wheel drive vehicles and those with an independent rear suspension may require alignment of all four wheels. The tires should also be balanced periodically. An unbalanced tire and wheel assembly may result in irregular tire wear. 249 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Wheels and Tires Note: Your vehicle may have a dissimilar spare wheel and tire assembly. A dissimilar spare wheel and tire assembly is defined as a spare wheel and tire assembly that is different in brand, size or appearance from the road tires and wheels. If you have a dissimilar spare wheel and tire assembly it is intended for temporary use only and should not be used in a tire rotation. Rear-wheel drive and four-wheel drive vehicles with dual rear wheels. Rear-wheel drive and four-wheel drive vehicles with single rear wheels (front tires at left of diagram). E166988 USING WINTER TIRES E142548 WARNING When you use winter tires on your vehicle, you must make sure that you use the correct lug nuts. If winter tires are used, you must make sure that you use the correct tire pressures. 250 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Wheels and Tires • USING SNOW CHAINS WARNING • Snow tires must be the same size, load index, speed rating as those originally provided by Ford. Use of any tire or wheel not recommended by Ford can affect the safety and performance of your vehicle, which could result in an increased risk of loss of vehicle control, vehicle rollover, personal injury and death. Additionally, the use of non-recommended tires and wheels could cause steering, suspension, axle, transfer case or power transfer unit failure. • • • • • The tires on your vehicle have all-weather treads to provide traction in rain and snow. However, in some climates, you may need to use snow tires or snow chains. TIRE PRESSURE MONITORING SYSTEM (If Equipped) If you choose to install snow tires on your vehicle, they must be the same size, construction, and load range as the original tires listed on the tire inflation pressure label (located on the edge of driver door or the B-Pillar) and they must be installed on all four wheels. Mixing tires of different size or construction on your vehicle can adversely affect your vehicle’s handling and braking, and may lead to loss of vehicle control. WARNING The tire pressure monitoring system is not a substitute for manually checking tire pressure. The tire pressure should be checked periodically (at least monthly) using a tire gauge, see Inflating your tires in this chapter. Failure to properly maintain your tire pressure could increase the risk of tire failure, loss of control, vehicle rollover and personal injury. If you use snow chains, we recommended that steel wheels of the same size and specifications are used, snow chains may damage aluminum wheels. Follow these guidelines when using snow chains: • Avoid fully loading your vehicle. • Only certain snow chains or cables have been approved by Ford as safe for use on vehicles with either 235/65 R16C or 195/75 R16C tires. • Snow chains or cables must be mounted in pairs on the rear tires only. 251 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Install snow chains securely, make sure they do not touch any wiring, brake lines or fuel lines. S class or 15mm or less in dimension as measured on the sidewall of the tire. Do not exceed 30 mph (48 km/h) or the maximum speed recommended by the chain manufacturer, whichever is less. Purchase snow chains or cables from a manufacturer that clearly labels the body to tire dimension restrictions. Remove the cables when they are no longer needed. Do not use snow chains on dry roads. If you have any questions regarding snow chains or cables, see an authorized dealer. Wheels and Tires Each tire, including the spare (if provided), should be checked monthly when cold and inflated to the inflation pressure recommended by the vehicle manufacturer on the vehicle placard or tire inflation pressure label. (If your vehicle has tires of a different size than the size indicated on the vehicle placard or tire inflation pressure label, you should determine the proper tire inflation pressure for those tires.) When the malfunction indicator is illuminated, the system may not be able to detect or signal low tire pressure as intended. TPMS malfunctions may occur for a variety of reasons, including the installation of replacement or alternate tires or wheels on the vehicle that prevent the TPMS from functioning properly. Always check the TPMS malfunction telltale after replacing one or more tires or wheels on your vehicle to ensure that the replacement or alternate tires and wheels allow the TPMS to continue to function properly. As an added safety feature, your vehicle has been equipped with a Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) that illuminates a low tire pressure telltale when one or more of your tires is significantly under-inflated. Accordingly, when the low tire pressure telltale illuminates, you should stop and check your tires as soon as possible, and inflate them to the proper pressure. Driving on a significantly under-inflated tire causes the tire to overheat and can lead to tire failure. Under-inflation also reduces fuel efficiency and tire tread life, and may affect the vehicle’s handling and stopping ability. The tire pressure monitoring system complies with part 15 of the FCC rules and with RSS-210 of Industry Canada. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) This device may not cause harmful interference, and (2) This device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation. Changing Tires With a Tire Pressure Monitoring System Please note that the TPMS is not a substitute for proper tire maintenance, and it is the driver’s responsibility to maintain correct tire pressure, even if under-inflation has not reached the level to trigger illumination of the TPMS low tire pressure telltale. Your vehicle has also been equipped with a TPMS malfunction indicator to indicate when the system is not operating properly. The TPMS malfunction indicator is combined with the low tire pressure telltale. When the system detects a malfunction, the telltale will flash for approximately one minute and then remain continuously illuminated. This sequence will continue upon subsequent vehicle start-ups as long as the malfunction exists. E142549 Note: Each road tire is equipped with a tire pressure sensor located inside the wheel and tire assembly cavity. The pressure sensor is attached to the valve stem. The pressure sensor is covered by the tire and is not visible unless the tire is removed. Take care when changing the tire to avoid damaging the sensor. 252 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Wheels and Tires You should always have your tires serviced by an authorized dealer. When the Temporary Spare Tire is Installed Check the tire pressure periodically (at least monthly) using an accurate tire gauge. See Inflating Your Tires in this chapter. If one of the road wheels and tire needs to be replaced with the temporary spare wheel and tire, the system will continue to identify a defect. This is to remind you that the damaged road wheel and tire must be repaired and refitted to your vehicle. Understanding the Tire Pressure Monitoring System To restore the correct operation of the system, you must have the repaired road wheel and tire assembly refitted to your vehicle. For additional information, see Changing Tires with a Tire Pressure Monitoring System in this section. The system measures the pressure in the four road tires and sends the tire pressure readings to your vehicle. The low tire pressure warning light will illuminate if any of the tire pressures are significantly low. If the warning light is illuminated, one or more of the tires are under-inflated and need to be inflated to the correct pressure. When You Believe the System is Not Operating Correctly The main function of the system is to warn you when the tire pressures are low. It can also warn you in the event the system is no longer capable of operating correctly. See the following chart for information concerning the system: Low tire pressure warning light Possible cause Action required Solid warning light Tire(s) under-inflated 1. Make sure tires are at the correct pressure. See Inflating the tires in this chapter. 2. After inflating the tires to the correct pressure See Maintenance (page 200). or the tire inflation pressure label (located on the edge of driver door or the B-Pillar), the vehicle must be driven for at least two minutes at over 20 mph (32 km/h) before the light will turn off. Spare tire in use Repair the damaged road wheel and tire assembly and refit it to your vehicle to restore correct system function. For a description on how the system functions, see When the temporary spare tire is installed in this section. 253 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Wheels and Tires Low tire pressure warning light Possible cause Action required Tire rotation without sensor training On vehicles with different front and rear tire pressures, you must retrain the system following every tire rotation. See Tire Care (page 234). Tire pressure monitoring If the tires are correctly inflated and the system malfunction spare tire is not in use but the light remains on, have your vehicle checked by an authorized dealer as soon as possible. Flashing warning light Spare tire in use Repair the damaged road wheel and tire assembly and refit it to your vehicle to restore correct system function. For a description on how the system functions, see When the temporary spare tire is installed in this section. Tire pressure monitoring If the tires are correctly inflated and the system malfunction spare tire is not in use but the light remains on, have your vehicle checked by an authorized dealer as soon as possible. decrease up to 3 psi (0.2 bar) for a drop of 30°F (17°C) in ambient temperature. This lower pressure value will be detected by the system as being significantly lower than the correct inflation pressure and the warning light will illuminate. When Inflating the Tires When inflating the tires (for example; at a gas station), the system may not respond immediately to the air added to the tires. It may take up to two minutes of driving over 20 mph (32 km/h) for the light to turn off after you have filled your tires to the recommended inflation pressure. If the warning light is on: • Check each tire to verify that none are flat. • If one or more tires are flat, repair as necessary. • Check the tire pressures and Inflate all the tires to the correct pressure. How Temperature Affects the Tire Pressures While driving in a normal manner, tire pressures may increase up to 4 psi (0.3 bar) from a cold start situation. If the vehicle is stationary overnight and the temperature significantly lower than the daytime temperature, tire pressures may Tire Pressure Monitoring System Reset Procedure Note: The system reset procedure needs to be carried out after each tire replacement. 254 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Wheels and Tires Overview Carrying Out the System Reset Procedure WARNING Read the entire procedure before carrying out a system reset. To determine the required pressure(s) for your vehicle, see the Safety Compliance Certification Label (affixed to either the door hinge pillar, door-latch post, or the door edge that meets the door-latch post, next to the driver seating position), or Tire Label located on the B-Pillar or the edge of the driver door. 1. Drive your vehicle above 20 mph (32 km/h) for at least two minutes and then park in a safe location where you can easily get to all four tires and have access to a tire inflation pump. 2. Switch the ignition off. 3. Switch the ignition on with the engine off. 4. Turn the hazard flashers on then off three times, this must be completed within 10 seconds. If the reset mode has been entered successfully, the horn will chirp once and the system indicator will flash. If this does not occur, repeat the procedure from step 2. If after repeated attempts to enter the reset mode, the horn does not chirp and the system indicator does not flash, have your vehicle checked by an authorized dealer as soon as possible. 5. Train the system sensors in the tires using the following reset sequence starting with the left front tire and following a clockwise order: Left front, right front, right rear, left rear. 6. Remove the valve cap from the valve stem on the left front tire. Decrease the air pressure until the horn chirps. Note: The single horn chirp confirms that the sensor identification code has been learned by your vehicle for this position. If a double horn chirp is heard, the reset procedure was unsuccessful and must be repeated. To maintain your vehicle’s load carrying capability, this vehicle requires different tire pressures in the front tires compared to the rear tires. The system on your vehicle is designed to illuminate the warning light at different pressures for the front and rear tires. The tires need to be periodically rotated to provide consistent performance and maximum tire life, the system needs to know when the tires have been rotated to determine which set of tires are on the front and rear axles. With this information, the system can detect and correctly warn of low tire pressures. System Reset Tips: • To reduce the chance of interference from another vehicle, the system reset procedure should be carried out at least three feet (one meter) away from another Ford vehicle undergoing the system reset procedure. • Do not wait more than two minutes between resetting each tire sensor or the system will time-out and the entire procedure will have to be repeated on all four wheels. A double horn chirp indicates the need to repeat the procedure. 7. Remove the valve cap from the valve stem on the right front tire. Decrease the air pressure until the horn chirps. 8. Remove the valve cap from the valve stem on the right rear tire. Decrease the air pressure until the horn chirps. 255 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Wheels and Tires If you get a flat tire while driving, do not apply the brake heavily. Instead, gradually decrease your speed. Hold the steering wheel firmly and slowly move to a safe place on the side of the road. 9. Remove the valve cap from the valve stem on the left rear tire. Decrease the air pressure until the horn chirps. Training is complete when the horn chirps after the last system sensor (left rear) has been trained and the system indicator stops flashing. 10. Switch the ignition off. If two short horn chirps are heard, the reset procedure was unsuccessful and must be repeated. Note: If after repeating the procedure two short horn chirps are heard again, have your vehicle checked by an authorized dealer as soon as possible. 11. Have a flat serviced by an authorized dealer in order to prevent damage to the system sensors See Tire Pressure Monitoring System (page 251). Replace the spare tire with a road tire as soon as possible. During repairing or replacing of the flat tire, have the authorized dealer inspect the system sensor for damage. Dissimilar Spare Wheel and Tire Assembly Information Set all four tires to the correct pressure See Maintenance (page 200). or the tire inflation pressure label (located on the edge of driver door or the B-Pillar). WARNING Failure to follow these guidelines could result in an increased risk of loss of vehicle control, injury or death. CHANGING A ROAD WHEEL If you have a dissimilar spare wheel and tire, then it is intended for temporary use only. This means that if you need to use it, you should replace it as soon as possible with a road wheel and tire assembly that is the same size and type as the road tires and wheels that were originally provided by Ford. If the dissimilar spare tire or wheel is damaged, it should be replaced rather than repaired. WARNINGS The use of tire sealant may damage your tire pressure monitoring system and should only be used in roadside emergencies. If you must use a sealant, the Ford Tire Mobility Kit sealant should be used. The tire pressure monitoring system sensor and valve stem on the wheel must be replaced by an authorized dealer after use of the sealant. A dissimilar spare wheel and tire assembly is defined as a spare wheel and tire assembly that is different in brand, size or appearance from the road tires and wheels and can be one of three types: If the tire pressure monitor sensor becomes damaged, it will no longer function. See Tire Pressure Monitoring System (page 251). 1. T-type mini-spare: This spare tire begins with the letter T for tire size and may have Temporary Use Only molded in the sidewall. Note: The tire pressure monitoring system indicator light will illuminate when the spare tire is in use. To restore the full function of the monitoring system, all road wheels equipped with tire pressure monitoring sensors must be mounted on this vehicle. 2. Full-size dissimilar spare with label on wheel: This spare tire has a label on the wheel that states: THIS WHEEL AND TIRE ASSEMBLY FOR TEMPORARY USE ONLY 256 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Wheels and Tires When driving with one of the dissimilar spare tires listed above, do not: • • • • • • • The usage of a full-size dissimilar spare wheel and tire assembly can lead to impairment of the following: • Handling, stability and braking performance. • Comfort and noise. • Ground clearance and parking at curbs. • Winter weather driving capability. • Wet weather driving capability. • All-wheel driving capability Exceed 50 mph (80 km/h) Load the vehicle beyond maximum vehicle load rating listed on the Safety Compliance Label. Tow a trailer. Use snow chains on the end of the vehicle with the dissimilar spare tire. Use more than one dissimilar spare tire at a time. Use commercial car washing equipment. Try to repair the dissimilar spare tire. When driving with the full-size dissimilar spare wheel and tire assembly additional caution should be given to: • Towing a trailer. • Driving vehicles equipped with a camper body. • Driving vehicles with a load on the cargo rack. Use of one of the dissimilar spare tires listed above at any one wheel location can lead to impairment of the following: • Handling, stability and braking performance. • Comfort and noise. • Ground clearance and parking at curbs. • Winter weather driving capability. • Wet weather driving capability. • All-wheel driving capability Drive cautiously when using a full-size dissimilar spare wheel and tire assembly and seek service as soon as possible. Locking Lug Nuts You can obtain replacement locking lug nuts or a locking lug nut key using the reference number certificate. 3. Full-size dissimilar spare without label on wheel Vehicles With a Spare Wheel When driving with the full-size dissimilar spare wheel and tire assembly, do not: • Exceed 70 mph (113 km/h). • Use more than one dissimilar spare wheel and tire assembly at a time. • Use commercial car washing equipment. • Use snow chains on the end of the vehicle with the dissimilar spare wheel and tire assembly. Van, Bus or Wagon The spare wheel is under the rear of your vehicle. If the spare wheel is the same type and size as your vehicle road wheel, you can fit the spare wheel and continue to drive in the normal manner. If the spare wheel is not the same type and size as your vehicle road wheel, it has a label showing the maximum driving speed limit. 257 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Wheels and Tires Note: If your vehicle is fitted with a tire pressure monitoring system, the warning indicator will flash if you fit the spare wheel to your vehicle. To restore the correct operation of the tire pressure monitoring system, you must have the repaired road wheel and tire assembly refitted to your vehicle. See Tire Pressure Monitoring System (page 251). To prevent damage occurring to the tire pressure monitoring system sensors, make sure you have a damage tire repaired or replaced by a tire professional. E146811 2. Raise the cable end cover. 1 2 E145138 1. Open the rear doors. Remove the grommet and insert the flat end of the lug wrench into the socket. Turn counterclockwise until the spare wheel rests on the ground and the cable is loose. E146812 3. Rotate the cable through 90 degrees. Slide the cable through the slot to release the spare wheel bracket from the winch. 258 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Wheels and Tires E184880 1. E146813 4. Remove the retaining nut to release the spare wheel bracket. Insert the flat end of the lug wrench into the socket. Turn counterclockwise until the spare wheel rests on the ground and the cable is loose. Vehicles With a Spare Wheel Chassis Cab and Cutaway The spare wheel is under the rear of your vehicle. If the spare wheel is the same type and size as your vehicle road wheel, you can fit the spare wheel and continue to drive in the normal manner. If the spare wheel is not the same type and size as your vehicle road wheel, it has a label showing the maximum driving speed limit. Note: If your vehicle is fitted with a tire pressure monitoring system, the warning indicator will flash if you fit the spare wheel to your vehicle. To restore the correct operation of the tire pressure monitoring system, you must have the repaired road wheel and tire assembly refitted to your vehicle. See Tire Pressure Monitoring System (page 251). To prevent damage occurring to the tire pressure monitoring system sensors, make sure you have a damage tire repaired or replaced by a tire professional. E146811 2. Raise the cable end cover. 259 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Wheels and Tires Vehicle Jack 1 WARNINGS When one of the front wheels is off the ground, the transmission alone will not prevent the vehicle from moving or slipping off the jack. 2 To help prevent the vehicle from moving when you change a tire, be sure to place the transmission in park (P), set the parking brake and block (in both directions) the wheel that is diagonally opposite (other side and end of the vehicle) to the tire being changed. Never get underneath a vehicle that is supported only by a jack. If the vehicle slips off the jack, you or someone else could be seriously injured. E146812 3. Rotate the cable through 90 degrees. Slide the cable through the slot to release the spare wheel bracket from the winch. Do not attempt to change a tire on the side of the vehicle close to moving traffic. Pull far enough off the road to avoid the danger of being hit when operating the jack or changing the wheel. Always use the jack provided as original equipment with your vehicle. If using a jack other than the one provided as original equipment with your vehicle, make sure the jack capacity is adequate for the vehicle weight, including any vehicle cargo or modifications. Disable the power running boards before jacking, lifting, or placing any object under the vehicle. Never place your hand between the power running board and the vehicle as extended power running boards will retract when the doors are closed. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury. E146813 4. Remove the retaining nut to release the spare wheel bracket. Note: Passengers should not remain in the vehicle when the vehicle is being jacked. Note: Vehicles with a Temporary Mobility Kit do not have a vehicle jack or a lug wrench. 260 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Wheels and Tires Vehicle Jack Storage The vehicle jack is under the passenger seat. The jack handle and lug wrench are located in a storage compartment in the front right-hand side stepwell. Note: The vehicle jack is in the load space area on vehicles with rear climate control. E171405 Position the head of the vehicle jack under the protrusions at the rear of front sub-frame. E70959 1. Assemble the jack handle. 2. Insert the jack handle onto the release valve and rotate clockwise until you feel a strong resistance. 3. Insert the jack handle into the pump and use a pumping action to raise your vehicle. 4. Insert the jack handle into the release valve and rotate counterclockwise to lower your vehicle. Rear Jacking Points WARNING You must use the specified jacking points. Front Jacking Points WARNING You must use the specified jacking points. Note: If your vehicle has rear air conditioning make sure the vehicle jack does not come in contact with the air conditioning lines. 261 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Wheels and Tires WARNINGS Chock the diagonally opposite wheel to the punctured tire with an appropriate block or wheel chock. A wheel chock may be located in the B-pillar or in a storage compartment in the front right-hand side stepwell. Make sure that the arrows on directional tires point in the direction of rotation when your vehicle is moving forward. If you have to fit a spare tire with the arrows pointing in the opposite direction have the tire refitted as soon as possible. 1. Insert the flat end of the lug wrench between the wheel rim and the wheel trim and carefully remove the wheel trim. 2. Use the locking lug nut key to loosen the locking lug nut. 3. Loosen the remaining lug nuts, but do not remove them. 4. Raise your vehicle until the tire is clear of the ground. 5. Remove the lug nuts and the road wheel. Note: Do not lay alloy road wheels face down on the ground. E171406 Position the head of the vehicle jack under the rear axle. Removing a Road Wheel WARNINGS Park your vehicle so that you do not obstruct the flow of traffic or place yourself in any danger and set up a warning triangle. Switch the ignition off and apply the parking brake. Installing a Road Wheel WARNINGS Use only approved wheel and tire sizes. Using other wheel and tire sizes could damage your vehicle and will make the National Type Approval invalid. If your vehicle has a manual transmission, shift into first or reverse gear. If your vehicle has an automatic transmission, shift into park (P). Make sure all passengers are out of your vehicle. Make sure there is no lubrication (grease or oil) on the threads or the surface between the wheel lugs and nuts. This can cause the lug nuts to loosen while driving. Make sure that your vehicle is on firm and level ground with the front wheels pointing straight ahead. 262 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Wheels and Tires 4. Fully tighten all of the lug nuts in the sequence shown. See Technical Specifications (page 264). WARNINGS Make sure the wheel and hub contact surfaces are free from foreign material. 5. Install the wheel trim. Note: Make sure that the cones on the lug nuts are against the wheel. Never use wheels or lug nuts different than the original equipment as this could damage the wheel or mounting system. This damage could allow the wheels to come off when your vehicle is moving. 1. Note: Alloy wheel lug nuts are suitable for use on a steel spare wheel. Note: If the spare wheel is not the same type and size as your vehicle road wheel replace it as soon as possible. Install the wheel. Note: Check the lug nuts for correct tightness and check the tire pressure as soon as possible. See Technical Specifications (page 264). 1 Stowing the Wheel and Vehicle Jack 4 3 Note: Do not raise the spare wheel bracket without a wheel attached. Damage can occur to the winch mechanism if the spare wheel bracket is lowered without a wheel attached. 2 5 1. 1 6 2. 3 4 3. 4. 2 5 E70961 5. 2. Install all of the lug nuts and partially tighten them in the sequence shown. 3. Lower your vehicle and remove the vehicle jack. 263 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Attach the spare wheel bracket to the wheel using the retaining nut. Slide the cable through the slot and attach the spare wheel bracket to the winch. Rotate the cable through 90 degrees and lower the cable end cover. Insert the flat end of the lug wrench into the socket. Turn it clockwise until you feel a strong resistance. Make sure the wheel is secure. Stow the vehicle jack, jack handle and lug wrench in their correct locations and secure them with the straps. Wheels and Tires TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS Wheel Lug Nut Torque Specifications WARNING When a wheel is installed, always remove any corrosion, dirt or foreign materials present on the mounting surfaces of the wheel or the surface of the wheel hub, brake drum or brake disc that contacts the wheel. Make sure that any fasteners that attach the rotor to the hub are secured so they do not interfere with the mounting surfaces of the wheel. Installing wheels without correct metal-to-metal contact at the wheel mounting surfaces can cause the wheel nuts to loosen and the wheel to come off while your vehicle is in motion, resulting in loss of control. Bolt size Ib-ft (Nm) M14 x 1.5 148 lb.ft (200 Nm) * * Torque specifications are for nut and bolt threads free of dirt and rust. Use only Ford recommended replacement fasteners. Retighten the lug nuts to the specified torque within 100 miles (160 kilometers) after any wheel disturbance, for example tire rotation, changing a flat tire or wheel removal. E145950 A Wheel pilot bore Inspect the wheel pilot bore and mounting surface prior to installation. Remove any visible corrosion or loose particles. 264 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Capacities and Specifications ENGINE SPECIFICATIONS - 3.5L Engine 3.5L V6 Ecoboost Cubic inches 214 Required fuel Minimum 87 octane Firing order 1-4-2-5-3-6 Ignition system Coil on plug Spark plug gap .030-.033 in. (.75-.85 mm) Compression ratio 10.0:1 Drivebelt Routing 3.5L V6 Ecoboost Engines with A/C E167467 ENGINE SPECIFICATIONS - 3.7L Engine 3.7 V6 Cubic inches 226 Required fuel Minimum 87 octane or E85 Firing order 1-4-2-5-3-6 Ignition system Coil on plug Spark plug gap .049-.053 in. (1.25-1.35 mm) Compression ratio 10.5:1 265 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Capacities and Specifications Drivebelt Routing 3.7L V6 Engines with A/C E167464 ENGINE SPECIFICATIONS - 3.2L POWER STROKE DIESEL Engine 3.2L Power Stroke Diesel Cubic inches 195 Required fuel No. 2 Diesel Firing order 1-2-4-5-3 Compression ratio 15.4:1 Drivebelt Routing 3.2L Power Stroke Diesel Engines with A/C E175582 266 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Capacities and Specifications MOTORCRAFT PARTS - 3.5L 3.5L V6 Ecoboost Component Part number Pre air filter FA-1921 Air filter element FA-1916 Automatic transmission fluid filter Service required Battery BXT-48H6-610 BAGM-48H6-760 - dual batteries Oil filter FL-500S Fuel filter FD-46-21 Spark plugs SP534 Windshield wiper blades - vehicles with low roof Windshield wiper blades - vehicles with medium or high roof WW-2955 - driver side WW-2112 - passenger side WW-2901 - driver side WW-2049 - passenger side Note: Motorcraft replacement parts are recommended for scheduled maintenance and are available at an authorized dealer or at fordparts.com. These parts meet or exceed Ford Motor Company’s specifications, and are engineered for your vehicle. Use of other parts may impact vehicle performance, emissions and durability. Your vehicle Warranty may be void for any damage related to use of other parts. Note: Should a Motorcraft oil filter not be available, use an oil filter that meets industry performance specification SAE/USCAR-36. Note: For spark plug replacement, see an authorized dealer. Replace the spark plugs at the appropriate intervals. Refer to Scheduled Maintenance for the replacement intervals. See Normal Scheduled Maintenance (page 436). 267 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Capacities and Specifications MOTORCRAFT PARTS - 3.7L 3.7L Duratec Component Part number Pre air filter FA-1921 Air filter element FA-1916 Automatic transmission fluid filter Service required Battery BXT-48H6-610 BAGM-48H6-760 - dual batteries Oil filter FL-500S Fuel filter FD-46-21 Spark plugs SP520 Windshield wiper blades - vehicles with low roof Windshield wiper blades - vehicles with medium or high roof WW-2955 - driver side WW-2112 - passenger side WW-2901 - driver side WW-2049 - passenger side Note: Motorcraft replacement parts are recommended for scheduled maintenance and are available at an authorized dealer or at fordparts.com. These parts meet or exceed Ford Motor Company’s specifications, and are engineered for your vehicle. Use of other parts may impact vehicle performance, emissions and durability. Your vehicle Warranty may be void for any damage related to use of other parts. Note: Should a Motorcraft oil filter not be available, use an oil filter that meets industry performance specification SAE/USCAR-36. Note: For spark plug replacement, see an authorized dealer. Replace the spark plugs at the appropriate intervals. Refer to Scheduled Maintenance for the replacement intervals. See Normal Scheduled Maintenance (page 436). 268 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Capacities and Specifications MOTORCRAFT PARTS - 3.2L POWER STROKE DIESEL 3.2L Power Stroke Diesel Component Part number Pre air filter FA-1921 Air filter element FA-1916 Automatic transmission fluid filter Service required Battery BAGM-48H6-760 - dual batteries Oil filter FL-500S Fuel filter FD-46-21 Windshield wiper blades - vehicles with low roof Windshield wiper blades - vehicles with medium or high roof WW-2955 - driver side WW-2112 - passenger side WW-2901 - driver side WW-2049 - passenger side Note: Motorcraft replacement parts are recommended for scheduled maintenance and are available at an authorized dealer or at fordparts.com. These parts meet or exceed Ford Motor Company’s specifications, and are engineered for your vehicle. Use of other parts may impact vehicle performance, emissions and durability. Your vehicle Warranty may be void for any damage related to use of other parts. Note: Should a Motorcraft oil filter not be available, use an oil filter that meets industry performance specification SAE/USCAR-36. 269 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Capacities and Specifications VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION NUMBER The vehicle identification number is located on the left-hand side of the instrument panel. C Make, vehicle line, series, body type D Engine type E Check digit F Model year G Assembly plant H Production sequence number VEHICLE CERTIFICATION LABEL E142476 Please note that in the graphic, XXXX is representative of your vehicle identification number. The Vehicle Identification Number contains the following information: E167469 The National Highway Traffic Safety Administration Regulations require that a Safety Compliance Certification Label be affixed to a vehicle and prescribe where the Safety Compliance Certification Label may be located. The Safety Compliance Certification Label shall be affixed to either the door hinge pillar, the door latch post, or the edge of the door near the door latch, next to the driver's seating position. E142477 A World manufacturer identifier B Brake system, Gross Vehicle Weight Rating, Restraint Devices and their locations 270 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Capacities and Specifications The transmission code is on the Safety Compliance Certification Label. The following table shows the transmission code along with the transmission description. TRANSMISSION CODE DESIGNATION Code Description A Six-speed automatic transmission 6R80 CAPACITIES AND SPECIFICATIONS - 3.5L WARNING The air conditioning refrigerant system contains refrigerant R-134a under high pressure. Only qualified personnel should service the air conditioning refrigerant system. Opening the air conditioning refrigerant system can cause personal injury. E142806 Capacities Item Capacity Engine lubrication system - including the oil filter 5.9 qt (5.6 L) Engine lubrication system - excluding the oil filter 5.4 qt (5.1 L) Engine oil top-up - raise the level on the dipstick from minimum to maximum 1 qt (0.9 L) Engine cooling system, vehicles with an auxiliary 16.4 qt (15.5 L) 1 heater Engine cooling system, vehicles without an auxiliary 14.9 qt (14.1 L) 1 heater Automatic transmission 13.1 qt (12.4 L) Fuel tank 20.9 gal (95 L) 2, 3 Windshield and rear window washer system including headlamp washer 271 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 4.8 qt (4.5 L) Capacities and Specifications 1 Item Capacity A/C Refrigerant, vehicles with rear heating, ventilation and air conditioning 2.43 lb (1.1 kg) A/C Refrigerant, vehicles without rear heating, ventilation and air conditioning 1.76 lb (0.8 kg) A/C Refrigerant oil, vehicles with rear heating, ventilation and air conditioning 9.5 fl oz (280 ml) A/C Refrigerant oil, vehicles without rear heating, ventilation and air conditioning 5.4 fl oz (160 ml) Add the coolant type originally used in your vehicle. 2 Automatic transmissions that require Motorcraft MERCON LV transmission fluid should only use Motorcraft MERCON LV transmission fluid. Use of any fluid other than the recommended fluid may cause transmission damage. 3 Change the automatic transmission fluid and filter at the correct service interval. See Scheduled Maintenance (page 433). Specifications Materials Name Specification Motor oil (U.S. and Mexico): Motorcraft SAE 5W-30 Premium Synthetic Blend Motor Oil XO-5W30-QSP WSS-M2C946-A Motor oil (Canada): Motorcraft SAE 5W-30 Super Premium Motor Oil CXO-5W30-LSP12 WSS-M2C946-A Engine coolant (U.S. and Mexico): Motorcraft Orange Antifreeze/Coolant Prediluted VC-3DIL-B WSS-M97B44-D2 Engine coolant (Canada): Motorcraft Orange Antifreeze/Coolant Prediluted CVC-3DIL-B WSS-M97B44-D2 Brake fluid: Motorcraft DOT 4 LV High Performance Motor Vehicle Brake Fluid PM-20 WSS-M6C65-A2 272 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Capacities and Specifications Name Specification Automatic transmission fluid (U.S. and Mexico): Motorcraft MERCON LV Automatic Transmission Fluid XT-10-QLVC WSS-M2C938-A MERCON LV Automatic transmission fluid (Canada): Motorcraft MERCON LV Automatic Transmission Fluid CXT-10-LV12 WSS-M2C938-A MERCON LV Power steering fluid (U.S. and Mexico): Motorcraft MERCON LV Automatic Transmission Fluid XT-10-QLVC WSS-M2C938-A MERCON LV Power steering fluid (Canada): Motorcraft MERCON LV Automatic Transmission Fluid CXT-10-LV12 WSS-M2C938-A MERCON LV Windshield washer fluid (U.S. and Mexico): WSS-M14P19-A Motorcraft Premium Windshield Wash Concentrate with Bitterant ZC-32-B2 Windshield washer fluid (Canada): Motorcraft Premium Quality Windshield Washer Fluid CXC-37-(A, B, D, F) WSS-M14P19-A A/C refrigerant (U.S. and Mexico): Motorcraft R-134a Refrigerant YN-19 WSH-M17B19-A A/C refrigerant (Canada): Motorcraft R-134a Refrigerant CYN-16-R WSH-M17B19-A A/C refrigerant compressor oil: Motorcraft PAG Refrigerant Compressor Oil YN-12-D WSH-M1C231-B Grease: Premium Long-Life Grease XG-1-E1 ESA-M1C75-B 273 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Capacities and Specifications Only use fluid that meets Ford specifications. Motor oils of the recommended viscosity grade that meet API SN requirements and display the API Certification Mark for gasoline engines are also acceptable. Do not use oil labeled with API SN service category unless the label also displays the API certification mark. Use only Motorcraft DOT 4 LV High Performance Brake Fluid, or equivalent, meeting WSS-M6C65-A2 or ISO 4925 Class 6. Use of any fluid other than the recommended fluid may cause brake system damage. Use multi-purpose grease for door latches, hood latch, auxiliary hood latch, trunk latch and seat tracks. If you use oil and fluids that do not meet the defined specification and viscosity grades this may lead to: • Component damage which may not be covered by the vehicle Warranty. • Longer engine cranking periods. • Increased emission levels. • Reduced engine performance. • Reduced fuel economy. • Degraded brake performance. E142732 An oil that displays this symbol conforms to current engine, emission system and fuel economy performance standards of the International Lubricant Standardization and Approval Committee (ILSAC). CAPACITIES AND SPECIFICATIONS - 3.7L WARNING Note: Do not use supplemental engine oil additives. They are unnecessary and could lead to engine damage that is not covered by Ford’s warranty. The air conditioning refrigerant system contains refrigerant R-134a under high pressure. Only qualified personnel should service the air conditioning refrigerant system. Opening the air conditioning refrigerant system can cause personal injury. Capacities Item Capacity Engine lubrication system – including the oil filter 6 qt (5.7 L) Engine lubrication system – excluding the oil filter 5.5 qt (5.2 L) Engine oil top-up – raise the level on the dipstick from minimum to maximum 1 qt (0.9 L) 274 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Capacities and Specifications Item Capacity Engine cooling system, vehicles with an auxiliary 16.4 qt (15.5 L) 1 heater Engine cooling system, vehicles without an auxiliary 14.9 qt (14.1 L) 1 heater Automatic transmission 13.1 qt (12.4 L) Fuel tank 20.9 gal (95 L) 2, 3 1 Windshield and rear window washer system – including headlamp washer 4.8 qt (4.5 L) A/C Refrigerant, vehicles with rear heating, ventilation and air conditioning 2.43 lb (1.1 kg) A/C Refrigerant, vehicles without rear heating, ventilation and air conditioning 1.76 lb (0.8 kg) A/C Refrigerant oil, vehicles with rear heating, ventilation and air conditioning 9.5 fl oz (280 ml) A/C Refrigerant oil, vehicles without rear heating, ventilation and air conditioning 5.4 fl oz (160 ml) Add the coolant type originally used in your vehicle. 2 Automatic transmissions that require Motorcraft MERCON LV transmission fluid should only use Motorcraft MERCON LV transmission fluid. Use of any fluid other than the recommended fluid may cause transmission damage. 3 Change the automatic transmission fluid and filter at the correct service interval. See Scheduled Maintenance (page 433). 275 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Capacities and Specifications Specifications Materials Name Specification Motor oil (U.S. and Mexico): Motorcraft SAE 5W-20 Premium Synthetic Blend Motor Oil XO-5W20-QSP WSS-M2C945-A Motor oil (Canada): Motorcraft SAE 5W-20 Super Premium Motor Oil CXO-5W20-LSP12 WSS-M2C945-A Engine coolant (U.S. and Mexico): Motorcraft Orange Antifreeze/Coolant Prediluted VC-3DIL-B WSS-M97B44-D2 Engine coolant (Canada): Motorcraft Orange Antifreeze/Coolant Prediluted CVC-3DIL-B WSS-M97B44-D2 Brake fluid: Motorcraft DOT 4 LV High Performance Motor Vehicle Brake Fluid PM-20 WSS-M6C65-A2 Automatic transmission fluid (U.S. and Mexico): Motorcraft MERCON LV Automatic Transmission Fluid XT-10-QLVC WSS-M2C938-A MERCON LV Automatic transmission fluid (Canada): Motorcraft MERCON LV Automatic Transmission Fluid CXT-10-LV12 WSS-M2C938-A MERCON LV Power steering fluid (U.S. and Mexico): Motorcraft MERCON LV Automatic Transmission Fluid XT-10-QLVC WSS-M2C938-A MERCON LV Power steering fluid (Canada): Motorcraft MERCON LV Automatic Transmission Fluid CXT-10-LV12 WSS-M2C938-A MERCON LV Windshield washer fluid (U.S. and Mexico): WSS-M14P19-A Motorcraft Premium Windshield Wash Concentrate with Bitterant 276 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Capacities and Specifications Name Specification ZC-32-B2 Windshield washer fluid (Canada): Motorcraft Premium Quality Windshield Washer Fluid CXC-37-(A, B, D, F) WSS-M14P19-A A/C refrigerant (U.S. and Mexico): Motorcraft R-134a Refrigerant YN-19 WSH-M17B19-A A/C refrigerant (Canada): Motorcraft R-134a Refrigerant CYN-16-R WSH-M17B19-A A/C refrigerant compressor oil: Motorcraft PAG Refrigerant Compressor Oil YN-12-D WSH-M1C231-B Grease: Premium Long-Life Grease XG-1-E1 ESA-M1C75-B Only use fluid that meets Ford specifications. Motor oils of the recommended viscosity grade that meet API SN requirements and display the API Certification Mark for gasoline engines are also acceptable. Do not use oil labeled with API SN service category unless the label also displays the API certification mark. E142732 An oil that displays this symbol conforms to current engine, emission system and fuel economy performance standards of the International Lubricant Standardization and Approval Committee (ILSAC). Note: Do not use supplemental engine oil additives. They are unnecessary and could lead to engine damage that is not covered by your Ford warranty. 277 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Capacities and Specifications Use only Motorcraft DOT 4 LV High Performance Brake Fluid, or equivalent, meeting WSS-M6C65-A2. Use of any fluid other than the recommended fluid may cause brake system damage. • • Reduced fuel economy. Degraded brake performance. CAPACITIES AND SPECIFICATIONS - 3.2L POWER STROKE DIESEL Use multi-purpose grease for door latches, hood latch, auxiliary hood latch, trunk latch and seat tracks. WARNING If you use oil and fluids that do not meet the defined specification and viscosity grades this may lead to: • Component damage which may not be covered by the vehicle Warranty. • Longer engine cranking periods. • Increased emission levels. • Reduced engine performance. The air conditioning refrigerant system contains refrigerant R-134a under high pressure. Only qualified personnel should service the air conditioning refrigerant system. Opening the air conditioning refrigerant system can cause personal injury. Capacities Item Capacity Engine lubrication system — including the oil filter 12.0 qt (11.4 L) Engine lubrication system — excluding the oil filter 11.6 qt (11 L) Engine oil top-up — raise the level on the dipstick from minimum to maximum 2.6 qt (2.5 L) Engine cooling system, vehicles with an auxiliary 15.3 qt (14.5 L) 1 heater Engine cooling system, vehicles without an auxiliary 13.9 qt (13.2 L) 1 heater Automatic transmission fluid 13.1 qt (12.4 L) 2, 3 Fuel tank 20.9 gal (95 L) Diesel exhaust fluid 4.6 gal (21 L) Windshield and rear window washer system — including headlamp washer 4.8 qt (4.5 L) A/C Refrigerant, vehicles with rear heating, ventilation and air conditioning 2.43 lb (1.1 kg) 278 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Capacities and Specifications Item Capacity A/C Refrigerant, vehicles without rear heating, ventilation and air conditioning 1 1.76 lb (0.8 kg) A/C Refrigerant oil, vehicles with rear heating, ventilation and air conditioning 9.5 fl oz (280 ml) A/C Refrigerant oil, vehicles without rear heating, ventilation and air conditioning 5.4 fl oz (160 ml) Add the coolant type originally used in your vehicle. 2 Automatic transmissions that require Motorcraft MERCON LV transmission fluid should only use Motorcraft MERCON LV transmission fluid. Use of any fluid other than the recommended fluid may cause transmission damage. 3 Change the automatic transmission fluid and filter at the correct service interval. See Scheduled Maintenance (page 433). Specifications Materials Name Specification Motor oil: Motorcraft SAE 5W-40 Full Synthetic Diesel Motor Oil XO-5W40-5QSD WSS-M2C171-E Engine coolant (U.S. and Mexico): Motorcraft Orange Antifreeze/Coolant Prediluted VC-3DIL-B WSS-M97B44-D2 Engine coolant (Canada): Motorcraft Orange Antifreeze/Coolant Prediluted CVC-3DIL-B WSS-M97B44-D2 Brake fluid: Motorcraft DOT 4 LV High Performance Motor Vehicle Brake Fluid PM-20 WSS-M6C65-A2 Automatic transmission fluid (U.S. and Mexico): Motorcraft MERCON LV Automatic Transmission Fluid XT-10-QLVC WSS-M2C938-A MERCON LV Automatic transmission fluid (Canada): WSS-M2C938-A 279 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Capacities and Specifications Name Specification Motorcraft MERCON LV Automatic Transmission Fluid CXT-10-LV12 MERCON LV Power steering fluid (U.S. and Mexico): Motorcraft MERCON LV Automatic Transmission Fluid XT-10-QLVC WSS-M2C938-A MERCON LV Power steering fluid (Canada): Motorcraft MERCON LV Automatic Transmission Fluid CXT-10-LV12 WSS-M2C938-A MERCON LV Windshield washer fluid (U.S. and Mexico): WSS-M14P19-A Motorcraft Premium Windshield Wash Concentrate with Bitterant ZC-32-B2 Windshield washer fluid (Canada): Motorcraft Premium Quality Windshield Washer Fluid CXC-37-(A, B, D, F) WSS-M14P19-A A/C refrigerant (U.S. and Mexico): Motorcraft R-134a Refrigerant YN-19 WSH-M17B19-A A/C refrigerant (Canada): Motorcraft R-134a Refrigerant CYN-16-R WSH-M17B19-A A/C refrigerant compressor oil: Motorcraft PAG Refrigerant Compressor Oil YN-12-D WSH-M1C231-B Grease: Premium Long-Life Grease XG-1-E1 ESA-M1C75-B Note: The American Petroleum Institute (API) service symbol is used to identify the correct engine oil for your vehicle's engine. The API service symbol is on the oil container. 280 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Capacities and Specifications If you use oil and fluids that do not meet the defined specification and viscosity grades this may lead to: • Component damage which may not be covered by the vehicle Warranty. • Longer engine cranking periods. • Increased emission levels. • Reduced engine performance. • Reduced fuel economy. • Degraded brake performance. E179966 Note: The use of correct oil viscosities is important for satisfactory operation. Determine which oil viscosity best suits the temperature range you expect to encounter for the next service interval from the SAE viscosity grade chart. E176394 Note: For the use of biodiesel fuel (B6 – B20), use SAE 5W-40 API CJ-4. Use only Motorcraft DOT 4 LV High Performance Brake Fluid, or equivalent, meeting WSS-M6C65-A2. Use of any fluid other than the recommended fluid may cause brake system damage. Use multi-purpose grease for door latches, hood latch, auxiliary hood latch, trunk latch and seat tracks. 281 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Audio System AM and FM frequencies are established by the Federal Communications Commission (FCC) and the Canadian Radio and Telecommunications Commission (CRTC). Those frequencies are: • AM: 530, 540-1700, 1710 kHz • FM: 87.9-107.7, 107.9 MHz GENERAL INFORMATION Radio Frequencies and Reception Factors Radio Reception Factors Distance and Strength The further you travel from an FM station, the weaker the signal and the weaker the reception. Terrain Hills, mountains, tall buildings, bridges, tunnels, freeway overpasses, parking garages, dense tree foliage and thunderstorms can interfere with the reception. Station overload When you pass a ground-based broadcast repeating tower, a stronger signal may overtake a weaker one and result in the audio system muting. Do not expose discs to direct sunlight or heat sources for extended periods. CD and CD Player Information Note: CD units play commercially pressed 4.75-inch (12 centimeter) audio compact discs only. Due to technical incompatibility, certain recordable and re-recordable compact discs may not function correctly when used in Ford CD players. MP3 and WMA Track and Folder Structure Audio systems capable of recognizing and playing MP3 and WMA individual tracks and folder structures work as follows: • There are two different modes for MP3 and WMA disc playback: MP3 and WMA track mode (system default) and MP3 and WMA folder mode. • MP3 and WMA track mode ignores any folder structure on the MP3 and WMA disc. The player numbers each MP3 and WMA track on the disc (noted by the MP3 or WMA file extension) from T001 to a maximum of T255. The maximum number of playable MP3 and WMA files may be less depending on the structure of the CD and exact model of radio present. Note: Do not insert CDs with homemade paper (adhesive) labels into the CD player as the label may peel and cause the CD to become jammed. You should use a permanent felt tip marker rather than adhesive labels on your homemade CDs. Ballpoint pens may damage CDs. Please contact an authorized dealer for further information. Note: Do not use any irregularly shaped discs or discs with a scratch protection film attached. Always handle discs by their edges only. Clean the disc with an approved CD cleaner only. Wipe it from the center of the disc toward the edge. Do not clean in a circular motion. 282 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Audio System • • MP3 and WMA folder mode represents a folder structure consisting of one level of folders. The CD player numbers all MP3 and WMA tracks on the disc (noted by the MP3 or WMA file extension) and all folders containing MP3 and WMA files, from F001 (folder) T001 (track) to F253 T255. Creating discs with only one level of folders helps with navigation through the disc files. In track mode, the system displays and plays the structure as if it were only one level deep (all MP3 and WMA files play, regardless of being in a specific folder). In folder mode, the system only plays the MP3 and WMA files in the current folder. AUDIO UNIT - VEHICLES WITH: AM/FM WARNING If you are burning your own MP3 and WMA discs, it is important to understand how the system reads the structures you create. While various files may be present, (files with extensions other than MP3 and WMA), only files with the MP3 and WMA extension are played; other files are ignored by the system. This enables you to use the same MP3 and WMA disc for a variety of tasks on your work computer, home computer and your in-vehicle system. Driving while distracted can result in loss of vehicle control, crash and injury. We strongly recommend that you use extreme caution when using any device that may take your focus off the road. Your primary responsibility is the safe operation of your vehicle. We recommend against the use of any hand-held device while driving and encourage the use of voice-operated systems when possible. Make sure you are aware of all applicable local laws that may affect the use of electronic devices while driving. 283 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Audio System A B K C J I H G D F E E175058 A Display: Shows the status of the current mode selected. B Clock: Press the button to select clock setup. C Seek up: Press the button to go to the next station up the radio frequency band. Seek down: Press the button to go to the next station down the radio frequency band. D Numeric keypad: Press the button to recall a previously stored station. To store a favorite station press and hold until the sound returns. E On, Off and VOL: Press the button to switch the audio system on or off. Turn the dial to adjust the volume. F MENU: Press the button to access different audio system features. G Sound: Press the button to adjust the sound settings for bass, treble, balance or fade. H AUX: Press the button to access the AUX features, it will also cancel the menu or list browsing. 284 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Audio System I Radio: Press the button to select different radio frequency bands. Press to cancel the menu or list browsing. J Cursor up or down: Press the cursor up or down arrow buttons to adjust the settings within the menus or to move to the next radio station while listening to the radio on the FM or AM frequency band. K Mute: Press the button to mute the sound. Clock Button This allows you to adjust the clock settings. Press the Clock button until the following message is displayed. Message Set Hour Action and Description Use the cursor up or down arrow buttons to set the correct hour. Press the Clock button again until the following message is displayed. Set Minutes Use the cursor up or down arrow buttons to set the correct minutes. Setting 24 Hour or 12 Hour Display Press the Menu button until the following message is displayed. Message 24 Hour Action and Description Use the cursor up or down arrow buttons to select one of the following: 12 Hour 24 Hour Note: The default setting is 24 hour. Manual Tuning Station Tuning Buttons Use the cursor up or down arrow buttons to tune up or down the frequency band in small increments. To increment quickly, press and hold until you find a station you want to listen to. Seek Tuning Select a frequency band and briefly press one of the seek buttons. The unit will stop at the first station it finds in the direction you have chosen. 285 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Audio System Station Preset Buttons 2. Use the cursor up or down arrow buttons to select the required level. Note: Fade settings are only adjustable if there are speakers in the rear of your vehicle. This feature allows you to store your favorite stations. They can be recalled by selecting the appropriate frequency band and pressing one of the preset buttons. AUX Button 1. Select a frequency band. 2. Tune to the station required. 3. Press and hold one of the preset buttons. The audio unit will also mute momentarily as confirmation. Connect your media device to the audio unit. See USB Port (page 297). Select your media device as the audio source by pressing the AUX button. After connecting your media device, the first track will start to play automatically. You can repeat this on each frequency band and for each preset button. AUDIO UNIT - VEHICLES WITH: PREMIUM AM/FM/CD Menu Button This allows you to adjust all of the audio system settings. Press the button repeatedly until the required setting is displayed. Use the cursor up or down arrow buttons to adjust the following settings: • • • • • • • • WARNING Driving while distracted can result in loss of vehicle control, crash and injury. We strongly recommend that you use extreme caution when using any device that may take your focus off the road. Your primary responsibility is the safe operation of your vehicle. We recommend against the use of any hand-held device while driving and encourage the use of voice-operated systems when possible. Make sure you are aware of all applicable local laws that may affect the use of electronic devices while driving. Clock hour. Clock minutes. 24 hour, 12 hour. Bass. Treble. Balance. Fade. RDS. Sound Button Note: The MyFord Touch system controls most of the audio features. See MyFord Touch™ (page 349). This allows you to adjust the sound settings for bass, treble, balance or fade. 1. Press the sound button until the required setting is displayed. 286 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Audio System A E177140 A B G C F D E - TUNE +: Press this button to manually search through the radio frequency band. B Mute: Press the button to mute the sound. C DISP: Press this button to switch the display screen off. D SEEK: Press this button to go to the next station up or down the radio frequency band or the next or previous track on a CD. E SOUND: Press this button to adjust the sound settings for Bass, Treble, Balance, Fade and Occupancy. F ON/OFF and VOL: Press this button to switch the audio system off and on. Turn to adjust the volume. G SOURCE: Press this button to access different audio modes, such as AM, FM and A/V input. 287 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Audio System Note: You can operate your audio system for up to one hour after you switch the ignition off. Press the on and off control to operate the system with the ignition turned off. The system automatically turns off after one hour. AUDIO UNIT - VEHICLES WITH: AM/FM/CD/SYNC WARNING Driving while distracted can result in loss of vehicle control, crash and injury. We strongly recommend that you use extreme caution when using any device that may take your focus off the road. Your primary responsibility is the safe operation of your vehicle. We recommend against the use of any hand-held device while driving and encourage the use of voice-operated systems when possible. Make sure you are aware of all applicable local laws that may affect the use of electronic devices while driving. A B C D O E N M F L K E166684 G H I J 288 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 I H Audio System A Eject: Press this button to eject a CD. B Cursor arrows: Press these buttons to scroll through on screen audio system choices. C OK: Press this button to confirm menu selections. D Information: Press this button to access any available radio or CD information. E TUNE - and TUNE +: Press these buttons to manually search the frequency band. F Numeric keypad: In radio mode, store your favorite radio stations. To store a radio station, tune to the station, then press and hold a preset button until sound returns. In CD mode, select a track. In phone mode, enter a phone number. G Clock: Push to access clock settings. You can also set the clock by pressing the MENU button and scrolling to Clock Settings. H Function buttons: Select different functions of the audio system depending on which mode you are in (such as Radio mode or CD mode). I Seek: Press and release these buttons to go to the previous or next preset radio station or disc track. Press and hold these buttons to fast forward to the previous or next strong radio station, memory preset or through the current disc track. J On, off and volume: Press this button to switch the system off and on. Turn to adjust the volume. K MENU: Press this button to access different audio system features. See Menu Structure later in this section. L SOUND: Press this button to access settings for Treble, Middle, Bass, Fade, Balance and Occupancy. Use the up and down arrow buttons to select the various settings. When you make your selection, press the left and right arrow buttons to change the settings. Press OK to set or press MENU to exit. M PHONE: Press this button to access the phone features of the SYNC system. See SYNC™ (page 300). N MEDIA: Press this button to switch between listening to a CD and the SYNC-Media menu. To change the SYNC-Media device (such as switching from a device plugged into the USB port to a Bluetooth audio device), press MENU and scroll to Select Source. O RADIO: Press this button to listen to the radio or change radio frequencies. Press the function buttons below the radio screen to select different radio functions. 289 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Audio System Note: You can operate your audio system for up to one hour after you switch the ignition off. Press the on and off control to operate the system with the ignition turned off. The system automatically turns off after one hour. AUDIO UNIT - VEHICLES WITH: AM/FM/CD/SYNC/SATELLITE RADIO WARNING Note: Some features, such as SIRIUS satellite radio, may not be available in your location. Check with an authorized dealer. Driving while distracted can result in loss of vehicle control, crash and injury. We strongly recommend that you use extreme caution when using any device that may take your focus off the road. Your primary responsibility is the safe operation of your vehicle. We recommend against the use of any hand-held device while driving and encourage the use of voice-operated systems when possible. Make sure you are aware of all applicable local laws that may affect the use of electronic devices while driving. A B C D P E O N F M L E166685 G H J K 290 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 J I H Audio System A Eject: Press this button to eject a CD. B Cursor arrows: Press these buttons to scroll through on screen audio system choices. C OK: Press this button to confirm menu selections. D Information: Press this button to access any available radio or CD information. E TUNE - and TUNE +: Press these buttons to manually search the frequency band. F Numeric keypad: In radio mode, store your favorite radio stations. To store a radio station, tune to the station, then press and hold a preset button until sound returns. In CD mode, select a track. In phone mode, enter a phone number. G Clock: Push to access clock settings. You can also set the clock by pressing the MENU button and scrolling to Clock Settings. H Function buttons: Select different functions of the audio system depending on which mode you are in (such as Radio mode or CD mode). I Sound: Press this button to access settings for Treble, Middle, Bass, Fade, Balance and Occupancy. Use the up and down arrow buttons to select the various settings. When you make your selection, press the left and right arrow buttons to change the settings. Press OK to set or press MENU to exit. J Seek: Press and release these buttons to go to the previous or next preset radio station or disc track. Press and hold these buttons to fast forward to the previous or next strong radio station, memory preset or through the current disc track. K On, off and volume: Press this button to switch the system off and on. Turn to adjust the volume. L MENU: Press this button to access different audio system features. See Menu Structure later in this section. M PHONE: Press this button to access the phone features of the SYNC system. See SYNC™ (page 300). N MEDIA: Press this button to switch between listening to a CD and the SYNC-Media menu. To change the SYNC-Media device (such as switching from a device plugged into the USB port to a Bluetooth audio device), press MENU and scroll to Select Source. O SIRIUS: Press this button to listen to SIRIUS satellite radio. P RADIO: Press this button to listen to the radio or change radio frequencies. Press the function buttons below the radio screen to select different radio functions. 291 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Audio System DIGITAL RADIO When HD Radio broadcasts are active, you can access the following functions: Note: HD Radio broadcasts are not available in all markets. When HD Radio broadcasts are active, you can access the following functions: • Scan allows you to hear a brief sampling of all available stations. This feature still works when HD Radio reception is on, although it does not scan for HD2-HD7 channels. You may see the HD logo appear if the station has a digital broadcast. • Memory presets allow you to save an active channel as a memory preset. Touch and hold a memory preset slot until the sound returns. There is a brief mute while the radio saves the station. Sound returns when finished. When switching to an HD2 or HD3 memory preset, the sound mutes before the digital audio plays, because the system has to reacquire the digital signal. HD Radio technology is the digital evolution of analog AM/FM radio. Your system has a special receiver that allows it to receive digital broadcasts (where available) in addition to the analog broadcasts, it already receives. Digital broadcasts provide a better sound quality than analog broadcasts with free, crystal-clear audio and no static or distortion. For more information, and a guide to available stations and programming, please visit www.hdradio.com. When HD Radio is on and you tune to a station broadcasting HD Radio technology, you may notice the HD Radio logo on your screen. When this logo is available, you may also see Title and Artist fields on-screen. Note: As with any saved radio station, you cannot access the saved station if your vehicle is outside the station’s reception area. The multicast indicator appears in FM mode (only) if the current station is broadcasting multiple digital broadcasts. The highlighted numbers signify available digital channels where new or different content is available. HD1 signifies the main programming status and is available in analog and digital broadcasts. Other multicast stations (HD2 through HD7) are only available digitally. 292 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Audio System HD Radio Reception and Station Troubleshooting Potential reception issues Reception area If you are listening to a multicast station and you are on the fringe of the reception area, the station may mute due to weak signal strength. If you are listening to HD1, the system switches back to the analog broadcast until the digital broadcast is available again. However, if you are listening to any of the possible HD2-HD7 multicast channels, the station mutes and stays muted unless it is able to connect to the digital signal again. Station blending When the system first receives a station (aside from HD2HD7 multicast stations), it first plays the station in the analog version. Once the receiver verifies the station is an HD Radio station, it shifts to the digital version. Depending on the station quality, you may hear a slight sound change when the station changes from analog to digital. Blending is the shift from analog to digital sound or digital back to analog sound. In order to provide the best possible experience, use the contact form to report any station issues found while listening to a station broadcasting with HD Radio technology. Independent entities own and operate each station. These stations are responsible for ensuring all audio streams and data fields are accurate. 293 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Audio System Potential station issues Issues Echo, stutter, skip or repeat in audio. Increase or decrease in audio volume. Cause Action This is poor time alignment No action required. This is a by the radio broadcaster. broadcast issue. Sound fading or blending in The radio is shifting between No action required. The and out. analog and digital audio. reception issue may clear up as you continue to drive. * There is an audio mute delay when selecting HD2 or HD3, multicast preset or Direct Tune. The digital multicast is not No action required. This is available until the HD Radio normal behavior. Wait until broadcast is decoded. Once the audio is available. decoded, the audio is available. Cannot access HD2 or HD3 multicast channel when recalling a preset or from a direct tune. The previously stored No action required. The multicast preset or direct station is not available in tune is not available in your your current location. current reception area. Text information does not match currently playing audio. Data service issue by the radio broadcaster. Fill out the station issue form at website listed below. * There is no text information Data service issue by the shown for currently selected radio broadcaster. frequency. Fill out the station issue form at website listed HD2-HD7 stations not found Pressing Scan disables when Scan is pressed. HD2-HD7 channel search. No action required. This is normal behavior. below. * http://www.ibiquity.com/automotive/report_radio_station_experiences HD Radio Technology manufactured under license from iBiquity Digital Corp. U.S. and foreign patents. HD Radio and the HD and HD Radio logos are proprietary trademarks of iBiquity Digital Corp. Ford Motor Company and iBiquity Digital Corp. are not responsible for the content sent using HD Radio technology. Content may be changed, added or deleted at any time at the station owner's discretion. SATELLITE RADIO SIRIUS® broadcasts a variety of music, news, sports, weather, traffic and entertainment satellite radio channels. For more information and a complete list of SIRIUS satellite radio channels, visit www.siriusxm.com in the United States, www.sirius.ca in Canada, or call SIRIUS at 1-888-539-7474. 294 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Audio System Note: This receiver includes the eCos real-time operating system. eCos is published under the eCos License. Satellite Radio Reception Factors Potential satellite radio reception issues Antenna obstructions For optimal reception performance, keep the antenna clear of snow and ice build-up and keep luggage and other material as far away from the antenna as possible. Terrain Hills, mountains, tall buildings, bridges, tunnels, freeway overpasses, parking garages, dense tree foliage and thunderstorms can interfere with your reception. Station overload When you pass a ground-based broadcast-repeating tower, a stronger signal may overtake a weaker one and the audio system may mute. Satellite radio signal interfer- Your display may show ACQUIRING . . . to indicate the ence interference and the audio system may mute. SIRIUS satellite radio is a subscription-based satellite radio service that broadcasts a variety of music, sports, news, weather, traffic and entertainment programming. Your factory-installed SIRIUS satellite radio system includes hardware and a limited subscription term, which begins on the date of sale or lease of your vehicle. See an authorized dealer for availability. SIRIUS® Satellite Radio Service Note: SIRIUS reserves the unrestricted right to change, rearrange, add or delete programming including canceling, moving or adding particular channels, and its prices, at any time, with or without notice to you. Ford Motor Company shall not be responsible for any such programming changes. For more information on extended subscription terms (a service fee is required), the online media player and a complete list of SIRIUS satellite radio channels, and other features, please visit www.siriusxm.com in the United States, www.sirius.ca in Canada, or call SIRIUS at 1-888-539-7474. E142593 Satellite Radio Electronic Serial Number (ESN) You need your ESN to activate, modify or track your satellite radio account. When in satellite radio mode, press Options. 295 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Audio System Troubleshooting Message Condition Action Acquiring… Radio requires more than two seconds to produce audio for the selected channel. Satellite antenna fault There is an internal module If this message does not or system failure present. clear shortly, or with an ignition key cycle, your receiver may have a fault. See an authorized dealer for service. SIRIUS system failure No action required. This message should disappear shortly. Invalid Channel The channel is no longer available. Tune to another channel or choose another preset. Unsubscribed Channel Your subscription does not include this channel. Contact SIRIUS at 1-888539-7474 to subscribe to the channel, or tune to another channel. No Signal The signal is lost from the SIRIUS satellite or SIRIUS tower to your vehicle antenna. The signal is blocked. When you move into an open area, the signal should return. Updating… Update of channel programming in progress. No action required. The process may take up to three minutes. Questions? Call Your satellite service is no longer available. Contact SIRIUS at 1-888539-7474 to resolve subscription issues. 1-888-539-7474 None found Check Channel Guide Subscription Updated All the channels in the Use the channel guide to selected category are either turn off the Lock or Skip skipped or locked. function on that station. SIRIUS has updated the channels available for your vehicle. 296 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 No action required. Audio System The audio input jack allows you to connect and play music from a portable music player through your vehicle speakers. You can use any portable music player designed for use with headphones. The audio extension cable must have a 0.14 in (3.5 mm) male connector at each end. The audio extension cable must be long enough to allow the portable music player to be safely stored while your vehicle is moving. AUDIO INPUT JACK WARNINGS Driving while distracted can result in loss of vehicle control, crash and injury. We strongly recommend that you use extreme caution when using any device that may take your focus off the road. Your primary responsibility is the safe operation of your vehicle. We recommend against the use of any hand-held device while driving and encourage the use of voice-operated systems when possible. Make sure you are aware of all applicable local laws that may affect the use of electronic devices while driving. 1. 2. For safety reasons, do not connect or adjust the settings on your portable music player while your vehicle is moving. 3. 4. 5. Store the portable music player in a secure location when your vehicle is moving, for example the glove compartment. Hard objects may become projectiles in a crash or sudden stop, which may increase the risk of serious injury. 6. 7. Make sure your vehicle is stationary with the audio unit and the portable music player switched off. Plug the extension cable from the portable music player into the audio input jack. Switch the audio unit on. Select either a tuned FM station or a CD. Adjust the volume as desired. Switch the portable music player on and adjust the volume to half its maximum level. Press the AUX button on the audio unit. You should hear music from the portable music player even if it is low. Adjust the volume on the portable music player as desired. Do this by switching back and forth between the AUX and FM or CD controls. USB PORT WARNINGS Driving while distracted can result in loss of vehicle control, crash and injury. We strongly recommend that you use extreme caution when using any device that may take your focus off the road. Your primary responsibility is the safe operation of your vehicle. We recommend E185568 297 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Audio System The USB port allows you to plug in media playing devices, memory sticks and charge devices (if supported). See (page 300). The extension cable must be long enough to allow the device to be safely stored while your vehicle is moving. WARNINGS against the use of any hand-held device while driving and encourage the use of voice-operated systems when possible. Make sure you are aware of all applicable local laws that may affect the use of electronic devices while driving. MEDIA HUB (If Equipped) For safety reasons, do not connect or adjust the settings on your device while your vehicle is moving. The media hub is located in the center console and has the following features: Store all devices in a secure location when your vehicle is moving, for example the glove compartment. Hard objects may become projectiles in a crash or sudden stop, which may increase the risk of serious injury. E185339 E185567 A/V inputs B SD card slot C USB ports See MyFord Touch™ (page 349). 298 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 A Audio System AUDIO TROUBLESHOOTING Message Description and Action Please check CD General error message for CD fault conditions. For example cannot read the CD, data-CD inserted, etc. Make sure the disc is loaded correctly. Clean and re-try, or replace disc with known music disc. If the error persists contact an authorized dealer. CD drive malfunction General error message for a mechanism fault. The system has detected a fault that requires service. CD drive high temp. General error message for the mechanism being too hot. The unit will not work until it has cooled down. If the error persists contact an authorized dealer. 299 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 SYNC™ GENERAL INFORMATION E142598 • SYNC is an in-vehicle communications system that works with your Bluetooth-enabled cellular phone and portable media player. This allows you to: • Make and receive calls. • Access and play music from your portable music player. • Use 911 Assist, Vehicle Health Report and SYNC Services (Traffic, Directions * & Information). • • • • • * These features require activation. Make sure that you review your device's manual before using it with SYNC. Support The SYNC support team is available to help you with any questions you cannot answer on your own. Use applications, such as Pandora and Stitcher, via SYNC AppLink. Access phonebook contacts and music using voice commands. Stream music from your connected phone. Text message. Monday-Saturday, 8:30am-9:00pm EST. Sunday, 10:30am-7:30pm EST. In the United States, call 1-800-392-3673. In Canada, call 1-800-565-3673. 300 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Use the advanced voice recognition system Charge your USB device (if your device supports this). SYNC™ Times are subject to change due to holidays. When using SYNC: • Do not operate playing devices if the power cords or cables are broken, split or damaged. Place cords and cables out of the way, so they do not interfere with the operation of pedals, seats, compartments or safe driving abilities. • Do not leave playing devices in your vehicle during extreme conditions as it could cause them damage. See your device's manual for further information. • Do not attempt to service or repair the system. See an authorized dealer. SYNC Owner Account Why do I need a SYNC owner account? • Required to activate Vehicle Health Report and to view the reports online. • Required to activate the subscription-based SYNC Services and to personalize your Saved Points and Favorites. • Essential for keeping up with the latest software downloads available for SYNC. • Access to customer support for any questions you may have. Privacy Information When a cellular phone is connected to SYNC, the system creates a profile within your vehicle that is linked to that cellular phone. This profile is created in order to offer you more cellular features and to operate more efficiently. Among other things, this profile may contain data about your cellular phone book, text messages (read and unread), and call history, including history of calls when your cellular phone was not connected to the system. In addition, if you connect a media device, the system creates and retains an index of supported media content. The system also records a short development log of approximately 10 minutes of all recent system activity. The log profile and other system data may be used to improve the system and help diagnose any problems that may occur. Driving Restrictions For your safety, certain features are speed-dependent and restricted when your vehicle is traveling over 3 mph (5 km/h). Safety Information WARNING Driving while distracted can result in loss of vehicle control, crash and injury. We strongly recommend that you use extreme caution when using any device that may take your focus off the road. Your primary responsibility is the safe operation of your vehicle. We recommend against the use of any hand-held device while driving and encourage the use of voice-operated systems when possible. Make sure you are aware of all applicable local laws that may affect the use of electronic devices while driving. The cellular profile, media device index, and development log will remain in the vehicle unless you delete them and are generally accessible only in the vehicle when the cellular phone or media player is connected. If you no longer plan to use the system or the vehicle, we recommend you perform a Master Reset to erase all stored information. 301 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 SYNC™ System data cannot be accessed without special equipment and access to the vehicle's SYNC module. Ford Motor Company and Ford of Canada will not access the system data for any purpose other than as described absent consent, a court order, or where required by law enforcement, other government authorities, or other third parties acting with lawful authority. Other parties may seek to access the information independently of Ford Motor Company and Ford of Canada. For further privacy information, see the sections on 911 Assist, Vehicle Health Report, and Traffic, Directions and Information. Helpful Hints • Make sure the interior of your vehicle is as quiet as possible. Wind noise from open windows and road vibrations may prevent the system from correctly recognizing spoken commands. • After pressing the voice button, wait until after the tone sounds and Listening appears before saying a command. Any command spoken before this does not register with the system. • Speak naturally, without long pauses between words. • At any time, you can interrupt the system while it is speaking by pressing the voice button. USING VOICE RECOGNITION Initiating a Voice Session This system helps you control many features using voice commands. This allows you to keep your hands on the wheel and focus on what is in front of you. Initiate a voice session by pressing the voice button on the steering wheel controls. See Voice Control (page 62). E142599 A tone sounds and the following message appears in the information display. Message Listening You can then say any of the following: Voice command If you want the system to carry out the following Bluetooth audio Stream audio from your phone. (cancel | stop | exit) Cancel the requested action. ((line | AV | audio video) in | AUX | audio video) Access the device connected to the auxiliary input jack. mobile (apps | applications) Access mobile applications. 302 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 SYNC™ Voice command If you want the system to carry out the following (phone | Blackberry | iPhone | Mobile) Make calls. Services Access the SYNC Services portal. SYNC Return to the main menu. (USB [stick] | iPod | MP3 Access the device connected to your USB port. [player]) vehicle [health] report Run a vehicle health report. voice settings Adjust the level of voice interaction and feedback. [main menu] help Hear a list of voice commands available in the current mode. You can say any of the voice commands that appear within open and close brackets that are separated by |. For example, where (cancel | stop | exit) appears you say; cancel or stop or exit. You must say any of the voice commands that appear outside of open and close brackets. For example, where mobile (apps | applications) appears, you must say mobile followed by either apps or applications. You do not need to say words that appear within square brackets. For example, for where (USB [stick] | iPOD | MP3 [player]) appears, you can say USB or USB stick. Note: Mobile Applications, Services and Vehicle health report, is only available in the United States of America. Adjusting the Interaction Level System Interaction and Feedback Initiate a voice session by pressing the voice button on the steering wheel controls. See Voice Control (page 62). The system provides feedback through audible tones, prompts, questions and spoken confirmations depending on the situation and the chosen level of interaction (voice settings). You can customize the voice recognition system to provide more or less instruction and feedback. E142599 A tone sounds and the following message appears in the information display. The default setting is to a higher level of interaction in order to help you learn to use the system. You can change these settings at any time. Message Listen 303 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 SYNC™ When prompted say the following: Voice command If you want the system to carry out the following voice settings Followed by either of the following: interaction mode novice Provide more detailed interaction and guidance. interaction mode advanced Provide less audible interaction and more tone prompts. The system defaults to the standard interaction mode. Confirmation prompts are short questions the system asks when it is not sure of your request or when there are multiple possible responses to your request. For example, the system may ask "Phone, is that correct?". If turned off, the system simply makes a best guess as to what you requested and may ask you to confirm settings. Voice command If you want the system to carry out the following confirmation prompts off Make a best guess from the command; you may still occasionally be asked to confirm settings. confirmation prompts on Clarify your voice command with a short question. For example, say "Say 1 after the tone to call John Doe at home. Say 2 after the tone to call Johnny Doe on mobile. Say 3 after the tone to call Jane Doe at home." You could also say "Say 1 after the tone to play John Doe, Say 2 after the tone to play Johnny Doe." The system creates candidate lists when it has the same confidence level of several options based on your voice command. When turned on, it may prompt you with as many as four possibilities for clarification. 304 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 SYNC™ Voice command If you want the system to carry out the following media candidate lists off Make a best guess from the media candidate list. You may still occasionally be asked questions. media candidate lists on Clarify your voice command for media candidates. phone candidate lists off Make a best guess from the phone candidate list. You may still occasionally be asked questions. phone candidate lists on Clarify your voice command for phone candidates Other features, such as text messaging using Bluetooth and automatic phonebook download, are cell phone-dependent features. To check your cell phone's compatibility, see your cell phone's manual and visit www.SYNCMyRide.com, www.SYNCMyRide.ca or www.syncmaroute.ca. USING SYNC™ WITH YOUR PHONE Hands-free calling is one of the main features of SYNC. While the system supports a variety of features, many are dependent on your cell phone's functionality. At a minimum, most cell phones with Bluetooth wireless technology support the following functions: • Answering an incoming call. • Ending a call. • Using privacy mode. • Dialing a number. • Redialing. • Call waiting notification. • Caller ID. Pairing a Cell Phone for the First Time Note: SYNC can support downloading up to approximately 1000 entries per Bluetooth-enabled cell phone. Note: Make sure to switch on the ignition and the radio. Put the transmission in position park (P) (automatic transmission) or neutral with the parking brake applied (manual transmission). Note: To scroll through the menus, press the up and down arrows on your audio system. Wirelessly pairing your cell phone with SYNC allows you to make and receive hands-free calls. 305 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 SYNC™ Press the phone button. When the display indicates there is no cell phone paired, do the following: Message Action and Description No Phone Paired Press the OK button. When the following message appears in the display. Find SYNC 1. Press the OK button. 2. Put your cell phone into Bluetooth discovery mode. See your device's manual if necessary. 3. When prompted on your cell phone's display, enter the six-digit PIN provided by SYNC in the radio display. The display indicates when the pairing is successful. Depending on your cell phone's capability and your market, the system may prompt you with questions, such as setting the current cell phone as the primary cell phone (the cell phone SYNC automatically tries to connect with first upon vehicle start-up) and downloading your phonebook. 306 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 SYNC™ Pairing Subsequent Cell Phones Press the phone button, then scroll to: Message Action Phone settings Press the OK button. Bluetooth Devices Press the OK button. Add Device Press the OK button. When the following message appears in the display. Find SYNC 1. Press the OK button. 2. Put your cell phone into Bluetooth discovery mode. See your device's manual if necessary. 3. When prompted on your cell phone's display, enter the six-digit PIN provided by SYNC in the radio display. The display indicates when the pairing is successful. The system then prompts with questions, such as if you would like to set the current cell phone as the primary cell phone (the cell phone SYNC automatically tries to connect with first upon vehicle start-up) or download your phonebook. Note: Make sure to switch on the ignition and the radio. Put the transmission in position park (P) (automatic transmission) or neutral with the parking brake applied (manual transmission). Note: To scroll through the menus, press the up and down arrows on your audio system. Phone Voice Commands Voice Command Action call (someone | [[a] name]) You do not need to preceed this command by saying; phone. This command is not available until your cell phone information is completely downloaded using Bluetooth. Call [name] at home You do not need to preceed this command by saying; phone. This command is not available until your cell phone information is completely downloaded using Bluetooth. Call [name] at work You do not need to preceed this command by saying; phone. This command is not available until your cell phone information is completely downloaded using Bluetooth. Call [name] at office You do not need to preceed this command by saying; phone. This command is not available until your cell phone information is completely downloaded using Bluetooth. 307 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 SYNC™ Voice Command Action Call [name] at cell You do not need to preceed this command by saying; phone. This command is not available until your cell phone information is completely downloaded using Bluetooth. Call [name] at other You do not need to preceed this command by saying; phone. This command is not available until your cell phone information is completely downloaded using Bluetooth. Call history incoming This command is not available until your cell phone information is completely downloaded using Bluetooth. Call history missed This command is not available until your cell phone information is completely downloaded using Bluetooth. Call history outgoing This command is not available until your cell phone information is completely downloaded using Bluetooth. Connections dial [[a] number] You do not need to preceed this command by saying; phone. See the following Phonebook Commands. ([go to] privacy [on] | transfer to phone | handsfree off) (hold call [on] | (put | place) call on hold) join (call | calls) main menu This command is not available until your cell phone information is completely downloaded using Bluetooth. See the following Menu Commands. Phonebook This command is not available until your cell phone information is completely downloaded using Bluetooth. Phonebook at home This command is not available until your cell phone information is completely downloaded using Bluetooth. Phonebook at office This command is not available until your cell phone information is completely downloaded using Bluetooth. Phonebook at work This command is not available until your cell phone information is completely downloaded using Bluetooth. 308 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 SYNC™ Voice Command Phonebook at Action cell This command is not available until your cell phone information is completely downloaded using Bluetooth. Phonebook at other This command is not available until your cell phone information is completely downloaded using Bluetooth. 2 You can say any of the voice commands that appear within open and close brackets that are separated by |. For example, where (call | calls) appears you say; call or calls. You must say any of the voice commands that appear outside of open and close brackets. For example, where; join (call | calls) appears, you must say join followed by either call or calls. You do not need to say words that appear within square brackets. For example, for where ([go to] privacy [on]) appears, you can say privacy. Phonebook Commands When you ask SYNC to access content, for example the phonebook name or number, the requested information appears in the display to view. Press the phone button and say, Call; followed by any of the following: Voice Command Action 411 Four-one-one. 911 Nine-one-one. 700 Seven hundred. 800 Eight hundred. 900 Nine hundred. Pound # Number Zero to nine. Asterisk * Clear Deletes all entered digits. Delete Deletes one digit. 309 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 SYNC™ Voice Command Action Plus Star * Note: To exit dial mode, press and hold the phone button or press MENU to go to the phone menu. Voice Command Phone Menu Commands (Phone) settings (set) ringer 3 Voice Command (Phone) settings (set) ringer off (Phone) connections Battery (Phone) settings (message) notification off Phone name Signal (Phone) settings (message) notification on Text message inbox (Phone) settings (set) phone ringer You do not need to say word contained within brackets for the system to understand your command. (Phone) settings (set) ringer 1 (Phone) settings (set) ringer 2 Making a Call Press the voice button and when prompted say: Voice Command call (someone | [[a] name]) Action and Description This command is not available until your cell phone information is completely downloaded using Bluetooth. dial [[a] number] When the system confirms the number say one of the following commands: dial [[a] number] To confirm the number and initiate the call. (delete | correct) To erase the last spoken digit or press the left arrow button. clear To erase all spoken digits or press and hold the left arrow button. To end a call press and hold the red phone button. 310 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 SYNC™ Receiving Calls Phone Options during an Active Call When receiving a call, you can: • Answer the call by pressing the phone button. • Reject the call by pressing and holding the red phone button. • Ignore the call by doing nothing. During an active call, you have more menu features that become available, for example putting a call on hold or joining calls. Use the arrow buttons to scroll through the menu options. Press the MENU button during an active call, then scroll to: Message Active call Action and Description Press the OK button. Select one of the following: Mute Call Press the OK button to mute the call. Privacy Press the OK button to switch a call from an active handsfree environment to your cell phone for a more private conversation. Hold Press the OK button to put an active call on hold. Enter Tones Enter numbers for passwords. Scroll until the desired number appears in the display, then press OK; a tone sounds as confirmation. Repeat as necessary. Join calls Join two separate calls. SYNC supports a maximum of three callers on a multiparty call or conference call. 1. Press the phone button. 2. Access the desired contact through SYNC or use voice commands to place the second call. Once actively in the second call, press MENU. 3. Scroll to Join Calls, and press the OK button. Wait until the following message appears. Join Calls? Press the OK button. Phonebook To access your phonebook contacts. 1. Press the OK button to select, and then scroll through your phonebook contacts. 2. Press the OK button again when the desired selection appears in the display. 3. Press the phone button to call the contact. 311 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 SYNC™ Message Call History Action and Description To access your call history log. Press the OK button to select, then scroll through your call history options (incoming, outgoing or missed). 2. Press the OK button when the desired selection appears in the display. 3. Press the phone button to call the selection. 1. Return Exit the current menu. Accessing Features Through the Phone Menu The phone menu allows you to redial a number, access your call history and phonebook and sends text messages as well as access cell phone and system settings. You can also access advanced features, for example 911 Assist, Vehicle Health Report and SYNC Services. Press the phone button, then scroll to: Message Action and Description Phone Redial Press the OK button to redial the last number called. Press the OK button again to confirm. Call History Access any previously dialed, received or missed calls after you 1 connect your Bluetooth-enabled cell phone to SYNC . Press the OK button then select one of the following and press the OK button again to confirm. Incoming calls Outgoing calls Missed calls The system attempts to automatically re-download your phonebook and call history each time your cell phone connects to SYNC (if the auto download feature is on and your Bluetoothenabled cell phone supports this feature). 312 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 SYNC™ Message Phonebook Action and Description Access and call any contacts in your previously downloaded 1,2 phonebook . If your phonebook has less than 255 entries, they appear alphabetically in flat file mode. If there are more than 255 entries, the system will organize them into alphabetical categories. 1. Press the OK button. 2. Scroll to the desired contact. 3. Press OK or the phone button to call the contact. Text messaging Press the OK button to send, download, read and delete text 1 messages . Phone settings View your cell phone's status, set ring tones, select your message notification, change phonebook entries and automat1 ically download your cell phone content among other features . SYNC Services Access the SYNC Services portal where you can request various 3 types of information, for example traffic reports and directions . 911 Assist Auotmatically place an emergency call to a 911 operator 4 following a crash . Vehicle Health Report Create and receive a diagnostic report card on your vehicle . Mobile Apps Interact with SYNC-capable mobile applications on your 3 3 smartphone . System Settings Access Bluetooth devices menu listings, for example Add, Connect, Set as Primary, Delete, On and Off. Access advanced menu listings, for example prompts, languages, defaults, master reset, install application and system information. Exit Phone Menu Press the OK button to to exit the phone menu. 1 This is a cell phone-dependent feature. 2 This is a cell phone-dependent and speed-dependent feature. 3 This is an optional feature and available in the United States only. 4 This is an optional feature and available in the United States and Canada only. 313 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 SYNC™ Text Messaging Receiving a Text Message SYNC allows you to receive, send, download and delete text messages. The system can also read incoming text messages to you so that you do not have to take your eyes off the road. When a new text message arrives, an audible tone sounds and the information display indicates you have a new message. Note: This is a cell phone-dependent feature. Your cell phone must support downloading text messages using Bluetooth to receive incoming text messages. Note: This is a cell phone-dependent feature. Following the notification choose from the following: Read or store the text message: Message Action and Description Text msg notify Press the OK button to receive and open the text message. Press the OK button again and SYNC reads your message aloud if you are not able to view the message. You can then also choose to reply or forward the message. Text msg notify Take no action, the message goes into your text message inbox. Press the voice button and when prompted say: Voice Command Read message Action and Description Press the OK button to have SYNC read the message to you. Reply or forward the message: Message Text msg notify Action and Description Press the OK button. Select one of the following: Reply to sender Press the OK button to access and then scroll through the list of pre-defined messages to send. Forward msg. Press the OK button to forward the message to anyone in your Phonebook or Call History. You can also choose Enter Number. Note: Forwarding a text message is a speed-dependent feature. It is only available when your vehicle is traveling at 3 mph (5 km/h) or less. 314 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 SYNC™ Sending, Downloading and Deleting Your Text Messages Note: Sending a text message is a speed-dependent feature. It is only available when your vehicle is traveling at 3 mph (5 km/h) or less. Text messaging is a cell phone-dependent feature. If your cell phone is compatible, SYNC allows you to receive, send, download and delete text messages. Note: You can only have one recipient per text message. Press the phone button, then scroll to: Message Text message Action and Description Press the OK button. Select one of the following: Download now Allows you to download your unread messages to SYNC. To download the messages, press the OK button to select. The display indicates the system is downloading your messages. When downloading is complete, SYNC returns you to the inbox. Delete All Messages? Allows you to delete current text messages from SYNC. To delete the messages, press the OK button to select. The display indicates when it is finished deleting all your text messages. SYNC returns you to the text message menu. Send Text Message? Allows you to send a new text message based on a predefined set of 15 messages. See the following Pre-defined text messages table. 1. 2. 3. 4. Press the OK button. Scroll to your desired message. Press the OK button. Scroll through your phonebook, call history entries or enter a new number. 5. Press the OK button to enter the desired contact. 6. Press the OK button again when the system asks if you would like to send the message. The system sends each text message with the following signature: This message was sent from my Ford. Unsupported If the system detects your cell phone does not support any feature, this message will appear in the information display. SYNC returns you to the text message menu. Return Press the OK button to exit the current menu. 315 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 SYNC™ Message Pre-defined text messages Where R you? Message I need more directions Can't talk right now I love you Call me Too funny :-) Call you later Can't wait to see you Be there in 10 minutes Stuck in traffic. Be there in 20 minutes Yes Accessing Your Phone Settings No These are cell phone-dependent features. Your cell phone settings allow you to access and adjust some features. For example ring tones, text message notification, modify your phonebook and set up automatic download. Why? Thanks Press the phone button, then scroll to: Message Phone settings Action and Description Press the OK button. Select one of the following: Phone status See the provider, name, signal power, battery power and roaming status of your connected cell phone. Press OK to select and scroll to view the information. When done, press OK again to return to the phone status menu. Set ringtone Select which ring tone sounds during an incoming call. You can choose one of the system ring tones or your cell phone ring tones. Press the OK button and scroll to hear and choose from the following ring tones. Set ringer X Set ringer X Set ringer X Phone Ringer 316 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 SYNC™ Message Action and Description Press the OK button to select th desired ring tone. If your cell phone supports in-band ringing, your cell phone ring plays when you choose the phone ringer option. Text Message Notification You have the option of hearing an audible tone to notify you when a text message arrives. Press the OK button then select one of the following and press the OK button again to confirm. Message Notification On Message Notification Off Modify Phonebook Modify the contents of your phonebook, for example add, delete or download. Press the OK button to choose between: Add contacts Press the OK button to add more contacts from your phonebook. Push the desired contact(s) on your cell phone. See your cell phone's manual on how to push contacts. Delete Phonebook Press the OK button to delete the current phonebook and call history. When the message appears, press the OK button again to confirm. SYNC returns you to the phone settings menu. Download Phonebook Press the OK button. When the message appears, press the OK button again to confirm. Auto-download Automatically download your phonebook each time your cell phone connects to SYNC. Auto Download on * Press the OK button to automatically download your phonebook every time your cell phone connects to SYNC. * Auto Download off Press the OK button if you do not want to download your phonebook every time your cell phone connects to SYNC. Return Exit the current menu. ** Downloading times are cell phone-dependent and quantity-dependent. ** When Auto Download is on, it automatically deletes any changes, additions or deletions saved since your last download. 317 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 SYNC™ System Settings Bluetooth Devices This menu provides access to your Bluetooth Devices and Advanced menu features. Use the arrow buttons to scroll through the menu options. The Bluetooth Devices menu allows you to add, connect and delete devices, set a cell phone as primary as well as turn your Bluetooth feature on and off. Press the phone button, then scroll to: Message Action and Description System settings Press the OK button. BT Devices Press the OK button. Select one of the following: Add Device See Using SYNC™ With Your Phone (page 305). Connect Bluetooth Device Connect a previously paired Bluetooth-enabled cell phone. * ** 1. Press the OK button to select and view a list of previously paired cell phones. 2. Scroll until you find the desired device, and then press OK to connect the cell phone. Set as Primary Phone Set a previously paired cell phone as your primary cell phone. Press the OK button to select and scroll to select the desired cell phone. Press OK to confirm. SYNC attempts to connect with the primary cell phone at every ignition cycle. When you select a cell phone as a primary cell phone, it appears first in the list and the system marks it with an asterisk. Bluetooth On and Off Turn the Bluetooth feature on and off. Press the OK button and scroll to toggle between on and off. Press the OK button again. Setting Bluetooth to off disconnects all Bluetooth devices and turns off all Bluetooth features. Delete Device Delete a paired cell phone. Press the OK button and scroll to select the device. Press OK to confirm. Delete All Devices Delete all previously paired cell phones and all information originally saved with those cell phones. 318 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 SYNC™ Message Action and Description Press the OK button. Return Exit the current menu. * This is a speed-dependent feature. It is only available when your vehicle is traveling at 3 mph (5 km/h) or less. ** You can only connect one device at a time. When another cell phone is connected, the previous one is disconnected. Advanced The Advanced menu allows you to access and set prompts, languages, defaults, perform a master reset, install an application and view system information. Press the phone button, then scroll to: Message Action and Description System settings Press the OK button. Advanced Press the OK button. Select one of the following: Confirmation Prompts Get help from SYNC by using questions, helpful hints or asking you for a specific action. To turn these prompts on or off: 1. Press the OK button to select and scroll to select between On and Off. 2. Press the OK button when the desired selection appears in the display. SYNC returns you to the Advanced menu. Language 1. Press OK to select and then scroll through the languages. Choose between English, Français and Español. Once selected, all of the radio displays and prompts are in the selected language. 2. Press OK when the desired selection appears in the display. If you change the language setting, the display indicates that the system is updating. When complete, SYNC returns you to the Advanced menu. Factory Defaults Return to the factory default settings. This selection does not erase your indexed information, for example phonebook, call history, text messages or paired devices. 319 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 SYNC™ Message Action and Description Press the OK button to select and then press OK again when the following message appears in the display. Restore Defaults? Master reset Completely erase all information stored on SYNC, for example phonebook, call history, text messages and paired devices, and return the system to the factory default settings. Press OK to select. The display indicates when complete. SYNC returns you to the Advanced menu. Install Application? Install applications you have downloaded. Press the OK button and scroll to select. Press the OK button to confirm. System info Access the Auto Version number as well as the FDN number. Press the OK button to select. MAP Profile This is a Bluetooth component, which can further help your cell phone with the exchange of text messages. Return Exit the current menu. • SYNC™ APPLICATIONS AND SERVICES (If Equipped) • In order for the following features to work, your cell phone must be compatible with SYNC. To check your phone's compatibility, visit www.SYNCMyRide.com, www.SYNCMyRide.ca or www.syncmaroute.ca. * • SYNC Services : Provides access to traffic, directions and information such as travel, horoscopes, stock prices and more. • 911 Assist: Can alert 911 in the event of an emergency. * This is an optional feature and available in the United States only. 911 Assist (If Equipped) WARNINGS Unless the 911 Assist setting is set on before a crash, the system will not dial for help which could delay response time, potentially increasing the risk of serious injury or death after a crash. 320 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 * Vehicle Health Report : Provides a diagnostic and maintenance report card of your vehicle. SYNC AppLink: Allows you to connect to and use certain applications, for example Pandora and Stitcher on a compatible cell phone. SYNC™ Note: If any user turns 911 Assist on or off, that setting applies for all paired phones. If 911 Assist is turned off, either a voice message plays or a display message (or icon) comes on (or both) when your vehicle is started after a previously paired phone connects. WARNINGS Do not wait for 911 Assist to make an emergency call if you can do it yourself. Dial emergency services immediately to avoid delayed response time which could increase the risk of serious injury or death after a crash. If you do not hear 911 Assist within five seconds of the crash, the system or phone may be damaged or non-functional. Note: Every phone operates differently. While SYNC 911 Assist works with most cellular phones, some may have trouble using this feature. Always place your phone in a secure location in your vehicle so it does not become a projectile or get damaged in a crash. Failure to do so may cause serious injury to someone or damage the phone which could prevent 911 Assist from working properly. If a crash deploys an airbag (excluding knee airbags and rear inflatable safety belts [if equipped]) or activates the fuel pump shut-off, your SYNC-equipped vehicle may be able to contact emergency services by dialing 911 through a paired and connected Bluetooth-enabled phone. You can learn more about the 911 Assist feature, visit www.SYNCMyRide.com, www.SYNCMyRide.ca or www.syncmaroute.ca. Note: The SYNC 911 Assist feature must be set on before the incident. Note: Before setting this feature on, make sure that you read the 911 Assist Privacy Notice later in this section for important information. See Supplementary Restraints System (page 33). Important information about airbag deployment is in this chapter. See Roadside Emergencies (page 176). Important information about the fuel pump shut-off is in this chapter. Switching 911 Assist On or Off Press the phone button to enter the phone menu and scroll to: Message Action and Description 911 Assist Press the OK button to confirm and enter the 911 Assist menu. On Press the OK button when the desired option appears in the radio display. Off 321 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 SYNC™ Off selections include: • Off with reminder: Provides a display and voice reminder at phone connection at vehicle start. • Off without reminder: Provides a display reminder only without a voice reminder at phone connection. Before making the call: • SYNC provides a short window of time (about 10 seconds) to cancel the call. If you fail to cancel the call, SYNC attempts to dial 911. • SYNC says the following, or a similar message: "SYNC will attempt to call 911, to cancel the call, press Cancel on your screen or press and hold the phone button on your steering wheel." To make sure that 911 Assist works correctly: • SYNC must be powered and working properly at the time of the incident and throughout feature activation and use. • The 911 Assist feature must be set on before the incident. • You must pair and connect a Bluetooth-enabled and compatible cell phone to SYNC. • A connected Bluetooth-enabled phone must have the ability to make and maintain an outgoing call at the time of the incident. • A connected Bluetooth-enabled phone must have adequate network coverage, battery power and signal strength. • The vehicle must have battery power and be located in the U.S., Canada or in a territory in which 911 is the emergency number. If you do not cancel the call, and SYNC makes a successful call, a pre-recorded message plays for the 911 operator, and then the occupant(s) in your vehicle is able to talk with the operator. Be prepared to provide your name, phone number and location immediately, because not all 911 systems are capable of receiving this information electronically. 911 Assist May Not Work If • • • 911 Assist Privacy Notice In the Event of a Crash When you turn on 911 Assist, it may disclose to emergency services that your vehicle has been in a crash involving the deployment of an airbag or activation of the fuel pump shut-off. Certain versions or updates to 911 Assist may also be capable of electronically or verbally disclosing to 911 operators your vehicle location or other details about your vehicle or crash to assist 911 operators to provide the most appropriate emergency services. If you do not want to disclose this information, do not turn the feature on. Not all crashes will deploy an airbag or activate the fuel pump shut-off (the triggers for 911 Assist). If a connected cell phone sustains damage or loses its connection to SYNC during a crash, SYNC will search for and try to connect to a previously paired cell phone; SYNC will then attempt to call the emergency services. 322 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Your cellular phone or 911 Assist hardware sustains damage in a crash. The vehicle's battery or the SYNC system has no power. The phone(s) thrown from your vehicle are the ones paired and connected to the system. SYNC™ Vehicle Health Report Note: In order to allow a break-in period for your vehicle, you may not be able to create a Vehicle Health Report until your vehicle odometer has reached 200 miles. WARNING Always follow scheduled maintenance instructions, regularly inspect your vehicle, and seek repair for any damage or problem you suspect. Vehicle Health Report supplements, but cannot replace, normal maintenance and vehicle inspection. Vehicle Health Report only monitors certain systems electronically monitored by your vehicle and will not monitor or report the status of any other system, (such as brake lining wear). Failure to perform scheduled maintenance and regularly inspect your vehicle may result in vehicle damage and serious injury. Note: Cellular phone and SMS charges may apply when making a report. Register for Vehicle Health Report and set your report preferences at www.SYNCMyRide.com. After registering, you can request a Vehicle Health Report (inside your vehicle). Return to your account at www.SYNCMyRide.com to view your report. You can also choose for SYNC to remind you automatically to run reports at specific mileage intervals. The system allows you to check your vehicle's overall health in the form of a diagnostic report card. The Vehicle Health Report contains valuable information, for example: • Vehicle diagnostic information • Scheduled maintenance • Open recalls and Field Service Actions • Items noted during vehicle inspections by an authorized dealer that still need servicing. Note: This feature is only available in the United States. Note: Your Vehicle Health Report feature requires activation before use. Visit www.SYNCMyRide.com to register. There is no fee or subscription associated with Vehicle Health Report, but you must register to use this feature. Note: This feature may not function properly if you have enabled caller ID blocking on your cellular phone. Before running a report, review the Vehicle Health Report Privacy Notice. You can run a vehicle health report after your vehicle has been running a minimum of 60 seconds. Choose one of the following options. Press the voice button and when prompted say: Voice command vehicle [health] report Action and Description The system will run a vehicle health report of your vehicle's diagnostic systems and send the results to Ford where it combines with scheduled maintenance information, open recalls, other field service actions and vehicle inspection items that still need servicing by an authorized dealer. 323 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 SYNC™ Press the phone button, then scroll to: Message vehicle [health] report Action and Description Press the OK button. Select one of the following: Report Interval Press the OK button to and select on or off. Select On to have SYNC automatically prompt you to run a * health report at certain mileage intervals. * Mileage Interval Scroll to select between 5000, 7500 or 10000-mile intervals. Select your desire option and press the OK button. Run Report Press the OK button for SYNC to run a health report of your vehicle's diagnostic systems and send the results to Ford where it combines with scheduled maintenance information, open recalls, other field service actions and vehicle inspection items that still need servicing by an authorized dealer. Return Exit the current menu. You must first turn this feature on before you can select the desired mileage interval. SYNC Services: Traffic, Directions & Information (TDI) (If Equipped, United States Only) Vehicle Health Report Privacy Notice When you create a Vehicle Health Report, Ford Motor Company may collect your cellular phone number (to process your report request) and diagnostic information about your vehicle. Certain versions or updates to Vehicle Health Report may also collect more vehicle information. Ford may use your vehicle information it collects for any purpose. If you do not want to disclose your cellular phone number or vehicle information, do not run the feature or set up your Vehicle Health Report profile at www.SYNCMyRide.com. See www.SYNCMyRide.com (Vehicle Health Report Terms and Conditions, and Privacy Statement) for more information. Note: SYNC Services varies by trim level and model year and may require a subscription. Traffic alerts and turn-by-turn directions available in select markets. Message and data rates may apply. Ford Motor Company reserves the right to change or discontinue this product service at any time without prior notification or incurring any future obligation. 324 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 SYNC™ Note: SYNC Services requires activation before use. Visit www.SYNCMyRide.com to register and check your eligibility for complimentary services. Standard phone and message rates may apply. Subscription may be required. You must also have the active SYNC Services Bluetooth-enabled cellular phone paired and connected to the system in order to connect to, and use, SYNC Services. See Using SYNC™ With Your Phone (page 305). Note: When you connect, the service uses GPS technology and advanced vehicle sensors to collect your vehicle's current location, travel direction and speed to help provide you with the directions, traffic reports, or business searches you request. Further, to provide the services you request, for continuous improvement, the service may collect and record call details and voice communications. For more information, see SYNC Services Terms and Conditions at www.SYNCMyRide.com. If you do not want Ford or its service providers to collect your vehicle travel information or other information identified in the Terms and Conditions, do not subscribe or use the service. Note: This feature does not function properly if you have enabled caller ID blocking on your cellular phone. Make sure your cellular phone is not blocking caller ID before using SYNC Services. Note: The driver is ultimately responsible for the safe operation of the vehicle, and therefore, must evaluate whether it is safe to follow the suggested directions. Any navigation features provided are only an aid. Make your driving decisions based on your observations of local conditions and existing traffic regulations. Do not follow the route suggestions if doing so would result in an unsafe or illegal maneuver, place you in an unsafe situation, or if you would be directed into an area that you consider unsafe. Maps used by this system may be inaccurate because of errors, changes in roads, traffic conditions or driving conditions. SYNC Services uses advanced vehicle sensors, integrated GPS technology and comprehensive map and traffic data, to give you personalized traffic reports, precise turn-by-turn directions, business search, news, sports, weather and more. For a complete list of services, or to learn more, please visit www.SYNCMyRide.com. Connecting to SYNC Services Using Voice Commands Press the voice button and when prompted say: Voice command Services Action and Description This initiates an outgoing call to SYNC Services using your paired and connected Bluetooth-enabled cellular phone. Once you connect to the service, follow the voice prompts to request the desired service, for example traffic or directions. You can also say the following: (what are my (options | Receive a list of available services from which to choose. choices) | what can I say | [available] commands) 325 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 SYNC™ Voice command Action and Description Services To return to the Services main menu. Help Receive system help. You can say any of the voice commands that appear within open and close brackets that are separated by |. For example, where (options | choices) appears you say; options or choices. You must say any of the voice commands that appear outside of open and close brackets. For example, where; what are my (options | choices) appears, you must say; what are my, followed by either, options or choices. You do not need to say words that appear within square brackets. For example, for where (what can I say [available] commands) appears, you can say, what can I say commands. Connecting to SYNC Services Using the Phone Menu Press the phone button, then scroll to: Message Services Action and Description 1. Press the OK button. The display indicates the system is connecting. 2. Press the OK button again. SYNC initiates the call to the Services portal. 3. Once you connect to the service, follow the prompts to request the desired service, for example traffic or directions. 326 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 SYNC™ Receiving Turn-by-Turn Directions When connected to SYNC Services, press the voice button and when prompted say: Voice command Action and Description Directions To receive directions to a location. Once you select your destination, the system uploads your current vehicle location, calculates a route based on current traffic conditions and sends it back to your vehicle. After the route download is complete, the phone call automatically ends. You then receive audible and visual driving instructions as you travel toward your destination. Business search To find the closest business or type of business to your current location. Once you select your destination, the system uploads your current vehicle location, calculates a route based on current traffic conditions and sends it back to your vehicle. After the route download is complete, the phone call automatically ends. You then receive audible and visual driving instructions as you travel toward your destination. You can also say the following: Search near me If you need further assistance in finding a location. Operator If you need further assistance in finding a location at any time within a Directions or Business search and need to speak with a live operator. The live operator can assist you by searching for businesses by name or by category, residential addresses by street address or by name or specific street intersections. The system may prompt you to speak with an operator when it has difficulty matching your voice request. Operator Assist is a feature of your SYNC Services subscription. For more information on Operator Assist, visit www.SYNCMyRide.com/ support. Yes If you miss a turn, SYNC automatically asks if you want the route updated. Say yes when prompted and the system sends a new route to your vehicle. 327 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 SYNC™ Disconnecting from SYNC Services To disconnect from SYNC services, say: Voice command Goodbye Action and Description From the SYNC Services main menu, or press and hold the phone button on the steering wheel. SYNC Services quick tips SYNC Services quick tips Personalizing You can personalize your Services feature to provide quicker access to your most used or favorite information. You can save address points, for example work or home. You can also save favorite information like sports teams or a news category. You can learn more about personalization by logging onto www.SYNCMyRide.com. Push to interrupt Press the voice button at any time while connected to SYNC Services to interrupt a voice prompt or an audio clip, say your voice command. Portable Your subscription is associated with your Bluetooth-enabled cellular phone number, not your VIN (Vehicle Identification Number). You can pair and connect your phone to any vehicle equipped with SYNC Services and continue enjoying your personalized services. You can even access your account outside your vehicle. Just use the number on your phone's call history. Traffic and Directions features do not function properly but information services and the 411 connect and text message features are available. Note: Android users need to connect the phone to SYNC using Bluetooth. SYNC Mobile Apps Note: For information on available apps, supported smartphone devices and troubleshooting tips please visit the Ford website. The system enables voice and steering wheel control of SYNC AppLink enabled smartphone apps. Once an app is running through AppLink, you can control main features of the app through voice commands and steering wheel controls. Note: You must pair and connect your smartphone to SYNC to access AppLink. Note: iPhone users need to connect the phone to the USB port. 328 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 SYNC™ Note: Make sure you have an active account for the app that you have downloaded. Some apps work automatically with no setup. Other apps want you to configure your personal settings and personalize your experience by creating stations or favorites. We recommend you do this at home or outside of your vehicle. Note: AppLink is not available if your vehicle is equipped with the MyFordTouch system. To Access Using the SYNC Menu Press the Menu button to the SYNC menu and scroll to: Message Action and Description SYNC applications Press the OK button. Mobile Apps Press the OK button and scroll through the list of available applications and select your desired app. Find New Apps Press the OK button to search for new app's. Note: If a SYNC AppLink compatible app cannot be found, make sure the required app is running on the mobile device. You can access various app features from here, for example thumbs up and thumbs down. Accessing an App's Menu Once an app is running through SYNC, press the right arrow button on the steering wheel control to access the app menu. Press the left arrow button on the steering wheel control to exit the app menu. To Access Using Voice Commands Press the voice button and when prompted say: Voice command Mobile Apps Action and Description Say the name of the application after the tone. The app should start. While an app is running through SYNC, you can press the voice button and speak commands specific to the app, for example, Playlist Road Trip. You can also say the following: Help To discover the available voice commands. 329 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 SYNC™ SYNC Mobile App Voice Commands The following voice commands are always available: Voice command Action and Description Mobile Apps SYNC prompts you to say the name of an app to start it on SYNC. List mobile apps SYNC lists all of the currently available mobile apps. Find New Apps SYNC searches your connected mobile device for SYNCcompatible mobile apps. At any time you can say the name of a mobile app to start the mobile app on SYNC. help SYNC lists the available voice commands for the specified app if the app is running on SYNC. • App Permissions App permissions are organized by groups. You can grant these group permissions individually. You can change a permission group status any time when not driving, by using the settings menu. • When you launch an app using SYNC, the system may ask you to grant certain permissions, for example: • To allow your vehicle to provide vehicle information to the app such as, but not limited to: Fuel level, fuel economy, fuel consumption, engine speed, rain sensor, odometer, VIN, external temperature, gear position, tire pressure, and head lamp status. • To allow your vehicle to provide driving characteristic information such as, but not limited to: MyKey, seat belt status, engine revolutions per minute, gear position, braking events, steering wheel angle, and accelerator pedal position. Note: You only need to grant permissions the first time you use an app with SYNC. Note: Ford is not responsible or liable for any damages or loss of privacy relating to usage of an app, or dissemination of any vehicle data that you approve Ford to provide to an app. 330 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 To allow your vehicle to provide location information, including: GPS and speed. To allow the app to send push notifications using the vehicle display and voice capabilities while running in a background state. Push notifications may be particularly useful for news or location based apps. SYNC™ Enabling and Disabling App Permissions Using the SYNC Menu Press the Menu button to the SYNC menu and scroll to: Message Action and Description SYNC applications Press the OK button. Mobile Apps Press the OK button. App Settings Select the specific app and press the OK button. All Apps If push notifications are supported, this setting is listed. Select to enable or disable the feature as required. Note: You must enable mobile apps for each connected device the first time you select a mobile app using the system. Enabling SYNC Mobile Apps In order to enable mobile apps, SYNC requires user consent to send and receive app authorization information and updates using the data plan associated with the connected device. Note: Standard data rates apply. Ford is not responsible for any additional charges you may receive from your service provider, when your vehicle sends or receives data through the connected device. This includes any additional charges incurred due to driving in areas when roaming out of a home network. Data is sent to Ford in the United States through the connected device. The information is encrypted and includes your VIN, SYNC module number, anonymous usage statistics and debugging information. Updates may take place automatically. App Status You can view the current status of an app in the settings menu. There are three possible statuses: Message Action and Description Update Needed The system has detected a new app requiring authorization or a general permissions update is required. Up-To-Date No update is required. Updating... The system is trying to receive an update. Request Update If an update is required and you want to request it update manually, for example when in a Wi-Fi hotspot. Disable Updates You can disable automatic updates in the settings menu. Doing so also disables the use of Mobile Apps on SYNC. 331 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 SYNC™ Connecting Your Digital Media Player to the USB Port USING SYNC™ WITH YOUR MEDIA PLAYER Note: If your digital media player has a power switch, make sure you switch it on before plugging it in. You can access and play music from your digital music player over your vehicle's speaker system using the system's media menu or voice commands. You can also sort and play your music by specific categories, for example artist and album. To Connect Using Voice Commands Plug the device into the USB port. See USB Port (page 297). Note: The system is capable of indexing up to 6,000 songs. SYNC is capable of hosting nearly any digital media player including: iPod®, Zune™, plays from device players, and most USB drives. SYNC also supports the following audio formats MP3, WMA, WAV and ACC. E142599 Press the voice button and when prompted say: Voice command Action and Description (USB [stick] | iPod | MP3 You can now play music by saying any of the appropriate [player]) voice commands. See Media voice commands. You do not need to say words that appear within square brackets. For example, for where (USB [stick] | iPOD | MP3 [player]) appears, you can say USB or USB stick. To Connect Using the System Menu Plug the device into the USB port. See USB Port (page 297). Press the AUX button, then scroll to: Message Action and Description Menu Press the OK button to enter the media menu. Browse device Press the OK button. USB Press the OK button. Depending on how many digital media files are on your connected device, the following message may appear in the radio display. When indexing is complete, the screen returns to the Play menu. Indexing… 332 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 SYNC™ Message Action and Description Select one of the following: Play all Artist Albums Genres Playlists Tracks Browse USB Similar music Return Exit the current menu. What's Playing? When a track is playing, you can ask the system to tell you what is currently playing. Press the voice button and when prompted say: Voice command Action and Description ((who's | who is) this | The system reads the metadata tags of the playing track, who plays this | (what's and if the metadata tags are populated, the system will tell | what is) playing [now] you what track is playing. | (what | which) (song | track | artist) is this | (who's | who is) playing | (what's | what is) this) You can say any of the voice commands that appear within open and close brackets that are separated by |. For example, where; (what's | what is) appears you say; what's or what is. You must say any of the voice commands that appear outside of open and close brackets. For example, where; who plays this (what's | what is) playing, you must say; who plays this (what's or what is) playing. 333 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 SYNC™ Media Voice Commands Voice command Press the voice button and when prompted say any of the following: Voice command Refine song 1,2 Refine track 1,2 (USB [stick] | iPod | MP3 [player]) repeat (track | song) [on] Autoplay Off repeat off Autoplay [on] (browse | search | show) album [Phone] Connections | [Media] Connections | [Bluetooth] Connections (browse | search | show) all (artist | artists) pause (browse | search | show) all (genre | genres) play play [album] [by [artist]] (browse | search | show) all (song | songs | title | titles | file | files | track | tracks) 1,2 Play all play [artist] 1,2 play [genre] 1,2 [Play] Next Folder 3 1,2 1,2 1,2 1,2 shuffle [all] [on] shuffle off [play] (similar music | more like this) ((who's | who is) this | who plays this | (what's | what is) playing [now] | (what | which) (song | track | artist) is this | (who's | who is) playing | (what's | what is) this) [play] next track play [playlist] 1,2 [Play] Previous Folder 3 1 1,2 2 is a dynamic listing, meaning that it could be the name of anything, such as a group, artist or song. [play] previous track play [song | track | title | file] Refine album Refine artist This voice command is not available until indexing is complete. 1,2 3 This voice command is only available in folder mode. 1,2 334 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 SYNC™ Voice Command Guide Voice command Autoplay Action and Description Turn autoplay on to listen to music processed during indexing. Turn autoplay off to allow the indexing process to finish * before the system plays any of your music. (browse | search | show) The system searches all the data from your indexed music and, if available, begins to play the chosen type of music. You all (genre | genres) can only play genres of music that are present in the GENRE play [genre] metadata tags that you have on your digital media player. [play] (similar music | more like this) The system compiles a playlist and then plays music similar to what is currently playing from the USB port using indexed metadata information. (browse | search | show) The system searches for specific artist information from the all (artist | artists) music indexed through the USB port. (browse | search | show) The system searches for specific track information from the all (song | songs | title | music indexed through the USB port. titles | file | files | track | tracks) (browse | search | show) The system searches for specific album information from the album music indexed through the USB port. play [artist] The system searches for specific artist information from the music indexed through the USB port. play [song | track | title | file] The system searches for specific track information from the music indexed through the USB port. play [album] [by [artist]] The system searches for specific album information from the music indexed through the USB port. Refine This allows you to make your previous command more specific. For example, if you asked to search and play all music by a certain artist, you could then say, refine album and choose a specific album from the list to view. If you then select Play, the system only plays music from that specific album. * Indexing times can vary from device to device and with regard to the number of songs the system needs to process. 335 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 SYNC™ Bluetooth Audio Command Guide Voice command Press the voice button and when prompted say any of the following: [play] next track [play] previous track Voice command Media Menu Features [Phone] Connections | [Media] Connections | [Bluetooth] Connections The media menu allows you to select your media source, how to play your music, for example by artist, genre, shuffle or repeat, and to add, connect or delete devices. pause play Press the AUX button, then scroll to: Message Menu Action and Description Press the OK button to enter the media menu. Select one of the following: Menu Play your music by artist, album, genre, playlist, track, similar music or play all music. You can also choose to Explore USB to view the supported digital music files on your playing device. Browse device Select and play music from your USB port, auxiliary input jack or stream music from your Bluetooth-enabled cell phone. Select one of the following: USB Press the OK button to access music plugged into your USB port. You can also plug in devices to charge them (if supported by your device). Once connected, the system indexes any readable media files. Bluetooth audio Line In 1 Press the OK button. This is a phone-dependent feature that allows you to stream music playing on your Bluetoothenabled phone. If supported by your device, you can press seek to play the previous or next track. Press the OK button to select and play music from your 2 portable music player over your vehicle's speakers. Media Player Settings Choose to shuffle or repeat your music and select your Autoplay settings. Once you turn these selections on, they remain on until you turn them off. Press SEEK to play the previous or next track. 336 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 3 SYNC™ Message Action and Description Select one of the following: Shuffle Press the OK button to shuffle available media files in the current playlist. To shuffle all media tracks, you must select Play All in the play menu and then select Shuffle. Repeat Press the OK button to repeat any song. Autoplay Press the OK button to turn autoplay on to listen to music processed during indexing. Turn autoplay off to allow the indexing process to finish before the system plays any of your music. 4 Mobile Apps Interact with SYNC-capable mobile applications on your smartphone. Settings Access available Bluetooth Device menu listings as well as Advanced menu listings. Exit Press OK to exit the media menu. 1 The time required to complete this depends on the size of the media the system needs to index. If autoplay is on, you can listen to media processed during indexing. If autoplay is off, you cannot listen to music until the system finishes indexing media. SYNC is capable of indexing thousands of average size media and notifies you if it reaches the maximum indexing file size. 2 If you have already connected a device to the USB port, you cannot access the line in feature. Some digital media players require both USB and line in ports to stream data and music separately. 3 Some digital media players require both USB and line in ports to stream data and music separately 4 Indexing times can vary from device to device and with regard to the number of songs the system needs to process. If there are no media files to access, the display indicates there is no media. If there are media files, you have the following options: Accessing Your Play Menu This menu allows you to select and play your media by artist, album, genre, playlist, track, similar music or even to explore what is on your USB device. Note: If your digital media player has a power switch, make sure you switch it on before plugging it in. 337 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 SYNC™ Press the AUX button, then scroll to: Message Menu Action and Description Press the OK button to enter the media menu. Select one of the following: Play all Press the OK button. The first track title appears in the display. Play all indexed media (tracks) from your playing device in flat file mode, one at a time in numerical order. Artist Sort all indexed media by artist. Once selected, the system lists and then play all artists and tracks alphabetically. If there are fewer than 255 indexed artists, the system lists them alphabetically in flat file mode. If there are more than 255, the system categorizes them alphabetically. 1. Press the OK button. You can select to play all artists or any indexed artist. 2. Scroll to choose the desired artist. Press the OK button. Albums Sort all indexed media by albums. If there are fewer than 255 indexed albums, the system lists them alphabetically in flat file mode. If there are more than 255, the system categorizes them alphabetically. Press the OK button. You can enter the album menu and select from playing all albums or from any individual indexed album. 2. Scroll to choose the desired album. Press the OK button. 1. Genres Sort indexed music by genre (category) type. SYNC lists the genres alphabetically in flat file mode. If there are more than 255, the system categorizes them alphabetically. 1. Press the OK button. 2. Scroll to select the desired genre. Press the OK button. Playlists Access your playlists from formats ASX, M3U, WPL or MTP. The system lists your playlists alphabetically in flat-file mode. If there are more than 255, the system categorizes them alphabetically. 1. Press the OK button. 2. Scroll to select the desired playlist. Press the OK button. 338 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 SYNC™ Message Tracks Action and Description Search for and play a specific indexed track. SYNC lists your tracks alphabetically in flat file mode. If there are more than 255, the system categorizes them alphabetically. 1. Press the OK button. 2. Scroll to select the desired track. Press the OK button. Explore USB Explore all supported digital media on your media device connected to the USB port. You can only view media content which is compatible with SYNC; other files saved are not visible. 1. Press the OK button. 2. Scroll to explore indexed media on your flash drive. Similar Music Play music similar to what is currently playing from the USB port. The system uses the metadata information of each song * to compile a playlist for you. 1. Press the OK button. 2. The system creates a new list of similar songs and begins playing. This feature does not include tracks with incomplete metadata information. Press the OK button. Return Exit the current menu. * With certain playing devices, if your metadata tags are not populated, the tracks are not available in voice recognition, play menu or similar music. However, if you place these tracks onto your playing device in "Mass Storage Device Mode", they are available in voice recognition, play menu browsing and similar music. The system places Unknown items into any unpopulated metadata tag. System Settings Bluetooth Devices The Bluetooth Devices menu allows you to add, connect and delete a device as turn the Bluetooth feature on and off. 339 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 SYNC™ Press the AUX button, then scroll to: Message Action and Description Menu Press the OK button to enter the media menu. Settings Press the OK button. Bluetooth Devices Press the OK button. Select one of the following: Add Device Pair more devices to the system. * 1. Press the OK button. When find SYNC appears in the display, press the OK button again. 2. Follow the directions in your phone's manual to put your phone into discovery mode. A six-digit PIN appears in the display. 3. When prompted on your phone's six-digit display, enter the PIN. Connect Bluetooth Device Connect a previously paired Bluetooth-enabled device. Bluetooth On and Off Turn the Bluetooth feature on and off. 1. Press the OK button to select and view a list of previously paired devices. 2. Scroll until you find the desired device, and then press OK to connect the device. ** 1. Press the OK button and scroll to toggle between on and off. 2. Make a selection, press the OK button. DEL DEVICE Delete a paired media device. 1. Press the OK button and scroll to select the device. 2. Press the OK button to confirm. Delete All Devices Delete all previously paired devices. 340 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 SYNC™ Message Action and Description 1. Press the OK button. 2. Press the OK button to confirm. Return Exit the current menu. * This is a speed-dependent feature. It is only available when your vehicle is traveling at 3 mph (5 km/h) or less. ** Setting Bluetooth to off disconnects all Bluetooth devices and turns off all Bluetooth features. Advanced The Advanced menu allows you to access and set prompts, languages, defaults and perform a master reset. Message Action and Description Menu Press the OK button to enter the media menu. Settings Press the OK button. Advanced Press the OK button. Select one of the following: Confirmation Prompts Have SYNC guide you by asking questions, helpful hints or ask you for a specific action. 1. Press the OK button and scroll to toggle between on and off. 2. Make a selection, press the OK button. SYNC takes you back to the Advanced menu. Language Choose from the available languages. The displays and prompts are in the selected language. Press the OK button and scroll through the available languages. 2. Press the OK button when the desired language appears in the display. 3. If you change the language setting, the display indicates that the system is updating. When complete, SYNC takes you back to the Advanced menu. 1. 341 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 SYNC™ Message Factory Defaults Action and Description Return to the factory default settings. This selection does not erase your indexed information, for example phonebook, call history, text messages and paired devices. 1. Press the OK button. 2. Press the OK button. When restore defaults appears in the display, press the OK button again to confirm. Master reset Completely erase all information stored on SYNC. All phonebook, call history, text messages and all paired devices will be deleted and the system will return to the factory default settings. Application Download available software applications through the USB port. Return Exit the current menu. Use the website at any time to check your phone's compatibility, register your account and set preferences as well as access a customer representative via an online chat (during certain hours). Visit www.SYNCMyRide.com, www.SYNCMyRide.ca or www.syncmaroute.ca for more information. SYNC™ TROUBLESHOOTING Your SYNC system is easy to use. However, should questions arise, see the tables below. Phone issues Issue Possible cause(s) Possible solution(s) There is excessive backThe audio control settings ground noise during a phone on your phone may be call. affecting SYNC performance. Review your phone's manual about audio adjustments. During a call, I can hear the other person but they cannot hear me. This may be a possible phone malfunction. Try turning off the device, resetting the device, removing the device's battery, then trying again. SYNC is not able to download my phonebook. This is a phone-dependent feature. Go to the website to review your phone's compatibility. 342 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 SYNC™ Phone issues Issue Possible cause(s) This may be a possible phone malfunction. Possible solution(s) Try turning off the device, resetting the device or removing the device's battery, then trying again. Try pushing your phonebook contacts to SYNC by using the Add Contacts feature. Use the SYNCmyphone feature available on the website. The system says Phonebook This may be a limitation on Downloaded but the your phone's capability. phonebook in SYNC is empty or missing contacts. Try pushing your phonebook contacts to SYNC by using the Add Contacts feature. If the missing contacts are stored on your SIM card, try moving them to the device memory. Remove any pictures or special ring tones associated with the missing contact. Depending upon your phone, you may have to grant SYNC permission to access your phonebook contacts. Make sure to confirm when prompted by your phone during the phonebook download. I am having trouble connecting my phone to SYNC. Go to the website to review your phone's compatibility. Try turning off the device, resetting the device or removing the device's battery, then trying again. Try deleting your device from SYNC, deleting SYNC from your device and trying again. This is a phone-dependent feature. This may be a possible phone malfunction. 343 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 SYNC™ Phone issues Issue Possible cause(s) Possible solution(s) Check the security and auto accept and prompt always settings relative to the SYNC Bluetooth connection on your phone. Update your device's firmware. Turn off the Auto phonebook download setting. Text messaging is not working on SYNC. This is a phone-dependent feature. This may be a possible phone malfunction. Go to the website to review your phone's compatibility. Try turning off the device, resetting the device or removing the device's battery, then trying again. USB and media issues Issue I am having trouble connecting my device. Possible cause(s) This may be a possible device malfunction. 344 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Possible solution(s) Try turning off the device, resetting the device, removing the device's battery, then trying again. Make sure you are using the manufacturer's cable. Make sure you insert the USB cable correctly into the device and the USB port. SYNC™ USB and media issues Issue Possible cause(s) Possible solution(s) Make sure that the device does not have an autoinstall program or active security settings. SYNC does not recognize This is a device limitation. my device when I turn on the car. Make sure you are not leaving the device in your vehicle during very hot or cold temperatures. Bluetooth audio does not stream. This is a phone-dependent Review the device compatibility chart on the SYNC feature. The device is not connected. website to confirm your phone supports the Bluetooth audio streaming function. Make sure you correctly connect the device to SYNC, and that you have pressed play on your device. SYNC does not recognize music that is on my device. Your music files may not contain the correct artist, song title, album or genre information. The file may be corrupted. The song may have copyright protection, which does not allow it to play. Make sure that all song details are populated. Some devices require you to change the USB settings from mass storage to MTP class. Vehicle Health Report and Services (Traffic, Directions and Information) issues Issue I received a text that I did not activate Vehicle Health Report. Possible cause(s) You did not activate your account on the website. You may have the wrong VIN (vehicle identification number) listed. 345 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Possible solution(s) This is a free feature, but you must first register online to use it. SYNC™ Vehicle Health Report and Services (Traffic, Directions and Information) issues Issue Possible cause(s) Possible solution(s) Make sure that your VIN is correctly listed in your account. I am unable to retrieve the report on the website, or I receive a system error. The preferred dealer information did not load correctly. When you register your account, you must choose a preferred dealer. If it already lists a dealer, try selecting another dealer and logging out. Log back in, change it back to your preferred dealer, and retrieve the report. I am unable to submit a report. This could be due to your phone's compatibility. Bad signal strength. You did not register your phone correctly on the website. Update your cellular number in your account on the website. Make sure you have full signal strength and that your Bluetooth volume level has been turned up. Make sure the currently connected phone is registered on your SYNCMyRide account. Try deleting your phone and performing a clean pairing. I heard a commercial when I tried to use Traffic, Directions and Information. You did not activate this phone for this service. Your phone has ID blocker active. This is a free feature, but you must first register online to use it. Turn off ID blocker on your phone as the system recognizes you by your phone number. Make sure the currently connected phone is the same one that is registered on your SYNCMyRide account. 346 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 SYNC™ Voice command issues Issue Possible cause(s) Possible solution(s) SYNC does not understand You may be using the wrong voice commands. what I am saying. You may be speaking too soon or at the wrong time. Review the phone voice commands and the media voice commands at the beginning of their respective sections. After pressing the voice icon, wait until after the tone sounds and Listening appears before saying a command. Any command spoken before this does not register with the system. SYNC does not understand You may be using the wrong the name of a song or artist. voice commands. You may be saying the name differently than the way you saved it. The system may not be reading the name the same way you are saying it. Review the media voice commands at the beginning of the media section. Say the song or artist exactly as listed. If you say "Play Artist Prince", the system does not play music by Prince and the Revolution or Prince and the New Power Generation. Make sure you are saying the complete title, such as "California remix featuring Jennifer Nettles". If the song titles are in all CAPS, you have to spell them. LOLA requires you to say "L-O-L-A". Do not use special characters in the title. The system does not recognize them. SYNC does not understand or is calling the wrong contact when I want to make a call. You may be using the wrong Review the Phone voice voice commands. commands at the beginning You may be saying the of the phone section. name differently than the way you saved it. 347 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 SYNC™ Voice command issues Issue Possible cause(s) Possible solution(s) The system may not be reading the name the same way you are saying it. Contacts in your phonebook may be very short and similar, or they may contain special characters. Your phonebook contacts may be in CAPS. Make sure you are saying the contacts exactly as they are listed. For example, if you save a contact as Joe Wilson, say "Call Joe Wilson". Using the SYNC phone menu, open the phonebook and scroll to the name SYNC is having trouble understanding. SYNC will read the name to you, giving you some idea of the pronunciation SYNC is expecting. The system works better if you list full names, such as "Joe Wilson" rather than "Joe". Do not use special characters, such as 123 or ICE, as the system does not recognize them. If a contact is in CAPS, you have to spell it. JAKE requires you to say "Call JA-K-E". 348 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 MyFord Touch™ GENERAL INFORMATION WARNING Driving while distracted can result in loss of vehicle control, crash and injury. We strongly recommend that you use extreme caution when using any device that may take your focus off the road. Your primary responsibility is the safe operation of your vehicle. We recommend against the use of any hand-held device while driving and encourage the use of voice-operated systems when possible. Make sure you are aware of all applicable local laws that may affect the use of electronic devices while driving. E162500 Item This system uses a four-corner strategy to provide quick access to several vehicle features and settings. The touchscreen provides easy interaction with your cell phone, entertainment, information and system settings. The corners display active modes within the menus, for example; your cell phone's status. Message A Phone B Navigation C Settings D Home E Information F Entertainment Note: Some features are not available while your vehicle is moving. Note: You can access the entertainment features for 30 minutes after you switch the ignition off, and no doors are opened. 349 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 MyFord Touch™ PHONE Press to select any of the following: Press to select any of the following: Message Message Clock Phone Display Quick Dial Sound Phonebook Vehicle History Settings Messaging Help Settings HOME NAVIGATION Press to access the home screen. Press to select any of the following: E142613 Previous Destinations Note: Depending on your vehicle’s option package and software, the screens may vary in appearance from the descriptions in this section. The features may also be limited depending on the market. Check with an authorized dealer for availability. Point of Interest INFORMATION Message My Home Favorites Emergency Street Address E142608 Intersection Press to select any of the following: City Center Message Map Services Edit Route Travel Link Cancel Route Alerts Calendar SETTINGS Apps E142607 350 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 MyFord Touch™ ENTERTAINMENT Message Press to select any of the following: CD Message USB AM BT Stereo FM SD Card SIRIUS Line In Using the Audio Controls Depending on your vehicle, it may also have the following controls: Message Action and Description Power Switch the media features on or off. Vol: Adjust the volume of playing media. Seek Use as you normally would in media modes. Tune Use as you normally would in media modes. Eject Eject a CD from the entertainment system. Display Press this button to switch the display screen off. Press again, or touch the screen to switch the display screen on. Source Touch the control repeatedly to switch between media modes. Sound Adjust the settings for: • Bass • Treble • Midrange • Balance • Fade • DSP (Digital Signal Processing) • Occupancy Mode • Speed Compensated Volume. 351 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 MyFord Touch™ Using the Steering Wheel Controls Depending on your vehicle, it may also have the following controls: Control Action and Description VOL Adjust the volume of playing media. Seek Use as you normally would in media modes. Voice Press to start a voice session. Press again to interrupt a voice prompt and begin speaking. Press and hold to end an active voice session. Seek/call accept Use as you normally would in media and phone modes. Seek/call reject Use as you normally would in media and phone modes. Safety Information Cleaning the Touchscreen Display WARNING Use a dry, clean, soft cloth. If dirt or fingerprints are still visible, apply a small amount of alcohol to the cloth. Do not pour or spray alcohol onto the display. Do not use detergent or any type of solvent to clean the display. The SYNC support team is available: • Monday-Saturday, 8:30am-8:00pm EST. • United States: 1-888-270-1055 • Canada: 1-800-565-3673 Driving while distracted can result in loss of vehicle control, crash and injury. We strongly recommend that you use extreme caution when using any device that may take your focus off the road. Your primary responsibility is the safe operation of your vehicle. We recommend against the use of any hand-held device while driving and encourage the use of voice-operated systems when possible. Make sure you are aware of all applicable local laws that may affect the use of electronic devices while driving. Note: Times are subject to change due to holidays. • Support • 352 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Do not attempt to service or repair the system. Have your vehicle checked by an authorized dealer. Do not operate media devices if the power cables are broken or damaged. MyFord Touch™ • • Speed-restricted Features Make sure the power cables do not interfere with the safe operation of your vehicle's controls or affect your safe driving abilities. Some SYNC functions are speed-dependent. Their use is limited to when your vehicle is traveling at speeds below 3 mph (5 km/h). Some features of this system are restricted from use unless your vehicle is stationary. • Screens crowded with information, for example: • Point of Interest reviews and ratings • SIRIUS Travel Link sports scores • Movie times • Ski conditions. • Any action that requires keyboard use, for example: entering a navigation destination or editing information. • All lists are limited, for example: phone contacts. Make sure that you review your device's manual before using it with SYNC. See the following chart for more specific examples. Speed-restricted Features Cell phone Pairing a cell phone Adding or editing phonebook contacts Phone contacts and recent phone call entries System Functionality Enabling Valet Mode Editing settings while the rear view camera or active park assist are active Wi-Fi and Wireless Editing wireless settings Editing the list of wireless networks Photos and Graphics Adding or editing wallpaper Text Messages Composing text messages Viewing received text messages Editing preset text messages Navigation Using the keyboard to enter a destination Demo navigation route Adding or editing Address Book or Avoid Area entries 353 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 MyFord Touch™ Privacy Information Using Voice Commands When you connect a cell phone to SYNC, the system creates a profile within your vehicle that links to that cell phone. This profile helps in offering you more cellular features and operating more efficiently. Among other things, this profile may contain data about your cell phone book, text messages (read and unread), and call history, including history of calls when your cell phone was not connected to the system. In addition, if you connect a media device, the system creates and retains an index of supported media content. The system also records a short development log of approximately 10 minutes of all recent system activity. The log profile and other system data may be used to improve the system and help diagnose any problems that may occur. This system helps you control many features using voice commands. This allows you to keep your hands on the wheel and focus on what is in front of you. The system provides feedback through audible tones, prompts, questions and spoken confirmations depending on the situation and the chosen level of interaction (voice settings). The cellular profile, media device index, and development log remain in your vehicle unless you delete them, and are generally accessible only in your vehicle when your cell phone or media player is connected. If you no longer plan to use the system or your vehicle, we recommend you carry out a Master Reset to erase all stored information. How to Use Voice Commands The system also asks short questions (confirmation prompts) when it is not sure of your request or when there are multiple possible responses to your request. When using voice commands, words and icons may appear in the lower left status bar indicating the status of the voice command session (such as Listening, Success, Failed, Paused or Try Again). E142599 Press the voice button and when prompted say: Voice command System data cannot be accessed without special equipment and access to your vehicle's SYNC module. Ford Motor Company and Ford of Canada do not access the system data for any purpose other than as described without consent, a court order, or where required by law enforcement, other government authorities, or other third parties acting with lawful authority. Other parties may seek to access the information independently of Ford Motor Company and Ford of Canada. For further privacy information, see the sections on 911 Assist®, Vehicle Health Report, and Traffic, Directions and Information. main menu List of commands (what are my (options | choices) | what can I say | [available] commands) Next page Previous page Go back 354 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 The following voice commands can be said at any time during a voice command session. MyFord Touch™ You can say any of the voice commands that appear within open and close brackets that are separated by |. For example, where (cancel | stop | exit) appears you say; cancel or stop or exit. Voice command (cancel | stop | exit) [main menu] help You must say any of the voice commands that appear outside of open and close brackets. For example, what are my (options | choices) appears, you must say; what are my, followed by either options or choices. You do not need to say words that appear within square brackets. For example, for what can I say [available] commands appears, you can say what can I say commands. What Can I Say? During a voice command session, press the help icon ? in the lower left status bar of the screen, and when prompted say one of the following: Voice command Action and Description (what are my (options | This will provide an on-screen listing of the possible voice choices) | what can I say commands associated with your current voice command | [available] commands) session. voice settings help This will provide a spoken listing of the possible voice commands associated with your current voice command session. Helpful Hints • • • • Make sure the interior of your vehicle is as quiet as possible. Wind noise from open windows and road vibrations may prevent the system from correctly recognizing spoken voice commands. After pressing the voice command icon, wait until after the tone sounds and Listening appears before saying a voice command. Any voice command spoken prior to this will not register with the system. Accessing a List of Available Voice Commands To access a list of available voice commands you can do either of the following. 355 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Speak naturally, without long pauses between words. At any time, you can interrupt the system while it is speaking by pressing the voice command icon. MyFord Touch™ Voice Command Settings Using the touchscreen, press: These allow you to customize the level of system interaction, help and feedback. The system defaults to standard interaction that uses candidate lists and confirmation prompts as these provide the highest level of guidance and feedback. Message Settings Help Voice Command List • Using the steering wheel control, press the voice button and when prompted say one of the following: • Voice Commands Audio list of commands Bluetooth audio list of commands Browse list of commands CD list of commands • List of commands Navigation list of commands * Phone list of commands Interaction Mode: Novice mode provides detailed interaction and guidance. Advanced mode has less audible interaction and more tone prompts. Confirmation Prompts: The system uses these short questions to confirm your voice command. If turned off, the system simply makes a best guess as to what you requested. The system may still occasionally ask you to confirm a voice command. Phone and Media Candidate Lists: Candidate lists are lists of possible results from your voice commands. The system creates these lists when it has the same confidence level of several options based on your voice command. Using the touchscreen, press the settings icon, then press: Radio list of commands SD card list of commands Message Sirius satellite list of commands * Travel link list of commands * Voice settings Voice Control USB list of commands Select from the following: Voice instructions list of commands Interaction Mode Voice settings list of commands Confirmation Prompts voice settings help Media Candidate Lists * Phone Candidate Lists These voice commands are only available when your vehicle is fitted with a navigation system, and the navigation system SD card is in the SD card slot. Voice Control Volume 356 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 MyFord Touch™ Voice command Using the steering wheel control, press the voice button and when prompted say one of the following: media candidate lists on media candidate lists off Voice command voice settings help interaction mode novice Using Voice Commands with the Touchscreen Options interaction mode advanced confirmation prompts on The voice command system has a dual mode feature which allows you to switch between using voice commands and making on-screen selections. This is available only when the system displays a list of candidates generated during a voice command session. For example, when entering a street address or trying to call a contact from a cell phone paired to the system. confirmation prompts off phone candidate lists on phone candidate lists off SETTINGS A B C D E F E161968 357 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 MyFord Touch™ Clock Item Message A Clock B Display C Sound D Vehicle E Settings F Help Under this menu, you can set the clock, access and adjust the display, sound and vehicle settings as well as access settings for specific modes or the help feature. E142607 To make adjustments using the touchscreen, select: Message Action and Description Settings Press the settings icon. Clock Press the + or - to adjust the time. From this screen, you can also make other adjustments such as 12-hour or 24-hour mode, activate GPS time synchronization and have the system automatically update new time zones. You can also turn the outside air temperature display off and on. It appears at the top center of the touchscreen, next to the time and date. Note: You cannot manually set the date. Your vehicle’s GPS does this for you. Note: If the battery has been disconnected, your vehicle needs to acquire a GPS signal to update the clock. Once your vehicle acquires the signal, it may take a few minutes for the update to display the correct time. You can adjust the display using the touchscreen or the voice button on the steering wheel controls. Display E142607 To make adjustments using the touchscreen, select: Message Settings Action and Description Press the settings icon. Display Then select from the following: 358 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 MyFord Touch™ Message Action and Description Brightness Make the screen display brighter or dimmer. Mode Allows you to turn the display off. It also allows you to set the screen to a certain brightness or have the system automatically change based on the outside light level. If you select AUTO or NIGHT, you have the options of turning the display's Auto Dim feature on or off and changing the Auto Dim Manual Offset feature. Edit Wallpaper Allows you to display the default photo or upload your own. Note: Photographs with extremely large dimensions (such as 2048 x 1536) may not be compatible and appear as a blank (black) image on the display. E142599 To make adjustments using the voice button, press the button and when prompted, say: The system allows you to upload and view up to 32 photos. To access, press: Voice command E142607 Display settings Uploading Photos for Your Home Screen Wallpaper Note: You cannot load photos directly from your camera. You must access the photos either from your USB mass storage device or from an SD card. To upload your photos, select: Message Settings Action and Description Press the settings icon. Display Edit Wallpaper Follow the system prompts to upload your photographs. Sound Only the photograph(s), which meets the following conditions will display: • Compatible file formats are as follows: .jpg, .gif, .png, .bmp. • Each file must be 1.5 MB or less. • Recommended dimensions: 800 x 384. E142607 359 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 MyFord Touch™ Vehicle To make adjustments using the touchscreen, select: Message E142607 Settings To make adjustments using the touchscreen, select: Sound Message Then select from the following: Settings Bass Vehicle Midrange Then select from the following: Treble Vehicle Health Set Balance and Fade Rear View Camera Occupancy Mode Enable Valet Mode Speed Compensated Volume DSP Note: Your vehicle may not have all of these sound settings. Vehicle Health Report To make adjustments using the touchscreen, select: Message Settings Action and Description Press the settings icon. Vehicle Vehicle Health Automatic Reminders Turn on and off and set the mileage interval at which you would like to receive the reports. Press the ? for more information on these selections. Run Vehicle Health Report Now To run the vehicle health report immediately. You can find more information on Vehicle Health Report in this chapter. 360 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 MyFord Touch™ Camera Settings This menu allows you to access settings for your rear view camera. E142607 To make adjustments using the touchscreen, select: Message Settings Action and Description Press the settings icon. Vehicle Rear View Camera Camera Settings Then select from the following: Enhanced Park Aids Rear Camera Delay You can find more information on the rear view camera system in another chapter. See Parking Aids (page 143). Note: If the system locks, and you need to reset the PIN, enter 3681 and the system unlocks. Enable Valet Mode Valet mode allows you to lock the system. No information is accessible until the system is unlocked with the correct PIN. E142607 To make adjustments using the touchscreen, select: Message Settings Action and Description Press the settings icon. Vehicle Enable Valet Mode Continue After you press Continue the system locks until you enter the PIN again. System Settings Access and adjust system settings, voice features, as well as phone, navigation and wireless settings. E142607 361 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 MyFord Touch™ To make adjustments using the touchscreen, select: Message Settings Action and Description Press the settings icon. System Then select from the following: Language Select to have the touchscreen display in English, Spanish or French. Distance Select to display units in kilometers or miles. Temperature Select to display units in Celsius or Fahrenheit. System Prompt Volume Adjust the volume of voice prompts from the system. Touch Screen Button Beep Select to have the system beep to confirm choices made through the touchscreen. Keyboard Layout Have the touchscreen keyboard display in QWERTY or ABC format. Install Applications Install any downloaded applications or view the current software licenses. Master reset Select to restore factory defaults. This erases all personal settings and personal data. Voice Control E142607 To make adjustments using the touchscreen, select: Message Action and Description Settings Voice Control Then select from the following: Interaction Mode Standard interaction mode provides more detailed interaction and guidance. Advanced mode has less audible interaction and more tone prompts. 362 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 MyFord Touch™ Message Action and Description Confirmation Prompts Have the system ask you short questions if it has not clearly heard or understood your request. Note: Even with confirmation prompts turned off, the system may occasionally ask you to confirm settings. Media Candidate Lists Candidate lists are possible results from your voice commands. The system simply makes a best guess at your request with these turned off. Phone Candidate Lists Candidate lists are possible results from your voice commands. The system simply makes a best guess at your request with these turned off. Voice Control Volume This allows you to adjust the system’s voice volume level. Media Player E142607 To make adjustments using the touchscreen, select: Message Settings Action and Description Press the settings icon. Media Player Then select from the following: Autoplay When this feature is on, the system automatically switches to the media source upon initial connection. This allows you to listen to music during the indexing process. When this feature is off, the system does not automatically switch to the inserted media source. Bluetooth Devices Select to connect, disconnect, add or delete a device. You can also set a device as your favorite so that the system automatically attempts to connect to that device at every ignition cycle. 363 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 MyFord Touch™ Message Action and Description Gracenote® Database Info This allows you to view the version level of the Gracenote Database. Gracenote® Mgmt With this feature on, the Gracenote Database supplies metadata information for your music files. This overrides information from your device. This feature defaults to off. Cover Art Priority With this feature on, the Gracenote Database supplied cover art for your music files. This overrides any art from your device. This feature defaults to Media Player. Navigation E142607 To make adjustments using the touchscreen, select: Message Settings Action and Description Press the settings icon. Navigation Then select from the following: Phone E142607 To make adjustments using the touchscreen, select: Message Settings Action and Description Press the settings icon. Phone Then select from the following: Bluetooth Devices Connect, disconnect, add or delete a device, as well as save it as a favorite. Bluetooth Turn Bluetooth on and off. 364 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 MyFord Touch™ Message Action and Description Do Not Disturb Have all calls go directly to your voice mail and not ring inside your vehicle. With this feature turned on, text message notifications are also suppressed and do not ring inside your vehicle. 911 Assist Turn on or turn off the 911 Assist feature. See Information (page 395). Phone Ringer Select the type of notification for phone calls - ring tone, beep, text to speech or silent. Text Message Notification Select the type of notification for text messages - alert tone, beep, text to speech, or have it be silent. Internet Data Connection If compatible with your phone, you can adjust your internet data connection. Select to make your connection profile with the personal area network or to turn off your connection. You can also choose to adjust your settings or have the system always connect, never connect when roaming, or query on connect. Press ? for more information. Manage Phonebook Access features, such as automatic phonebook download, re-download your phonebook, add contacts from your phone as well as delete or upload your phonebook. Roaming Warning Have the system alert you when in Roaming mode. feature, everyone in your vehicle can also gain access the internet if you have a USB mobile broadband connection inside your vehicle, your phone supports personal area networking and if you park outside a wireless hotspot. Wireless & Internet Your system has a Wi-Fi feature that creates a wireless network within your vehicle, thereby allowing other devices (such as personal computers or phones) in your vehicle to speak to each other, share files or play games. Using this Wi-Fi E142607 To make adjustments using the touchscreen, select: Message Settings Action and Description Press the settings icon. Wireless & Internet Then select from the following: Wi-Fi Settings Wi-Fi Network (Client) Mode 365 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 MyFord Touch™ Message Action and Description Turns the Wi-Fi feature on and off in your vehicle. Make sure you turn it on for connectivity purposes. Choose a Wireless Network Allows you to use a previously stored wireless network. You can categorize by alphabetical listing, priority and signal strength. You can also choose to search for a network, connect to a network, disconnect from a network, receive more information, prioritize a network or delete a network. Gateway (Access Point) Mode Makes SYNC an access point for a phone or a computer when turned on. This forms the local area network within your vehicle for things, such as game playing, file transfer and internet browsing. Press ? for more information. Gateway (Access Point) Settings Allows you to view and change settings for using SYNC as the internet gateway. Gateway (Access Point) Device List Allows you to view recent connections to your Wi-Fi system. USB Mobile Broadband Instead of using Wi-Fi, your system can also use a USB mobile broadband connection to access the internet. (You must turn on your mobile broadband device on your personal computer before connecting it to the system.) This screen allows you to set up what is your typical area for your USB mobile broadband connection. (USB mobile broadband settings may not display if the device is already on.) You can select the following: Country, Carrier, Phone Number, User Name and Password. Bluetooth Settings Shows you the currently paired devices as well as giving you your typical Bluetooth options to connect, disconnect, set as favorite, delete and add device. Bluetooth is a registered trademark of the Bluetooth SIG. Prioritize Connection Methods Choose your connection methods and change them as needed. You can select to change order and have the system either always attempt to connect using a USB mobile broadband or using Wi-Fi. 366 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 MyFord Touch™ The Wi-Fi CERTIFIED Logo is a certification mark of the Wi-Fi Alliance. Help E142607 E142626 To make adjustments using the touchscreen, select: Message Settings Action and Description Press the settings icon. Help Then select from the following: Where Am I? View your vehicle's current location, if your vehicle is equipped with navigation. If your vehicle is not equipped with navigation, nothing displays. System Information Touchscreen system serial number Your vehicle identification number (VIN) Touchscreen system software version Navigation system version Map database version Sirius satellite radio ESN Gracenote® Database Information and Library version View Software Licenses View the licenses for any software and applications installed on your system. Driving Restrictions Certain features are not accessible when your vehicle is moving. 911 Assist Turn on and turn off the 911 Assist feature. See Information (page 395). 367 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 MyFord Touch™ Message Action and Description In Case of Emergency (ICE) Quick Dial: allows you to save up to two numbers as ICE contacts for quick access if there is an emergency. Select Edit to access your phonebook and then select the desired contacts. The numbers then appear as options on this screen for the ICE 1 and ICE 2 buttons. The ICE contacts you select appear at the end of the 911 Assist call process. Voice Command List View categorized lists of voice commands. You can also access Help using the voice commands. The system provides allowable voice commands for the current mode. Press the voice button and when prompted say: Voice command Help E142599 ENTERTAINMENT A B G C D E H F E161892 368 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 MyFord Touch™ Voice command Message Message and Description A AM 1 and AM AST B FM 1, FM 2 and FM AST C SIRIUS D USB Browse SD card Browse Sirius channel guide ** Browse USB Help * If you only say browse, you can then say any commands in the following chart. E BT Stereo F Touch this button to scroll down for more options, for example SD Card and A/V In G These buttons change with the media mode you are in. H Radio memory presets. ** These commands are only usable if you have an active subscription to SIRIUS satellite radio. Browse Voice command Note: Some features may not be available in your area. Contact an authorized dealer for more information. Games * channels * You can access these options using the touchscreen or voice commands. SD card ** Browsing Device Content Sirius Channel Guide * When listening to audio on a device, you can browse through other devices without having to change sources. For example, if you are currently listening to audio on an SD card, you can browse all the artists that are stored on your USB device. USB ** Help * This command is only usable if you have an active subscription to SIRIUS satellite radio. Browse Within Devices ** For more commands in SD card or USB mode, see the "SD Card and USB Port" section of this chapter. E142599 Press the voice button and when prompted say one of the following: The voice system allows you to change audio sources with a simple voice command. For example, if you are listening to music on a USB device, then want to switch to a satellite radio channel, simply press the voice button on the steering wheel controls and say the name of the Voice command Browse * Browse games ** Browse channels ** 369 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 MyFord Touch™ SIRIUS station (for example, "the Highway"). The following voice commands are available at the top level of the voice session no matter which current audio source you are listening to (for example a USB device or SIRIUS satellite radio). Voice command Sirius <0-223> * Sports games * * This command is only usable if you have an active subscription to SIRIUS satellite radio. Note: This is only available when your MyFord Touch system language is set to North American English. ** The commands that have [ ] around the word means that the word is optional. For example, if you say, "Play Metallica", this is the same as the voice command, "Play [artist] ". Press the voice button and when prompted say any of the following: Voice command <87.9-107.9> AM/FM Radio <530-1710> Touch the AM or FM tab to listen to the radio. * E142611 AM <530-1710> To change between AM and FM presets, just touch the AM or FM tab. FM <87.9-107.9> play [album] [by [artist]] ** play [artist] ** play [genre] ** play [playlist] ** play [song | track | title | file] ** Memory Presets Save a station by pressing and holding one of the memory preset areas. There is a brief mute while the radio saves the station. Sound returns when finished. HD Radio Touch this button to turn HD Radio on. The light on the button illuminates when the feature is on. HD Radio allows you to receive radio broadcasts digitally, where available, providing free, crystal-clear sound. See HD Radio information later in this chapter. Play Play by Scan Touch this button to go to the next strong AM or FM radio station. The light on the button illuminates when the feature is on. 370 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 MyFord Touch™ Options player, the information transfers, if supported by your device. When you are connected to iTunes, the tags appear to remind you of the songs you would like to download. See HD Radio information later in this chapter. Sound Settings Touch this button to adjust settings for: Message Direct Tune Bass Touch this button to manually enter the desired station number. Touch Enter when you are done. Midrange Treble HD Radio™ Information (If Available) Set Balance and Fade Note: HD Radio broadcasts are not available in all markets. DSP HD Radio technology is the digital evolution of analog AM/FM radio. Your system has a special receiver that allows it to receive digital broadcasts (where available) in addition to the analog broadcasts, it already receives. Digital broadcasts provide a better sound quality than analog broadcasts with free, crystal-clear audio and no static or distortion. For more information, and a guide to available stations and programming, please visit www.hdradio.com. Occupancy Mode Speed Compensated Volume Note: Your vehicle may not have all these sound settings. Set PTY for Seek/Scan This allows you to select a category of music you would like to search for. You can then choose to either seek or scan for the stations playing that category. RDS Text Display When HD Radio is on and you tune to a station broadcasting HD Radio technology, you may notice the following indicators on your screen: This allows you to view the information broadcast by FM stations. AST AST (Autostore) allows you to have the system automatically store the six strongest stations in your current location. TAG Button This feature is available when HD Radio is on, and allows you to tag a song to download later. When you select On, TAG appears on-screen when HD Radio is active. You can touch TAG to save the information of the song that is playing. When you plug in your portable music 371 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 MyFord Touch™ on-screen. The multicast indicator appears in FM mode (only) if the current station is broadcasting multiple digital broadcasts. The highlighted numbers signify available digital channels where new or different content is available. HD1 signifies the main programming status and is available in analog and digital broadcasts. Other multicast stations (HD2 through HD7) are only available digitally. E142616 The HD logo either blinks when acquiring a digital station, and then stays solid when digital audio is playing, or is grey when acquiring a digital station, and then changes to orange when digital audio is playing. When this logo is available, you may also see Title and Artist fields TAG allows you to save a song to download later when you are on an acquired HD Radio station and the feature is on. To turn the feature on and use it, select AM or FM and the select: Message Action and Description Options TAG Button On When you hear a song you, select: TAG The system automatically saves the song's information and transfers it to your portable music player (if supported) when you connect it to the system. The system automatically transfers the tag to your player (if already connected) and a pop-up confirms the transfer. When you access iTunes with your portable music player, the tags appear to you as a reminder. The system allows you to tag up to approximately 100 songs. For a list of devices that support tagging, see www.SYNCMyRide.com, www.SYNCMyRide.ca or www.syncmaroute.ca 372 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 MyFord Touch™ When HD Radio broadcasts are active, you can access the following functions: Message Action and Description Scan Allows you to hear a brief sampling of all available stations. This feature still works when HD Radio reception is on, although it does not scan for HD2-HD7 channels. You may see the HD logo appear if the station has a digital broadcast. Memory presets Allows you to save an active channel as a memory preset. Touch and hold a memory preset slot until the sound returns. There is a brief mute while the radio saves the station. Sound returns when finished. When switching to an HD2 or HD3 memory preset, the sound mutes before the digital audio plays, because the system has to reacquire the digital signal. Note: As with any saved radio station, you cannot access the saved station if your vehicle is outside the station’s reception area. HD Radio Reception and Station Troubleshooting Potential reception issues Reception area If you are listening to a multicast station and you are on the fringe of the reception area, the station may mute due to weak signal strength. If you are listening to HD1, the system switches back to the analog broadcast until the digital broadcast is available again. However, if you are listening to any of the possible HD2-HD7 multicast channels, the station mutes and stays muted unless it is able to connect to the digital signal again. Station blending When the system first receives a station (aside from HD2HD7 multicast stations), it first plays the station in the analog version. Once the receiver verifies the station is an HD Radio station, it shifts to the digital version. Depending on the station quality, you may hear a slight sound change when the station changes from analog to digital. Blending is the shift from analog to digital sound or digital back to analog sound. 373 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 MyFord Touch™ In order to provide the best possible experience, use the contact form to report any station issues found while listening to a station broadcasting with HD Radio technology. Independent entities own and operate each station. These stations are responsible for ensuring all audio streams and data fields are accurate. Potential station issues Issues Cause Action Echo, stutter, skip or This is poor time alignment by No action required. This is a repeat in audio. the radio broadcaster. broadcast issue. Increase or decrease in audio volume. Sound fading or blending in and out. The radio is shifting between analog and digital audio. No action required. The reception issue may clear up as you continue to drive. There is an audio mute delay when selecting HD2 or HD3, multicast preset or . The digital multicast is not No action required. This is available until the HD Radio normal behavior. Wait until the broadcast is decoded. Once audio is available. decoded, the audio is available. Direct Tune Cannot access HD2 or HD3 multicast channel when recalling a preset or from a direct tune. The previously stored multicast No action required. The station is not available in your current preset or direct tune is not available in your current recep- location. tion area. Text information does Data service issue by the radio Fill out the station issue form at http://www.ibiquity.com/ not match currently broadcaster. automotive/ playing audio. report_radio_station_experiences There is no text Data service issue by the radio information shown for broadcaster. currently selected frequency. Fill out the station issue form at http://www.ibiquity.com/ automotive/ report_radio_station_experiences HD2-HD7 stations not This selection disables HD2found when you press. HD7 channel search. No action required. This is normal behavior. Scan 374 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 MyFord Touch™ HD Radio Technology manufactured under license from iBiquity Digital Corp. U.S. and foreign patents. HD Radio and the HD and HD Radio logos are proprietary trademarks of iBiquity Digital Corp. Ford Motor Company and iBiquity Digital Corp. are not responsible for the content sent using HD Radio technology. Content may be changed, added or deleted at any time at the station owner's discretion. Voice command FM autoset preset <#> FM preset <#> FM 1 FM 1 preset <#> FM 2 FM 2 preset <#> Radio Voice Commands HD <#> E142599 Preset <#> Press the voice button and when prompted say: Radio off 1 Radio on Voice command Set PTY Radio Tune 3 Then any of the following: Help <87.9-107.9> 1 <<87.9-107.9> HD> 1 If available. 2 If you have said browse, see the Browse chart later in this section. <530-1710> 3 If you have said tune, see the following Tune chart. AM AM <530-1710> Tune AM autoset Voice command AM autoset preset <#> <530-1710> AM preset <#> Browse <87.9-107.9> 2 <87.9-107.9> HD <#> FM AM FM <87.9-107.9> FM <87.9-107.9> HD <#> AM <530-1710> 1 AM autoset FM autoset AM autoset preset <#> 375 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 * MyFord Touch™ Voice command To turn the feature on press the lower left corner of the touchscreen, and then select: AM preset <#> FM * Message FM <87.9-107.9> SIRIUS FM <87.9-107.9> HD <#> Memory Presets FM autoset Save a channel by pressing and holding one of the memory preset areas. There is a brief mute while the radio saves the channel. Sound returns when finished. FM autoset preset <#> FM preset <#> FM 1 ALERT FM 1 preset <#> Save the current song, artist, or team as a favorite. The system alerts you when it plays again on any channel. FM 2 FM 2 preset <#> HD <#> Replay * Replay audio on the current channel. You can replay approximately 45 minutes of audio as long as you have remained tuned to the current station. Changing stations erases the previous audio. Preset <#> Help * If available. While in replay mode: • Press and release the seek buttons to hear the previous or next song. • Press and hold the seek buttons to reverse or fast forward in the current track. • Press play or pause to play or pause the audio. • Press Replay to return to live audio if you have been using the feature to replay audio. SIRIUS® Satellite Radio (If Activated) E142611 Scan Touch this button to hear a brief sampling of channels. 376 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 MyFord Touch™ Options Artist/Title/Team Alerts Touch this button to view and adjust various media settings. This feature allows you to select Artists, Titles and Teams that you would like the system to alert you to when they are playing on other channels. Press Edit Alerts to delete or turn off alerts. You can also set all alerts to on or off. When an alert appears on the screen, you can choose to Tune to the channel, to Cancel the alert or to Disable Alerts. If you are listening to a sporting event, you can save your favorite teams so that the system can alert you when they are playing on a satellite radio channel. Sound Settings Touch this button to adjust settings for: Message Bass Midrange Treble Note: SIRIUS does not support the Alert feature on all channels. Ford Motor Company shall not be responsible for Alert feature variation. Set Balance and Fade DSP Occupancy Mode Electronic Serial Number (ESN) Speed Compensated Volume Note: Your vehicle may not have all these sound settings. SIRIUS requires this number when communicating with you about your account. Set Category for Seek/Scan Direct Tune This allows you to select a category of music you would like to search for. You can then choose to either seek or scan for the stations playing that category. Touch this button to manually enter the desired satellite channel number. Touch Enter when you are done. Browse Parental Lockout Touch this button to view a list of all available stations. Scroll to see more categories. Touch the station you want to listen to. This allows you to lock and unlock channels, change or reset your PIN or unlock all channels. To use this feature, you need your initial PIN, which is 1234. 377 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 MyFord Touch™ You can also select: Message Action and Description Skip Touch this button if you want to skip this channel. Lock Touch this button if you do not want anyone to listen to this channel. Title Touch this button to see song and artists on other stations. Artist Touch this button to see song and artists on other stations. For more information on extended subscription terms (a service fee is required), the online media player and a list of SIRIUS satellite radio channels, and other features, please visit www.siriusxm.com in the United States, www.sirius.ca in Canada, or call SIRIUS at 1-888-539-7474. SIRIUS Satellite Radio Information Note: SIRIUS reserves the unrestricted right to change, rearrange, add or delete programming including canceling, moving or adding particular channels, and its prices, at any time, with or without notice to you. Ford Motor Company shall not be responsible for any such programming changes. Note: This receiver includes the eCos real-time operating system. eCos is published under the eCos License. Satellite Radio Electronic Serial Number (ESN) You need your ESN to activate, modify or track your satellite radio account. The ESN is on the System Information Screen (SR ESN:XXXXXXXXXXXX). E142593 SIRIUS satellite radio is a subscription-based satellite radio service that broadcasts a variety of music, sports, news, weather, traffic and entertainment programming. Your factory-installed SIRIUS satellite radio system includes hardware and a limited subscription term that begins on the date of sale or lease of your vehicle. See an authorized dealer for availability. To access your ESN, touch the bottom left corner of the touchscreen, then select: Message SIRIUS Options 378 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 MyFord Touch™ SIRIUS Satellite Radio Reception Factors and Troubleshooting Potential reception issues Antenna obstructions For optimal reception performance, keep the antenna clear of snow and ice build-up and keep luggage and other materials as far away from the antenna as possible. Terrain Hills, mountains, tall buildings, bridges, tunnels, freeway overpasses, parking garages, dense tree foliage and thunderstorms can interfere with your reception. Station overload When you pass a ground-based broadcast-repeating tower, a stronger signal may overtake a weaker one and the audio system may mute. Satellite radio signal interference Your display may show ACQUIRING... to indicate the interference and the audio system may mute. Troubleshooting tips Message Acquiring… Cause Radio requires more than two seconds to produce audio for the selected channel. Satellite antenna fault There is an internal module or system failure present. SIRIUS system failure Invalid Channel Action No action required. This message should disappear shortly. If this message does not clear shortly, or with an ignition key cycle, your receiver may have a fault. See an authorized dealer for service. The channel is no longer avail- Tune to another channel or able. choose another preset. Unsubscribed Channel Your subscription does not include this channel. Contact SIRIUS at 1-888-5397474 to subscribe to the channel, or tune to another channel. No Signal The signal is lost from the The signal is blocked. When SIRIUS satellite or SIRIUS you move into an open area, tower to your vehicle antenna. the signal should return. Updating… Update of channel programming in progress. 379 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 No action required. The process may take up to three minutes. MyFord Touch™ Troubleshooting tips Message Questions? Call 1-888-539-7474 None found Check Channel Guide Cause Action Your satellite service is no longer available. Contact SIRIUS at 1-888-5397474 to resolve subscription issues. All the channels in the selected Use the channel guide to turn category are either skipped or off the Lock or Skip function on locked. that station. Subscription Updated SIRIUS has updated the chan- No action required. nels available for your vehicle. Voice command SIRIUS Satellite Radio Voice Commands SAT 2 preset <#> If you are listening to SIRIUS satellite radio, press the voice E142599 button on the steering wheel controls. When prompted, say any of the following commands. SAT 3 If you are not listening to SIRIUS satellite radio, press the voice button and, after the tone, say "", then any of the following commands. Sirius off Sports game * Press the voice button and when prompted say: Tune * SAT 3 preset <#> Sirius <0-223> Sirius on Help Voice command * SIRIUS If you have said, sports game, see the following Sports game chart. Then any of the following: ** If you have said, tune, see the following Tune chart. Preset <#> SAT SAT preset <#> SAT 1 SAT 1 preset <#> SAT 2 380 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 MyFord Touch™ Sports Game Voice command Tune to the game Tune to the game Tune to the game Tune to the game E142619 The SD card slot is located either in the center console or behind a small access door in the instrument panel. To access and play music from your device, press the lower left corner of the touchscreen. Help Tune Voice command Preset <#> SAT SAT 1 SAT 1 preset <#> E142620 SAT 2 SD logo is a trademark of SD-3C, LLC. SAT 2 preset <#> USB Port SAT 3 SAT 3 preset <#> Sirius <0-223> Help SD Card Slot and USB Port SD Card Note: Your SD card slot is spring-loaded. To remove the SD card, press the card in and the system ejects it. Do not attempt to pull the card to remove it as this could cause damage. E142621 The USB ports are located either in the center console or behind a small access door in the instrument panel. To access and play music from your device, press the lower left corner of the touchscreen. Note: The navigation system also uses this card slot. See Navigation (page 404). 381 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 MyFord Touch™ This feature allows you to plug in media playing devices, memory sticks, flash drives or thumb drives, and charge devices if they support this feature. Playing Music from Your Device Note: The system is capable of indexing up to 30,000 songs. In order to playback video from your iPod or iPhone, you must have a special combination USB/RCA composite video cable (which you can buy from Apple). When you connect the cable to your iPod or iPhone, plug the other end into both the RCA jacks and the USB port. E142611 Insert your device and select: Message USB SD Card Action and Description Once the system recognizes your USB or SD card you can then select from the following options: Repeat This feature replays the currently playing song or album. Shuffle Touch this button to play music on the selected album or folder in random order. Similar Music This feature allows you to choose music similar to what is currently playing. More Info Touch this button to see disc information, for example current track, artist name, album and genre. Options Touch this button to view and adjust various media settings. Sound Sound settings allows you to adjust settings for: Message Action and Description Bass Midrange Treble Set Balance and Fade DSP Occupancy Mode 382 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 MyFord Touch™ Message Action and Description Speed Compensated Volume Media Player Settings Allows you to select more settings, which is under Media Player. See Settings (page 357). Device Information Displays software and firmware information about the currently connected media device. Update Media Index Indexes your device when you connect it for the first time and each time the content changes (for example adding or removing tracks) to make sure you have the latest voice commands available for all media on the device. Note: Your vehicle may not have all these sound settings. If you want to view song information, for example Title, Artist, File, Folder, Album, and Genre, touch the on-screen album art. Browse This feature allows you to view the contents of the device. It also allows you to search by categories, for example genre, artist or album. You can also select: Message What’s Playing Action and Description To hear how the system pronounces the current band and song. This can be helpful when using voice commands to make sure the system correctly plays your request. Press the voice button and when prompted say: Playing Video from Your Device To access and play video from your device, your vehicle's transmission must be in park (P) with the ignition in accessory mode. See Starting and Stopping the Engine (page 106). Voice command (USB [stick] | iPod | MP3 [player]) SD card USB and SD Card Voice Commands Then any of the following: Browse E142599 [play] next track pause 383 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 * MyFord Touch™ Voice command Voice command play Repeat off play [album] [by [artist]] Repeat one play all shuffle [all] [on] play [artist] Shuffle album Play audiobook shuffle off Play author What's this? Play composer Help * Play folder If you have said you would like to browse your USB or SD card, the system prompts you to specify what you would like to browse. See the following Browse chart. play [genre] Play movie * Play music video * ** These commands are only available in USB mode and are device-dependent. play [playlist] Browse Play podcast Voice command Play podcast episode Album [play] (similar music | more like this) All albums All artists play [song | track | title | file] Play TV show All audiobooks * All authors Play TV show episode "" Play video podcast "" Play video podcast episode "" Play video playlist "" ** All composers All folders ** All genres ** All movies * All movies * [play] previous track All music videos * repeat [all | folder | track | song] off All playlists ** All podcasts 384 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 MyFord Touch™ It is also able to organize your indexed media from your playing device by metadata tags. Metadata tags, which are descriptive software identifiers embedded in the media files, provide information about the file. Voice command All songs All TV shows * All video playlists * All video podcasts * All videos * If your indexed media files contain no information embedded in these metadata tags, SYNC may classify the empty metadata tags as unknown. Composer In order to playback video from your iPod or iPhone, you must have a special combination USB/RCA composite video cable (which you can buy from Apple). When you connect the cable to your iPod or iPhone, plug the other end into both the RCA jacks and the USB port. Folder Bluetooth Audio Genre The system allows you to stream audio over your vehicle's speakers from your connected, Bluetooth-enabled cell phone. Artist Audiobook Author Playlist Podcast TV show * Video * Video playlist * Video podcast * E142611 To access, press the lower left corner on the touchscreen, then select: Message BT Stereo Help Bluetooth Audio Voice Commands * This command is only available in USB mode and is device-dependent. E142599 Supported Media Players, Formats and Metadata Information SYNC is capable of hosting nearly any digital media player, including iPod, Zune™, plays from device players, and most USB drives. Supported audio formats include MP3, WMA, WAV and AAC. 385 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 MyFord Touch™ Press the voice button and when prompted say: Voice command Next song play pause [play] previous track E142622 The A/V inputs allow you to connect an auxiliary audio/video source (for example gaming systems or a personal camcorder) by connecting RCA cords (not included) to these input jacks. The jacks are yellow, red and white and are located either behind a small access door on the instrument panel or in your center console. A/V Inputs WARNINGS Driving while distracted can result in loss of vehicle control, crash and injury. We strongly recommend that you use extreme caution when using any device that may take your focus off the road. Your primary responsibility is the safe operation of your vehicle. We recommend against the use of any handheld device while driving and encourage the use of voice-operated systems when possible. Make sure you are aware of all applicable local laws that may affect the use of electronic devices while driving. You can also use the A/V inputs as an auxiliary input jack to play music from your portable music player over your vehicle's speakers. Plug in your 1/8 inch (3.5 millimeter) RCA adapter into the two left A/V input jacks (red and white). Press the lower left corner of the touchscreen, and then select A/V In. For safety reasons, do not connect or adjust the settings on your portable music player while your vehicle is moving. To use the auxiliary input jack feature, make sure that your portable music player is designed for use with headphones and that it is fully charged. You also need an audio extension cable with stereo male 1/8-inch (3.5 millimeter) connectors at one end and a RCA jack at the other. Store the portable music player in a secure location, for example the center console or the glove box, when your vehicle is moving. Hard objects may become projectiles in a crash or sudden stop, which may increase the risk of serious injury. The audio extension cable must be long enough to allow the portable music player to be safely stored while your vehicle is moving. 1. Switch off the engine, radio and portable music player. Set the parking brake and put the transmission in park (P). 2. Attach one end of the audio extension cable to the headphone output of your player and the other end into the adapter in one of the two left A/V input jacks (white or red) inside the center console. 386 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 MyFord Touch™ Troubleshooting 3. Press the lower left corner on the touchscreen. Select a tuned FM station. 4. Adjust the volume as desired. 5. Turn the portable music player on and adjust the volume to ½ the maximum. 6. Press the lower left corner on the touchscreen. Select the A/V In tab. (You should hear audio from your portable music player although it may be low.) 7. Adjust the sound on your portable music player until it reaches the level of the FM station by switching back and forth between the controls. • • • In order to playback video from your iPod or iPhone, you must have a special combination USB/RCA composite video cable (which you can buy from Apple). When you connect the cable to your iPod or iPhone, plug the other end into both the RCA jacks and the USB port. • PHONE A B C D E F E161968 387 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Do not connect the audio input jack to a line level output. The jack only works correctly with devices that have a headphone output with a volume control. Do not set the portable music player's volume level higher than is necessary to match the volume of the FM radio as this causes distortion and reduces sound quality. If the music sounds distorted at lower listening levels, turn the portable music player volume down. If the problem persists, replace or recharge the batteries in the portable media player. Control the portable media player in the same manner when used with headphones, as the auxiliary input jack does not provide control (for example Play or Pause) over the attached portable media player. MyFord Touch™ Item Other features, such as text messaging using Bluetooth and automatic phonebook download, are cell phone-dependent features. To check your cell phone’s compatibility, see your cell phone’s user manual and visit www.SYNCMyRide.com, www.SYNCMyRide.ca or www.syncmaroute.ca. Message A Phone B Quick Dial C Phonebook D History E Messaging F Settings Pairing Your Cell Phone for the First Time WARNING Driving while distracted can result in loss of vehicle control, crash and injury. We strongly recommend that you use extreme caution when using any device that may take your focus off the road. Your primary responsibility is the safe operation of your vehicle. We recommend against the use of any handheld device while driving and encourage the use of voice-operated systems when possible. Make sure you are aware of all applicable local laws that may affect the use of electronic devices while driving. Hands-free calling is one of the main features of SYNC®. Once you pair your cell phone, you can access many options using the touchscreen or voice commands. While the system supports a variety of features, many are dependent on your cell phone’s functionality. At a minimum, most cell phones with Bluetooth wireless technology support the following functions: • Answering an incoming call. • Ending a call. • Using privacy mode. • Dialing a number. • Redialing. • Call waiting notification. • Caller ID. The first thing you must do to use the phone features of SYNC is to pair your Bluetooth-enabled cell phone with SYNC. This allows you to use your cell phone in a hands-free manner. Note: Put the transmission in position P. Turn on your vehicle ignition and the radio. Touch the upper left corner of the touchscreen: Message Action and Description Add phone Find SYNC Follow the on-screen instructions. Make sure that Bluetooth is set to On and that your cell phone is in the correct mode. See your cell phone’s manual if necessary. Select SYNC and a six-digit PIN appears on your device. 388 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 MyFord Touch™ Message Action and Description If you are prompted to enter a PIN on your device, it does not support Secure Simple Pairing. To pair, enter the PIN displayed on the touchscreen. Skip the next step. When prompted on your cell phone’s display, confirm that the PIN provided by SYNC matches the PIN displayed on your cell phone. The display indicates when the pairing is successful. SYNC may prompt you with more cell phone options. For more information on your cell phone's capability, see your cell phone's manual and visit the website. Make sure that Bluetooth is set to On and that your cell phone is in the correct mode. See your device's manual if necessary. Pairing Subsequent Cell Phones Note: Move the gearshift lever to park (P). Switch your vehicle ignition and the radio on. To pair a subsequent cell phone, select: Message Action and Description Phone Settings BT Devices Add Device Select SYNC and a six-digit PIN appears on your device. If you are prompted to enter a PIN on your device, it does not support Secure Simple Pairing. To pair, enter the PIN displayed on the touchscreen. Skip the next step. When prompted on your cell phone’s display, confirm that the PIN provided by SYNC matches the PIN displayed on your cell phone. The display indicates when the pairing is successful. SYNC may prompt you with more cell phone options. For more information on your cell phone's capability, see your cell phone's manual and visit the website. Making Calls E142599 389 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 MyFord Touch™ Phone Menu Options Press the voice button and when prompted say: Press the top left corner on the touchscreen to select from the following options: Voice command Call Phone dial [[a] number] Touch this button to access the on-screen numerical pad to enter a number and place a call. During an active call, you can also choose to: To end the call or exit phone mode, press and hold the phone button. Message Receiving Calls Mute the call During an incoming call, an audible tone sounds. Call information appears in the display if it is available. Put the call on hold Turn on the privacy feature Join two calls End the call To accept the call, select: Quick Dial Message Select and call contacts stored in your phonebook contacts and call history folder. Accept Note: You can also accept the call by pressing the phone button on the steering wheel. Phonebook Touch this button to access and call any contacts in your previously downloaded phonebook. The system places the entries in alphabetical categories summarized at the top of the screen. To reject the call, select: Message Reject Note: You can also reject the call by pressing the phone button on the steering wheel. Ignore the call by doing nothing. SYNC logs it as a missed call. 390 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 MyFord Touch™ Text Messaging To turn on contact picture settings, if your device supports this feature, select: Note: Downloading and sending text messages using Bluetooth are cell phone-dependent features. Message Note: Certain features in text messaging are speed-dependent and not available when your vehicle is traveling at speeds over 3.1 mph (5 km/h). Phone Settings Note: SYNC does not download read text messages from your cell phone. Manage Phonebook Download photos from Phonebook You can send and receive text messages using Bluetooth, read them aloud and translate text messaging acronyms, for example LOL. On Certain smartphones may support transferring street addresses when listed with phonebook contact information. If your cell phone supports this feature, you can select and use these addresses as destinations and save them as favorites. Touch the top left corner of the display, then select: Message Phone History Messaging After you connect your Bluetooth-enabled cell phone to SYNC, you can access any previously dialed, received or missed calls. You can also choose to save these to your Favorites or to Quick Dial. Then any of the following: Listen (speaker icon) Dial Note: This is a cell phone-dependent feature. If your cell phone does not support downloading call history using Bluetooth, SYNC keeps track of calls made with the SYNC system. Send Text View Delete Messaging Composing a Text Message Send text messages using the touchscreen. See Text messaging later in this section. Note: This is a speed-dependent feature. It is unavailable when your vehicle is traveling at speeds over 3.1 mph (5 km/h). Settings Note: Downloading and sending text messages using Bluetooth are cell phone-dependent features. Touch this button to access various phone settings, for example turning Bluetooth on and off, managing your phonebook and more. See Phone settings later in this section. 391 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 MyFord Touch™ To compose and send a text message, select: Message Action and Description Phone Messaging Send Text Enter a cell phone number or choose from your phonebook. Edit Text Allows you to customize the pre-defined message or create a message on your own. Send Sends the message as it is. Message You can then preview the message, verify the recipient as well as update the message list, and send it to a connected device, for example a USB drive. Stuck in traffic. Text Message Options LOL Call me later. Message Receiving a Text Message I’ll call you back in a few minutes. Note: If you select View and your vehicle is traveling over 3.1 mph (5 km/h), the system offers to read the message to you instead of allowing you to view it while driving. I just left, I’ll be there soon. Can you give me a call? I’m on my way. When a new message arrives, an audible tone sounds and the screen displays a pop-up with the caller name and ID, if supported by your cell phone. You can select: I’m running a few minutes late. I’m ahead of schedule, so I’ll be there early. I’m outside. Message Action and Description I’ll call you when I get there. View To view the text message. OK Listen For SYNC to read the message to you. Dial To call the contact. Ignore To exit the screen. Yes No Thanks 392 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 MyFord Touch™ Phone Settings To enter the phone settings menu select: Message Action and Description Phone Settings Then any of the following: Bluetooth Devices Connect, disconnect, add or delete a device, as well as save it as a favorite. Bluetooth To turn Bluetooth off or on. Do Not Disturb If you want all calls to go directly to your voicemail and not ring in the vehicle. When this feature is on, text message notifications do not ring inside the cabin either. 911 Assist Turn the 911 Assist feature on and off. See Information (page 395). Phone Ringer Select the ring tone you want to hear when you receive a call. Choose from possible system ring tones, your currently paired cell phone’s ring tone, a beep, text-to-speech or a silent notification. Text Message Notification Select a text message notification, if supported by your cell phone. Choose from possible system alert tones, text-tospeech or silent. Internet Data Connection If your cell phone is compatible, use this screen to adjust your internet data connection. Select to make your connection profile with the personal area network or to turn off your connection. You can also choose to adjust your settings or have the system always connect, never connect when roaming or query on connect. Press ? for more information. Manage Phonebook To access features such as automatic phonebook download, re-download your phonebook, add contacts from your cell phone as well as delete or upload your phonebook. Roaming Warning To have the system alert you when your cell phone is in roaming mode. 393 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 MyFord Touch™ Phone Voice Commands Voice command Listen to text messages E142599 Messages 2 Press the voice button and when prompted say any of the following: mute [call] [on] 1 Pair phone Voice command Call Privacy on call (someone | [[a] name]) Read text message Call at home Reply to text messages Call at work (turn ringer off | silent mode [on]) Call on cell (turn ringer on | silent mode off) Call on other (mute [call] off | Unmute [call]) Call voicemail 1 Help dial [[a] number] 1 These commands are only available during an active call. Do not disturb off 2 If you say messages, see the following additional commands. Do not disturb on Forward text messages Go to hands free 1 (hold call off | take call off hold) 1 Voice command Call Forward text messages (hold call [on] | (put | place) call on hold) join (call | calls) 1 Listen to text message <#> Listen to text messages 1 Reply to text messages Listen to text message <#> Help 394 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 1 MyFord Touch™ INFORMATION A B C D E E161889 Item If your vehicle is equipped with Navigation, press the E142608 Information button to access these features. If your vehicle is not equipped with Navigation, press the corner of the touchscreen with the green tab. Message A SYNC Services B Travel Link C Alerts D Calendar E SYNC-Applications SYNC Services (If Equipped, United States Only) Note: SYNC Services varies by trim level and model year and may require a subscription. Traffic alerts and turn-by-turn directions available in select markets. Message and data rates may apply. Ford Motor Company reserves the right to change or discontinue this product service at any time without prior notification or incurring any future obligation. Under the information menu, you can access the following features: Message SYNC Services Travel Link Alerts Calendar SYNC-Applications 395 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 MyFord Touch™ Note: SYNC Services requires activation before use. Visit www.SYNCMyRide.com to register and check your eligibility for complimentary services. Standard phone and message rates may apply. Subscription may be required. You must also have the active SYNC Services Bluetooth-enabled cellular phone paired and connected to the system in order to connect to, and use, SYNC Services. See Phone (page 387). Note: When you connect, the service uses GPS technology and advanced vehicle sensors to collect your vehicle's current location, travel direction and speed to help provide you with the directions, traffic reports, or business searches you request. Further, to provide the services you request, for continuous improvement, the service may collect and record call details and voice communications. For more information, see SYNC Services Terms and Conditions at www.SYNCMyRide.com. If you do not want Ford or its service providers to collect your vehicle travel information or other information identified in the Terms and Conditions, do not subscribe or use the service. Note: This feature does not function properly if you have enabled caller ID blocking on your cellular phone. Make sure your cellular phone is not blocking caller ID before using SYNC Services. Note: The driver is ultimately responsible for the safe operation of the vehicle, and therefore, must evaluate whether it is safe to follow the suggested directions. Any navigation features provided are only an aid. Make your driving decisions based on your observations of local conditions and existing traffic regulations. Do not follow the route suggestions if doing so would result in an unsafe or illegal maneuver, if you would be placed in an unsafe situation, or if you would be directed into an area that you consider unsafe. Maps used by this system may be inaccurate because of errors, changes in roads, traffic conditions or driving conditions. SYNC Services uses advanced vehicle sensors, integrated GPS technology and comprehensive map and traffic data, to give you personalized traffic reports, precise turn-by-turn directions, business search, news, sports, weather and more. For a complete list of services, or to learn more, please visit www.SYNCMyRide.com. Connecting to SYNC Services Using Voice Commands E142599 1. Press the voice button. 2. When prompted, say "Services". This initiates an outgoing call to SYNC Services using your paired and connected Bluetooth-enabled cellular phone. 3. Once you connect to the service, follow the voice prompts to request the desired service, such as "Traffic" or "Directions". You can also say, "What are my choices?" to receive a list of available services from which to choose. 4. Say, "Services" to return to the Services main menu or for help, say, "Help". 396 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 MyFord Touch™ Connecting to SYNC Services Using the Touchscreen E142608 addresses by street address or by name or specific street intersections. Operator Assist is a feature of your SYNC Services subscription. For more information on Operator Assist, visit www.SYNCMyRide.com/support. 2. Follow the voice prompts to select your Destination. After the route download is finished, the phone call automatically ends. If your vehicle is equipped with Navigation, press the Information button. If your vehicle is not equipped with Navigation, press the green tab on your touchscreen. 1. Select Connect to Services to initiate an outgoing call to SYNC Services using your phone. 2. Once connected, follow the voice prompts to request your desired Service, such as "Traffic" or "Directions". You can also say, "What are my choices?" to receive a list of available services from which to choose. 3. Say, "Services" to return to the Services main menu or for help, say, "Help". If your vehicle is not equipped with Navigation: • Turn-by-turn directions appear in the information display, in the status bar of your touchscreen system and on the SYNC Services screen. You also receive driving instructions from audible prompts. • When on an active route, you can select Route Summary or Route Status using the touchscreen controls or voice commands to view the Route Summary Turn List or the Route Status ETA. You can also turn voice guidance on or off, cancel the route or update the route. Receiving Turn-by-Turn Directions 1. When connected to SYNC Services, say "Directions" or "Business search". To find the closest business or type of business to your current location, just say "Business search" and then "Search near me". If you need further assistance in finding a location you can say "Operator" at any time within a Directions or Business search to speak with a live operator. The system may prompt you to speak with an operator when it has difficulty matching your voice request. The live operator can assist you by searching for businesses by name or by category, residential If you miss a turn, SYNC automatically asks if you want the route updated. Just say, "Yes" when prompted and the system delivers a new route to your vehicle. If your vehicle is equipped with Navigation, SYNC Services downloads your requested destination to the navigation system. The navigation system then calculates the route and provides driving instructions. See Navigation (page 404). Disconnecting from SYNC Services 1. Press and hold the hang-up phone button on the steering wheel. 2. Say "Good-bye" from the SYNC Services main menu. 397 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 MyFord Touch™ SYNC Services Quick Tips Message Action and Description Personalizing You can personalize your Services feature to provide quicker access to your most used or favorite information. You can save address points, such as work or home. You can also save favorite information like sports teams, for example Detroit Lions, or a news category. You can learn more about personalization by logging onto www.SYNCMyRide.com. Push to interrupt Press the voice button at any time (while connected to SYNC Services) to interrupt a voice prompt or an audio clip (such as a sports report) and say your voice command. Portable Your subscription is associated with your Bluetooth-enabled cellular phone number, not your VIN (Vehicle Identification Number). You can pair and connect your phone to any vehicle equipped with SYNC Services and continue enjoying your personalized services. Voice command SYNC Services Voice Commands Services When a route has been downloaded (non-navigation E142599 systems), press the voice button on the steering wheel controls. When prompted, say any of the following commands: Update route Help Sirius Travel Link (If Equipped) Services WARNING Driving while distracted can result in loss of vehicle control, crash and injury. We strongly recommend that you use extreme caution when using any device that may take your focus off the road. Your primary responsibility is the safe operation of your vehicle. We recommend against the use of any handheld device while driving and encourage the use of voice-operated systems when possible. Make sure you are aware of all applicable local laws that may affect the use of electronic devices while driving. Voice command Cancel route Navigation voice off Navigation voice on Next turn Route status Route summary 398 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 MyFord Touch™ Note: In order to use Sirius Travel Link, your vehicle must be equipped with navigation and your navigation SD card must be in the SD card slot. Weather Touch this button to view the nearby weather, current weather, or the five day forecast for the chosen area. Select Map to see the weather map, which can show storms, radar information, charts and winds. Select Area to select from a listing of weather locations. Note: A paid subscription is required to access and use these features. Go to www.siriusxm.com/travellink for more information. Note: Visit www.siriusxm.com/traffic and click on Coverage map and details for a complete listing of all traffic areas covered by Sirius Travel Link. Sports Info Touch this button to view scores and schedules from a variety of sports. You can also save up to 10 favorite teams for easier access. The score automatically refreshes when a game is in progress. Note: Neither Sirius nor Ford is responsible for any errors or inaccuracies in the Sirius Travel Link services or its use in vehicles. When you subscribe to Sirius Travel Link, it can help you locate the best gas prices, find movie listings, get current traffic alerts, view the current weather map, get accurate ski conditions and see scores to current sports games. Ski Conditions If your vehicle is equipped with Navigation, touch the I E142608 (Information) button to access these features. If your vehicle is not equipped with Navigation, touch the corner of the touchscreen with the green tab. Press the voice button on the steering wheel controls. When E142599 prompted, say any of the following commands: Touch this button to view ski conditions for a specific area. Sirius Travel Link Voice Commands Sirius Travel Link Voice command Traffic On Route and Traffic Nearby Touch these buttons to identify traffic incidents on your route, nearby your vehicle’s current location or near any of your favorite places, if programmed. 5-day weather forecast Fuel Prices Sports headlines * Touch this button to view fuel prices at stations close to your vehicle’s location or on an active navigation route. Sports schedules * Sports scores * Fuel prices Movie listings Movie Listings Traffic Touch this button to view nearby movie theaters and their show times, if available. Weather 399 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 MyFord Touch™ Voice command Voice command Weather map College football headlines Help College football schedule * If you say "Sports headlines", "Sports schedules" or "Sports scores", you can then say any of the commands in the following chart. College football scores Sports-Related Commands Golf schedule Golf headlines Golf leaderboard MLS headlines Voice command Baseball MLS schedule College basketball MLS scores College football Motor sports headlines Golf Motor sports order MLS Motor sports schedule My teams My team headlines NBA My teams schedule NFL My teams scores NHL NBA headlines WNBA NBA schedule Help NBA scores NFL headlines Additional Sports-Related Voice Commands NFL schedule Voice command NFL scores Baseball headlines NHL headlines Baseball schedule NHL schedule Baseball scores NHL scores College basketball headlines WNBA headlines College basketball schedule College basketball scores 400 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 MyFord Touch™ 911 Assist (If Equipped) Voice command WARNINGS Unless the 911 Assist setting is set on before a crash, the system will not dial for help, which could delay response time, potentially increasing the risk of serious injury or death after a crash. WNBA schedule WNBA scores Help Alerts Do not wait for 911 Assist to make an emergency call if you can do it yourself. Dial emergency services immediately to avoid delayed response time, which could increase the risk of serious injury or death after a crash. If you do not hear 911 Assist within five seconds of the crash, the system or phone may be damaged or non-functional. If your vehicle is equipped with Navigation, touch the I E142608 (Information) button to access these features. If your vehicle is not equipped with Navigation, touch the corner of the touchscreen with the green tab. Press Alerts, and then choose from any of the following services: Message Always place your phone in a secure location in your vehicle so it does not become a projectile or damaged in a crash. Failure to do so may cause serious injury to someone or damage the phone, which could prevent 911 Assist from working properly. Action and Description View The complete message Delete The message Delete All Messages Note: The SYNC 911 Assist feature must be set on prior to the incident. This screen displays any system messages (such as an SD card fault). Note: Before setting this feature on, make sure that you read the 911 Assist Privacy Notice later in this section for important information. Note: The system alerts you to any messages by turning the information icon yellow. After you read or delete the messages, the icon returns to white. Note: If any user turns 911 Assist on or off, that setting applies for all paired phones. If 911 Assist is turned off, either a voice message plays or a display message (or icon) comes on (or both) when your vehicle is started after a previously paired phone connects. Calendar If your vehicle is equipped with Navigation, touch the I (Information) button to access these features. If your vehicle is not equipped with Navigation, touch the corner of the touchscreen with the green tab. E142608 Note: Every phone operates differently. While SYNC 911 Assist works with most cellular phones, some may have trouble using this feature. Press Calendar. You can view the current calendar by day, week or month. 401 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 MyFord Touch™ If a crash deploys an airbag, excluding knee airbags and rear inflatable safety belts where fitted or activates the fuel pump shut-off, your SYNC-equipped vehicle may be able to contact emergency services by dialing 911 through a paired and connected Bluetooth-enabled phone. You can learn more about the 911 Assist feature, visit www.SYNCMyRide.com, www.SYNCMyRide.ca or www.syncmaroute.ca. You can also access 911 Assist by pressing the Setting icon and then selecting: Message Settings Phone 911 Assist See Supplementary Restraints System (page 33). Important information regarding airbag deployment is in this chapter. You can also select: Help 911 Assist See Roadside Emergencies (page 176). Important information regarding the fuel pump shut-off is in this chapter. To make sure that 911 Assist works properly: • SYNC must be powered and working properly at the time of the incident and throughout feature activation and use. • The 911 Assist feature must be set on prior to the incident. • You must pair and connect a Bluetooth-enabled and compatible phone to SYNC. • A connected Bluetooth-enabled phone must have the ability to make and maintain an outgoing call at the time of the incident. • A connected Bluetooth-enabled phone must have adequate network coverage, battery power and signal strength. • The vehicle must have battery power and be located in the United States, Canada or in a territory in which 911 is the emergency number. Setting 911 Assist On E142608 If your vehicle is equipped with Navigation, touch the I (Information) button to access these features. If your vehicle is not equipped with Navigation, touch the corner of the touchscreen with the green tab. Then select: Message Apps 911 Assist On E142607 402 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 MyFord Touch™ In the Event of a Crash 911 Assist Privacy Notice Not all crashes deploy an airbag or activate the fuel pump shut-off (which would trigger 911 Assist); however, SYNC tries to contact emergency services if 911 Assist triggers. If a connected phone sustains damage or loses connection to SYNC, SYNC searches for, and tries to connect to, any available previously paired phone and tries to make the call to 911. When you turn on 911 Assist, it may disclose to emergency services that your vehicle has been in a crash involving the deployment of an airbag or activation of the fuel pump shut-off. Certain versions or updates to 911 Assist may also be capable of electronically or verbally disclosing to 911 operators your vehicle location or other details about your vehicle or crash to assist 911 operators to provide the most appropriate emergency services. If you do not want to disclose this information, do not turn the feature on. Before making the call: • SYNC provides a short window of time (approximately 10 seconds) to cancel the call. If you fail to cancel the call, SYNC attempts to dial 911. • SYNC says the following, or a similar message: "SYNC will attempt to call 911, to cancel the call, press Cancel on your screen or press and hold the phone button on your steering wheel." Vehicle Health Report WARNING Always follow scheduled maintenance instructions, regularly inspect your vehicle, and seek repair for any damage or problem you suspect. Vehicle Health Report supplements, but cannot replace, normal maintenance and vehicle inspection. Vehicle Health Report only monitors certain systems electronically monitored by your vehicle and will not monitor or report the status of any other system, (such as brake lining wear). Failure to perform scheduled maintenance and regularly inspect your vehicle may result in vehicle damage and serious injury. If you do not cancel the call, and SYNC makes a successful call, a pre-recorded message plays for the 911 operator, and then the occupant(s) in your vehicle is able to talk with the operator. Be prepared to provide your name, phone number and location immediately, because not all 911 systems are capable of receiving this information electronically. 911 Assist May Not Work If: • • • Your cellular phone or 911 Assist hardware sustains damage in a crash. The vehicle's battery or the SYNC system has no power. The phones(s) previously paired or connected to the system are thrown from the vehicle. Note: This feature is only available in the United States. Note: Your Vehicle Health Report feature requires activation prior to use. Visit www.SYNCMyRide.com to register. There is no fee or subscription associated with Vehicle Health Report, but you must register to use this feature. 403 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 MyFord Touch™ Note: This feature may not function properly if you have enabled caller ID blocking on your cellular phone. Before running a report, review the Vehicle Health Report Privacy Notice. If you want to run a report by using the touchscreen, select: Message Apps Note: In order to allow a break-in period for your vehicle, you may not be able to create a Vehicle Health Report until your vehicle odometer has reached 200 miles. Vehicle Health Report You can also run a vehicle health report by voice command. Note: Cellular phone and SMS charges may apply when making a report. E142599 Register for Vehicle Health Report and set your report preferences at www.SYNCMyRide.com. After registering, you can request a Vehicle Health Report (inside your vehicle). Return to your account at www.SYNCMyRide.com to view your report. You can also choose for SYNC to remind you automatically to run reports at specific mileage intervals. Cellular phone airtime usage may apply when reporting. Press the voice button and when prompted say: Voice command vehicle [health] report Vehicle Health Report Privacy Notice When you create a Vehicle Health Report, Ford Motor Company may collect your cellular phone number (to process your report request) and diagnostic information about your vehicle. Certain versions or updates to Vehicle Health Report may also collect more vehicle information. Ford may use your vehicle information it collects for any purpose. If you do not want to disclose your cellular phone number or vehicle information, do not run the feature or set up your Vehicle Health Report profile at www.SYNCMyRide.com. See www.SYNCMyRide.com (Vehicle Health Report Terms and Conditions, and Privacy Statement) for more information. The system allows you to check your vehicle’s overall health in the form of a diagnostic report card. The Vehicle Health Report contains valuable information, for example: • Vehicle diagnostic information. • Scheduled maintenance. • Open recalls and Field Service Actions. • Items noted during vehicle inspections by your authorized dealer that still need servicing. Making a Report NAVIGATION E142608 Note: The navigation SD card must be in the SD card slot to operate the navigation system. If you need a replacement SD card, see an authorized dealer. 404 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 MyFord Touch™ 1. Enter the necessary information into the highlighted text fields (in any order). For address destination entry, the Go! button appears once you enter all the necessary information. Pressing the Go! button makes the address location appear on the map. If you choose Previous Destination, the last 20 destinations you have selected appear. 2. Select Set as Dest to make this your destination. You can also choose to set this as a waypoint (have the system route to this point on the way to your current destination) or save it as a favorite. The system considers any Avoid Areas selections in its route calculation. 3. Choose from up to three different types of routes, and then select Start Route. • Fastest: Uses the fastest moving roads possible. • Shortest: Uses the shortest distance possible. • Eco Route: Uses the most fuel-efficient route. Note: The SD card slot is spring-loaded. To remove the SD card, just push the card in and release it. Do not attempt to pull the card out to remove it; this could cause damage. Your navigation system is comprised of two main features, destination mode and map mode. To set a destination, press the green corner of your touchscreen, then the Dest button when it appears. See Setting a Destination later in this chapter. To view the navigation map and your vehicle's current location, touch the green bar in the upper right-hand corner of the touchscreen, or, press Dest, then Map. See Map mode later in this chapter. Setting a Destination Press the green corner of your touchscreen, then the Dest button when it appears. Choose any of the following: Destination Message You can cancel the route or have the system demo the route for you. Select Route Prefs to set route preferences like avoiding freeways, tollroads, ferries and car trains as well as to use or not use high-occupancy vehicle lanes. (High-occupancy vehicle lanes are also known as carpool or diamond lanes. People who ride in buses, vanpools or carpools use these lanes.) My Home Favorites Previous Destinations Point of Interest Emergency Street Address Intersection Note: If your vehicle is on a recognized road and you do not press the Start Route button, the system defaults to the Fastest Route option and begins guidance. City Center Map Edit Route Cancel Route 405 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 MyFord Touch™ During route guidance, you can press the talking bubble icon that appears in the upper right navigation corner (green bar) if you want the system to repeat route guidance information. When the system repeats the last guidance instruction, it updates the distance to the next guidance instruction, since it detects when the vehicle is moving. Message Auto Dealership Govt Office Public Transit Education Point of Interest (POI) Categories To expand these listings, press the + in front of the listing. Main categories The system also allows you to sort alphabetically, by distance or by cityseekr listings (if available). Message Food/Drink & Dining cityseekr Travel & Transportation Note: cityseekr point of interest (POI) information is limited to approximately 912 cities (881 in the United States, 20 in Canada and 11 in Mexico). Financial Emergency Community Health & Medicine Automotive Shopping Entertainment & Arts E142634 Recreation & Sports cityseekr, when available, is a service that provides more information about certain points of interest such as restaurants, hotels and attractions. Government Domestic Services When you have selected a point of interest, the location and information appear, such as address and phone number. If cityseekr lists the point of interest, more information is available, such as a brief description, check-in and checkout times or restaurant hours. Subcategories Message Restaurant Golf Parking Press More Information for a longer review, a list of services and facilities, the average room or meal price as well as the website. This screen displays the point of interest icon such as: Home & Garden Personal Care Services 406 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 MyFord Touch™ Hotel Message Fitness center E143884 Internet access Coffeehouse Pool Wi-fi E142636 Food & Drink For restaurants, cityseekr can provide information such as star rating, average cost, review, handicap access, hours of operation, and website address. Nightlife For hotels, cityseekr can provide information such as star rating, price category, review, check-in and checkout times, hotel service icons and website address. E142637 E142638 Attraction Setting Your Navigation Preferences E142639 Select settings for the system to take into account when planning your route. This icon appears when your selection exists in multiple categories within the system. Press the Settings icon > Settings > Navigation. E142640 E142607 When you are viewing more information for hotels, cityseekr also tells you if the hotel has certain services and facilities using icons, such as: Map Preferences Breadcrumbs Display your vehicle’s previously traveled route with white dots. Switch this feature ON or OFF. Subcategories Turn List Format Message Have the system display your turn list Top to Bottom or Bottom to Top. Restaurant Business center Handicap facilities Laundry Refrigerator 24 hour room service 407 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 MyFord Touch™ Parking POI Notification Navigation Preferences Set the automatic parking point of interest notification. Switch this feature ON or OFF. When parking point of interest notification is on, the icons display on the map when you get close to your destination. This may not be very useful in dense areas, and may clutter the map when other points of interest display. Guidance Prompts Have the system use Voice & Tones or Tone Only on your programmed route. Auto - Fill State/Province Route Preferences Have the system automatically fill in the state and province based on the information already entered into the system. Switch this feature ON or OFF. Preferred Route Traffic Preferences Choose to have the system display the Shortest, Fastest or most Ecological route first. If you set Always Use Preferred Route to Yes, the system uses the selected route type to calculate only one route to the desired destination. Avoid Traffic Problems Choose how you want the system to handle traffic problems along your route. • Automatic: Have the system reroute you to avoid traffic incidents that develop and impact the current route. The system does not provide a traffic alert notification. • Manual: Have the system always provide a traffic alert notification for traffic incidents along the planned route. You have a choice to accept or ignore the notification before making the route deviation. Always Use Preferred Route Bypass route selection in destination programming. The system only calculates one route based on preferred route setting. Eco Time Penalty Select a low, medium or high cost for the calculated Eco Route. The higher the setting, the longer the time allotment is for the route. Traffic Alert Notification Have the system display traffic alert notifications. Avoid These features allow you to choose to have the system avoid freeways, toll roads, ferries and car trains when planning your route. Switch these features ON or OFF. Other traffic alert features allows you to turn on certain, or all, traffic icons on the map such as road work, incident, accidents and closed roads. Scroll down to view all the different types of alerts. Switch these features ON or OFF. Use HOV Lanes Have the system use high-occupancy vehicle lanes, if available, when planning your route. Avoid Areas Choose areas which you want the system to avoid when calculating a route for you. 408 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 MyFord Touch™ Press Add to program an entry. Once you make a selection, the system tries to avoid the area(s) if possible for all routes. To delete a selection, choose the listing on the screen. When the screen changes to Avoid Areas Edit, you can press Delete at the bottom right of the screen. Heading up (2D map) always shows the direction of forward travel to be upward on the screen. E142642 This view is available for map scales up to 2.5 miles (4 kilometers). The system remembers this setting for larger map scales, but shows the map in North up only. If the scale returns below this level, the system restores Heading up. Map Mode Press the green bar in the upper right area of the touchscreen to view map mode. Map mode shows advanced viewing comprised of both 2D city maps as well as 3D landmarks (when available). E142643 North up (2D map) always shows the northern direction to be upward on the screen. 3D map mode provides an elevated perspective of the map. This viewing angle can be adjusted E142644 and the map can be rotated 180 degrees by touching the map twice, and then dragging your finger along the shaded bar with arrows at the bottom of the map. 2D city maps show detailed outlines of buildings, visible land use and land elements and detailed railway infrastructure for the most essential cities around the globe. These maps also contain features, such as town blocks, building footprints and railways. View switches between full map, street list and exit view in route guidance. 3D landmarks appear as clear, visible objects that are typically recognizable and have a certain tourist value. The 3D landmarks appear in 3D map mode only. Coverage varies and improves with updated map releases. Menu displays a pop-up box that allows direct access to navigation settings, View/Edit Route, SIRIUS Travel Link, Guidance Mute and Cancel Route. Press the speaker button on the map to mute route guidance. E174017 When the light on the button illuminates, the feature is on. The speaker button appears on the map only when route guidance is active. Re-center the map by pressing this icon whenever you scroll the E146188 map away from your vehicle’s current location. Auto Zoom E174016 Change the appearance of the map display by repeatedly pressing the arrow button in the upper left corner of the screen. It toggles between three different map modes: Heading up, North up and 3D. Press the green bar to access map mode, then select the + or - zoom button to bring up the zoom level and Auto buttons on the touchscreen. When you press Auto, Auto Zoom turns on and Auto displays in the bottom left corner of the screen in the map 409 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 MyFord Touch™ scale. The map zoom level then synchronizes with vehicle speed. The slower your vehicle is traveling, the farther the map zooms in; the faster your vehicle is traveling, the farther the map zooms out. To switch off the feature, just press the + or - button again. Home indicates the location on the map currently stored as the home position. You can only save E142649 one address from the Address Book as your Home entry. You cannot change this icon. POI (Point Of Interest) icons indicate locations of any point of interest categories you choose to E142650 display on the map. You can choose to display three point of interest categories on the map at one time. In 3D mode, rotate the map view by swiping your finger across the shaded bar with the arrows. The ETA box under the zoom buttons appears when a route is active and displays the distance and time to your destination. If the button is pressed, a pop up appears with the destination listed (and waypoint if applicable) along with mileage and time to destination. You may also select to have either the estimated time to reach your destination or your estimated arrival time. Starting point indicates the starting point of a planned route. E142651 Waypoint indicates the location of a waypoint on the map. The number inside the circle is different E142652 for each waypoint and represents the position of the waypoint in the route list. Map Icons E142646 Vehicle mark shows the current location of your vehicle. It stays in the center of the map display, except when in scroll mode. Destination symbol indicates the ending point of a planned route. E142653 Scroll cursor allows you to scroll the map; the fixed icon is in the center of the screen. The map E142647 position closest to the cursor is in a window on the top center part of the screen. E142654 No GPS symbol indicates that insufficient GPS satellite signals are available for accurate map E142655 positioning. This icon may display under normal operation in an area with poor GPS access. Address book entry default icon(s) indicates the location on the map of an address book entry. E142648 This is the default symbol shown after the entry has been stored to the Address Book by any method other than the map. You can select from any of the 22 icons available. You can use each icon more than once. Quick-touch Buttons When in map mode, touch anywhere on the map display to access the following options: 410 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Next maneuver point indicates the location of the next turn on the planned route. MyFord Touch™ Touch this button to select a scrolled location on the map as your destination. You may scroll the map by pressing your index finger on the map display. When you reach the desired location, simply let go and then touch Set as Dest. Nokia is the digital map provider for the navigation application. If you find map data errors, you may report them directly to Nokia by going to http://mapreporter.navteq.com. Nokia evaluates all reported map errors and responds with the result of their investigation by e-mail. Set as Waypoint Navigation Map Updates Set as Dest Touch this button to set the current location as a waypoint. Annual navigation map updates are available for purchase through your dealership, by calling 1-866-4NAVTEQ (1-866-462-8837) or going to www.navigation.com/sync. You need to specify the make and model of your vehicle to determine if there is an update available. Save to Favorites Touch this button to save the current location to your favorites. POI Icons Navigation Voice Commands Touch this button to select icons to display on the map. You can select up to three icons to display on the map at the same time. Turn these ON or OFF. When in navigation mode, press the voice button on the steering E142599 wheel controls. After the tone, say any of the following commands: Cancel Route Touch this button to cancel the active route. Navigation system voice commands Voice command View/Edit Route When a Route is Active Cancel next waypoint 1 Subcategories Cancel route 1 Destination 2 Message View Route Destination Edit Destination/Waypoints Destination Edit Turn List Destination favorites Detour Destination home Edit Route Preferences Destination intersection Edit Traffic Preferences Destination nearest Cancel Route Destination nearest POI 411 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 MyFord Touch™ Voice command Voice command Destination play nametags Zoom out Destination POI Help 1 Destination POI category These commands are only available when a navigation route is active. Destination previous destination 2 If you say "Destination", you can then say any command in the following "Destination" chart. Destination street address Detour 1 Navigation 3 3 If you say "Navigation", you can then say any command in the following "Navigation" chart. Navigation voice volume decrease Destination Navigation voice volume increase Repeat instruction Voice command 1 Show 3D Show heading up Favorites Show map Home Show north up Intersection Show route 1 Show turn list 1 Nearest Nearest POI Voice guidance off Play nametags Voice guidance on POI category Where am I? Previous destination Zoom in Street address Help 412 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 MyFord Touch™ Navigation Voice command Destination * Zoom city Zoom country Zoom minimum Zoom maximum Zoom province Zoom state Zoom street Zoom to Help * If you say "Destination", you can then say any command in the "Destination" chart. One-shot Destination Street Address When you say either "Navigation destination street address" or "Destination street address", the system asks you to say the full address. The system displays an example on-screen. You can then speak the address naturally, such as "One two three four Main Street, Anytown". 413 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Accessories For a complete listing of the accessories that are available for your vehicle, contact an authorized dealer or visit our online store at www.accessories.ford.com (United States only). • • • *The Ford Licensed Accessory manufacturer designs, develops and therefore warrants Ford Licensed Accessories, and does not design or test these accessories to Ford Motor Company engineering requirements. Contact an authorized Ford dealer for the manufacturer's limited warranty details, and request a copy of the Ford Licensed Accessories product limited warranty from the accessory manufacturer. Ford Motor Company will repair or replace any properly authorized dealer-installed Ford Genuine Accessory found to be defective in factory-supplied materials or workmanship during the warranty period, as well as any component damaged by the defective accessories. Ford Motor Company will warrant your accessory through the warranty that provides the greatest benefit: • • For maximum vehicle performance, keep the following information in mind when adding accessories or equipment to your vehicle: 24 months, unlimited miles The remainder of your new vehicle limited warranty Contact an authorized dealer for details and a copy of the warranty. • Exterior Style • • • Side window deflectors Splash guards Wheels • Interior Style • • • • • All-weather floor mats Interior ambient lighting Cargo organizers Rear seat entertainment* Premium carpeted floor mats Lifestyle • • • Ash cup and smokers packages Roof racks and carriers* Hitch and towing accessories Peace of Mind • • Remote start Vehicle security system 414 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Wheel locks Bumper-mounted parking sensor* Keyless entry keypad When adding accessories, equipment, passengers and luggage to your vehicle, do not exceed the total weight capacity of the vehicle or of the front or rear axle (GVWR or GAWR as indicated on the Safety Compliance Certification label). Ask an authorized dealer for specific weight information. The Federal Communications Commission (FCC) and Canadian Radio Telecommunications Commission (CRTC) regulate the use of mobile communications systems that are equipped with radio transmitters, for example, two-way radios, telephones and theft alarms. Any such equipment installed in your vehicle should comply with Federal Communications Commission (FCC) and Canadian Radio Telecommunications Commission (CRTC) regulations and should be installed only by an authorized dealer. Accessories • • Mobile communications systems may harm the operation of your vehicle, particularly if they are not properly designed for automotive use. If you or an authorized Ford dealer add any non-Ford electrical or electronic accessories or components to your vehicle, you may adversely affect battery performance and durability, and may adversely affect the performance of other electrical systems in the vehicle. E163431 The switches only operate while the ignition is in the on position, whether the engine is running or not. It is, however, recommended that the engine remain running to maintain a battery charge when using the switches for an extended duration or higher current draws. When you switch them on they provide 20 amps of electrical battery power for a variety of uses. AUXILIARY SWITCHES The auxiliary switchboard on the center console makes aftermarket customization easier, with four prewired switches attached to the power distribution box for electrical accessories. A fuse and relay kit is included with this option. The kit contains the required fuses and relays that are included under the driver seat in the pre-fusebox. Refer to the instructions included with the kit. See an authorized dealer for service. There will also be one power lead for each switch found in a four way connector located under the driver seat. The relays are coded as follows: Switch Circuit number Wire color Fuse AUX 1 CAC05 Yellow 20A AUX 2 CAC06 Green with brown trace 20A AUX 3 CAC07 Violet with green trace 20A AUX 4 CAC08 Brown 20A 415 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Appendices • END USER LICENSE AGREEMENT SYNC End User License Agreement (EULA) • • You have acquired a device ("DEVICE") that includes software licensed by Ford Motor Company and its affiliates ("FORD MOTOR COMPANY") from an affiliate of Microsoft Corporation ("MS") . Those installed software products of MS origin, as well as associated media, printed materials, and "online" or electronic documentation ("MS SOFTWARE") are protected by international intellectual property laws and treaties. The MS SOFTWARE is licensed, not sold. All rights reserved. The MS SOFTWARE may interface with and/or communicate with, or may be later upgraded to interface with and/or communicate with additional software and/or systems provided by FORD MOTOR COMPANY. The additional software and systems of FORD MOTOR COMPANY origin, as well as associated media, printed materials, and "online" or electronic documentation ("FORD SOFTWARE") are protected by international intellectual property laws and treaties. The FORD SOFTWARE is licensed, not sold. All rights reserved. • IF YOU DO NOT AGREE TO THIS END USER LICENSE AGREEMENT ("EULA") DO NOT USE THE DEVICE OR COPY THE SOFTWARE. ANY USE OF THE SOFTWARE, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO USE ON THE DEVICE, WILL CONSTITUTE YOUR AGREEMENT TO THIS EULA (OR RATIFICATION OF ANY PREVIOUS CONSENT). GRANT OF SOFTWARE LICENSE: This EULA grants you the following license: • 416 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 The MS SOFTWARE and/or FORD SOFTWARE may interface with and/or communicate with, or may be later upgraded to interface with and/or communicate with additional software and/or systems provided by third party software and service suppliers. The additional software and services of third party origin, as well as associated media, printed materials, and "online" or electronic documentation ("THIRD PARTY SOFTWARE") are protected by international intellectual property laws and treaties. The THIRD PARTY SOFTWARE is licensed, not sold. All rights reserved. The MS SOFTWARE, FORD SOFTWARE and THIRD PARTY SOFTWARE hereinafter collectively and individually will be referred to as "SOFTWARE". You may use the SOFTWARE as installed on the DEVICE and as otherwise interfacing with systems and/or services provide by or through FORD MOTOR COMPANY or its third party software and service providers. Appendices Description of Other Rights and Limitations • • • • • Speech Recognition: If the SOFTWARE includes speech recognition component(s), you should understand that speech recognition is an inherently statistical process and that recognition errors are inherent in the process. Neither FORD MOTOR COMPANY nor its suppliers shall be liable for any damages arising out of errors in the speech recognition process. Limitations on Reverse Engineering, Decompilation and Disassembly: You may not reverse engineer, decompile, or disassemble nor permit others to reverse engineer, decompile or disassemble the SOFTWARE, except and only to the extent that such activity is expressly permitted by applicable law notwithstanding this limitation. Limitations on Distributing, Copying, Modifying and Creating Derivative Works: You may not distribute, copy, make modifications to or create derivative works based on the SOFTWARE, except and only to the extent that such activity is expressly permitted by applicable law notwithstanding this limitation. Single EULA: The end user documentation for the DEVICE and related systems and services may contain multiple EULAs, such as multiple translations and/or multiple media versions (e.g., in the user documentation and in the software). Even if you receive multiple EULAs, you are licensed to use only one (1) copy of the SOFTWARE. • • 417 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 SOFTWARE Transfer: You may permanently transfer your rights under this EULA only as part of a sale or transfer of the DEVICE, provided you retain no copies, you transfer all of the SOFTWARE (including all component parts, the media and printed materials, any upgrades, and, if applicable, the Certificate(s) of Authenticity), and the recipient agrees to the terms of this EULA. If the SOFTWARE is an upgrade, any transfer must include all prior versions of the SOFTWARE. Termination: Without prejudice to any other rights, FORD MOTOR COMPANY or MS may terminate this EULA if you fail to comply with the terms and conditions of this EULA. Security Updates/Digital Rights Management: Content owners use the WMDRM technology included in your DEVICE to protect their intellectual property, included copyrighted content. Portions of the SOFTWARE on your DEVICE use WMDRM software to access WMDRM-protected content. If the WMDRM software fails to protect the content, content owners may ask Microsoft to revoke the SOFTWARE's ability to use WMDRM to play or copy protected content. This action does not affect unprotected content. When your DEVICE downloads licenses for protected content, you agree that Microsoft may include a revocation list with the licenses. Content owners may require you to upgrade the SOFTWARE on your DEVICE to access their content. If you decline an upgrade, you will not be able to access content that requires the upgrade. Appendices • • • Consent to Use of Data: You agree that MS, Microsoft Corporation, FORD MOTOR COMPANY, third party software and systems suppliers, their affiliates and/or their designated agent may collect and use technical information gathered in any manner as part of product support services related to the SOFTWARE or related services. MS, Microsoft Corporation, FORD MOTOR COMPANY, third party software and services suppliers, their affiliates and/or their designated agent may use this information solely to improve their products or to provide customized services or technologies to you. MS, Microsoft Corporation, FORD MOTOR COMPANY, third party software and systems suppliers, their affiliates and/or their designated agent may disclose this information to others, but not in a form that personally identifies you. Internet-Based Services Components: The SOFTWARE may contain components that enable and facilitate the use of certain Internet-based services. You acknowledge and agree that MS, Microsoft Corporation, FORD MOTOR COMPANY, third party software and service suppliers, their affiliates and/or their designated agent may automatically check the version of the SOFTWARE and/or its components that you are utilizing and may provide upgrades or supplements to the SOFTWARE that may be automatically downloaded to your DEVICE. Additional Software/Services: The SOFTWARE may permit FORD MOTOR COMPANY, third party software and service suppliers, MS, Microsoft Corporation, their affiliates and/or their designated agent to provide or make available to you SOFTWARE updates, supplements, add-on components, or Internet-based services components of the SOFTWARE after the date you obtain your initial copy of the SOFTWARE ("Supplemental Components"). If FORD MOTOR COMPANY or third party software and services suppliers provide or make available to you Supplemental Components and no other EULA terms are provided along with the Supplemental Components, then the terms of this EULA shall apply. If MS, Microsoft Corporation, their affiliates and/or their designated agent make available Supplemental Components, and no other EULA terms are provided, then the terms of this EULA shall apply, except that the MS, Microsoft Corporation or affiliate entity providing the Supplemental Component(s) shall be the licensor of the Supplemental Component(s). FORD MOTOR COMPANY, MS, Microsoft Corporation, their affiliates and/or their designated agent reserve the right to discontinue without liability any Internet-based services provided to you or made available to you through the use of the SOFTWARE. 418 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Appendices • • Links to Third Party Sites: The MS SOFTWARE may provide you with the ability to link to third party sites through the use of the SOFTWARE. The third party sites are not under the control of MS, Microsoft Corporation, their affiliates and/or their designated agent. Neither MS nor Microsoft Corporation nor their affiliates nor their designated agent are responsible for (i) the contents of any third party sites, any links contained in third party sites, or any changes or updates to third party sites, or (ii) webcasting or any other form of transmission received from any third party sites. If the SOFTWARE provides links to third party sites, those links are provided to you only as a convenience, and the inclusion of any link does not imply an endorsement of the third party site by MS, Microsoft Corporation, their affiliates and/or their designated agent. Obligation to Drive Responsibly: You recognize your obligation to drive responsibly and keep attention on the road. You will read and abide with the DEVICE operating instructions particularly as they pertain to safety and assumes any risk associated with the use of the DEVICE. INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY RIGHTS: All title and intellectual property rights in and to the SOFTWARE (including but not limited to any images, photographs, animations, video, audio, music, text and "applets" incorporated into the SOFTWARE), the accompanying printed materials, and any copies of the SOFTWARE, are owned by MS, Microsoft Corporation, FORD MOTOR COMPANY, or their affiliates or suppliers. The SOFTWARE is licensed, not sold. You may not copy the printed materials accompanying the SOFTWARE. All title and intellectual property rights in and to the content which may be accessed through use of the SOFTWARE is the property of the respective content owner and may be protected by applicable copyright or other intellectual property laws and treaties. This EULA grants you no rights to use such content. All rights not specifically granted under this EULA are reserved by MS, Microsoft Corporation, FORD MOTOR COMPANY, third party software and service providers, their affiliates and suppliers. Use of any on-line services which may be accessed through the SOFTWARE may be governed by the respective terms of use relating to such services. If this SOFTWARE contains documentation that is provided only in electronic form, you may print one copy of such electronic documentation. UPGRADES AND RECOVERY MEDIA: If the SOFTWARE is provided by FORD MOTOR COMPANY separate from the DEVICE on media such as a ROM chip, CD ROM disk(s) or via web download or other means, and is labeled "For Upgrade Purposes Only" or "For Recovery Purposes Only" you may install one (1) copy of such SOFTWARE onto the DEVICE as a replacement copy for the existing SOFTWARE, and use it in accordance with this EULA, including any additional EULA terms accompanying the upgrade SOFTWARE. EXPORT RESTRICTIONS: You acknowledge that the SOFTWARE is subject to U.S. and European Union export jurisdiction. You agree to comply with all applicable international and national laws that apply to the SOFTWARE, including the U.S. Export Administration Regulations, as well as end-user, end-use and destination restrictions issued by U.S. and other governments. For additional information, see http://www.microsoft.com/exporting/. 419 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Appendices Adobe TRADEMARKS: This EULA does not grant you any rights in connection with any trademarks or service marks of FORD MOTOR COMPANY, MS, Microsoft Corporation, third party software or service providers, their affiliates or suppliers. Contains Adobe® [Flash® Player] or [AIR®] technology by Adobe Systems Incorporated. This [Licensee Product] contains [Adobe® Flash® Player] [Adobe® AIR®] software under license from Adobe Systems Incorporated, Copyright ©1995-2009 Adobe Macromedia Software LLC. All rights reserved. Adobe, Flash and AIR are trademarks of Adobe Systems Incorporated. PRODUCT SUPPORT: Product support for the SOFTWARE is not provided by MS, its parent corporation Microsoft Corporation, or their affiliates or subsidiaries. For product support, please refer to FORD MOTOR COMPANY instructions provided in the documentation for the DEVICE. Should you have any questions concerning this EULA, or if you desire to contact FORD MOTOR COMPANY for any other reason, please refer to the address provided in the documentation for the DEVICE. End User Notice Microsoft® Windows® Mobile for Automotive Important Safety Information This system Ford SYNC contains software that is licensed to Manufacturer FORD MOTOR COMPANY by an affiliate of Microsoft Corporation pursuant to a license agreement. Any removal, reproduction, reverse engineering or other unauthorized use of the software from this system in violation of the license agreement is strictly prohibited and may subject you to legal action. No Liability for Certain Damages: EXCEPT AS PROHIBITED BY LAW, FORD MOTOR COMPANY, ANY THIRD PARTY SOFTWARE OR SERVICES SUPPLIERS, MS, MICROSOFT CORPORATION AND THEIR AFFILIATES SHALL HAVE NO LIABILITY FOR ANY INDIRECT, SPECIAL, CONSEQUENTIAL OR INCIDENTAL DAMAGES ARISING FROM OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THE SOFTWARE. THIS LIMITATION SHALL APPLY EVEN IF ANY REMEDY FAILS OF ITS ESSENTIAL PURPOSE. IN NO EVENT SHALL MS, MICROSOFT CORPORATION AND/OR THEIR AFFILIATES BE LIABLE FOR ANY AMOUNT IN EXCESS OF U.S. TWO HUNDRED FIFTY DOLLARS (U.S. $250.00). • Read and follow instructions: Before using your Windows Automotive- based system, read and follow all instructions and safety information provided in this end user manual ("User's Guide"). Not following precautions found in this User's Guide can lead to an accident or other serious consequences. Keep User's Guide in vehicle: When kept in the vehicle, the User's Guide will be a ready reference for you and other users unfamiliar with the Windows Automotive-based system. Please make certain that before using the system for the first time, all persons have access to the User's Guide and read its instructions and safety information carefully. THERE ARE NO WARRANTIES OTHER THAN THOSE THAT MAY EXPRESSLY BE PROVIDED FOR YOUR NEW VEHICLE. 420 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Appendices Use of Speech Recognition Functions: Speech recognition software is inherently a statistical process which is subject to errors. It is your responsibility to monitor any speech recognition functions included in the system and address any errors. WARNING Operating certain parts of this system while driving can distract your attention away from the road, and possibly cause an accident or other serious consequences. Do not change system settings or enter data non-verbally (using your hands) while driving. Stop the vehicle in a safe and legal manner before attempting these operations. This is important since while setting up or changing some functions you might be required to distract your attention away from the road and remove your hands from the wheel. Navigation Features: Any navigation features included in the system are intended to provide turn by turn instructions to get you to a desired destination. Please make certain all persons using this system carefully read and follow instructions and safety information fully. Distraction Hazard: Any navigation features may require manual (non-verbal) setup. Attempting to perform such set-up or insert data while driving can seriously distract your attention and could cause an accident or other serious consequences. Stop the vehicle in a safe and legal manner before attempting these operations. General Operation Voice Command Control: Functions within the Windows Automotive-based system may be accomplished using only voice commands. Using voice commands while driving allows you to operate the system without removing your hands from the wheel. Let Your Judgment Prevail: Any navigation features are provided only as an aid. Make your driving decisions based on your observations of local conditions and existing traffic regulations. Any such feature is not a substitute for your personal judgment. Any route suggestions made by this system should never replace any local traffic regulations or your personal judgment or knowledge of safe driving practices. Prolonged Views of Screen: Do not access any function requiring a prolonged view of the screen while you are driving. Pull over in a safe and legal manner before attempting to access a function of the system requiring prolonged attention. Even occasional short scans to the screen may be hazardous if your attention has been diverted away from your driving task at a critical time. Route Safety: Do not follow the route suggestions if doing so would result in an unsafe or illegal maneuver, if you would be placed in an unsafe situation, or if you would be directed into an area that you consider unsafe. The driver is ultimately responsible for the safe operation of the vehicle and therefore, must evaluate whether it is safe to follow the suggested directions. Volume Setting: Do not raise the volume excessively. Keep the volume at a level where you can still hear outside traffic and emergency signals while driving. Driving while unable to hear these sounds could cause an accident. 421 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Appendices Potential Map Inaccuracy: Maps used by this system may be inaccurate because of changes in roads, traffic controls or driving conditions. Always use good judgment and common sense when following the suggested routes. Telenav may revise this Agreement and the privacy policy at any time, with or without notice to you. You agree to visit http://www.telenav.com from time to time to review the then current version of this Agreement and of the privacy policy. Emergency Services: Do not rely on any navigation features included in the system to route you to emergency services. Ask local authorities or an emergency services operator for these locations. Not all emergency services such as police, fire stations, hospitals and clinics are likely to be contained in the map database for such navigation features. 1. Safe and Lawful Use You acknowledge that devoting attention to the Telenav Software may pose a risk of injury or death to you and others in situations that otherwise require your undivided attention, and you therefore agree to comply with the following when using the Telenav Software: (a) observe all traffic laws and otherwise drive safely; (b) use your own personal judgment while driving. If you feel that a route suggested by the Telenav Software instructs you to perform an unsafe or illegal maneuver, places you in an unsafe situation, or directs you into an area that you consider to be unsafe, do not follow such instructions; (c) do not input destinations, or otherwise manipulate the Telenav Software, unless your vehicle is stationary and parked; (d) do not use the Telenav Software for any illegal, unauthorized, unintended, unsafe, hazardous, or unlawful purposes, or in any manner inconsistent with this Agreement; (e) arrange all GPS and wireless devices and cables necessary for use of the Telenav Software in a secure manner in your vehicle so that they will not interfere with your driving and will not prevent the operation of any safety device (such as an airbag). TeleNav Software End User License Agreement Please read these terms and conditions carefully before you use the Telenav Software. Your use of the Telenav Software indicates that you accept these terms and conditions. If you do not accept these terms and conditions, do not break the seal of the package, launch, or otherwise use the Telenav Software. These terms and conditions represent the agreement (“Agreement”) between you and Telenav, Inc. (“Telenav”) with respect to the Telenav Software (including upgrades, modifications, or additions thereto) (collectively “Telenav Software”). All references herein to “you” and “your” means you, your employees, agents, and contractors, and any other entity on whose behalf you accept these terms and conditions, all of whom shall also be bound by this Agreement. Additionally, all of your account information, as well as other payment and personal information provided by you to Telenav (directly or through the use of the Telenav Software, is subject to Telenav’s privacy policy located at http://www.telenav.com. You agree to indemnify and hold Telenav harmless against all claims resulting from any dangerous or otherwise inappropriate use of the Telenav Software in any moving vehicle, including as a result of your failure to comply with the directions above. 422 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Appendices 2. Account Information or proprietary rights, rights of publicity or privacy or other rights of any party, (ii) violates any law, statute, ordinance or regulation, including but not limited to laws and regulations related to spamming, privacy, consumer and child protection, obscenity or defamation, or (iii) is harmful, threatening, abusive, harassing, tortuous, defamatory, vulgar, obscene, libelous, or otherwise objectionable; and (f) lease, rent out, or otherwise permit unauthorized access by third parties to the Telenav Software without advanced written permission of Telenav. You agree: (a) when registering the Telenav Software, to provide Telenav with true, accurate, current, and complete information about yourself, and (b) to inform Telenav promptly of any changes to such information, and to keep it true, accurate, current and complete. 3. Software License Subject to your compliance with the terms of this Agreement, Telenav hereby grants to you a personal, non-exclusive, non-transferable license (except as expressly permitted below in connection with your permanent transfer of the Telenav Software license), without the right to sublicense, to use the Telenav Software (in object code form only) in order to access and use the Telenav Software. This license shall terminate upon any termination or expiration of this Agreement. You agree that you will use the Telenav Software only for your personal business or leisure purposes, and not to provide commercial navigation services to other parties. 4. Disclaimers To the fullest extent permissible pursuant to applicable law, in no event will Telenav, its licensors and suppliers, or agents or employees of any of the foregoing, be liable for any decision made or action taken by you or anyone else in reliance on the information provided by the Telenav Software. Telenav also does not warrant the accuracy of the map or other data used for the Telenav Software. Such data may not always reflect reality due to, among other things, road closures, construction, weather, new roads and other changing conditions. You are responsible for the entire risk arising out of your use of the Telenav Software. For example but without limitation, you agree not to rely on the Telenav Software for critical navigation in areas where the well-being or survival of you or others is dependent on the accuracy of navigation, as the maps or functionality of the Telenav Software are not intended to support such high risk applications, especially in more remote geographical areas. 3.1 License Limitations You agree not to do any of the following: (a) reverse engineer, decompile, disassemble, translate, modify, alter or otherwise change the Telenav Software or any part thereof; (b) attempt to derive the source code, audio library or structure of the Telenav Software without the prior express written consent of Telenav; (c) remove from the Telenav Software, or alter, any of Telenav’s or its suppliers’ trademarks, trade names, logos, patent or copyright notices, or other notices or markings; (d) distribute, sublicense or otherwise transfer the Telenav Software to others, except as part of your permanent transfer of the Telenav Software; or (e) use the Telenav Software in any manner that (i) infringes the intellectual property TELENAV EXPRESSLY DISCLAIMS AND EXCLUDES ALL WARRANTIES IN CONNECTION WITH THE TELENAV SOFTWARE, WHETHER STATUTORY, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING ALL WARRANTIES WHICH MAY ARISE FROM 423 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Appendices STATES AND/OR JURISDICTIONS DO NOT ALLOW THE EXCLUSION OR LIMITATION OF INCIDENTAL OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES, SO THE ABOVE LIMITATIONS OR EXCLUSIONS MAY NOT APPLY TO YOU. COURSE OF DEALING, CUSTOM OR TRADE AND INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND NON-INFRINGEMENT OF THIRD PARTY RIGHTS WITH RESPECT TO THE TELENAV SOFTWARE. Certain jurisdictions do not permit the disclaimer of certain warranties, so this limitation may not apply to you. 6. Arbitration and Governing Law You agree that any dispute, claim or controversy arising out of or relating to this Agreement or the Telenav Software shall be settled by independent arbitration involving a neutral arbitrator and administered by the American Arbitration Association in the County of Santa Clara, California. The arbitrator shall apply the Commercial Arbitration Rules of the American Arbitration Association, and the judgment upon the award rendered by the arbitrator may be entered by any court having jurisdiction. Note that there is no judge or jury in an arbitration proceeding and the decision of the arbitrator shall be binding upon both parties. You expressly agree to waive your right to a jury trial. 5. Limitation of Liability TO THE EXTENT PERMITTED UNDER APPLICABLE LAW, UNDER NO CIRCUMSTANCES SHALL TELENAV OR ITS LICENSORS AND SUPPLIERS BE LIABLE TO YOU OR TO ANY THIRD PARTY FOR ANY INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, CONSEQUENTIAL, SPECIAL OR EXEMPLARY DAMAGES (INCLUDING IN EACH CASE, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, DAMAGES FOR THE INABILITY TO USE THE EQUIPMENT OR ACCESS DATA, LOSS OF DATA, LOSS OF BUSINESS, LOSS OF PROFITS, BUSINESS INTERRUPTION OR THE LIKE) ARISING OUT OF THE USE OF OR INABILITY TO USE THE TELENAV SOFTWARE, EVEN IF TELENAV HAS BEEN ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES. This Agreement and performance hereunder will be governed by and construed in accordance with the laws of the State of California, without giving effect to its conflict of laws provisions. To the extent judicial action is necessary in connection with the binding arbitration, both Telenav and you agree to submit to the exclusive jurisdiction of the courts of the County of Santa Clara, California. The United Nations Convention on Contracts for the International Sale of Goods shall not apply. NOTWITHSTANDING ANY DAMAGES THAT YOU MIGHT INCUR FOR ANY REASON WHATSOEVER (INCLUDING, WITHOUT LIMITATION, ALL DAMAGES REFERENCED HEREIN AND ALL DIRECT OR GENERAL DAMAGES IN CONTRACT, TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE) OR OTHERWISE), THE ENTIRE LIABILITY OF TELENAV AND OF ALL OF TELENAV’S SUPPLIERS SHALL BE LIMITED TO THE AMOUNT ACTUALLY PAID BY YOU FOR THE TELENAV SOFTWARE. SOME 7. Assignment You may not resell, assign, or transfer this Agreement or any of your rights or obligations, except in totality, in connection with your permanent transfer of the Telenav Software, and expressly conditioned upon the new user of the Telenav Software agreeing to be bound by 424 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Appendices the terms and conditions of this Agreement. Any such sale, assignment or transfer that is not expressly permitted under this paragraph will result in immediate termination of this Agreement, without liability to Telenav, in which case you and all other parties shall immediately cease all use of the Telenav Software. Notwithstanding the foregoing, Telenav may assign this Agreement to any other party at any time without notice, provided the assignee remains bound by this Agreement. Notices by posting them on Telenav’s Website or by downloading such Notices to your wireless device. If you desire to withdraw your consent to receive Notices electronically, you must discontinue your use of the Telenav Software. 8.4 Telenav’s or your failure to require performance of any provision shall not affect that party’s right to require performance at any time thereafter, nor shall a waiver of any breach or default of this Agreement constitute a waiver of any subsequent breach or default or a waiver of the provision itself. 8. Miscellaneous 8.1 This Agreement constitutes the entire agreement between Telenav and you with respect to the subject matter hereof. 8.5 If any provision herein is held unenforceable, then such provision will be modified to reflect the intention of the parties, and the remaining provisions of this Agreement will remain in full force and effect. 8.2 Except for the limited licenses expressly granted in this Agreement, Telenav retains all right, title and interest in and to the Telenav Software, including without limitation all related intellectual property rights. No licenses or other rights which are not expressly granted in this Agreement are intended to, or shall be, granted or conferred by implication, statute, inducement, estoppel or otherwise, and Telenav and its suppliers and licensors hereby reserve all of their respective rights other than the licenses explicitly granted in this Agreement. 8.6 The headings in this Agreement are for convenience of reference only, will not be deemed to be a part of this Agreement, and will not be referred to in connection with the construction or interpretation of this Agreement. As used in this Agreement, the words “include” and “including,” and variations thereof, will not be deemed to be terms of limitation, but rather will be deemed to be followed by the words “without limitation”. 8.3 By using the Telenav Software, you consent to receive from Telenav all communications, including notices, agreements, legally required disclosures or other information in connection with the Telenav Software (collectively, “Notices”) electronically. Telenav may provide such 9. Other Vendors Terms and Conditions The Telenav Software utilizes map and other data licensed to Telenav by third party vendors for the benefit of you and other end users. This Agreement includes end-user terms applicable to these companies (included at the end of this 425 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Appendices TERMS AND CONDITIONS Agreement), and thus your use of the Telenav Software is also subject to such terms. You agree to comply with the following additional terms and conditions, which are applicable to Telenav’s third party vendor licensors: License Limitations on Use: You agree that your license to use this Data is limited to and conditioned on use for solely personal, noncommercial purposes, and not for service bureau, timesharing or other similar purposes. Except as otherwise set forth herein, you agree not to otherwise reproduce, copy, modify, decompile, disassemble or reverse engineer any portion of this Data, and may not transfer or distribute it in any form, for any purpose, except to the extent permitted by mandatory laws. End User License Agreement For Distribution By HERE For North America/APAC The content provided (“Data”) is licensed, not sold. By opening this package, or installing, copying, or otherwise using the Data, you agree to be bound by the terms of this agreement. If you do not agree to the terms of this agreement, you are not permitted to install, copy, use, resell or transfer the Data. If you wish to reject the terms of this agreement, and have not installed, copied, or used the Data, you must contact your retailer or HERE North America, LLC (as defined below) within thirty (30) days of purchase for a refund of your purchase price. To contact HERE, please visit www.here.com. License Limitations on Transfer: Your limited license does not allow transfer or resale of the Data, except on the condition that you may transfer the Data and all accompanying materials on a permanent basis if: (a) you retain no copies of the Data; (b) the recipient agrees to the terms of this End-User License Agreement; and (c) you transfer the Data in the exact same form as you purchased it by physically transferring the original media (e.g., the CD-ROM or DVD you purchased), all original packaging, all Manuals and other documentation. Specifically, Multi-disc sets may only be transferred or sold as a complete set as provided to you and not as a subset thereof. The Data is provided for your personal, internal use only and may not be resold. It is protected by copyright, and is subject to the following terms (this “End User License Agreement”) and conditions which are agreed to by you, on the one hand, and HERE and its licensors (including their licensors and suppliers) on the other hand. For purposes of these terms, “HERE” shall mean (a) HERE North America, LLC with respect to Data for the Americas and/or the Asia Pacific region and (b) HERE Europe B.V. for Data for Europe, the Middle East and/or Africa. Additional License Limitations: Except where you have been specifically licensed to do so by HERE in a separate written agreement, and without limiting the preceding paragraph, your license is conditioned on use of the Data as prescribed in this agreement, and you may not (a) use this Data with any products, systems, or applications installed or otherwise connected to or in communication with vehicles capable of vehicle navigation, positioning, dispatch, The Data includes certain information and related content provided under license to HERE from third parties and is subject to the applicable supplier terms and copyright notices set forth at the following URL: http://corporate.navteq.com/supplier_terms.html. 426 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Appendices Disclaimer of Liability: real time route guidance, fleet management or similar applications; or (b) with, or in communication with, including without limitation, cellular phones, palmtop and handheld computers, pagers, and personal digital -assistants or PDAs. This Data is provided to you “as is”, and you agree to use it at your own risk. HERE and its licensors (and their licensors and suppliers) make no guarantees, representations or warranties of any kind, express or implied, arising by law or otherwise, including but not limited to, content, quality, accuracy, completeness, effectiveness, reliability, fitness for a particular purpose, usefulness, use or results to be obtained from this Data, or that the Data or server will be uninterrupted or error ¬free. HERE AND ITS LICENSORS (INCLUDING THEIR LICENSORS AND SUPPLIERS) SHALL NOT BE LIABLE TO YOU IN RESPECT OF ANY CLAIM, DEMAND OR ACTION, IRRESPECTIVE OF THE NATURE OF THE CAUSE OF THE CLAIM, DEMAND OR ACTION ALLEGING ANY LOSS, INJURY OR DAMAGES, DIRECT OR INDIRECT, WHICH MAY RESULT FROM THE USE OR POSSESSION OF THIS DATA; OR FOR ANY LOSS OF PROFIT, REVENUE, CONTRACTS OR SAVINGS, OR ANY OTHER DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES ARISING OUT OF YOUR USE OF OR INABILITY TO USE THIS DATA, ANY DEFECT IN THIS DATA, OR THE BREACH OF THESE TERMS OR CONDITIONS, WHETHER IN AN ACTION IN CONTRACT OR TORT OR BASED ON A WARRANTY, EVEN IF HERE OR ITS LICENSORS HAVE BEEN ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES. Some States, Territories and Countries do not allow certain liability exclusions or damages limitations, so to that extent the above may not apply to you. Disclaimer of Warranty: Export Control: HERE AND ITS LICENSORS (INCLUDING THEIR LICENSORS AND SUPPLIERS) DISCLAIM ANY WARRANTIES, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, OF QUALITY, PERFORMANCE, MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE OR NON-INFRINGEMENT. Some States, Territories and Countries do not allow certain warranty exclusions, so to that extent the above exclusion may not apply to you. You agree not to export from anywhere any part of the Data or any direct product thereof except in compliance with, and with all licenses and approvals required under, applicable export laws, rules and regulations, including but not limited to the laws, rules and regulations administered by the Office of Foreign Assets Control of the U.S. Department of Commerce and the Bureau of Industry and Security of the U.S. Department of Commerce. To the extent that any such export laws, rules or regulations prohibit HERE from complying with any of its obligations hereunder to deliver or distribute Data, such failure shall be excused and shall not constitute a breach of this Agreement. Note: This Data may contain inaccurate or incomplete information due to the passage of time, changing circum-stances, sources used and the nature of collecting comprehensive geographic Data, any of which may lead to incorrect results. No Warranty: 427 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Appendices Entire Agreement: Government End Users: These terms and conditions constitute the entire agreement between HERE (and its licensors, including their licensors and suppliers) and you pertaining to the subject matter hereof, and supersedes in their entirety any and all written or oral agreements previously existing between us with respect to such subject matter. If the Data is being acquired by or on behalf of the United States government or any other entity seeking or applying rights similar to those customarily claimed by the United States government, this Data is a “commercial item” as that term is defined at 48 C.F.R. (“FAR”) 2.101, is licensed in accordance with this End¬ User License Agreement, and each copy of Data delivered or otherwise furnished shall be marked and embedded as appropriate with the following “Notice of Use”, and be treated in accordance with such Notice: Severability: You and HERE agree that if any portion of this agreement is found illegal or unenforceable, that portion shall be severed and the remainder of the Agreement shall be given full force and effect. NOTICE OF USE CONTRACTOR (MANUFACTURER/SUPPLIER) Severability: NAME: You and HERE agree that if any portion of this agreement is found illegal or unenforceable, that portion shall be severed and the remainder of the Agreement shall be given full force and effect. HERE CONTRACTOR (MANUFACTURER/SUPPLIER) ADDRESS: 425 West Randolph Street, Chicago, IL 60606. Governing Law: This Data is a commercial item as defined in FAR 2.101 The above terms and conditions shall be governed by the laws of the State of Illinois (for Data for the Americas and/or the Asia Pacific region) or The Netherlands (for Data for Europe, the Middle East and Africa), without giving effect to (i) its conflict of laws provisions, or (ii) the United Nations Convention for Contracts for the International Sale of Goods, which is explicitly excluded. For any and all disputes, claims and actions arising from or in connection with the Data (“Claims”), you agree to submit to the personal jurisdiction of (a) the State of Illinois for Claims related to Data for the Americas and/or the Asia Pacific region provided to you hereunder, and (b) The Netherlands for Data for Europe, the Middle East and/or Africa provided to you hereunder. and is subject to the End User License Agreement under which this Data was provided. © 1987-2013 HERE. All rights reserved. If the Contracting Officer, federal government agency, or any federal official refuses to use the legend provided herein, the Contracting Officer, federal government agency, or any federal official must notify HERE prior to seeking additional or alternative rights in the Data. 428 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Appendices Gracenote® Copyright You agree that you will use the content from Gracenote ("Gracenote Content") , Gracenote Data, the Gracenote Software, and Gracenote Servers for your own personal, non-commercial use only. You agree not to assign, copy, transfer or transmit the Gracenote Content, Gracenote Software or any Gracenote Data (except in a Tag associated with a music file) to any third party. YOU AGREE NOT TO USE OR EXPLOIT GRACENOTE CONTENT, GRACENOTE DATA, THE GRACENOTE SOFTWARE, OR GRACENOTE SERVERS, EXCEPT AS EXPRESSLY PERMITTED HEREIN. CD and music-related data from Gracenote, Inc., copyright© 2000-2007 Gracenote. Gracenote Software, copyright © 2000-2007 Gracenote. This product and service may practice one or more of the following U.S. Patents #5,987,525, #6,061,680, #6,154,773, #6,161,132, #6,230,192, #6,230,207, #6.240,459, #6,330,593 and other patents issued or pending. Some services supplied under license from Open Globe, Inc. for U.S. Patent: #6,304,523. Gracenote and CDDB are registered trademarks of Gracenote. The Gracenote logo and logotype, and the "Powered by Gracenote™" logo are trademarks of Gracenote. You agree that your non-exclusive licenses to use the Gracenote Content, Gracenote Data, the Gracenote Software, and Gracenote Servers will terminate if you violate these restrictions. If your licenses terminate, you agree to cease any and all use of the Gracenote Content, Gracenote Data, the Gracenote Software, and Gracenote Servers. Gracenote, respectively, reserve all rights in Gracenote Data, the Gracenote Software, and the Gracenote Servers and Gracenote Content, including all ownership rights. Under no circumstances will either Gracenote become liable for any payment to you for any information that you provide, including any copyrighted material or music file information. You agree that Gracenote may enforce its respective rights, collectively or separately, under this agreement against you, directly in each company's own name. Gracenote® End User License Agreement (EULA) This device contains software from Gracenote, Inc. of 2000 Powell Street Emeryville, California 94608 ("Gracenote"). The software from Gracenote (the "Gracenote Software") enables this device to do disc and music file identification and obtain music-related information, including name, artist, track, and title information ("Gracenote Data") from online servers ("Gracenote Servers"), and to perform other functions. You may use Gracenote Data only by means of the intended End User functions of this device. This device may contain content belonging to Gracenote's providers. If so, all of the restrictions set forth herein with respect to Gracenote Data shall also apply to such content and such content providers shall be entitled to all of the benefits and protections set forth herein that are available to Gracenote. Gracenote uses a unique identifier to track queries for statistical purposes. The purpose of a randomly assigned numeric identifier is to allow Gracenote to count queries without knowing anything about who you are. For more information, see the web page at www.gracenote.com for the Gracenote Privacy Policy. 429 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Appendices THE GRACENOTE SOFTWARE, EACH ITEM OF GRACENOTE DATA AND THE GRACENOTE CONTENT ARE LICENSED TO YOU "AS IS". NEITHER GRACENOTE MAKES ANY REPRESENTATIONS OR WARRANTIES, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, REGARDING THE ACCURACY OF ANY GRACENOTE DATA FROM THE GRACENOTE SERVERS OR GRACENOTE CONTENT. GRACENOTE COLLECTIVELY AND SEPARATELY RESERVE THE RIGHT TO DELETE DATA AND/OR CONTENT FROM THE COMPANIES' RESPECTIVE SERVERS OR, IN THE CASE OF GRACENOTE, CHANGE DATA CATEGORIES FOR ANY CAUSE THAT GRACENOTE DEEMS SUFFICIENT. NO WARRANTY IS MADE THAT EITHER GRACENOTE CONTENT OR THE GRACENOTE SOFTWARE OR GRACENOTE SERVERS ARE ERROR-FREE OR THAT THE FUNCTIONING OF THE GRACENOTE SOFTWARE OR GRACENOTE SERVERS WILL BE UNINTERRUPTED. GRACENOTE IS NOT OBLIGATED TO PROVIDE YOU WITH ANY ENHANCED OR ADDITIONAL DATA TYPES THAT GRACENOTE MAY CHOOSE TO PROVIDE IN THE FUTURE AND IS FREE TO DISCONTINUE ITS ONLINE SERVICES AT ANY TIME. GRACENOTE DISCLAIM ALL WARRANTIES EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE, TITLE, AND NON-INFRINGEMENT. NEITHER GRACENOTE WARRANTS THE RESULTS THAT WILL BE OBTAINED BY YOUR USE OF THE GRACENOTE SOFTWARE OR ANY GRACENOTE SERVER. IN NO CASE WILL GRACENOTE BE LIABLE FOR ANY CONSEQUENTIAL OR INCIDENTAL DAMAGES OR FOR ANY LOST PROFITS OR LOST REVENUES FOR ANY REASON WHATSOEVER. Vehicle with SYNC only FCC ID: KMHSG1G1 IC: 1422A-SG1G1 Vehicle with SYNC and MyFord Touch or MyLincoln Touch FCC ID: KMHSYNCG2 IC: 1422A-SYNCG2 This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC Rules and with RSS-210 of Industry Canada. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) This device may not cause harmful interference, and (2) this device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation. WARNING Changes or modifications not expressively approved by the party responsible for compliance could void the user's authority to operate the equipment. The term "IC" before the radio certification number only signifies that Industry Canada technical specifications were met. The antenna used for this transmitter must not be co-located or operating in conjunction with any other antenna or transmitter. © Gracenote 2007. 430 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Extended Service Plan (ESP) That means you get: • Reliable, quality service at any Ford or Lincoln dealership • Repairs performed by factory trained technicians, using genuine parts PROTECT YOURSELF FROM THE RISING COST OF VEHICLE REPAIRS WITH A FORD EXTENDED SERVICE PLAN. SERVICE PLANS (U.S. Only) More than 32 million Ford owners have discovered the powerful protection of Ford Extended Service Plan. It is the only extended service plan backed by Ford Motor Company, and provides peace of mind protection beyond the New Vehicle Limited Warranty coverage. Rental Car Reimbursement 1st day Rental Benefit You take advantage of replacement transportation if your vehicle is at your authorized dealer for same day covered repairs. Ford ESP Can Quickly Pay for Itself One service bill – the cost of parts and labor – can easily exceed the price of your Ford Extended Service Plan. With Ford ESP you minimize your risk for unexpected repair bills and rising repair costs. Extended Rental Benefits Up to 1,000+ Covered Vehicle Components Roadside Assistance If your vehicle is kept overnight for covered repairs, you are eligible for rental car coverage, including bumper to bumper warranty repairs, and Field Service Actions. Exclusive 24/7 roadside assistance, including: There are four Extended Service Plans with different levels of coverage. Ask your authorized dealer for details. • 1. PremiumCARE - Our most comprehensive coverage. With over 1,000 covered components, this plan is so complete that we generally only discuss what’s not covered. 2. ExtraCARE - Covers 113 components, and includes many high-tech items. 3. BaseCARE - Covers 84 components. 4. PowertrainCARE - Covers 29 critical components. • • • Transferable Coverage If you sell your vehicle before your Ford Extended Service Plan coverage expires, you can transfer any remaining coverage to the new owner. Whenever you sell your vehicle, prospective buyers may have a higher degree of confidence that vehicle was properly maintained with Ford ESP, thereby improving resale value. Ford Extended Service Plan is honored by all authorized Ford dealers in the U.S. and Canada. It is the only extended service plan authorized and backed by Ford Motor Company. 431 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Towing, flat-tire change and battery jump starts Out of fuel and lock-out assistance. Travel expense reimbursement for lodging, meals and rental car. Destination assistance for taxi, shuttle, rental car coverage and emergency transportation. Extended Service Plan (ESP) SERVICE PLANS (CANADA ONLY) Avoid the Rising Cost of Properly Maintaining Your Vehicle! You can get more protection for your vehicle by purchasing a Ford Extended Service Plan. Ford Extended Service Plan is the only service contract backed by Ford Motor Company of Canada, Limited. Depending on the plan you purchase, Ford Extended Service Plan provides benefits such as: Ford Extended Service Plan also offers a Premium Maintenance Plan that covers all scheduled maintenance, and selected wear items. The coverage is prepaid, so you never have to worry about affording your vehicle’s maintenance. It covers regular checkups, routine inspections, preventive care and replacement of select items that require periodic attention for normal wear: • • • • • • • • • Windshield wiper blades. Spark plugs (except in California). The clutch disc. Brake pads and linings. Shock absorbers. Belts and hoses. Diesel exhaust fluid replenishment. • • There are several Ford Extended Service Plans available in various time, distance and deductible combinations. Each plan is tailored to fit your own driving needs, including reimbursement for towing and rental. When you purchase Ford Extended Service Plan, you receive added peace-of-mind protection throughout Canada and the United States, provided by a network of participating authorized Ford Motor Company dealers. Interest Free Finance Options Available Take advantage of our interest free installment payment plan. Just a 10% down payment will provide you with an affordable, no interest, no fee payment program allowing you all the security and benefits Ford ESP has to offer while paying over time. You are pre-approved with no credit checks, no hassles! To learn more, call our Ford ESP specialists at 800-367-3377. Note: Repairs performed outside of Canada and the United States are not eligible for Ford Extended Service Plan coverage. This information is subject to change. For more information, visit your local Ford of Canada dealer or www.ford.ca to find the Ford Extended Service Plan that is right for you. Ford ESP P.O. Box 8072 Royal Oak, MI 48068-0039 432 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Rental reimbursement. Coverage for certain maintenance and wear items. Protection against repair costs after your New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage expires. Roadside Assistance benefits. Scheduled Maintenance Genuine Ford and Motorcraft Replacement Parts GENERAL MAINTENANCE INFORMATION Dealerships stock Ford, Motorcraft and Ford-authorized branded re-manufactured replacement parts. These parts meet or exceed our specifications. Parts installed at your dealership carry a nationwide 12-month or 12000 mi (20,000 km) parts and labor limited warranty. Why Maintain Your Vehicle? Carefully following the maintenance schedule helps protect against major repair expenses resulting from neglect or inadequate maintenance and may help to increase the value of your vehicle when you sell or trade it. Keep all receipts for completed maintenance with your vehicle. If you do not use Ford authorized parts they may not meet our specifications and depending on the part, it could affect emissions compliance. We have established regular maintenance intervals for your vehicle based upon rigorous testing. It is important that you have your vehicle serviced at the correct times. These intervals serve two purposes; one is to maintain the reliability of your vehicle and the second is to keep the cost of owning your vehicle down. Convenience Many dealerships have extended evening and Saturday hours to make your service visit more convenient and they offer one stop shopping. They can perform any services that are required on your vehicle, from general maintenance to crash repairs. It is your responsibility to have all scheduled maintenance performed and to make sure that the materials used meet the specifications identified in this owner's manual. See Capacities and Specifications (page 265). Note: Not all dealers have extended hours or body shops. Please contact your dealer for details. Protecting Your Investment Failure to perform scheduled maintenance invalidates warranty coverage on parts affected by the lack of maintenance. Maintenance is an investment that pays dividends in the form of improved reliability, durability and resale value. To maintain the correct performance of your vehicle and its emission control systems, make sure you have scheduled maintenance performed at the designated intervals. Why Maintain Your Vehicle at Your Dealership? Factory-trained Technicians Service technicians participate in extensive factory-sponsored certification training to help them become experts on the operation of your vehicle. Ask your dealership about the training and certification their technicians have received. Vehicles with a 3.2L, 3.5L or 3.7L Engine Your vehicle is equipped with the Intelligent Oil-Life Monitor system, which displays a message in the information display at the correct oil change interval. This interval may be up to one year or 10000 mi (16,000 km). 433 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Scheduled Maintenance When the oil change message appears in the information display, it is time for an oil change. Make sure you perform the oil change within two weeks or 500 miles (800 kilometers) of the message appearing. Make sure you reset the Intelligent Oil-Life Monitor after each oil change. See Changing the Engine Oil and Oil Filter (page 205). Additives and Chemicals If your information display resets prematurely or becomes inoperative, you should perform the oil change interval at six months or 5000 mi (8,000 km) from your last oil change. Never exceed one year or 10000 mi (16,000 km) between oil change intervals. Oils, Fluids and Flushing This owner's manual and the Ford Workshop Manual list the recommended additives and chemicals for your vehicle. We do not recommend using chemicals or additives not approved by us as part of your vehicle’s normal maintenance. Please consult your warranty information. In many cases, fluid discoloration is a normal operating characteristic and, by itself, does not necessarily indicate a concern or that the fluid needs to be changed. However, a qualified expert, such as the factory-trained technicians at your dealership, should inspect discolored fluids that also show signs of overheating or foreign material contamination immediately. All Vehicles Your vehicle is very sophisticated and built with multiple, complex, performance systems. Every manufacturer develops these systems using different specifications and performance features. That is why it is important to rely upon your dealership to correctly diagnose and repair your vehicle. Make sure to change your vehicle’s oils and fluids at the specified intervals or in conjunction with a repair. Flushing is a viable way to change fluid for many vehicle sub-systems during scheduled maintenance. It is critical that systems are flushed only with new fluid that is the same as that required to fill and operate the system or using a Ford-approved flushing chemical. Ford Motor Company has recommended maintenance intervals for various parts and component systems based upon engineering testing. Ford Motor Company relies upon this testing to determine the most appropriate mileage for replacement of oils and fluids to protect your vehicle at the lowest overall cost to you and recommends against maintenance schedules that deviate from the scheduled maintenance information. Owner Checks and Services Make sure you perform the following basic maintenance checks and inspections every month or at six-month intervals. Check every month We strongly recommend the use of only genuine Ford, Motorcraft or Ford-authorized re-manufactured replacement parts engineered for your vehicle. Engine oil level. Function of all interior and exterior lights. Tires (including spare) for wear and correct pressure. Windshield washer fluid level. 434 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Scheduled Maintenance Multi-point inspection Check every six months Battery connections. Clean if necessary. Exterior lamps and hazard warning system operation. Body and door drain holes for obstructions. Clean if necessary. Fluid levels ; fill if necessary. * For oil and fluid leaks. Cooling system fluid level and coolant strength. Horn operation. Door weatherstrips for wear. Lubricate if necessary. Radiator, cooler, heater and A/C hoses. Suspension component for leaks or damage. Hinges, latches and outside locks for correct operation. Lubricate if necessary. Steering and linkage. Parking brake for correct operation. Tires (including spare) for wear and Safety belts and seat latches for wear and function. ** correct pressure . Windshield for cracks, chips or pits. Safety warning lamps (brake, ABS, airbag and safety belt) for operation. Washer spray and wiper operation. Washer spray and wiper operation. Clean or replace blades as necessary. * Brake, coolant recovery reservoir, automatic transmission, power steering (if equipped with hydraulic power assist steering) and window washer. Multi-point Inspection ** If your vehicle is equipped with a temporary mobility kit, check the tire sealant expiration Use By date on the canister. Replace as needed. In order to keep your vehicle running correctly, it is important to have the systems on your vehicle checked regularly. This can help identify potential issues and prevent major problems. We recommend having the following multi-point inspection performed at every scheduled maintenance interval to help make sure your vehicle keeps running correctly. Be sure to ask your dealership service advisor or technician about the multi-point vehicle inspection. It is a comprehensive way to perform a thorough inspection of your vehicle. Your checklist gives you immediate feedback on the overall condition of your vehicle. Multi-point inspection Accessory drive belt(s). Battery performance. Engine air filter. Exhaust system. 435 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Scheduled Maintenance important factors in its calculations, the monitor helps reduce the cost of owning your vehicle and reduces environmental waste at the same time. NORMAL SCHEDULED MAINTENANCE Intelligent Oil-Life Monitor® (Vehicles with a 3.2L, 3.5L and 3.7L Engine) The following table provides examples of vehicle use and its impact on oil change intervals. It is a guideline only. Actual oil change intervals depend on several factors and generally decrease with severity of use. Your vehicle is equipped with an Intelligent Oil-Life Monitor that determines when you should change the engine oil based on how your vehicle is used. By using several When to expect the oil change message Interval Vehicle use and example Normal 7500-10000 miles (12000-16000 km) Normal commuting with highway driving. No, or moderate, load or towing. Flat to moderately hilly roads. No extended idling. Severe 5000-7499 miles (8000-11999 km) 3000-4999 miles (4800-7999 km) Moderate to heavy load or towing. Mountainous or off-road conditions. Extended idling. Extended hot or cold operation. Extreme Maximum load or towing. Extreme hot or cold operation. 436 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Scheduled Maintenance Normal Maintenance Intervals 3.2L, 3.5L and 3.7L Engines At every oil change interval as indicated by the information display * ** Change engine oil and filter. Rotate tires, inspect tire wear and measure tread depth. Perform a multi-point inspection (recommended). Inspect the automatic transmission fluid level (if equipped with dipstick). Consult your dealer for requirements. Inspect the brake pads, shoes, rotors, drums, brake linings, hoses and parking brake. Inspect the engine cooling system strength and hoses. Inspect the exhaust system and heat shields. Inspect front axle and U-joints. Lubricate if equipped with grease fittings. Inspect the steering linkage, ball joints, suspension, tire-rod ends, driveshaft and Ujoints. Lubricate any areas with grease fittings. Diesel engine fill diesel exhaust fluid. Inspect the wheels and related components for abnormal noise, wear, looseness or drag. * Do not exceed one year or 10000 miles (16000 kilometers) between service intervals. ** Reset the Intelligent Oil-Life Monitor after engine oil and filter changes. Other maintenance items 1 Torque rear axle U-bolts to specification. Every 30000 miles (48000 2 Diesel engine replace fuel filter. km) Replace engine air filter. Every 45000 miles (70000 Change diesel foam air filter. km) At 100000 miles (160000 km) Change engine coolant. 437 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 3 Scheduled Maintenance Other maintenance items Every 100000 miles (160000 km) 1 Replace spark plugs. Inspect accessory drive belt(s). 4 Change automatic transmission fluid and filter. Every 150000 miles (240000 km) Change rear axle fluid. Replace accessory drive belt(s). 1 Perform these maintenance items within 3000 miles (4800 kilometers) of the last engine oil and filter change. Do not exceed the designated distance for the interval. 2 Replace early if indicated by per Water In Fuel warning lamp. See Warning Lamps and Indicators (page 75). 3 Initial replacement at six years or 100000 miles (160000 kilometers), then every three years or 50000 miles (80000 kilometers). 4 After initial inspection, inspect every other oil change until replaced. Perform the services shown in the following tables when specified or within 3000 miles (4800 kilometers) of the oil change required message appearing in the information display. • Example 1: The message appears at 28750 mi (46,270 km). Perform the 30000 mi (48,000 km) automatic transmission fluid replacement. • Example 2: The message does not appear, but the odometer reads 30000 mi (48,000 km) (for example, the Intelligent Oil-Life Monitor was reset at 25000 mi (40,000 km)). Perform the engine air filter replacement. SPECIAL OPERATING CONDITIONS SCHEDULED MAINTENANCE 3.2L, 3.5L and 3.7L Engines If you operate your vehicle primarily in any of the following conditions, you need to perform extra maintenance as indicated. If you operate your vehicle occasionally under any of these conditions, it is not necessary to perform the extra maintenance. For specific recommendations, see your dealership service advisor or technician. Towing a trailer or using a car-top carrier As required Change engine oil and filter as indicated by the information display and perform services listed in the Normal Scheduled Maintenance chart. Inspect frequently, service as required Inspect and lubricate U-joints. See axle maintenance items under Exceptions. 438 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Scheduled Maintenance Extensive idling or low-speed driving for long distances, as in heavy commercial use (such as delivery, taxi, patrol car or livery) As required Change engine oil and filter as indicated by the information display and perform services listed in the Normal Scheduled Maintenance chart. Inspect frequently, service as required Replace engine air filter. Every 60000 miles (96000 km) Replace spark plugs. Operating in dusty or sandy conditions (such as unpaved or dusty roads) Inspect frequently, service as required Replace engine air filter. Every 5000 miles (8000 Inspect the wheels and related components for abnormal km) noise, wear, looseness or drag. Rotate tires, inspect tires for wear and measure tread depth. Every 5000 miles (8000 Change engine oil and filter.* km) or six months * Reset your Intelligent Oil-Life Monitor after each engine oil and filter change. Off-road operation Inspect frequently, service as required Inspect steering linkage, ball joints and U-joints, Lubricate if equipped with grease fittings. Replace engine air filter. Every 5000 miles (8000 Change engine oil and filter.* km) or six months Inspect the wheels and related components for abnormal noise, wear, looseness or drag. Rotate tires, inspect tires for wear and measure tread depth. * Reset your Intelligent Oil-Life Monitor after each engine oil and filter change. 439 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Scheduled Maintenance Exclusive use of E85 (Flex fuel vehicles only) Every oil change interval If ran exclusively on E85, fill the fuel tank full with regular unleaded fuel. or equivalent. Add four ounces (118 milliliters) of additive friction modifier XL-3 EST-M2C118-A, or equivalent, for complete refill of Traction-Lok rear axles. Change the axle fluid anytime the axle submerges in water. Exceptions There are several exceptions to the Normal Schedule: Normal vehicle axle maintenance: Rear axles and power take-off units with synthetic fluid and light-duty trucks equipped with Ford-design axles are lubricated for life; do not check or change fluid unless a leak is suspected, service is required or the assembly has been submerged in water. During long periods of trailer towing with outside temperatures above 70°F (21°C) and at wide-open throttle for long periods above 45 mph (72 km/h), change non-synthetic rear axle fluid every 3000 mi (4,800 km) or three months, whichever comes first. This interval can be waived if the axle is filled with 75W140 synthetic gear fluid meeting Ford specification WSL-M2C192-A; GL-5 or equivalent. Add friction modifier XL-3 EST-M2C118-A or equivalent for complete refill of Traction-Lok rear axles. See Capacities and Specifications (page 265). California fuel filter replacement: If you register your vehicle in California, the California Air Resources Board has determined that the failure to perform this maintenance item does not nullify the emission warranty or limit recall liability before the completion of your vehicle's useful life. Ford Motor Company, however, urges you to have all recommended maintenance services performed at the specified intervals and to record all vehicle service. Hot climate oil change intervals: Vehicles operating in the Middle East, North Africa, Sub-Saharan Africa or locations with similar climates using an American Petroleum Institute (API) Certified for Gasoline Engines (Certification mark) oil of SM or SN quality, the normal oil change interval is 5000 mi (8,000 km). If the available API SM or SN oils are not available, then the oil change interval is 3000 mi (4,800 km). Police, Taxi and Livery vehicle axle maintenance: Change rear axle fluid every 100000 mi (160,000 km). Rear axle fluid change may be waived if the axle was filled with 75W140 synthetic gear fluid meeting Ford specification WSL-M2C192-A; GL-5 Engine air filter replacement: The life of the engine air filter is dependent on exposure to dusty and dirty conditions. Vehicles operated in these conditions require frequent inspection and replacement of the engine air filter. 440 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Scheduled Maintenance SCHEDULED MAINTENANCE RECORD Repair Order #: Dealer stamp Distance: Engine hours (optional): Multi-point inspection (recommended): Signature: E146852 Repair Order #: Dealer stamp Distance: Engine hours (optional): Multi-point inspection (recommended): Signature: E146852 441 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Scheduled Maintenance Repair Order #: Dealer stamp Distance: Engine hours (optional): Multi-point inspection (recommended): Signature: E146852 Repair Order #: Dealer stamp Distance: Engine hours (optional): Multi-point inspection (recommended): Signature: E146852 Repair Order #: Dealer stamp Distance: Engine hours (optional): Multi-point inspection (recommended): Signature: E146852 442 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Scheduled Maintenance Repair Order #: Dealer stamp Distance: Engine hours (optional): Multi-point inspection (recommended): Signature: E146852 Repair Order #: Dealer stamp Distance: Engine hours (optional): Multi-point inspection (recommended): Signature: E146852 Repair Order #: Dealer stamp Distance: Engine hours (optional): Multi-point inspection (recommended): Signature: E146852 443 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Scheduled Maintenance Repair Order #: Dealer stamp Distance: Engine hours (optional): Multi-point inspection (recommended): Signature: E146852 Repair Order #: Dealer stamp Distance: Engine hours (optional): Multi-point inspection (recommended): Signature: E146852 Repair Order #: Dealer stamp Distance: Engine hours (optional): Multi-point inspection (recommended): Signature: E146852 444 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Scheduled Maintenance Repair Order #: Dealer stamp Distance: Engine hours (optional): Multi-point inspection (recommended): Signature: E146852 Repair Order #: Dealer stamp Distance: Engine hours (optional): Multi-point inspection (recommended): Signature: E146852 Repair Order #: Dealer stamp Distance: Engine hours (optional): Multi-point inspection (recommended): Signature: E146852 445 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Scheduled Maintenance Repair Order #: Dealer stamp Distance: Engine hours (optional): Multi-point inspection (recommended): Signature: E146852 Repair Order #: Dealer stamp Distance: Engine hours (optional): Multi-point inspection (recommended): Signature: E146852 Repair Order #: Dealer stamp Distance: Engine hours (optional): Multi-point inspection (recommended): Signature: E146852 446 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Scheduled Maintenance Repair Order #: Dealer stamp Distance: Engine hours (optional): Multi-point inspection (recommended): Signature: E146852 Repair Order #: Dealer stamp Distance: Engine hours (optional): Multi-point inspection (recommended): Signature: E146852 Repair Order #: Dealer stamp Distance: Engine hours (optional): Multi-point inspection (recommended): Signature: E146852 447 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 448 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Index A Audio Control - Vehicles Without: Touchscreen Display...................................61 Seek, Next or Previous........................................62 A/C Audio Input Jack...........................................297 Audio System................................................282 See: Climate Control..........................................89 About This Manual...........................................7 General Information.........................................282 Protecting the Environment................................7 Audio Troubleshooting..............................299 Audio Unit - Vehicles With: AM/FM/CD/ SYNC/Satellite Radio.............................290 Audio Unit - Vehicles With: AM/FM/CD/ SYNC.............................................................288 Audio Unit - Vehicles With: AM/ FM...................................................................283 ABS See: Brakes............................................................137 ABS driving hints See: Hints on Driving With Anti-Lock Brakes.................................................................137 Accessories.....................................................414 Exterior Style........................................................414 Interior Style.........................................................414 Lifestyle..................................................................414 Peace of Mind......................................................414 AUX Button..........................................................286 Clock Button........................................................285 Menu Button.......................................................286 Sound Button.....................................................286 Station Preset Buttons....................................286 Station Tuning Buttons...................................285 Accessories See: Replacement Parts Recommendation............................................10 Audio Unit - Vehicles With: Premium AM/FM/CD.................................................286 Autolamps........................................................67 Adjusting the Headlamps..........................215 Horizontal Aim Adjustment............................216 Vertical Aim Adjustment..................................215 Windshield Wiper Activated Rain Lights....................................................................67 Adjusting the Steering Wheel....................61 Airbag Disposal...............................................43 Air Conditioning Automatic Transmission............................133 Brake-Shift Interlock.........................................135 Hints on Driving with an Automatic Transmission...................................................135 Understanding the Gearshift Lever Positions of the Automatic Transmission...................................................133 See: Climate Control..........................................89 Air Vents............................................................89 Center Air Vents....................................................89 Side Air Vent..........................................................90 Alarm See: Anti-Theft Alarm........................................60 Automatic Transmission Fluid Check............................................................209 Autowipers.......................................................64 Auxiliary Power Points................................103 Anti-Theft Alarm...........................................60 Alarm System.......................................................60 Arming the Alarm................................................60 Disarming the Alarm..........................................60 Triggering the Alarm...........................................60 AC Power Point...................................................103 Auxiliary Power Point Locations...................103 Appendices.....................................................416 Audible Warnings and Indicators..............77 Auxiliary Switches........................................415 Airbag Secondary Warning................................77 Door Ajar...................................................................77 Exterior Lamps On...............................................78 Gearshift Lever not in Park (P)........................78 Key in Ignition.........................................................78 Parking Brake On..................................................78 Safety Belt Minder...............................................78 B Bonnet Lock See: Opening and Closing the Hood.........200 Booster Seats..................................................22 Types of Booster Seats......................................22 Bottle Holder..................................................105 Brake Fluid Check.........................................210 Audio Control - Vehicles With: Touchscreen Display..................................62 449 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Index Brakes................................................................137 Changing the 12V Battery..........................213 General Information...........................................137 Installing the Battery.........................................214 Removing the Battery.......................................213 Breaking-In......................................................173 Bulb Specification Chart............................221 Changing the Engine Air Filter - 3.2L Power Stroke Diesel.................................225 Changing the Engine Air Filter 3.5L.................................................................223 Changing the Engine Air Filter 3.7L.................................................................224 Changing the Engine Oil and Oil Filter...............................................................205 C California Proposition 65.............................10 Capacities and Specifications - 3.2L Power Stroke Diesel.................................278 Capacities.............................................................278 Specifications......................................................279 Engine Lubrication for Severe Service Operation........................................................205 Resetting the Oil Life Monitoring System.............................................................206 Capacities and Specifications 3.5L..................................................................271 Capacities..............................................................271 Specifications......................................................272 Changing the Wiper Blades......................215 Capacities and Specifications 3.7L..................................................................274 Changing the Windshield Wiper Blades................................................................215 Capacities.............................................................274 Specifications......................................................276 Checking MyKey System Status..............50 Checking the Wiper Blades.......................215 Child Restraint and Safety Belt Maintenance.................................................32 Child Safety.......................................................13 Capacities and Specifications................265 Car Wash See: Cleaning the Exterior...............................227 Catalytic Converter.......................................116 General Information.............................................13 Driving with a Catalytic Converter.................116 Child Safety Locks..........................................25 Changing a Bulb............................................217 Left-Hand Side......................................................25 Right-Hand Side...................................................26 Central High Mounted Brake Lamp............220 Front Clearance Lamp......................................219 Headlamp..............................................................217 Interior Lamp.......................................................220 License Plate Lamp..........................................220 Reading Lamps....................................................221 Rear Lamps...........................................................219 Side Direction Indicator....................................219 Sun Visor Mirror Lamp.......................................221 Child Seat Positioning..................................24 Cigar Lighter...................................................104 Cleaning Products........................................227 Cleaning the Alloy Wheels.......................230 Cleaning the Engine....................................228 Cleaning the Exterior...................................227 Body Paintwork Preservation........................228 Cleaning the Chrome Trim..............................227 Cleaning the Headlamps.................................227 Cleaning the Rear Window.............................227 Changing a Fuse...........................................198 Changing a Road Wheel...........................256 Cleaning the Instrument Panel and Instrument Cluster Lens.........................229 Cleaning the Interior...................................229 Dissimilar Spare Wheel and Tire Assembly Information.....................................................256 Front Jacking Points...........................................261 Installing a Road Wheel..................................262 Locking Lug Nuts................................................257 Rear Jacking Points............................................261 Removing a Road Wheel................................262 Stowing the Wheel and Vehicle Jack.........263 Vehicle Jack.........................................................260 Vehicles With a Spare Wheel........................257 Instrument Cluster Screens, LCD Screens and Radio Screens.......................................229 Rear Windows.....................................................229 Safety Belts..........................................................229 Cleaning the Windows and Wiper Blades...........................................................229 Clearing All MyKeys.......................................48 450 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Index Climate Control..............................................89 Emission Control System...........................122 Principle of Operation........................................89 Diesel Exhaust System: Oxidation Catalyst And Diesel Particulate Filter System ..............................................................................124 Noise Emissions Warranty, Prohibited Tampering Acts and Maintenance..........132 On-Board Diagnostics (OBD-II)....................123 Readiness for Inspection/Maintenance (I/M) Testing....................................................124 Tampering With a Noise Control System................................................................131 Cold Weather Precautions.........................174 Coolant Check See: Engine Coolant Check...........................206 Crash Sensors and Airbag Indicator........42 Creating a MyKey............................................47 Programming/Changing Configurable Settings...............................................................48 Cruise Control..................................................63 Principle of Operation.......................................147 Cruise control End User License Agreement..................416 See: Using Cruise Control................................147 SYNC End User License Agreement (EULA)...............................................................416 Cup Holders....................................................105 Customer Assistance...................................181 Engine Block Heater....................................109 D Engine Coolant Check...............................206 Using the Engine Block Heater.......................110 Adding Engine Coolant...................................206 Checking the Engine Coolant.......................206 Recycled Engine Coolant................................207 Severe Climates.................................................208 What You Should Know About Fail-Safe Cooling.............................................................208 Data Recording..................................................9 Daytime Running Lamps............................68 Diesel Particulate Filter..............................108 Regeneration........................................................109 Digital Radio..................................................292 Engine Immobilizer HD Radio Reception and Station Troubleshooting............................................293 See: Passive Anti-Theft System.....................59 Direction Indicators.......................................69 DPF Engine Oil Check..........................................204 See: Diesel Particulate Filter..........................108 Engine Oil Dipstick - 3.2L Power Stroke Diesel............................................................204 Engine Oil Dipstick - 3.5L.........................204 Engine Oil Dipstick - 3.7L..........................204 Engine Specifications - 3.2L Power Stroke Diesel..............................................266 Adding Engine Oil..............................................205 Draining the Fuel Filter Water Trap........210 Changing the Fuel Filter....................................211 Purging Air From the Fuel System................212 Driver Alert......................................................149 Principle of Operation.......................................149 Using Driver Alert................................................149 Drivebelt Routing...............................................266 Driver and Passenger Airbags...................34 Engine Specifications - 3.5L....................265 Children and Airbags..........................................39 Passenger Airbag On and Off Switch ..........34 Proper Driver and Front Passenger Seating Adjustment........................................................39 Drivebelt Routing...............................................265 Engine Specifications - 3.7L....................265 Drivebelt Routing...............................................266 Entertainment..............................................368 Driving Aids.....................................................149 Driving Hints....................................................173 Driving Through Water................................174 DRL A/V Inputs............................................................386 AM/FM Radio......................................................370 Bluetooth Audio.................................................385 Browsing Device Content...............................369 SD Card Slot and USB Port............................381 SIRIUS® Satellite Radio (If Activated)........................................................376 Supported Media Players, Formats and Metadata Information................................385 See: Daytime Running Lamps........................68 E Economical Driving.......................................173 451 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Index Essential Towing Checks...........................164 Fuel Quality - Gasoline................................112 Before Towing a Trailer.....................................169 Launching or Retrieving a Boat or Personal Water Craft (PWC)........................................170 Safety Chains.......................................................165 Tow Hitch...............................................................165 Trailer Brakes........................................................165 Trailer Lamps.......................................................169 Trailer Towing Connector................................164 When Towing a Trailer......................................169 Choosing the Right Fuel With a Flex Fuel Vehicle (If Equipped).....................................112 Choosing the Right Fuel Without a Flex Fuel Vehicle (If Equipped).....................................112 Octane Recommendations.............................112 Fuel Shutoff.....................................................177 Fuse Box Locations......................................187 See: Data Recording..............................................9 Body Control Module Fuse Box.....................187 Engine Compartment Fuse Box....................187 Passenger Compartment Fuse Box.............187 Pre-fuse Box.........................................................187 Export Unique Options...................................11 Extended Service Plan (ESP)..................431 Fuses.................................................................187 Fuse Specification Chart...........................188 SERVICE PLANS (CANADA ONLY)............432 SERVICE PLANS (U.S. Only)..........................431 Body Control Module.........................................197 Engine Compartment Fuse Box...................188 Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel.........192 Pre-fuse Box.........................................................195 Event Data Recording Exterior Mirrors..................................................71 Fold-Away Exterior Mirrors.................................71 Power Exterior Mirrors..........................................71 G F Gauges................................................................73 Fastening the Safety Belts.........................28 Engine Coolant Temperature Gauge.............73 Fuel Gauge..............................................................74 Information Display.............................................73 Tripmeter Reset and Distance to Empty...................................................................74 Safety Belt Extension Assembly....................30 Safety Belt Locking Modes...............................29 Using Safety Belts During Pregnancy...........28 Floor Mats........................................................174 Ford Credit.........................................................10 General Information on Radio Frequencies...................................................44 General Maintenance Information........433 (U.S. Only)...............................................................10 Fuel and Refueling.........................................111 Fuel Consumption........................................122 Multi-point Inspection.....................................435 Owner Checks and Services..........................434 Protecting Your Investment...........................433 Why Maintain Your Vehicle?..........................433 Why Maintain Your Vehicle at Your Dealership?.....................................................433 Calculating Fuel Economy...............................122 Filling the Fuel Tank...........................................122 Fuel Filter - Gasoline....................................212 Fuel Quality - Diesel......................................113 Biodiesel..................................................................114 Diesel Fuel Additives .........................................115 Fuel Requirements - Choosing The Right Fuel: Vehicles Operated Where Ultra-Low Sulfur Diesel Fuel Is Not Required ............................................................113 Fuel Requirements - Choosing the Right Fuel: Vehicles Operated Where Ultra-Low Sulfur Diesel Fuel is Required (United States/Canada/Puerto Rico/U.S. Virgin Islands and Other Locales)............113 Getting Assistance Outside the U.S. and Canada..........................................................184 Getting the Services You Need.................181 Away From Home................................................181 H Handbrake See: Parking Brake.............................................138 Hazard Warning Flashers...........................177 452 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Index Head Restraints..............................................95 Installing Child Seats.....................................14 Adjusting the Head Restraint..........................96 Installing the Head Restraint ..........................96 Removing the Head Restraint.........................96 Child Seats...............................................................14 Using Lap and Shoulder Belts..........................15 Using Lower Anchors and Tethers for Children (LATCH)..............................................17 Using Tether Straps..............................................19 Heated Windows and Mirrors....................93 Heated Exterior Mirrors......................................93 Heated Rear Window.........................................93 See: Climate Control..........................................89 Instrument Cluster.........................................73 Instrument Lighting Dimmer.....................68 Interior Lamps.................................................69 Hints on Controlling the Interior Climate.............................................................91 Courtesy Lamp.....................................................69 Reading Lamps.....................................................69 Cooling the Interior Quickly...............................91 General Hints..........................................................91 Heating the Interior Quickly...............................91 Maximum Cooling Performance in Instrument Panel or Instrument Panel and Footwell Positions.................................92 Recommended Settings for Cooling ...........92 Recommended Settings for Heating.............91 Side Window Defogging in Cold Weather..............................................................92 Vehicle Stationary for Extended Periods During Extreme High Ambient Temperatures...................................................92 Interior Mirror.....................................................71 Heating Auto-Dimming Mirror...........................................71 Introduction.........................................................7 J Jump Starting the Vehicle.........................178 Connecting the Jumper Cables.....................179 Jump Starting.......................................................179 Preparing Your Vehicle......................................178 Removing the Jumper Cables........................179 K Hints on Driving With Anti-Lock Brakes.............................................................137 Hood Lock Keys and Remote Controls.........................44 Principle of Operation........................................44 See: Opening and Closing the Hood.........200 L I Lane Keeping System.................................150 Ignition Switch..............................................106 In California (U.S. Only).............................182 Information Display Control.......................63 Information Displays.....................................79 Lane Keeping Alert............................................150 Lighting Control..............................................66 Headlamp Flasher................................................67 High Beams............................................................66 Lighting Control Positions................................66 Parking Lamps.......................................................67 General Information............................................79 Information....................................................395 Lighting..............................................................66 911 Assist...............................................................401 Alerts.......................................................................401 Calendar................................................................401 Sirius Travel Link................................................398 SYNC Services (If Equipped, United States Only)..................................................................395 Vehicle Health Report.....................................403 Load Retaining Fixtures..............................153 Information Messages.................................84 Securing Cargo....................................................153 General Information...........................................66 Load Carrying.................................................153 Load Limit........................................................153 Vehicle Loading - with and without a Trailer..................................................................153 453 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Index N Locking and Unlocking.................................54 Automatic Locking...............................................57 Automatic Re-Locking........................................57 Automatic Unlocking...........................................57 Configurable Unlocking.....................................58 Locking.....................................................................54 Locking and Unlocking Confirmation...........54 Locking and Unlocking the Doors From Inside....................................................................54 One-Stage Unlocking.........................................58 Opening and Closing the Double Rear Doors....................................................................55 Opening and Closing the Sliding Door.........55 Rear Emergency Exit............................................57 Two-Stage Unlocking.........................................58 Unlocking................................................................54 Zone Re-Locking..................................................58 Navigation.....................................................404 cityseekr...............................................................406 Map Mode............................................................409 Navigation Map Updates..................................411 Navigation Voice Commands.........................411 Point of Interest (POI) Categories..............406 Quick-touch Buttons........................................410 Setting a Destination.......................................405 Setting Your Navigation Preferences.........407 Normal Scheduled Maintenance..........436 Intelligent Oil-Life Monitor® (Vehicles with a 3.2L, 3.5L and 3.7L Engine)....................436 Normal Maintenance Intervals.....................437 O Locks...................................................................54 Lug Nuts Oil Check See: Changing a Road Wheel.......................256 See: Engine Oil Check......................................204 M Opening and Closing the Hood.............200 Maintenance.................................................200 General Information.........................................200 Ordering Additional Owner's Literature......................................................185 Manual Climate Control..............................90 Manual Seats...................................................97 Overhead Console.......................................105 Closing the Hood................................................201 Opening the Hood............................................200 Obtaining a French Owner’s Manual..........185 Adjusting the Armrest........................................98 Adjusting the Lumbar Support........................97 Moving the Seat Backward or Forward...............................................................97 Recline Adjustment.............................................97 Overhead Storage Compartments..............105 P Parking Aid......................................................143 Media Hub......................................................298 Message Center Switching the Parking Aid System Off.......................................................................144 See: Information Displays.................................79 Parking Aids....................................................143 Mirrors Principle of Operation.......................................143 See: Heated Windows and Mirrors................93 See: Windows and Mirrors................................70 Parking Brake.................................................138 Mobile Communications Equipment........11 Motorcraft Parts - 3.2L Power Stroke Diesel............................................................269 Motorcraft Parts - 3.5L...............................267 Motorcraft Parts - 3.7L..............................268 MyFord Touch™...........................................349 Passive Anti-Theft System.........................59 General Information.........................................349 Measure Units........................................................83 Switching Chimes Off or On............................83 Center Parking Brake.........................................138 SecuriLock®...........................................................59 PATS See: Passive Anti-Theft System.....................59 Perchlorate........................................................10 Personalized Settings..................................83 MyKey Troubleshooting...............................52 MyKey™.............................................................47 Principle of Operation.........................................47 454 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Index Phone...............................................................387 Remote Control..............................................44 Making Calls........................................................389 Pairing Subsequent Cell Phones.................389 Pairing Your Cell Phone for the First Time..................................................................388 Phone Menu Options.......................................390 Phone Settings...................................................393 Phone Voice Commands................................394 Receiving Calls...................................................390 Text Messaging....................................................391 Car Finder................................................................45 Integrated Key head Transmitter...................44 Programming a New Remote Control..........45 Replacing the Battery.........................................45 Sounding a Panic Alarm....................................46 Removing a Headlamp...............................216 Repairing Minor Paint Damage..............230 Replacement Parts Recommendation........................................10 Post-Crash Alert System...........................180 Power Door Locks Collision Repairs.....................................................11 Scheduled Maintenance and Mechanical Repairs...................................................................11 Warranty on Replacement Parts......................11 See: Locking and Unlocking.............................54 Power Seats.....................................................98 Replacing a Lost Key or Remote Control............................................................46 Reporting Safety Defects (Canada Only)..............................................................186 Reporting Safety Defects (U.S. Only)...............................................................185 Roadside Assistance...................................176 Power Lumbar......................................................99 Power Steering Fluid Check.....................210 Adding Power Steering Fluid..........................210 Power Windows..............................................70 Accessory Delay....................................................70 Bounce-Back.........................................................70 Driver Side One-Touch Down..........................70 Driver Side One-Touch Up................................70 Vehicles Sold in Canada: Getting Roadside Assistance.........................................................176 Vehicles Sold in Canada: Using Roadside Assistance.........................................................176 Vehicles Sold in the United States: Getting Roadside Assistance....................................176 Vehicles Sold in the United States: Using Roadside Assistance....................................176 R Rear Passenger Climate Controls............93 Rear Quarter Windows.................................72 Closing the Rear Windows................................72 Opening the Rear Windows..............................72 Rear Seats........................................................99 Roadside Emergencies...............................176 Running-In Installing the Seats.............................................101 Recline Adjustment...........................................100 Removing Seats, 12 & 15 Passenger Vehicles.............................................................100 See: Breaking-In...................................................173 Running Out of Fuel......................................115 Adding Fuel From a Portable Fuel Container...........................................................115 Filling a Portable Fuel Container...................115 Rear View Camera.......................................144 Switching the Rear View Camera Off.........146 Switching the Rear View Camera On..........145 Using the Display................................................145 Vehicles with Parking Aid................................146 S Rear View Camera Safety Belt Height Adjustment................30 Safety Belt Minder..........................................31 See: Rear View Camera....................................144 Recommended Towing Weights............162 Belt-Minder®..........................................................31 Calculating the Maximum Loaded Trailer Weight for Your Vehicle...............................164 Safety Belts.......................................................27 Reduced Engine Performance.................173 Refueling..........................................................120 Safety Belt Warning Lamp and Indicator Chime..............................................................30 Principle of Operation.........................................27 Conditions of operation......................................31 Safety Canopy™.............................................41 455 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Index Starting a Diesel Engine.............................107 Safety Precautions.........................................111 Satellite Radio..............................................294 Cold Weather Operation.................................108 Engine Glow Plugs..............................................107 Failure to Start....................................................108 Starting a Cold or Hot Engine........................108 Satellite Radio Electronic Serial Number (ESN)................................................................295 Satellite Radio Reception Factors..............295 SIRIUS® Satellite Radio Service..................295 Troubleshooting.................................................296 Starting a Gasoline Engine.......................106 Before starting the engine check the following:..........................................................106 Cold or Hot Engine.............................................107 Engine Idle Speed after Starting...................107 Flooded Engine....................................................107 Scheduled Maintenance Record............441 Scheduled Maintenance...........................433 Seats...................................................................95 Security..............................................................59 Selective Catalytic Reduction System............................................................117 Starting and Stopping the Engine.........106 General Information..........................................106 Approximate Diesel Exhaust Fluid Usage..................................................................119 Contaminated Diesel Exhaust Fluid or Inoperative Selective Catalytic Reduction System................................................................119 Diesel Exhaust Fluid Guidelines.....................119 Diesel Exhaust Fluid Level................................117 Steering Wheel................................................61 Storage Compartments.............................105 Supplementary Restraints System.........33 Settings............................................................357 Symbols Glossary.............................................7 SYNC™ Applications and Services........................................................320 Principle of Operation - Canada/United States of America............................................33 Switching Off the Engine..........................109 Vehicles With a Turbocharger.......................109 Clock.......................................................................358 Display...................................................................358 Settings..................................................................361 Sound.....................................................................359 Vehicle...................................................................360 Side Airbags.....................................................40 Sitting in the Correct Position...................95 Snow Chains 911 Assist...............................................................320 SYNC Mobile Apps............................................328 SYNC Services: Traffic, Directions & Information (TDI) (If Equipped, United States Only)....................................................324 Vehicle Health Report......................................323 See: Using Snow Chains..................................251 SYNC™...........................................................300 Special Notices.................................................11 Special Operating Conditions Scheduled Maintenance..............................................438 SYNC™ Troubleshooting.........................342 General Information........................................300 T 3.2L, 3.5L and 3.7L Engines............................438 Exceptions...........................................................440 Speed Control Technical Specifications See: Cruise Control.............................................147 See: Capacities and Specifications............265 Speed Limiter.................................................149 The Better Business Bureau (BBB) Auto Line Program (U.S. Only)........................183 Engine Speed Limiter........................................149 Vehicle Speed Limiter - Fixed........................149 Stability Control.............................................141 Principle of Operation........................................141 Starter Switch See: Ignition Switch...........................................106 456 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Index Tire Care..........................................................234 Trip Computer.................................................82 Glossary of Tire Terminology.........................235 Inflating the Tires...............................................243 Information About Uniform Tire Quality Grades...............................................................234 Information Contained on the Tire Sidewall............................................................236 Inspecting the Tires and Wheel Valve Stems................................................................245 Location of the Tire Label...............................243 Tire Age.................................................................246 Tire and Wheel Alignment.............................249 Tire Damage........................................................246 Tire Pressure Monitoring System................248 Tire Replacement Requirements.................247 Tire Rotation........................................................249 Tire Safety Practices........................................248 Tire Wear...............................................................246 United States Department of Transportation Tire Quality Grades...............................................................234 All Values.................................................................82 Average Fuel Consumption..............................82 Distance to Empty...............................................83 Outside Air Temperature...................................83 Resetting the Trip Computer...........................82 Trip Odometer.......................................................83 Trip Timer................................................................83 U Under Hood Overview - 3.2L Power Stroke Diesel..............................................203 Under Hood Overview - 3.5L....................201 Under Hood Overview - 3.7L...................202 USB Port..........................................................297 Using Cruise Control....................................147 Switching Cruise Control Off.........................148 Switching Cruise Control On...........................147 Using MyKey With Remote Start Systems...........................................................51 Tire Pressure Monitoring System............251 Vehicles With Ford-Approved Aftermarket Remote Start Systems...................................51 Vehicles With Non-Ford-Approved Aftermarket Remote Start Systems.........51 Changing Tires With a Tire Pressure Monitoring System.......................................252 Tire Pressure Monitoring System Reset Procedure........................................................254 Understanding the Tire Pressure Monitoring System .............................................................253 Using Snow Chains......................................251 Using Stability Control................................142 AdvanceTrac® with Roll Stability Control™ (RSC®)..............................................................142 Tires Using SYNC™ With Your Media Player.............................................................332 See: Wheels and Tires......................................233 Towing a Trailer..............................................161 Load Placement...................................................161 Accessing Your Play Menu..............................337 Connecting Your Digital Media Player to the USB Port...........................................................332 Media Menu Features......................................336 Media Voice Commands.................................334 System Settings.................................................339 What's Playing?.................................................333 Towing the Vehicle on Four Wheels........171 Emergency Towing..............................................171 Recreational Vehicle Towing ...........................171 Towing...............................................................161 Traction Control............................................139 Principle of Operation.......................................139 Trailer Sway Control....................................162 Transmission Code Designation..............271 Transmission..................................................133 Transmission See: Transmission...............................................133 Transporting the Vehicle............................170 457 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014 Index W Using SYNC™ With Your Phone............305 Accessing Features Through the Phone Menu...................................................................312 Accessing Your Phone Settings....................316 Making a Call........................................................310 Pairing a Cell Phone for the First Time..................................................................305 Pairing Subsequent Cell Phones.................307 Phone Options during an Active Call...........311 Receiving Calls......................................................311 System Settings..................................................318 Text Messaging....................................................314 Warning Lamps and Indicators.................75 Anti-Lock Brake System....................................75 Battery......................................................................75 Brake System.........................................................75 Diesel Warning Lamps........................................75 Direction Indicator................................................76 Door Ajar..................................................................76 Engine Coolant Temperature...........................76 Engine Warning Lamps......................................76 Front Airbag............................................................76 High Beam...............................................................76 Lane Departure.....................................................76 Low Fuel Level........................................................77 Low Tire Pressure Warning................................77 Message Center Warning...................................77 Oil Pressure.............................................................77 Park Lamp................................................................77 Safety Belt Minder................................................77 Stability Control.....................................................77 Transmission Tow/Haul......................................77 Using Traction Control................................139 Using Voice Recognition...........................302 Initiating a Voice Session................................302 System Interaction and Feedback..............303 Using Winter Tires.......................................250 Utilizing the Mediation/Arbitration Program (Canada Only).........................183 V Vehicle Care....................................................227 Vehicle Certification Label.......................270 Vehicle Identification Number................270 Vehicle Storage..............................................231 Washer Fluid Check.....................................210 Washers Battery....................................................................232 Body.........................................................................231 Brakes.....................................................................232 Cooling system...................................................232 Engine......................................................................231 Fuel system...........................................................231 General...................................................................231 Miscellaneous.....................................................232 Removing Vehicle From Storage..................232 Tires.........................................................................232 Waxing.............................................................228 Wheel Nuts See: Cleaning the Exterior...............................227 See: Wipers and Washers.................................64 See: Changing a Road Wheel.......................256 Wheels and Tires.........................................233 General Information..........................................233 Technical Specifications.................................264 Windows and Mirrors....................................70 Windshield Washers.....................................65 Windshield Wipers........................................64 Intermittent Wipe................................................64 Ventilation Winter Tires See: Climate Control..........................................89 See: Using Winter Tires...................................250 Vents Wipers and Washers.....................................64 See: Air Vents........................................................89 VIN See: Vehicle Identification Number............270 Voice Control - Vehicles With: Touchscreen Display..................................62 MyFord Touch® Controls..................................63 Voice Control - Vehicles Without: Touchscreen Display..................................62 458 Transit (TTH) Canada/United States of America, enUSA, Edition date: 03/2014